Home | History | Annotate | Line # | Download | only in bfd
elf.c revision 1.1.1.8
      1      1.1     skrll /* ELF executable support for BFD.
      2      1.1     skrll 
      3  1.1.1.7  christos    Copyright (C) 1993-2018 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
      4      1.1     skrll 
      5      1.1     skrll    This file is part of BFD, the Binary File Descriptor library.
      6      1.1     skrll 
      7      1.1     skrll    This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
      8      1.1     skrll    it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
      9      1.1     skrll    the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
     10      1.1     skrll    (at your option) any later version.
     11      1.1     skrll 
     12      1.1     skrll    This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
     13      1.1     skrll    but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
     14      1.1     skrll    MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
     15      1.1     skrll    GNU General Public License for more details.
     16      1.1     skrll 
     17      1.1     skrll    You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
     18      1.1     skrll    along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
     19      1.1     skrll    Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street - Fifth Floor, Boston,
     20      1.1     skrll    MA 02110-1301, USA.  */
     21      1.1     skrll 
     22      1.1     skrll 
     23      1.1     skrll /*
     24      1.1     skrll SECTION
     25      1.1     skrll 	ELF backends
     26      1.1     skrll 
     27      1.1     skrll 	BFD support for ELF formats is being worked on.
     28      1.1     skrll 	Currently, the best supported back ends are for sparc and i386
     29      1.1     skrll 	(running svr4 or Solaris 2).
     30      1.1     skrll 
     31      1.1     skrll 	Documentation of the internals of the support code still needs
     32      1.1     skrll 	to be written.  The code is changing quickly enough that we
     33      1.1     skrll 	haven't bothered yet.  */
     34      1.1     skrll 
     35      1.1     skrll /* For sparc64-cross-sparc32.  */
     36      1.1     skrll #define _SYSCALL32
     37      1.1     skrll #include "sysdep.h"
     38      1.1     skrll #include "bfd.h"
     39      1.1     skrll #include "bfdlink.h"
     40      1.1     skrll #include "libbfd.h"
     41      1.1     skrll #define ARCH_SIZE 0
     42      1.1     skrll #include "elf-bfd.h"
     43      1.1     skrll #include "libiberty.h"
     44      1.1     skrll #include "safe-ctype.h"
     45  1.1.1.6  christos #include "elf-linux-core.h"
     46      1.1     skrll 
     47  1.1.1.3  christos #ifdef CORE_HEADER
     48  1.1.1.3  christos #include CORE_HEADER
     49  1.1.1.3  christos #endif
     50  1.1.1.3  christos 
     51      1.1     skrll static int elf_sort_sections (const void *, const void *);
     52      1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean assign_file_positions_except_relocs (bfd *, struct bfd_link_info *);
     53      1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean prep_headers (bfd *);
     54  1.1.1.5  christos static bfd_boolean swap_out_syms (bfd *, struct elf_strtab_hash **, int) ;
     55  1.1.1.7  christos static bfd_boolean elf_read_notes (bfd *, file_ptr, bfd_size_type,
     56  1.1.1.7  christos 				   size_t align) ;
     57      1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean elf_parse_notes (bfd *abfd, char *buf, size_t size,
     58  1.1.1.7  christos 				    file_ptr offset, size_t align);
     59      1.1     skrll 
     60      1.1     skrll /* Swap version information in and out.  The version information is
     61      1.1     skrll    currently size independent.  If that ever changes, this code will
     62      1.1     skrll    need to move into elfcode.h.  */
     63      1.1     skrll 
     64      1.1     skrll /* Swap in a Verdef structure.  */
     65      1.1     skrll 
     66      1.1     skrll void
     67      1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_in (bfd *abfd,
     68      1.1     skrll 			 const Elf_External_Verdef *src,
     69      1.1     skrll 			 Elf_Internal_Verdef *dst)
     70      1.1     skrll {
     71      1.1     skrll   dst->vd_version = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vd_version);
     72      1.1     skrll   dst->vd_flags   = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vd_flags);
     73      1.1     skrll   dst->vd_ndx     = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vd_ndx);
     74      1.1     skrll   dst->vd_cnt     = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vd_cnt);
     75      1.1     skrll   dst->vd_hash    = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vd_hash);
     76      1.1     skrll   dst->vd_aux     = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vd_aux);
     77      1.1     skrll   dst->vd_next    = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vd_next);
     78      1.1     skrll }
     79      1.1     skrll 
     80      1.1     skrll /* Swap out a Verdef structure.  */
     81      1.1     skrll 
     82      1.1     skrll void
     83      1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_out (bfd *abfd,
     84      1.1     skrll 			  const Elf_Internal_Verdef *src,
     85      1.1     skrll 			  Elf_External_Verdef *dst)
     86      1.1     skrll {
     87      1.1     skrll   H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vd_version, dst->vd_version);
     88      1.1     skrll   H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vd_flags, dst->vd_flags);
     89      1.1     skrll   H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vd_ndx, dst->vd_ndx);
     90      1.1     skrll   H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vd_cnt, dst->vd_cnt);
     91      1.1     skrll   H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vd_hash, dst->vd_hash);
     92      1.1     skrll   H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vd_aux, dst->vd_aux);
     93      1.1     skrll   H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vd_next, dst->vd_next);
     94      1.1     skrll }
     95      1.1     skrll 
     96      1.1     skrll /* Swap in a Verdaux structure.  */
     97      1.1     skrll 
     98      1.1     skrll void
     99      1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_swap_verdaux_in (bfd *abfd,
    100      1.1     skrll 			  const Elf_External_Verdaux *src,
    101      1.1     skrll 			  Elf_Internal_Verdaux *dst)
    102      1.1     skrll {
    103      1.1     skrll   dst->vda_name = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vda_name);
    104      1.1     skrll   dst->vda_next = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vda_next);
    105      1.1     skrll }
    106      1.1     skrll 
    107      1.1     skrll /* Swap out a Verdaux structure.  */
    108      1.1     skrll 
    109      1.1     skrll void
    110      1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_swap_verdaux_out (bfd *abfd,
    111      1.1     skrll 			   const Elf_Internal_Verdaux *src,
    112      1.1     skrll 			   Elf_External_Verdaux *dst)
    113      1.1     skrll {
    114      1.1     skrll   H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vda_name, dst->vda_name);
    115      1.1     skrll   H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vda_next, dst->vda_next);
    116      1.1     skrll }
    117      1.1     skrll 
    118      1.1     skrll /* Swap in a Verneed structure.  */
    119      1.1     skrll 
    120      1.1     skrll void
    121      1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_swap_verneed_in (bfd *abfd,
    122      1.1     skrll 			  const Elf_External_Verneed *src,
    123      1.1     skrll 			  Elf_Internal_Verneed *dst)
    124      1.1     skrll {
    125      1.1     skrll   dst->vn_version = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vn_version);
    126      1.1     skrll   dst->vn_cnt     = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vn_cnt);
    127      1.1     skrll   dst->vn_file    = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vn_file);
    128      1.1     skrll   dst->vn_aux     = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vn_aux);
    129      1.1     skrll   dst->vn_next    = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vn_next);
    130      1.1     skrll }
    131      1.1     skrll 
    132      1.1     skrll /* Swap out a Verneed structure.  */
    133      1.1     skrll 
    134      1.1     skrll void
    135      1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_swap_verneed_out (bfd *abfd,
    136      1.1     skrll 			   const Elf_Internal_Verneed *src,
    137      1.1     skrll 			   Elf_External_Verneed *dst)
    138      1.1     skrll {
    139      1.1     skrll   H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vn_version, dst->vn_version);
    140      1.1     skrll   H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vn_cnt, dst->vn_cnt);
    141      1.1     skrll   H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vn_file, dst->vn_file);
    142      1.1     skrll   H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vn_aux, dst->vn_aux);
    143      1.1     skrll   H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vn_next, dst->vn_next);
    144      1.1     skrll }
    145      1.1     skrll 
    146      1.1     skrll /* Swap in a Vernaux structure.  */
    147      1.1     skrll 
    148      1.1     skrll void
    149      1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_swap_vernaux_in (bfd *abfd,
    150      1.1     skrll 			  const Elf_External_Vernaux *src,
    151      1.1     skrll 			  Elf_Internal_Vernaux *dst)
    152      1.1     skrll {
    153      1.1     skrll   dst->vna_hash  = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vna_hash);
    154      1.1     skrll   dst->vna_flags = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vna_flags);
    155      1.1     skrll   dst->vna_other = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vna_other);
    156      1.1     skrll   dst->vna_name  = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vna_name);
    157      1.1     skrll   dst->vna_next  = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vna_next);
    158      1.1     skrll }
    159      1.1     skrll 
    160      1.1     skrll /* Swap out a Vernaux structure.  */
    161      1.1     skrll 
    162      1.1     skrll void
    163      1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_swap_vernaux_out (bfd *abfd,
    164      1.1     skrll 			   const Elf_Internal_Vernaux *src,
    165      1.1     skrll 			   Elf_External_Vernaux *dst)
    166      1.1     skrll {
    167      1.1     skrll   H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vna_hash, dst->vna_hash);
    168      1.1     skrll   H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vna_flags, dst->vna_flags);
    169      1.1     skrll   H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vna_other, dst->vna_other);
    170      1.1     skrll   H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vna_name, dst->vna_name);
    171      1.1     skrll   H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vna_next, dst->vna_next);
    172      1.1     skrll }
    173      1.1     skrll 
    174      1.1     skrll /* Swap in a Versym structure.  */
    175      1.1     skrll 
    176      1.1     skrll void
    177      1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_swap_versym_in (bfd *abfd,
    178      1.1     skrll 			 const Elf_External_Versym *src,
    179      1.1     skrll 			 Elf_Internal_Versym *dst)
    180      1.1     skrll {
    181      1.1     skrll   dst->vs_vers = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vs_vers);
    182      1.1     skrll }
    183      1.1     skrll 
    184      1.1     skrll /* Swap out a Versym structure.  */
    185      1.1     skrll 
    186      1.1     skrll void
    187      1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_swap_versym_out (bfd *abfd,
    188      1.1     skrll 			  const Elf_Internal_Versym *src,
    189      1.1     skrll 			  Elf_External_Versym *dst)
    190      1.1     skrll {
    191      1.1     skrll   H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vs_vers, dst->vs_vers);
    192      1.1     skrll }
    193      1.1     skrll 
    194      1.1     skrll /* Standard ELF hash function.  Do not change this function; you will
    195      1.1     skrll    cause invalid hash tables to be generated.  */
    196      1.1     skrll 
    197      1.1     skrll unsigned long
    198      1.1     skrll bfd_elf_hash (const char *namearg)
    199      1.1     skrll {
    200      1.1     skrll   const unsigned char *name = (const unsigned char *) namearg;
    201      1.1     skrll   unsigned long h = 0;
    202      1.1     skrll   unsigned long g;
    203      1.1     skrll   int ch;
    204      1.1     skrll 
    205      1.1     skrll   while ((ch = *name++) != '\0')
    206      1.1     skrll     {
    207      1.1     skrll       h = (h << 4) + ch;
    208      1.1     skrll       if ((g = (h & 0xf0000000)) != 0)
    209      1.1     skrll 	{
    210      1.1     skrll 	  h ^= g >> 24;
    211      1.1     skrll 	  /* The ELF ABI says `h &= ~g', but this is equivalent in
    212      1.1     skrll 	     this case and on some machines one insn instead of two.  */
    213      1.1     skrll 	  h ^= g;
    214      1.1     skrll 	}
    215      1.1     skrll     }
    216      1.1     skrll   return h & 0xffffffff;
    217      1.1     skrll }
    218      1.1     skrll 
    219      1.1     skrll /* DT_GNU_HASH hash function.  Do not change this function; you will
    220      1.1     skrll    cause invalid hash tables to be generated.  */
    221      1.1     skrll 
    222      1.1     skrll unsigned long
    223      1.1     skrll bfd_elf_gnu_hash (const char *namearg)
    224      1.1     skrll {
    225      1.1     skrll   const unsigned char *name = (const unsigned char *) namearg;
    226      1.1     skrll   unsigned long h = 5381;
    227      1.1     skrll   unsigned char ch;
    228      1.1     skrll 
    229      1.1     skrll   while ((ch = *name++) != '\0')
    230      1.1     skrll     h = (h << 5) + h + ch;
    231      1.1     skrll   return h & 0xffffffff;
    232      1.1     skrll }
    233      1.1     skrll 
    234      1.1     skrll /* Create a tdata field OBJECT_SIZE bytes in length, zeroed out and with
    235      1.1     skrll    the object_id field of an elf_obj_tdata field set to OBJECT_ID.  */
    236      1.1     skrll bfd_boolean
    237      1.1     skrll bfd_elf_allocate_object (bfd *abfd,
    238      1.1     skrll 			 size_t object_size,
    239  1.1.1.3  christos 			 enum elf_target_id object_id)
    240      1.1     skrll {
    241      1.1     skrll   BFD_ASSERT (object_size >= sizeof (struct elf_obj_tdata));
    242      1.1     skrll   abfd->tdata.any = bfd_zalloc (abfd, object_size);
    243      1.1     skrll   if (abfd->tdata.any == NULL)
    244      1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
    245      1.1     skrll 
    246      1.1     skrll   elf_object_id (abfd) = object_id;
    247  1.1.1.5  christos   if (abfd->direction != read_direction)
    248  1.1.1.5  christos     {
    249  1.1.1.5  christos       struct output_elf_obj_tdata *o = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof *o);
    250  1.1.1.5  christos       if (o == NULL)
    251  1.1.1.5  christos 	return FALSE;
    252  1.1.1.5  christos       elf_tdata (abfd)->o = o;
    253  1.1.1.5  christos       elf_program_header_size (abfd) = (bfd_size_type) -1;
    254  1.1.1.5  christos     }
    255      1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
    256      1.1     skrll }
    257      1.1     skrll 
    258      1.1     skrll 
    259      1.1     skrll bfd_boolean
    260  1.1.1.3  christos bfd_elf_make_object (bfd *abfd)
    261      1.1     skrll {
    262  1.1.1.3  christos   const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
    263      1.1     skrll   return bfd_elf_allocate_object (abfd, sizeof (struct elf_obj_tdata),
    264  1.1.1.3  christos 				  bed->target_id);
    265      1.1     skrll }
    266      1.1     skrll 
    267      1.1     skrll bfd_boolean
    268      1.1     skrll bfd_elf_mkcorefile (bfd *abfd)
    269      1.1     skrll {
    270      1.1     skrll   /* I think this can be done just like an object file.  */
    271  1.1.1.5  christos   if (!abfd->xvec->_bfd_set_format[(int) bfd_object] (abfd))
    272  1.1.1.5  christos     return FALSE;
    273  1.1.1.5  christos   elf_tdata (abfd)->core = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (*elf_tdata (abfd)->core));
    274  1.1.1.5  christos   return elf_tdata (abfd)->core != NULL;
    275      1.1     skrll }
    276      1.1     skrll 
    277  1.1.1.3  christos static char *
    278      1.1     skrll bfd_elf_get_str_section (bfd *abfd, unsigned int shindex)
    279      1.1     skrll {
    280      1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Shdr **i_shdrp;
    281      1.1     skrll   bfd_byte *shstrtab = NULL;
    282      1.1     skrll   file_ptr offset;
    283      1.1     skrll   bfd_size_type shstrtabsize;
    284      1.1     skrll 
    285      1.1     skrll   i_shdrp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
    286      1.1     skrll   if (i_shdrp == 0
    287      1.1     skrll       || shindex >= elf_numsections (abfd)
    288      1.1     skrll       || i_shdrp[shindex] == 0)
    289      1.1     skrll     return NULL;
    290      1.1     skrll 
    291      1.1     skrll   shstrtab = i_shdrp[shindex]->contents;
    292      1.1     skrll   if (shstrtab == NULL)
    293      1.1     skrll     {
    294      1.1     skrll       /* No cached one, attempt to read, and cache what we read.  */
    295      1.1     skrll       offset = i_shdrp[shindex]->sh_offset;
    296      1.1     skrll       shstrtabsize = i_shdrp[shindex]->sh_size;
    297      1.1     skrll 
    298      1.1     skrll       /* Allocate and clear an extra byte at the end, to prevent crashes
    299      1.1     skrll 	 in case the string table is not terminated.  */
    300      1.1     skrll       if (shstrtabsize + 1 <= 1
    301  1.1.1.8  christos 	  || shstrtabsize > bfd_get_file_size (abfd)
    302  1.1.1.5  christos 	  || bfd_seek (abfd, offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
    303  1.1.1.5  christos 	  || (shstrtab = (bfd_byte *) bfd_alloc (abfd, shstrtabsize + 1)) == NULL)
    304      1.1     skrll 	shstrtab = NULL;
    305      1.1     skrll       else if (bfd_bread (shstrtab, shstrtabsize, abfd) != shstrtabsize)
    306      1.1     skrll 	{
    307      1.1     skrll 	  if (bfd_get_error () != bfd_error_system_call)
    308      1.1     skrll 	    bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_truncated);
    309  1.1.1.5  christos 	  bfd_release (abfd, shstrtab);
    310      1.1     skrll 	  shstrtab = NULL;
    311      1.1     skrll 	  /* Once we've failed to read it, make sure we don't keep
    312      1.1     skrll 	     trying.  Otherwise, we'll keep allocating space for
    313      1.1     skrll 	     the string table over and over.  */
    314      1.1     skrll 	  i_shdrp[shindex]->sh_size = 0;
    315      1.1     skrll 	}
    316      1.1     skrll       else
    317      1.1     skrll 	shstrtab[shstrtabsize] = '\0';
    318      1.1     skrll       i_shdrp[shindex]->contents = shstrtab;
    319      1.1     skrll     }
    320      1.1     skrll   return (char *) shstrtab;
    321      1.1     skrll }
    322      1.1     skrll 
    323      1.1     skrll char *
    324      1.1     skrll bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (bfd *abfd,
    325      1.1     skrll 				 unsigned int shindex,
    326      1.1     skrll 				 unsigned int strindex)
    327      1.1     skrll {
    328      1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
    329      1.1     skrll 
    330      1.1     skrll   if (strindex == 0)
    331      1.1     skrll     return "";
    332      1.1     skrll 
    333      1.1     skrll   if (elf_elfsections (abfd) == NULL || shindex >= elf_numsections (abfd))
    334      1.1     skrll     return NULL;
    335      1.1     skrll 
    336      1.1     skrll   hdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex];
    337      1.1     skrll 
    338  1.1.1.5  christos   if (hdr->contents == NULL)
    339  1.1.1.5  christos     {
    340  1.1.1.5  christos       if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_STRTAB && hdr->sh_type < SHT_LOOS)
    341  1.1.1.5  christos 	{
    342  1.1.1.5  christos 	  /* PR 17512: file: f057ec89.  */
    343  1.1.1.7  christos 	  /* xgettext:c-format */
    344  1.1.1.8  christos 	  _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: attempt to load strings from"
    345  1.1.1.7  christos 				" a non-string section (number %d)"),
    346  1.1.1.5  christos 			      abfd, shindex);
    347  1.1.1.5  christos 	  return NULL;
    348  1.1.1.5  christos 	}
    349  1.1.1.5  christos 
    350  1.1.1.5  christos       if (bfd_elf_get_str_section (abfd, shindex) == NULL)
    351  1.1.1.5  christos 	return NULL;
    352  1.1.1.5  christos     }
    353      1.1     skrll 
    354      1.1     skrll   if (strindex >= hdr->sh_size)
    355      1.1     skrll     {
    356      1.1     skrll       unsigned int shstrndx = elf_elfheader(abfd)->e_shstrndx;
    357  1.1.1.7  christos       _bfd_error_handler
    358  1.1.1.7  christos 	/* xgettext:c-format */
    359  1.1.1.8  christos 	(_("%pB: invalid string offset %u >= %" PRIu64 " for section `%s'"),
    360  1.1.1.8  christos 	 abfd, strindex, (uint64_t) hdr->sh_size,
    361      1.1     skrll 	 (shindex == shstrndx && strindex == hdr->sh_name
    362      1.1     skrll 	  ? ".shstrtab"
    363      1.1     skrll 	  : bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, shstrndx, hdr->sh_name)));
    364  1.1.1.3  christos       return NULL;
    365      1.1     skrll     }
    366      1.1     skrll 
    367      1.1     skrll   return ((char *) hdr->contents) + strindex;
    368      1.1     skrll }
    369      1.1     skrll 
    370      1.1     skrll /* Read and convert symbols to internal format.
    371      1.1     skrll    SYMCOUNT specifies the number of symbols to read, starting from
    372      1.1     skrll    symbol SYMOFFSET.  If any of INTSYM_BUF, EXTSYM_BUF or EXTSHNDX_BUF
    373      1.1     skrll    are non-NULL, they are used to store the internal symbols, external
    374      1.1     skrll    symbols, and symbol section index extensions, respectively.
    375      1.1     skrll    Returns a pointer to the internal symbol buffer (malloced if necessary)
    376      1.1     skrll    or NULL if there were no symbols or some kind of problem.  */
    377      1.1     skrll 
    378      1.1     skrll Elf_Internal_Sym *
    379      1.1     skrll bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (bfd *ibfd,
    380      1.1     skrll 		      Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr,
    381      1.1     skrll 		      size_t symcount,
    382      1.1     skrll 		      size_t symoffset,
    383      1.1     skrll 		      Elf_Internal_Sym *intsym_buf,
    384      1.1     skrll 		      void *extsym_buf,
    385      1.1     skrll 		      Elf_External_Sym_Shndx *extshndx_buf)
    386      1.1     skrll {
    387      1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Shdr *shndx_hdr;
    388      1.1     skrll   void *alloc_ext;
    389      1.1     skrll   const bfd_byte *esym;
    390      1.1     skrll   Elf_External_Sym_Shndx *alloc_extshndx;
    391      1.1     skrll   Elf_External_Sym_Shndx *shndx;
    392      1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Sym *alloc_intsym;
    393      1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
    394      1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Sym *isymend;
    395      1.1     skrll   const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
    396      1.1     skrll   size_t extsym_size;
    397      1.1     skrll   bfd_size_type amt;
    398      1.1     skrll   file_ptr pos;
    399      1.1     skrll 
    400      1.1     skrll   if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
    401      1.1     skrll     abort ();
    402      1.1     skrll 
    403      1.1     skrll   if (symcount == 0)
    404      1.1     skrll     return intsym_buf;
    405      1.1     skrll 
    406      1.1     skrll   /* Normal syms might have section extension entries.  */
    407      1.1     skrll   shndx_hdr = NULL;
    408  1.1.1.5  christos   if (elf_symtab_shndx_list (ibfd) != NULL)
    409  1.1.1.5  christos     {
    410  1.1.1.5  christos       elf_section_list * entry;
    411  1.1.1.5  christos       Elf_Internal_Shdr **sections = elf_elfsections (ibfd);
    412  1.1.1.5  christos 
    413  1.1.1.5  christos       /* Find an index section that is linked to this symtab section.  */
    414  1.1.1.5  christos       for (entry = elf_symtab_shndx_list (ibfd); entry != NULL; entry = entry->next)
    415  1.1.1.6  christos 	{
    416  1.1.1.6  christos 	  /* PR 20063.  */
    417  1.1.1.6  christos 	  if (entry->hdr.sh_link >= elf_numsections (ibfd))
    418  1.1.1.6  christos 	    continue;
    419  1.1.1.6  christos 
    420  1.1.1.6  christos 	  if (sections[entry->hdr.sh_link] == symtab_hdr)
    421  1.1.1.6  christos 	    {
    422  1.1.1.6  christos 	      shndx_hdr = & entry->hdr;
    423  1.1.1.6  christos 	      break;
    424  1.1.1.6  christos 	    };
    425  1.1.1.6  christos 	}
    426  1.1.1.5  christos 
    427  1.1.1.5  christos       if (shndx_hdr == NULL)
    428  1.1.1.5  christos 	{
    429  1.1.1.5  christos 	  if (symtab_hdr == & elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd))
    430  1.1.1.5  christos 	    /* Not really accurate, but this was how the old code used to work.  */
    431  1.1.1.5  christos 	    shndx_hdr = & elf_symtab_shndx_list (ibfd)->hdr;
    432  1.1.1.5  christos 	  /* Otherwise we do nothing.  The assumption is that
    433  1.1.1.5  christos 	     the index table will not be needed.  */
    434  1.1.1.5  christos 	}
    435  1.1.1.5  christos     }
    436      1.1     skrll 
    437      1.1     skrll   /* Read the symbols.  */
    438      1.1     skrll   alloc_ext = NULL;
    439      1.1     skrll   alloc_extshndx = NULL;
    440      1.1     skrll   alloc_intsym = NULL;
    441      1.1     skrll   bed = get_elf_backend_data (ibfd);
    442      1.1     skrll   extsym_size = bed->s->sizeof_sym;
    443  1.1.1.6  christos   amt = (bfd_size_type) symcount * extsym_size;
    444      1.1     skrll   pos = symtab_hdr->sh_offset + symoffset * extsym_size;
    445      1.1     skrll   if (extsym_buf == NULL)
    446      1.1     skrll     {
    447      1.1     skrll       alloc_ext = bfd_malloc2 (symcount, extsym_size);
    448      1.1     skrll       extsym_buf = alloc_ext;
    449      1.1     skrll     }
    450      1.1     skrll   if (extsym_buf == NULL
    451      1.1     skrll       || bfd_seek (ibfd, pos, SEEK_SET) != 0
    452      1.1     skrll       || bfd_bread (extsym_buf, amt, ibfd) != amt)
    453      1.1     skrll     {
    454      1.1     skrll       intsym_buf = NULL;
    455      1.1     skrll       goto out;
    456      1.1     skrll     }
    457      1.1     skrll 
    458      1.1     skrll   if (shndx_hdr == NULL || shndx_hdr->sh_size == 0)
    459      1.1     skrll     extshndx_buf = NULL;
    460      1.1     skrll   else
    461      1.1     skrll     {
    462  1.1.1.6  christos       amt = (bfd_size_type) symcount * sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
    463      1.1     skrll       pos = shndx_hdr->sh_offset + symoffset * sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
    464      1.1     skrll       if (extshndx_buf == NULL)
    465      1.1     skrll 	{
    466  1.1.1.3  christos 	  alloc_extshndx = (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx *)
    467  1.1.1.7  christos 	      bfd_malloc2 (symcount, sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx));
    468      1.1     skrll 	  extshndx_buf = alloc_extshndx;
    469      1.1     skrll 	}
    470      1.1     skrll       if (extshndx_buf == NULL
    471      1.1     skrll 	  || bfd_seek (ibfd, pos, SEEK_SET) != 0
    472      1.1     skrll 	  || bfd_bread (extshndx_buf, amt, ibfd) != amt)
    473      1.1     skrll 	{
    474      1.1     skrll 	  intsym_buf = NULL;
    475      1.1     skrll 	  goto out;
    476      1.1     skrll 	}
    477      1.1     skrll     }
    478      1.1     skrll 
    479      1.1     skrll   if (intsym_buf == NULL)
    480      1.1     skrll     {
    481  1.1.1.3  christos       alloc_intsym = (Elf_Internal_Sym *)
    482  1.1.1.7  christos 	  bfd_malloc2 (symcount, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Sym));
    483      1.1     skrll       intsym_buf = alloc_intsym;
    484      1.1     skrll       if (intsym_buf == NULL)
    485      1.1     skrll 	goto out;
    486      1.1     skrll     }
    487      1.1     skrll 
    488      1.1     skrll   /* Convert the symbols to internal form.  */
    489      1.1     skrll   isymend = intsym_buf + symcount;
    490  1.1.1.3  christos   for (esym = (const bfd_byte *) extsym_buf, isym = intsym_buf,
    491  1.1.1.7  christos 	   shndx = extshndx_buf;
    492      1.1     skrll        isym < isymend;
    493      1.1     skrll        esym += extsym_size, isym++, shndx = shndx != NULL ? shndx + 1 : NULL)
    494      1.1     skrll     if (!(*bed->s->swap_symbol_in) (ibfd, esym, shndx, isym))
    495      1.1     skrll       {
    496      1.1     skrll 	symoffset += (esym - (bfd_byte *) extsym_buf) / extsym_size;
    497  1.1.1.7  christos 	/* xgettext:c-format */
    498  1.1.1.8  christos 	_bfd_error_handler (_("%pB symbol number %lu references"
    499  1.1.1.7  christos 			      " nonexistent SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX section"),
    500  1.1.1.7  christos 			    ibfd, (unsigned long) symoffset);
    501      1.1     skrll 	if (alloc_intsym != NULL)
    502      1.1     skrll 	  free (alloc_intsym);
    503      1.1     skrll 	intsym_buf = NULL;
    504      1.1     skrll 	goto out;
    505      1.1     skrll       }
    506      1.1     skrll 
    507      1.1     skrll  out:
    508      1.1     skrll   if (alloc_ext != NULL)
    509      1.1     skrll     free (alloc_ext);
    510      1.1     skrll   if (alloc_extshndx != NULL)
    511      1.1     skrll     free (alloc_extshndx);
    512      1.1     skrll 
    513      1.1     skrll   return intsym_buf;
    514      1.1     skrll }
    515      1.1     skrll 
    516      1.1     skrll /* Look up a symbol name.  */
    517      1.1     skrll const char *
    518      1.1     skrll bfd_elf_sym_name (bfd *abfd,
    519      1.1     skrll 		  Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr,
    520      1.1     skrll 		  Elf_Internal_Sym *isym,
    521      1.1     skrll 		  asection *sym_sec)
    522      1.1     skrll {
    523      1.1     skrll   const char *name;
    524      1.1     skrll   unsigned int iname = isym->st_name;
    525      1.1     skrll   unsigned int shindex = symtab_hdr->sh_link;
    526      1.1     skrll 
    527      1.1     skrll   if (iname == 0 && ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_SECTION
    528      1.1     skrll       /* Check for a bogus st_shndx to avoid crashing.  */
    529      1.1     skrll       && isym->st_shndx < elf_numsections (abfd))
    530      1.1     skrll     {
    531      1.1     skrll       iname = elf_elfsections (abfd)[isym->st_shndx]->sh_name;
    532      1.1     skrll       shindex = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_shstrndx;
    533      1.1     skrll     }
    534      1.1     skrll 
    535      1.1     skrll   name = bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, shindex, iname);
    536      1.1     skrll   if (name == NULL)
    537      1.1     skrll     name = "(null)";
    538      1.1     skrll   else if (sym_sec && *name == '\0')
    539      1.1     skrll     name = bfd_section_name (abfd, sym_sec);
    540      1.1     skrll 
    541      1.1     skrll   return name;
    542      1.1     skrll }
    543      1.1     skrll 
    544      1.1     skrll /* Elf_Internal_Shdr->contents is an array of these for SHT_GROUP
    545      1.1     skrll    sections.  The first element is the flags, the rest are section
    546      1.1     skrll    pointers.  */
    547      1.1     skrll 
    548      1.1     skrll typedef union elf_internal_group {
    549      1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr;
    550      1.1     skrll   unsigned int flags;
    551      1.1     skrll } Elf_Internal_Group;
    552      1.1     skrll 
    553      1.1     skrll /* Return the name of the group signature symbol.  Why isn't the
    554      1.1     skrll    signature just a string?  */
    555      1.1     skrll 
    556      1.1     skrll static const char *
    557      1.1     skrll group_signature (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Shdr *ghdr)
    558      1.1     skrll {
    559      1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
    560      1.1     skrll   unsigned char esym[sizeof (Elf64_External_Sym)];
    561      1.1     skrll   Elf_External_Sym_Shndx eshndx;
    562      1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Sym isym;
    563      1.1     skrll 
    564      1.1     skrll   /* First we need to ensure the symbol table is available.  Make sure
    565      1.1     skrll      that it is a symbol table section.  */
    566      1.1     skrll   if (ghdr->sh_link >= elf_numsections (abfd))
    567      1.1     skrll     return NULL;
    568      1.1     skrll   hdr = elf_elfsections (abfd) [ghdr->sh_link];
    569      1.1     skrll   if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_SYMTAB
    570      1.1     skrll       || ! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, ghdr->sh_link))
    571      1.1     skrll     return NULL;
    572      1.1     skrll 
    573      1.1     skrll   /* Go read the symbol.  */
    574      1.1     skrll   hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
    575      1.1     skrll   if (bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (abfd, hdr, 1, ghdr->sh_info,
    576      1.1     skrll 			    &isym, esym, &eshndx) == NULL)
    577      1.1     skrll     return NULL;
    578      1.1     skrll 
    579      1.1     skrll   return bfd_elf_sym_name (abfd, hdr, &isym, NULL);
    580      1.1     skrll }
    581      1.1     skrll 
    582      1.1     skrll /* Set next_in_group list pointer, and group name for NEWSECT.  */
    583      1.1     skrll 
    584      1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
    585      1.1     skrll setup_group (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr, asection *newsect)
    586      1.1     skrll {
    587      1.1     skrll   unsigned int num_group = elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group;
    588      1.1     skrll 
    589      1.1     skrll   /* If num_group is zero, read in all SHT_GROUP sections.  The count
    590      1.1     skrll      is set to -1 if there are no SHT_GROUP sections.  */
    591      1.1     skrll   if (num_group == 0)
    592      1.1     skrll     {
    593      1.1     skrll       unsigned int i, shnum;
    594      1.1     skrll 
    595      1.1     skrll       /* First count the number of groups.  If we have a SHT_GROUP
    596      1.1     skrll 	 section with just a flag word (ie. sh_size is 4), ignore it.  */
    597      1.1     skrll       shnum = elf_numsections (abfd);
    598      1.1     skrll       num_group = 0;
    599      1.1     skrll 
    600  1.1.1.5  christos #define IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER(shdr, minsize)	\
    601      1.1     skrll 	(   (shdr)->sh_type == SHT_GROUP		\
    602  1.1.1.5  christos 	 && (shdr)->sh_size >= minsize			\
    603      1.1     skrll 	 && (shdr)->sh_entsize == GRP_ENTRY_SIZE	\
    604      1.1     skrll 	 && ((shdr)->sh_size % GRP_ENTRY_SIZE) == 0)
    605      1.1     skrll 
    606      1.1     skrll       for (i = 0; i < shnum; i++)
    607      1.1     skrll 	{
    608      1.1     skrll 	  Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
    609      1.1     skrll 
    610  1.1.1.5  christos 	  if (IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER (shdr, 2 * GRP_ENTRY_SIZE))
    611      1.1     skrll 	    num_group += 1;
    612      1.1     skrll 	}
    613      1.1     skrll 
    614      1.1     skrll       if (num_group == 0)
    615      1.1     skrll 	{
    616      1.1     skrll 	  num_group = (unsigned) -1;
    617      1.1     skrll 	  elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group = num_group;
    618  1.1.1.7  christos 	  elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr = NULL;
    619      1.1     skrll 	}
    620      1.1     skrll       else
    621      1.1     skrll 	{
    622      1.1     skrll 	  /* We keep a list of elf section headers for group sections,
    623      1.1     skrll 	     so we can find them quickly.  */
    624      1.1     skrll 	  bfd_size_type amt;
    625      1.1     skrll 
    626      1.1     skrll 	  elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group = num_group;
    627  1.1.1.3  christos 	  elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr = (Elf_Internal_Shdr **)
    628  1.1.1.7  christos 	      bfd_alloc2 (abfd, num_group, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr *));
    629      1.1     skrll 	  if (elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr == NULL)
    630      1.1     skrll 	    return FALSE;
    631  1.1.1.8  christos 	  memset (elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr, 0,
    632  1.1.1.8  christos 		  num_group * sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr *));
    633      1.1     skrll 	  num_group = 0;
    634  1.1.1.7  christos 
    635      1.1     skrll 	  for (i = 0; i < shnum; i++)
    636      1.1     skrll 	    {
    637      1.1     skrll 	      Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
    638      1.1     skrll 
    639  1.1.1.5  christos 	      if (IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER (shdr, 2 * GRP_ENTRY_SIZE))
    640      1.1     skrll 		{
    641      1.1     skrll 		  unsigned char *src;
    642      1.1     skrll 		  Elf_Internal_Group *dest;
    643      1.1     skrll 
    644  1.1.1.7  christos 		  /* Make sure the group section has a BFD section
    645  1.1.1.7  christos 		     attached to it.  */
    646  1.1.1.7  christos 		  if (!bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, i))
    647  1.1.1.7  christos 		    return FALSE;
    648  1.1.1.7  christos 
    649      1.1     skrll 		  /* Add to list of sections.  */
    650      1.1     skrll 		  elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr[num_group] = shdr;
    651      1.1     skrll 		  num_group += 1;
    652      1.1     skrll 
    653      1.1     skrll 		  /* Read the raw contents.  */
    654      1.1     skrll 		  BFD_ASSERT (sizeof (*dest) >= 4);
    655      1.1     skrll 		  amt = shdr->sh_size * sizeof (*dest) / 4;
    656  1.1.1.3  christos 		  shdr->contents = (unsigned char *)
    657  1.1.1.7  christos 		      bfd_alloc2 (abfd, shdr->sh_size, sizeof (*dest) / 4);
    658      1.1     skrll 		  /* PR binutils/4110: Handle corrupt group headers.  */
    659      1.1     skrll 		  if (shdr->contents == NULL)
    660      1.1     skrll 		    {
    661      1.1     skrll 		      _bfd_error_handler
    662  1.1.1.7  christos 			/* xgettext:c-format */
    663  1.1.1.8  christos 			(_("%pB: corrupt size field in group section"
    664  1.1.1.8  christos 			   " header: %#" PRIx64),
    665  1.1.1.8  christos 			 abfd, (uint64_t) shdr->sh_size);
    666      1.1     skrll 		      bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
    667  1.1.1.5  christos 		      -- num_group;
    668  1.1.1.5  christos 		      continue;
    669      1.1     skrll 		    }
    670      1.1     skrll 
    671      1.1     skrll 		  memset (shdr->contents, 0, amt);
    672      1.1     skrll 
    673      1.1     skrll 		  if (bfd_seek (abfd, shdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
    674      1.1     skrll 		      || (bfd_bread (shdr->contents, shdr->sh_size, abfd)
    675      1.1     skrll 			  != shdr->sh_size))
    676  1.1.1.5  christos 		    {
    677  1.1.1.5  christos 		      _bfd_error_handler
    678  1.1.1.7  christos 			/* xgettext:c-format */
    679  1.1.1.8  christos 			(_("%pB: invalid size field in group section"
    680  1.1.1.8  christos 			   " header: %#" PRIx64 ""),
    681  1.1.1.8  christos 			 abfd, (uint64_t) shdr->sh_size);
    682  1.1.1.5  christos 		      bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
    683  1.1.1.5  christos 		      -- num_group;
    684  1.1.1.7  christos 		      /* PR 17510: If the group contents are even
    685  1.1.1.7  christos 			 partially corrupt, do not allow any of the
    686  1.1.1.7  christos 			 contents to be used.  */
    687  1.1.1.5  christos 		      memset (shdr->contents, 0, amt);
    688  1.1.1.5  christos 		      continue;
    689  1.1.1.5  christos 		    }
    690      1.1     skrll 
    691      1.1     skrll 		  /* Translate raw contents, a flag word followed by an
    692      1.1     skrll 		     array of elf section indices all in target byte order,
    693      1.1     skrll 		     to the flag word followed by an array of elf section
    694      1.1     skrll 		     pointers.  */
    695      1.1     skrll 		  src = shdr->contents + shdr->sh_size;
    696      1.1     skrll 		  dest = (Elf_Internal_Group *) (shdr->contents + amt);
    697  1.1.1.5  christos 
    698      1.1     skrll 		  while (1)
    699      1.1     skrll 		    {
    700      1.1     skrll 		      unsigned int idx;
    701      1.1     skrll 
    702      1.1     skrll 		      src -= 4;
    703      1.1     skrll 		      --dest;
    704      1.1     skrll 		      idx = H_GET_32 (abfd, src);
    705      1.1     skrll 		      if (src == shdr->contents)
    706      1.1     skrll 			{
    707      1.1     skrll 			  dest->flags = idx;
    708      1.1     skrll 			  if (shdr->bfd_section != NULL && (idx & GRP_COMDAT))
    709      1.1     skrll 			    shdr->bfd_section->flags
    710      1.1     skrll 			      |= SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES_DISCARD;
    711      1.1     skrll 			  break;
    712      1.1     skrll 			}
    713  1.1.1.8  christos 		      if (idx < shnum)
    714  1.1.1.8  christos 			{
    715  1.1.1.8  christos 			  dest->shdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[idx];
    716  1.1.1.8  christos 			  /* PR binutils/23199: All sections in a
    717  1.1.1.8  christos 			     section group should be marked with
    718  1.1.1.8  christos 			     SHF_GROUP.  But some tools generate
    719  1.1.1.8  christos 			     broken objects without SHF_GROUP.  Fix
    720  1.1.1.8  christos 			     them up here.  */
    721  1.1.1.8  christos 			  dest->shdr->sh_flags |= SHF_GROUP;
    722  1.1.1.8  christos 			}
    723  1.1.1.8  christos 		      if (idx >= shnum
    724  1.1.1.8  christos 			  || dest->shdr->sh_type == SHT_GROUP)
    725      1.1     skrll 			{
    726  1.1.1.7  christos 			  _bfd_error_handler
    727  1.1.1.8  christos 			    (_("%pB: invalid entry in SHT_GROUP section [%u]"),
    728  1.1.1.8  christos 			       abfd, i);
    729  1.1.1.8  christos 			  dest->shdr = NULL;
    730      1.1     skrll 			}
    731      1.1     skrll 		    }
    732      1.1     skrll 		}
    733      1.1     skrll 	    }
    734  1.1.1.5  christos 
    735  1.1.1.5  christos 	  /* PR 17510: Corrupt binaries might contain invalid groups.  */
    736  1.1.1.5  christos 	  if (num_group != (unsigned) elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group)
    737  1.1.1.5  christos 	    {
    738  1.1.1.5  christos 	      elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group = num_group;
    739  1.1.1.5  christos 
    740  1.1.1.5  christos 	      /* If all groups are invalid then fail.  */
    741  1.1.1.5  christos 	      if (num_group == 0)
    742  1.1.1.5  christos 		{
    743  1.1.1.5  christos 		  elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr = NULL;
    744  1.1.1.5  christos 		  elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group = num_group = -1;
    745  1.1.1.7  christos 		  _bfd_error_handler
    746  1.1.1.8  christos 		    (_("%pB: no valid group sections found"), abfd);
    747  1.1.1.5  christos 		  bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
    748  1.1.1.5  christos 		}
    749  1.1.1.5  christos 	    }
    750      1.1     skrll 	}
    751      1.1     skrll     }
    752      1.1     skrll 
    753      1.1     skrll   if (num_group != (unsigned) -1)
    754      1.1     skrll     {
    755  1.1.1.7  christos       unsigned int search_offset = elf_tdata (abfd)->group_search_offset;
    756  1.1.1.7  christos       unsigned int j;
    757      1.1     skrll 
    758  1.1.1.7  christos       for (j = 0; j < num_group; j++)
    759      1.1     skrll 	{
    760  1.1.1.7  christos 	  /* Begin search from previous found group.  */
    761  1.1.1.7  christos 	  unsigned i = (j + search_offset) % num_group;
    762  1.1.1.7  christos 
    763      1.1     skrll 	  Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr[i];
    764  1.1.1.7  christos 	  Elf_Internal_Group *idx;
    765  1.1.1.7  christos 	  bfd_size_type n_elt;
    766  1.1.1.7  christos 
    767  1.1.1.7  christos 	  if (shdr == NULL)
    768  1.1.1.7  christos 	    continue;
    769  1.1.1.7  christos 
    770  1.1.1.7  christos 	  idx = (Elf_Internal_Group *) shdr->contents;
    771  1.1.1.7  christos 	  if (idx == NULL || shdr->sh_size < 4)
    772  1.1.1.7  christos 	    {
    773  1.1.1.7  christos 	      /* See PR 21957 for a reproducer.  */
    774  1.1.1.7  christos 	      /* xgettext:c-format */
    775  1.1.1.8  christos 	      _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: group section '%pA' has no contents"),
    776  1.1.1.7  christos 				  abfd, shdr->bfd_section);
    777  1.1.1.7  christos 	      elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr[i] = NULL;
    778  1.1.1.7  christos 	      bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
    779  1.1.1.7  christos 	      return FALSE;
    780  1.1.1.7  christos 	    }
    781  1.1.1.7  christos 	  n_elt = shdr->sh_size / 4;
    782      1.1     skrll 
    783      1.1     skrll 	  /* Look through this group's sections to see if current
    784      1.1     skrll 	     section is a member.  */
    785      1.1     skrll 	  while (--n_elt != 0)
    786      1.1     skrll 	    if ((++idx)->shdr == hdr)
    787      1.1     skrll 	      {
    788      1.1     skrll 		asection *s = NULL;
    789      1.1     skrll 
    790      1.1     skrll 		/* We are a member of this group.  Go looking through
    791      1.1     skrll 		   other members to see if any others are linked via
    792      1.1     skrll 		   next_in_group.  */
    793      1.1     skrll 		idx = (Elf_Internal_Group *) shdr->contents;
    794      1.1     skrll 		n_elt = shdr->sh_size / 4;
    795      1.1     skrll 		while (--n_elt != 0)
    796  1.1.1.8  christos 		  if ((++idx)->shdr != NULL
    797  1.1.1.8  christos 		      && (s = idx->shdr->bfd_section) != NULL
    798      1.1     skrll 		      && elf_next_in_group (s) != NULL)
    799      1.1     skrll 		    break;
    800      1.1     skrll 		if (n_elt != 0)
    801      1.1     skrll 		  {
    802      1.1     skrll 		    /* Snarf the group name from other member, and
    803      1.1     skrll 		       insert current section in circular list.  */
    804      1.1     skrll 		    elf_group_name (newsect) = elf_group_name (s);
    805      1.1     skrll 		    elf_next_in_group (newsect) = elf_next_in_group (s);
    806      1.1     skrll 		    elf_next_in_group (s) = newsect;
    807      1.1     skrll 		  }
    808      1.1     skrll 		else
    809      1.1     skrll 		  {
    810      1.1     skrll 		    const char *gname;
    811      1.1     skrll 
    812      1.1     skrll 		    gname = group_signature (abfd, shdr);
    813      1.1     skrll 		    if (gname == NULL)
    814      1.1     skrll 		      return FALSE;
    815      1.1     skrll 		    elf_group_name (newsect) = gname;
    816      1.1     skrll 
    817      1.1     skrll 		    /* Start a circular list with one element.  */
    818      1.1     skrll 		    elf_next_in_group (newsect) = newsect;
    819      1.1     skrll 		  }
    820      1.1     skrll 
    821      1.1     skrll 		/* If the group section has been created, point to the
    822      1.1     skrll 		   new member.  */
    823      1.1     skrll 		if (shdr->bfd_section != NULL)
    824      1.1     skrll 		  elf_next_in_group (shdr->bfd_section) = newsect;
    825      1.1     skrll 
    826  1.1.1.7  christos 		elf_tdata (abfd)->group_search_offset = i;
    827  1.1.1.7  christos 		j = num_group - 1;
    828      1.1     skrll 		break;
    829      1.1     skrll 	      }
    830      1.1     skrll 	}
    831      1.1     skrll     }
    832      1.1     skrll 
    833      1.1     skrll   if (elf_group_name (newsect) == NULL)
    834      1.1     skrll     {
    835  1.1.1.7  christos       /* xgettext:c-format */
    836  1.1.1.8  christos       _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: no group info for section '%pA'"),
    837  1.1.1.7  christos 			  abfd, newsect);
    838  1.1.1.5  christos       return FALSE;
    839      1.1     skrll     }
    840      1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
    841      1.1     skrll }
    842      1.1     skrll 
    843      1.1     skrll bfd_boolean
    844      1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_setup_sections (bfd *abfd)
    845      1.1     skrll {
    846      1.1     skrll   unsigned int i;
    847      1.1     skrll   unsigned int num_group = elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group;
    848      1.1     skrll   bfd_boolean result = TRUE;
    849      1.1     skrll   asection *s;
    850      1.1     skrll 
    851      1.1     skrll   /* Process SHF_LINK_ORDER.  */
    852      1.1     skrll   for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
    853      1.1     skrll     {
    854      1.1     skrll       Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr = &elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr;
    855      1.1     skrll       if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_LINK_ORDER) != 0)
    856      1.1     skrll 	{
    857      1.1     skrll 	  unsigned int elfsec = this_hdr->sh_link;
    858      1.1     skrll 	  /* FIXME: The old Intel compiler and old strip/objcopy may
    859      1.1     skrll 	     not set the sh_link or sh_info fields.  Hence we could
    860      1.1     skrll 	     get the situation where elfsec is 0.  */
    861      1.1     skrll 	  if (elfsec == 0)
    862      1.1     skrll 	    {
    863      1.1     skrll 	      const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
    864      1.1     skrll 	      if (bed->link_order_error_handler)
    865      1.1     skrll 		bed->link_order_error_handler
    866  1.1.1.7  christos 		  /* xgettext:c-format */
    867  1.1.1.8  christos 		  (_("%pB: warning: sh_link not set for section `%pA'"),
    868      1.1     skrll 		   abfd, s);
    869      1.1     skrll 	    }
    870      1.1     skrll 	  else
    871      1.1     skrll 	    {
    872  1.1.1.3  christos 	      asection *linksec = NULL;
    873      1.1     skrll 
    874      1.1     skrll 	      if (elfsec < elf_numsections (abfd))
    875      1.1     skrll 		{
    876      1.1     skrll 		  this_hdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[elfsec];
    877  1.1.1.3  christos 		  linksec = this_hdr->bfd_section;
    878      1.1     skrll 		}
    879      1.1     skrll 
    880      1.1     skrll 	      /* PR 1991, 2008:
    881      1.1     skrll 		 Some strip/objcopy may leave an incorrect value in
    882      1.1     skrll 		 sh_link.  We don't want to proceed.  */
    883  1.1.1.3  christos 	      if (linksec == NULL)
    884      1.1     skrll 		{
    885  1.1.1.7  christos 		  _bfd_error_handler
    886  1.1.1.7  christos 		    /* xgettext:c-format */
    887  1.1.1.8  christos 		    (_("%pB: sh_link [%d] in section `%pA' is incorrect"),
    888  1.1.1.7  christos 		     s->owner, elfsec, s);
    889      1.1     skrll 		  result = FALSE;
    890      1.1     skrll 		}
    891      1.1     skrll 
    892  1.1.1.3  christos 	      elf_linked_to_section (s) = linksec;
    893      1.1     skrll 	    }
    894      1.1     skrll 	}
    895  1.1.1.7  christos       else if (this_hdr->sh_type == SHT_GROUP
    896  1.1.1.7  christos 	       && elf_next_in_group (s) == NULL)
    897  1.1.1.7  christos 	{
    898  1.1.1.7  christos 	  _bfd_error_handler
    899  1.1.1.7  christos 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
    900  1.1.1.8  christos 	    (_("%pB: SHT_GROUP section [index %d] has no SHF_GROUP sections"),
    901  1.1.1.7  christos 	     abfd, elf_section_data (s)->this_idx);
    902  1.1.1.7  christos 	  result = FALSE;
    903  1.1.1.7  christos 	}
    904      1.1     skrll     }
    905      1.1     skrll 
    906      1.1     skrll   /* Process section groups.  */
    907      1.1     skrll   if (num_group == (unsigned) -1)
    908      1.1     skrll     return result;
    909      1.1     skrll 
    910      1.1     skrll   for (i = 0; i < num_group; i++)
    911      1.1     skrll     {
    912      1.1     skrll       Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr[i];
    913  1.1.1.5  christos       Elf_Internal_Group *idx;
    914  1.1.1.5  christos       unsigned int n_elt;
    915  1.1.1.5  christos 
    916  1.1.1.5  christos       /* PR binutils/18758: Beware of corrupt binaries with invalid group data.  */
    917  1.1.1.5  christos       if (shdr == NULL || shdr->bfd_section == NULL || shdr->contents == NULL)
    918  1.1.1.5  christos 	{
    919  1.1.1.7  christos 	  _bfd_error_handler
    920  1.1.1.7  christos 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
    921  1.1.1.8  christos 	    (_("%pB: section group entry number %u is corrupt"),
    922  1.1.1.5  christos 	     abfd, i);
    923  1.1.1.5  christos 	  result = FALSE;
    924  1.1.1.5  christos 	  continue;
    925  1.1.1.5  christos 	}
    926  1.1.1.5  christos 
    927  1.1.1.5  christos       idx = (Elf_Internal_Group *) shdr->contents;
    928  1.1.1.5  christos       n_elt = shdr->sh_size / 4;
    929      1.1     skrll 
    930      1.1     skrll       while (--n_elt != 0)
    931  1.1.1.7  christos 	{
    932  1.1.1.7  christos 	  ++ idx;
    933  1.1.1.7  christos 
    934  1.1.1.7  christos 	  if (idx->shdr == NULL)
    935  1.1.1.7  christos 	    continue;
    936  1.1.1.7  christos 	  else if (idx->shdr->bfd_section)
    937  1.1.1.7  christos 	    elf_sec_group (idx->shdr->bfd_section) = shdr->bfd_section;
    938  1.1.1.7  christos 	  else if (idx->shdr->sh_type != SHT_RELA
    939  1.1.1.7  christos 		   && idx->shdr->sh_type != SHT_REL)
    940  1.1.1.7  christos 	    {
    941  1.1.1.7  christos 	      /* There are some unknown sections in the group.  */
    942  1.1.1.7  christos 	      _bfd_error_handler
    943  1.1.1.7  christos 		/* xgettext:c-format */
    944  1.1.1.8  christos 		(_("%pB: unknown type [%#x] section `%s' in group [%pA]"),
    945  1.1.1.7  christos 		 abfd,
    946  1.1.1.7  christos 		 idx->shdr->sh_type,
    947  1.1.1.7  christos 		 bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd,
    948  1.1.1.7  christos 						  (elf_elfheader (abfd)
    949  1.1.1.7  christos 						   ->e_shstrndx),
    950  1.1.1.7  christos 						  idx->shdr->sh_name),
    951  1.1.1.7  christos 		 shdr->bfd_section);
    952  1.1.1.7  christos 	      result = FALSE;
    953  1.1.1.7  christos 	    }
    954  1.1.1.7  christos 	}
    955      1.1     skrll     }
    956  1.1.1.7  christos 
    957      1.1     skrll   return result;
    958      1.1     skrll }
    959      1.1     skrll 
    960      1.1     skrll bfd_boolean
    961      1.1     skrll bfd_elf_is_group_section (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, const asection *sec)
    962      1.1     skrll {
    963      1.1     skrll   return elf_next_in_group (sec) != NULL;
    964      1.1     skrll }
    965      1.1     skrll 
    966  1.1.1.5  christos static char *
    967  1.1.1.5  christos convert_debug_to_zdebug (bfd *abfd, const char *name)
    968  1.1.1.5  christos {
    969  1.1.1.5  christos   unsigned int len = strlen (name);
    970  1.1.1.5  christos   char *new_name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len + 2);
    971  1.1.1.5  christos   if (new_name == NULL)
    972  1.1.1.5  christos     return NULL;
    973  1.1.1.5  christos   new_name[0] = '.';
    974  1.1.1.5  christos   new_name[1] = 'z';
    975  1.1.1.5  christos   memcpy (new_name + 2, name + 1, len);
    976  1.1.1.5  christos   return new_name;
    977  1.1.1.5  christos }
    978  1.1.1.5  christos 
    979  1.1.1.5  christos static char *
    980  1.1.1.5  christos convert_zdebug_to_debug (bfd *abfd, const char *name)
    981  1.1.1.5  christos {
    982  1.1.1.5  christos   unsigned int len = strlen (name);
    983  1.1.1.5  christos   char *new_name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
    984  1.1.1.5  christos   if (new_name == NULL)
    985  1.1.1.5  christos     return NULL;
    986  1.1.1.5  christos   new_name[0] = '.';
    987  1.1.1.5  christos   memcpy (new_name + 1, name + 2, len - 1);
    988  1.1.1.5  christos   return new_name;
    989  1.1.1.5  christos }
    990  1.1.1.5  christos 
    991      1.1     skrll /* Make a BFD section from an ELF section.  We store a pointer to the
    992      1.1     skrll    BFD section in the bfd_section field of the header.  */
    993      1.1     skrll 
    994      1.1     skrll bfd_boolean
    995      1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (bfd *abfd,
    996      1.1     skrll 				 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr,
    997      1.1     skrll 				 const char *name,
    998      1.1     skrll 				 int shindex)
    999      1.1     skrll {
   1000      1.1     skrll   asection *newsect;
   1001      1.1     skrll   flagword flags;
   1002      1.1     skrll   const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
   1003      1.1     skrll 
   1004      1.1     skrll   if (hdr->bfd_section != NULL)
   1005  1.1.1.3  christos     return TRUE;
   1006      1.1     skrll 
   1007      1.1     skrll   newsect = bfd_make_section_anyway (abfd, name);
   1008      1.1     skrll   if (newsect == NULL)
   1009      1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   1010      1.1     skrll 
   1011      1.1     skrll   hdr->bfd_section = newsect;
   1012      1.1     skrll   elf_section_data (newsect)->this_hdr = *hdr;
   1013      1.1     skrll   elf_section_data (newsect)->this_idx = shindex;
   1014      1.1     skrll 
   1015      1.1     skrll   /* Always use the real type/flags.  */
   1016      1.1     skrll   elf_section_type (newsect) = hdr->sh_type;
   1017      1.1     skrll   elf_section_flags (newsect) = hdr->sh_flags;
   1018      1.1     skrll 
   1019      1.1     skrll   newsect->filepos = hdr->sh_offset;
   1020      1.1     skrll 
   1021      1.1     skrll   if (! bfd_set_section_vma (abfd, newsect, hdr->sh_addr)
   1022      1.1     skrll       || ! bfd_set_section_size (abfd, newsect, hdr->sh_size)
   1023      1.1     skrll       || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, newsect,
   1024      1.1     skrll 				      bfd_log2 (hdr->sh_addralign)))
   1025      1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   1026      1.1     skrll 
   1027      1.1     skrll   flags = SEC_NO_FLAGS;
   1028      1.1     skrll   if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
   1029      1.1     skrll     flags |= SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
   1030      1.1     skrll   if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_GROUP)
   1031  1.1.1.7  christos     flags |= SEC_GROUP;
   1032      1.1     skrll   if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
   1033      1.1     skrll     {
   1034      1.1     skrll       flags |= SEC_ALLOC;
   1035      1.1     skrll       if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
   1036      1.1     skrll 	flags |= SEC_LOAD;
   1037      1.1     skrll     }
   1038      1.1     skrll   if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_WRITE) == 0)
   1039      1.1     skrll     flags |= SEC_READONLY;
   1040      1.1     skrll   if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_EXECINSTR) != 0)
   1041      1.1     skrll     flags |= SEC_CODE;
   1042      1.1     skrll   else if ((flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
   1043      1.1     skrll     flags |= SEC_DATA;
   1044      1.1     skrll   if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_MERGE) != 0)
   1045      1.1     skrll     {
   1046      1.1     skrll       flags |= SEC_MERGE;
   1047      1.1     skrll       newsect->entsize = hdr->sh_entsize;
   1048      1.1     skrll     }
   1049  1.1.1.6  christos   if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_STRINGS) != 0)
   1050  1.1.1.6  christos     flags |= SEC_STRINGS;
   1051      1.1     skrll   if (hdr->sh_flags & SHF_GROUP)
   1052      1.1     skrll     if (!setup_group (abfd, hdr, newsect))
   1053      1.1     skrll       return FALSE;
   1054      1.1     skrll   if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) != 0)
   1055      1.1     skrll     flags |= SEC_THREAD_LOCAL;
   1056  1.1.1.3  christos   if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_EXCLUDE) != 0)
   1057  1.1.1.3  christos     flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
   1058      1.1     skrll 
   1059      1.1     skrll   if ((flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0)
   1060      1.1     skrll     {
   1061      1.1     skrll       /* The debugging sections appear to be recognized only by name,
   1062      1.1     skrll 	 not any sort of flag.  Their SEC_ALLOC bits are cleared.  */
   1063      1.1     skrll       if (name [0] == '.')
   1064      1.1     skrll 	{
   1065  1.1.1.4  christos 	  const char *p;
   1066  1.1.1.4  christos 	  int n;
   1067  1.1.1.4  christos 	  if (name[1] == 'd')
   1068  1.1.1.4  christos 	    p = ".debug", n = 6;
   1069  1.1.1.4  christos 	  else if (name[1] == 'g' && name[2] == 'n')
   1070  1.1.1.4  christos 	    p = ".gnu.linkonce.wi.", n = 17;
   1071  1.1.1.4  christos 	  else if (name[1] == 'g' && name[2] == 'd')
   1072  1.1.1.4  christos 	    p = ".gdb_index", n = 11; /* yes we really do mean 11.  */
   1073  1.1.1.4  christos 	  else if (name[1] == 'l')
   1074  1.1.1.4  christos 	    p = ".line", n = 5;
   1075  1.1.1.4  christos 	  else if (name[1] == 's')
   1076  1.1.1.4  christos 	    p = ".stab", n = 5;
   1077  1.1.1.4  christos 	  else if (name[1] == 'z')
   1078  1.1.1.4  christos 	    p = ".zdebug", n = 7;
   1079  1.1.1.4  christos 	  else
   1080  1.1.1.4  christos 	    p = NULL, n = 0;
   1081  1.1.1.4  christos 	  if (p != NULL && strncmp (name, p, n) == 0)
   1082      1.1     skrll 	    flags |= SEC_DEBUGGING;
   1083      1.1     skrll 	}
   1084      1.1     skrll     }
   1085      1.1     skrll 
   1086      1.1     skrll   /* As a GNU extension, if the name begins with .gnu.linkonce, we
   1087      1.1     skrll      only link a single copy of the section.  This is used to support
   1088      1.1     skrll      g++.  g++ will emit each template expansion in its own section.
   1089      1.1     skrll      The symbols will be defined as weak, so that multiple definitions
   1090      1.1     skrll      are permitted.  The GNU linker extension is to actually discard
   1091      1.1     skrll      all but one of the sections.  */
   1092      1.1     skrll   if (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".gnu.linkonce")
   1093      1.1     skrll       && elf_next_in_group (newsect) == NULL)
   1094      1.1     skrll     flags |= SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES_DISCARD;
   1095      1.1     skrll 
   1096      1.1     skrll   bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   1097      1.1     skrll   if (bed->elf_backend_section_flags)
   1098      1.1     skrll     if (! bed->elf_backend_section_flags (&flags, hdr))
   1099      1.1     skrll       return FALSE;
   1100      1.1     skrll 
   1101      1.1     skrll   if (! bfd_set_section_flags (abfd, newsect, flags))
   1102      1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   1103      1.1     skrll 
   1104      1.1     skrll   /* We do not parse the PT_NOTE segments as we are interested even in the
   1105      1.1     skrll      separate debug info files which may have the segments offsets corrupted.
   1106      1.1     skrll      PT_NOTEs from the core files are currently not parsed using BFD.  */
   1107      1.1     skrll   if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_NOTE)
   1108      1.1     skrll     {
   1109      1.1     skrll       bfd_byte *contents;
   1110      1.1     skrll 
   1111      1.1     skrll       if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, newsect, &contents))
   1112      1.1     skrll 	return FALSE;
   1113      1.1     skrll 
   1114  1.1.1.7  christos       elf_parse_notes (abfd, (char *) contents, hdr->sh_size,
   1115  1.1.1.7  christos 		       hdr->sh_offset, hdr->sh_addralign);
   1116      1.1     skrll       free (contents);
   1117      1.1     skrll     }
   1118      1.1     skrll 
   1119      1.1     skrll   if ((flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
   1120      1.1     skrll     {
   1121      1.1     skrll       Elf_Internal_Phdr *phdr;
   1122      1.1     skrll       unsigned int i, nload;
   1123      1.1     skrll 
   1124      1.1     skrll       /* Some ELF linkers produce binaries with all the program header
   1125      1.1     skrll 	 p_paddr fields zero.  If we have such a binary with more than
   1126      1.1     skrll 	 one PT_LOAD header, then leave the section lma equal to vma
   1127      1.1     skrll 	 so that we don't create sections with overlapping lma.  */
   1128      1.1     skrll       phdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
   1129      1.1     skrll       for (nload = 0, i = 0; i < elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum; i++, phdr++)
   1130      1.1     skrll 	if (phdr->p_paddr != 0)
   1131      1.1     skrll 	  break;
   1132      1.1     skrll 	else if (phdr->p_type == PT_LOAD && phdr->p_memsz != 0)
   1133      1.1     skrll 	  ++nload;
   1134      1.1     skrll       if (i >= elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum && nload > 1)
   1135      1.1     skrll 	return TRUE;
   1136      1.1     skrll 
   1137      1.1     skrll       phdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
   1138      1.1     skrll       for (i = 0; i < elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum; i++, phdr++)
   1139      1.1     skrll 	{
   1140  1.1.1.3  christos 	  if (((phdr->p_type == PT_LOAD
   1141  1.1.1.3  christos 		&& (hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) == 0)
   1142  1.1.1.3  christos 	       || phdr->p_type == PT_TLS)
   1143  1.1.1.3  christos 	      && ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (hdr, phdr))
   1144      1.1     skrll 	    {
   1145      1.1     skrll 	      if ((flags & SEC_LOAD) == 0)
   1146      1.1     skrll 		newsect->lma = (phdr->p_paddr
   1147      1.1     skrll 				+ hdr->sh_addr - phdr->p_vaddr);
   1148      1.1     skrll 	      else
   1149      1.1     skrll 		/* We used to use the same adjustment for SEC_LOAD
   1150      1.1     skrll 		   sections, but that doesn't work if the segment
   1151      1.1     skrll 		   is packed with code from multiple VMAs.
   1152      1.1     skrll 		   Instead we calculate the section LMA based on
   1153      1.1     skrll 		   the segment LMA.  It is assumed that the
   1154      1.1     skrll 		   segment will contain sections with contiguous
   1155      1.1     skrll 		   LMAs, even if the VMAs are not.  */
   1156      1.1     skrll 		newsect->lma = (phdr->p_paddr
   1157      1.1     skrll 				+ hdr->sh_offset - phdr->p_offset);
   1158      1.1     skrll 
   1159      1.1     skrll 	      /* With contiguous segments, we can't tell from file
   1160      1.1     skrll 		 offsets whether a section with zero size should
   1161      1.1     skrll 		 be placed at the end of one segment or the
   1162      1.1     skrll 		 beginning of the next.  Decide based on vaddr.  */
   1163      1.1     skrll 	      if (hdr->sh_addr >= phdr->p_vaddr
   1164      1.1     skrll 		  && (hdr->sh_addr + hdr->sh_size
   1165      1.1     skrll 		      <= phdr->p_vaddr + phdr->p_memsz))
   1166      1.1     skrll 		break;
   1167      1.1     skrll 	    }
   1168      1.1     skrll 	}
   1169      1.1     skrll     }
   1170      1.1     skrll 
   1171  1.1.1.3  christos   /* Compress/decompress DWARF debug sections with names: .debug_* and
   1172  1.1.1.3  christos      .zdebug_*, after the section flags is set.  */
   1173  1.1.1.3  christos   if ((flags & SEC_DEBUGGING)
   1174  1.1.1.3  christos       && ((name[1] == 'd' && name[6] == '_')
   1175  1.1.1.3  christos 	  || (name[1] == 'z' && name[7] == '_')))
   1176  1.1.1.3  christos     {
   1177  1.1.1.3  christos       enum { nothing, compress, decompress } action = nothing;
   1178  1.1.1.5  christos       int compression_header_size;
   1179  1.1.1.5  christos       bfd_size_type uncompressed_size;
   1180  1.1.1.5  christos       bfd_boolean compressed
   1181  1.1.1.5  christos 	= bfd_is_section_compressed_with_header (abfd, newsect,
   1182  1.1.1.5  christos 						 &compression_header_size,
   1183  1.1.1.5  christos 						 &uncompressed_size);
   1184  1.1.1.3  christos 
   1185  1.1.1.5  christos       if (compressed)
   1186  1.1.1.3  christos 	{
   1187  1.1.1.3  christos 	  /* Compressed section.  Check if we should decompress.  */
   1188  1.1.1.3  christos 	  if ((abfd->flags & BFD_DECOMPRESS))
   1189  1.1.1.3  christos 	    action = decompress;
   1190  1.1.1.3  christos 	}
   1191  1.1.1.5  christos 
   1192  1.1.1.5  christos       /* Compress the uncompressed section or convert from/to .zdebug*
   1193  1.1.1.5  christos 	 section.  Check if we should compress.  */
   1194  1.1.1.5  christos       if (action == nothing)
   1195  1.1.1.5  christos 	{
   1196  1.1.1.5  christos 	  if (newsect->size != 0
   1197  1.1.1.5  christos 	      && (abfd->flags & BFD_COMPRESS)
   1198  1.1.1.5  christos 	      && compression_header_size >= 0
   1199  1.1.1.5  christos 	      && uncompressed_size > 0
   1200  1.1.1.5  christos 	      && (!compressed
   1201  1.1.1.5  christos 		  || ((compression_header_size > 0)
   1202  1.1.1.5  christos 		      != ((abfd->flags & BFD_COMPRESS_GABI) != 0))))
   1203  1.1.1.3  christos 	    action = compress;
   1204  1.1.1.5  christos 	  else
   1205  1.1.1.5  christos 	    return TRUE;
   1206  1.1.1.3  christos 	}
   1207      1.1     skrll 
   1208  1.1.1.5  christos       if (action == compress)
   1209  1.1.1.3  christos 	{
   1210  1.1.1.3  christos 	  if (!bfd_init_section_compress_status (abfd, newsect))
   1211  1.1.1.3  christos 	    {
   1212  1.1.1.7  christos 	      _bfd_error_handler
   1213  1.1.1.7  christos 		/* xgettext:c-format */
   1214  1.1.1.8  christos 		(_("%pB: unable to initialize compress status for section %s"),
   1215  1.1.1.3  christos 		 abfd, name);
   1216  1.1.1.3  christos 	      return FALSE;
   1217  1.1.1.3  christos 	    }
   1218  1.1.1.5  christos 	}
   1219  1.1.1.5  christos       else
   1220  1.1.1.5  christos 	{
   1221  1.1.1.3  christos 	  if (!bfd_init_section_decompress_status (abfd, newsect))
   1222  1.1.1.3  christos 	    {
   1223  1.1.1.7  christos 	      _bfd_error_handler
   1224  1.1.1.7  christos 		/* xgettext:c-format */
   1225  1.1.1.8  christos 		(_("%pB: unable to initialize decompress status for section %s"),
   1226  1.1.1.3  christos 		 abfd, name);
   1227  1.1.1.3  christos 	      return FALSE;
   1228  1.1.1.3  christos 	    }
   1229  1.1.1.5  christos 	}
   1230      1.1     skrll 
   1231  1.1.1.5  christos       if (abfd->is_linker_input)
   1232  1.1.1.5  christos 	{
   1233  1.1.1.5  christos 	  if (name[1] == 'z'
   1234  1.1.1.5  christos 	      && (action == decompress
   1235  1.1.1.5  christos 		  || (action == compress
   1236  1.1.1.5  christos 		      && (abfd->flags & BFD_COMPRESS_GABI) != 0)))
   1237  1.1.1.5  christos 	    {
   1238  1.1.1.5  christos 	      /* Convert section name from .zdebug_* to .debug_* so
   1239  1.1.1.5  christos 		 that linker will consider this section as a debug
   1240  1.1.1.5  christos 		 section.  */
   1241  1.1.1.5  christos 	      char *new_name = convert_zdebug_to_debug (abfd, name);
   1242  1.1.1.3  christos 	      if (new_name == NULL)
   1243  1.1.1.3  christos 		return FALSE;
   1244  1.1.1.5  christos 	      bfd_rename_section (abfd, newsect, new_name);
   1245  1.1.1.3  christos 	    }
   1246      1.1     skrll 	}
   1247  1.1.1.5  christos       else
   1248  1.1.1.5  christos 	/* For objdump, don't rename the section.  For objcopy, delay
   1249  1.1.1.5  christos 	   section rename to elf_fake_sections.  */
   1250  1.1.1.5  christos 	newsect->flags |= SEC_ELF_RENAME;
   1251      1.1     skrll     }
   1252  1.1.1.3  christos 
   1253  1.1.1.3  christos   return TRUE;
   1254      1.1     skrll }
   1255      1.1     skrll 
   1256  1.1.1.6  christos const char *const bfd_elf_section_type_names[] =
   1257  1.1.1.6  christos {
   1258      1.1     skrll   "SHT_NULL", "SHT_PROGBITS", "SHT_SYMTAB", "SHT_STRTAB",
   1259      1.1     skrll   "SHT_RELA", "SHT_HASH", "SHT_DYNAMIC", "SHT_NOTE",
   1260      1.1     skrll   "SHT_NOBITS", "SHT_REL", "SHT_SHLIB", "SHT_DYNSYM",
   1261      1.1     skrll };
   1262      1.1     skrll 
   1263      1.1     skrll /* ELF relocs are against symbols.  If we are producing relocatable
   1264      1.1     skrll    output, and the reloc is against an external symbol, and nothing
   1265      1.1     skrll    has given us any additional addend, the resulting reloc will also
   1266      1.1     skrll    be against the same symbol.  In such a case, we don't want to
   1267      1.1     skrll    change anything about the way the reloc is handled, since it will
   1268      1.1     skrll    all be done at final link time.  Rather than put special case code
   1269      1.1     skrll    into bfd_perform_relocation, all the reloc types use this howto
   1270      1.1     skrll    function.  It just short circuits the reloc if producing
   1271      1.1     skrll    relocatable output against an external symbol.  */
   1272      1.1     skrll 
   1273      1.1     skrll bfd_reloc_status_type
   1274      1.1     skrll bfd_elf_generic_reloc (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
   1275      1.1     skrll 		       arelent *reloc_entry,
   1276      1.1     skrll 		       asymbol *symbol,
   1277      1.1     skrll 		       void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
   1278      1.1     skrll 		       asection *input_section,
   1279      1.1     skrll 		       bfd *output_bfd,
   1280      1.1     skrll 		       char **error_message ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
   1281      1.1     skrll {
   1282      1.1     skrll   if (output_bfd != NULL
   1283      1.1     skrll       && (symbol->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) == 0
   1284      1.1     skrll       && (! reloc_entry->howto->partial_inplace
   1285      1.1     skrll 	  || reloc_entry->addend == 0))
   1286      1.1     skrll     {
   1287      1.1     skrll       reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
   1288      1.1     skrll       return bfd_reloc_ok;
   1289      1.1     skrll     }
   1290      1.1     skrll 
   1291      1.1     skrll   return bfd_reloc_continue;
   1292      1.1     skrll }
   1293      1.1     skrll 
   1294  1.1.1.6  christos /* Returns TRUE if section A matches section B.
   1296  1.1.1.6  christos    Names, addresses and links may be different, but everything else
   1297  1.1.1.6  christos    should be the same.  */
   1298  1.1.1.6  christos 
   1299  1.1.1.6  christos static bfd_boolean
   1300  1.1.1.6  christos section_match (const Elf_Internal_Shdr * a,
   1301  1.1.1.6  christos 	       const Elf_Internal_Shdr * b)
   1302  1.1.1.6  christos {
   1303  1.1.1.7  christos   return
   1304  1.1.1.6  christos     a->sh_type	       == b->sh_type
   1305  1.1.1.6  christos     && (a->sh_flags & ~ SHF_INFO_LINK)
   1306  1.1.1.6  christos     == (b->sh_flags & ~ SHF_INFO_LINK)
   1307  1.1.1.6  christos     && a->sh_addralign == b->sh_addralign
   1308  1.1.1.6  christos     && a->sh_size      == b->sh_size
   1309  1.1.1.6  christos     && a->sh_entsize   == b->sh_entsize
   1310  1.1.1.6  christos     /* FIXME: Check sh_addr ?  */
   1311  1.1.1.6  christos     ;
   1312  1.1.1.6  christos }
   1313  1.1.1.6  christos 
   1314  1.1.1.6  christos /* Find a section in OBFD that has the same characteristics
   1315  1.1.1.6  christos    as IHEADER.  Return the index of this section or SHN_UNDEF if
   1316  1.1.1.6  christos    none can be found.  Check's section HINT first, as this is likely
   1317  1.1.1.6  christos    to be the correct section.  */
   1318  1.1.1.6  christos 
   1319  1.1.1.7  christos static unsigned int
   1320  1.1.1.7  christos find_link (const bfd *obfd, const Elf_Internal_Shdr *iheader,
   1321  1.1.1.6  christos 	   const unsigned int hint)
   1322  1.1.1.6  christos {
   1323  1.1.1.6  christos   Elf_Internal_Shdr ** oheaders = elf_elfsections (obfd);
   1324  1.1.1.6  christos   unsigned int i;
   1325  1.1.1.7  christos 
   1326  1.1.1.7  christos   BFD_ASSERT (iheader != NULL);
   1327  1.1.1.7  christos 
   1328  1.1.1.7  christos   /* See PR 20922 for a reproducer of the NULL test.  */
   1329  1.1.1.7  christos   if (hint < elf_numsections (obfd)
   1330  1.1.1.7  christos       && oheaders[hint] != NULL
   1331  1.1.1.6  christos       && section_match (oheaders[hint], iheader))
   1332  1.1.1.6  christos     return hint;
   1333  1.1.1.6  christos 
   1334  1.1.1.6  christos   for (i = 1; i < elf_numsections (obfd); i++)
   1335  1.1.1.6  christos     {
   1336  1.1.1.6  christos       Elf_Internal_Shdr * oheader = oheaders[i];
   1337  1.1.1.7  christos 
   1338  1.1.1.7  christos       if (oheader == NULL)
   1339  1.1.1.6  christos 	continue;
   1340  1.1.1.6  christos       if (section_match (oheader, iheader))
   1341  1.1.1.6  christos 	/* FIXME: Do we care if there is a potential for
   1342  1.1.1.6  christos 	   multiple matches ?  */
   1343  1.1.1.6  christos 	return i;
   1344  1.1.1.6  christos     }
   1345  1.1.1.6  christos 
   1346  1.1.1.6  christos   return SHN_UNDEF;
   1347  1.1.1.6  christos }
   1348  1.1.1.6  christos 
   1349  1.1.1.6  christos /* PR 19938: Attempt to set the ELF section header fields of an OS or
   1350  1.1.1.6  christos    Processor specific section, based upon a matching input section.
   1351  1.1.1.7  christos    Returns TRUE upon success, FALSE otherwise.  */
   1352  1.1.1.6  christos 
   1353  1.1.1.6  christos static bfd_boolean
   1354  1.1.1.6  christos copy_special_section_fields (const bfd *ibfd,
   1355  1.1.1.6  christos 			     bfd *obfd,
   1356  1.1.1.6  christos 			     const Elf_Internal_Shdr *iheader,
   1357  1.1.1.6  christos 			     Elf_Internal_Shdr *oheader,
   1358  1.1.1.6  christos 			     const unsigned int secnum)
   1359  1.1.1.6  christos {
   1360  1.1.1.6  christos   const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (obfd);
   1361  1.1.1.6  christos   const Elf_Internal_Shdr **iheaders = (const Elf_Internal_Shdr **) elf_elfsections (ibfd);
   1362  1.1.1.6  christos   bfd_boolean changed = FALSE;
   1363  1.1.1.6  christos   unsigned int sh_link;
   1364  1.1.1.6  christos 
   1365  1.1.1.6  christos   if (oheader->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS)
   1366  1.1.1.6  christos     {
   1367  1.1.1.6  christos       /* This is a feature for objcopy --only-keep-debug:
   1368  1.1.1.6  christos 	 When a section's type is changed to NOBITS, we preserve
   1369  1.1.1.6  christos 	 the sh_link and sh_info fields so that they can be
   1370  1.1.1.6  christos 	 matched up with the original.
   1371  1.1.1.6  christos 
   1372  1.1.1.6  christos 	 Note: Strictly speaking these assignments are wrong.
   1373  1.1.1.6  christos 	 The sh_link and sh_info fields should point to the
   1374  1.1.1.6  christos 	 relevent sections in the output BFD, which may not be in
   1375  1.1.1.6  christos 	 the same location as they were in the input BFD.  But
   1376  1.1.1.6  christos 	 the whole point of this action is to preserve the
   1377  1.1.1.6  christos 	 original values of the sh_link and sh_info fields, so
   1378  1.1.1.6  christos 	 that they can be matched up with the section headers in
   1379  1.1.1.6  christos 	 the original file.  So strictly speaking we may be
   1380  1.1.1.6  christos 	 creating an invalid ELF file, but it is only for a file
   1381  1.1.1.6  christos 	 that just contains debug info and only for sections
   1382  1.1.1.6  christos 	 without any contents.  */
   1383  1.1.1.6  christos       if (oheader->sh_link == 0)
   1384  1.1.1.6  christos 	oheader->sh_link = iheader->sh_link;
   1385  1.1.1.6  christos       if (oheader->sh_info == 0)
   1386  1.1.1.6  christos 	oheader->sh_info = iheader->sh_info;
   1387  1.1.1.6  christos       return TRUE;
   1388  1.1.1.6  christos     }
   1389  1.1.1.6  christos 
   1390  1.1.1.6  christos   /* Allow the target a chance to decide how these fields should be set.  */
   1391  1.1.1.6  christos   if (bed->elf_backend_copy_special_section_fields != NULL
   1392  1.1.1.6  christos       && bed->elf_backend_copy_special_section_fields
   1393  1.1.1.6  christos       (ibfd, obfd, iheader, oheader))
   1394  1.1.1.6  christos     return TRUE;
   1395  1.1.1.6  christos 
   1396  1.1.1.6  christos   /* We have an iheader which might match oheader, and which has non-zero
   1397  1.1.1.6  christos      sh_info and/or sh_link fields.  Attempt to follow those links and find
   1398  1.1.1.6  christos      the section in the output bfd which corresponds to the linked section
   1399  1.1.1.6  christos      in the input bfd.  */
   1400  1.1.1.6  christos   if (iheader->sh_link != SHN_UNDEF)
   1401  1.1.1.7  christos     {
   1402  1.1.1.7  christos       /* See PR 20931 for a reproducer.  */
   1403  1.1.1.7  christos       if (iheader->sh_link >= elf_numsections (ibfd))
   1404  1.1.1.7  christos 	{
   1405  1.1.1.7  christos 	  _bfd_error_handler
   1406  1.1.1.8  christos 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
   1407  1.1.1.7  christos 	    (_("%pB: invalid sh_link field (%d) in section number %d"),
   1408  1.1.1.7  christos 	     ibfd, iheader->sh_link, secnum);
   1409  1.1.1.7  christos 	  return FALSE;
   1410  1.1.1.7  christos 	}
   1411  1.1.1.6  christos 
   1412  1.1.1.6  christos       sh_link = find_link (obfd, iheaders[iheader->sh_link], iheader->sh_link);
   1413  1.1.1.6  christos       if (sh_link != SHN_UNDEF)
   1414  1.1.1.6  christos 	{
   1415  1.1.1.6  christos 	  oheader->sh_link = sh_link;
   1416  1.1.1.6  christos 	  changed = TRUE;
   1417  1.1.1.6  christos 	}
   1418  1.1.1.6  christos       else
   1419  1.1.1.6  christos 	/* FIXME: Should we install iheader->sh_link
   1420  1.1.1.7  christos 	   if we could not find a match ?  */
   1421  1.1.1.7  christos 	_bfd_error_handler
   1422  1.1.1.8  christos 	  /* xgettext:c-format */
   1423  1.1.1.6  christos 	  (_("%pB: failed to find link section for section %d"), obfd, secnum);
   1424  1.1.1.6  christos     }
   1425  1.1.1.6  christos 
   1426  1.1.1.6  christos   if (iheader->sh_info)
   1427  1.1.1.6  christos     {
   1428  1.1.1.6  christos       /* The sh_info field can hold arbitrary information, but if the
   1429  1.1.1.6  christos 	 SHF_LINK_INFO flag is set then it should be interpreted as a
   1430  1.1.1.6  christos 	 section index.  */
   1431  1.1.1.6  christos       if (iheader->sh_flags & SHF_INFO_LINK)
   1432  1.1.1.6  christos 	{
   1433  1.1.1.6  christos 	  sh_link = find_link (obfd, iheaders[iheader->sh_info],
   1434  1.1.1.6  christos 			       iheader->sh_info);
   1435  1.1.1.6  christos 	  if (sh_link != SHN_UNDEF)
   1436  1.1.1.6  christos 	    oheader->sh_flags |= SHF_INFO_LINK;
   1437  1.1.1.6  christos 	}
   1438  1.1.1.6  christos       else
   1439  1.1.1.6  christos 	/* No idea what it means - just copy it.  */
   1440  1.1.1.6  christos 	sh_link = iheader->sh_info;
   1441  1.1.1.6  christos 
   1442  1.1.1.6  christos       if (sh_link != SHN_UNDEF)
   1443  1.1.1.6  christos 	{
   1444  1.1.1.6  christos 	  oheader->sh_info = sh_link;
   1445  1.1.1.6  christos 	  changed = TRUE;
   1446  1.1.1.6  christos 	}
   1447  1.1.1.7  christos       else
   1448  1.1.1.7  christos 	_bfd_error_handler
   1449  1.1.1.8  christos 	  /* xgettext:c-format */
   1450  1.1.1.6  christos 	  (_("%pB: failed to find info section for section %d"), obfd, secnum);
   1451  1.1.1.6  christos     }
   1452  1.1.1.6  christos 
   1453  1.1.1.6  christos   return changed;
   1454  1.1.1.7  christos }
   1455      1.1     skrll 
   1456      1.1     skrll /* Copy the program header and other data from one object module to
   1457      1.1     skrll    another.  */
   1458      1.1     skrll 
   1459      1.1     skrll bfd_boolean
   1460      1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_copy_private_bfd_data (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
   1461  1.1.1.6  christos {
   1462  1.1.1.6  christos   const Elf_Internal_Shdr **iheaders = (const Elf_Internal_Shdr **) elf_elfsections (ibfd);
   1463  1.1.1.6  christos   Elf_Internal_Shdr **oheaders = elf_elfsections (obfd);
   1464  1.1.1.6  christos   const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
   1465  1.1.1.6  christos   unsigned int i;
   1466      1.1     skrll 
   1467  1.1.1.6  christos   if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
   1468      1.1     skrll     || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
   1469      1.1     skrll     return TRUE;
   1470  1.1.1.5  christos 
   1471  1.1.1.5  christos   if (!elf_flags_init (obfd))
   1472  1.1.1.5  christos     {
   1473  1.1.1.5  christos       elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_flags;
   1474  1.1.1.5  christos       elf_flags_init (obfd) = TRUE;
   1475      1.1     skrll     }
   1476      1.1     skrll 
   1477  1.1.1.5  christos   elf_gp (obfd) = elf_gp (ibfd);
   1478  1.1.1.5  christos 
   1479  1.1.1.5  christos   /* Also copy the EI_OSABI field.  */
   1480  1.1.1.5  christos   elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_ident[EI_OSABI] =
   1481      1.1     skrll     elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_ident[EI_OSABI];
   1482  1.1.1.6  christos 
   1483  1.1.1.6  christos   /* If set, copy the EI_ABIVERSION field.  */
   1484  1.1.1.6  christos   if (elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_ident[EI_ABIVERSION])
   1485  1.1.1.6  christos     elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_ident[EI_ABIVERSION]
   1486  1.1.1.7  christos       = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_ident[EI_ABIVERSION];
   1487      1.1     skrll 
   1488      1.1     skrll   /* Copy object attributes.  */
   1489  1.1.1.5  christos   _bfd_elf_copy_obj_attributes (ibfd, obfd);
   1490  1.1.1.6  christos 
   1491  1.1.1.6  christos   if (iheaders == NULL || oheaders == NULL)
   1492  1.1.1.6  christos     return TRUE;
   1493  1.1.1.6  christos 
   1494  1.1.1.5  christos   bed = get_elf_backend_data (obfd);
   1495  1.1.1.6  christos 
   1496  1.1.1.6  christos   /* Possibly copy other fields in the section header.  */
   1497  1.1.1.5  christos   for (i = 1; i < elf_numsections (obfd); i++)
   1498  1.1.1.6  christos     {
   1499  1.1.1.6  christos       unsigned int j;
   1500  1.1.1.6  christos       Elf_Internal_Shdr * oheader = oheaders[i];
   1501  1.1.1.6  christos 
   1502  1.1.1.6  christos       /* Ignore ordinary sections.  SHT_NOBITS sections are considered however
   1503  1.1.1.6  christos 	 because of a special case need for generating separate debug info
   1504  1.1.1.6  christos 	 files.  See below for more details.  */
   1505  1.1.1.6  christos       if (oheader == NULL
   1506  1.1.1.6  christos 	  || (oheader->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS
   1507  1.1.1.6  christos 	      && oheader->sh_type < SHT_LOOS))
   1508  1.1.1.5  christos 	continue;
   1509  1.1.1.6  christos 
   1510  1.1.1.6  christos       /* Ignore empty sections, and sections whose
   1511  1.1.1.6  christos 	 fields have already been initialised.  */
   1512  1.1.1.6  christos       if (oheader->sh_size == 0
   1513  1.1.1.6  christos 	  || (oheader->sh_info != 0 && oheader->sh_link != 0))
   1514  1.1.1.6  christos 	continue;
   1515  1.1.1.6  christos 
   1516  1.1.1.6  christos       /* Scan for the matching section in the input bfd.
   1517  1.1.1.6  christos 	 First we try for a direct mapping between the input and output sections.  */
   1518  1.1.1.5  christos       for (j = 1; j < elf_numsections (ibfd); j++)
   1519  1.1.1.6  christos 	{
   1520  1.1.1.5  christos 	  const Elf_Internal_Shdr * iheader = iheaders[j];
   1521  1.1.1.6  christos 
   1522  1.1.1.5  christos 	  if (iheader == NULL)
   1523  1.1.1.5  christos 	    continue;
   1524  1.1.1.6  christos 
   1525  1.1.1.6  christos 	  if (oheader->bfd_section != NULL
   1526  1.1.1.6  christos 	      && iheader->bfd_section != NULL
   1527  1.1.1.6  christos 	      && iheader->bfd_section->output_section != NULL
   1528  1.1.1.6  christos 	      && iheader->bfd_section->output_section == oheader->bfd_section)
   1529  1.1.1.6  christos 	    {
   1530  1.1.1.6  christos 	      /* We have found a connection from the input section to the
   1531  1.1.1.6  christos 		 output section.  Attempt to copy the header fields.  If
   1532  1.1.1.6  christos 		 this fails then do not try any further sections - there
   1533  1.1.1.6  christos 		 should only be a one-to-one mapping between input and output. */
   1534  1.1.1.6  christos 	      if (! copy_special_section_fields (ibfd, obfd, iheader, oheader, i))
   1535  1.1.1.6  christos 		j = elf_numsections (ibfd);
   1536  1.1.1.5  christos 	      break;
   1537  1.1.1.5  christos 	    }
   1538  1.1.1.6  christos 	}
   1539  1.1.1.6  christos 
   1540  1.1.1.6  christos       if (j < elf_numsections (ibfd))
   1541  1.1.1.6  christos 	continue;
   1542  1.1.1.6  christos 
   1543  1.1.1.6  christos       /* That failed.  So try to deduce the corresponding input section.
   1544  1.1.1.6  christos 	 Unfortunately we cannot compare names as the output string table
   1545  1.1.1.6  christos 	 is empty, so instead we check size, address and type.  */
   1546  1.1.1.6  christos       for (j = 1; j < elf_numsections (ibfd); j++)
   1547  1.1.1.6  christos 	{
   1548  1.1.1.6  christos 	  const Elf_Internal_Shdr * iheader = iheaders[j];
   1549  1.1.1.6  christos 
   1550  1.1.1.6  christos 	  if (iheader == NULL)
   1551  1.1.1.6  christos 	    continue;
   1552  1.1.1.6  christos 
   1553  1.1.1.6  christos 	  /* Try matching fields in the input section's header.
   1554  1.1.1.6  christos 	     Since --only-keep-debug turns all non-debug sections into
   1555  1.1.1.6  christos 	     SHT_NOBITS sections, the output SHT_NOBITS type matches any
   1556  1.1.1.6  christos 	     input type.  */
   1557  1.1.1.6  christos 	  if ((oheader->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS
   1558  1.1.1.6  christos 	       || iheader->sh_type == oheader->sh_type)
   1559  1.1.1.6  christos 	      && (iheader->sh_flags & ~ SHF_INFO_LINK)
   1560  1.1.1.6  christos 	      == (oheader->sh_flags & ~ SHF_INFO_LINK)
   1561  1.1.1.6  christos 	      && iheader->sh_addralign == oheader->sh_addralign
   1562  1.1.1.6  christos 	      && iheader->sh_entsize == oheader->sh_entsize
   1563  1.1.1.6  christos 	      && iheader->sh_size == oheader->sh_size
   1564  1.1.1.6  christos 	      && iheader->sh_addr == oheader->sh_addr
   1565  1.1.1.6  christos 	      && (iheader->sh_info != oheader->sh_info
   1566  1.1.1.6  christos 		  || iheader->sh_link != oheader->sh_link))
   1567  1.1.1.6  christos 	    {
   1568  1.1.1.6  christos 	      if (copy_special_section_fields (ibfd, obfd, iheader, oheader, i))
   1569  1.1.1.6  christos 		break;
   1570  1.1.1.6  christos 	    }
   1571  1.1.1.6  christos 	}
   1572  1.1.1.6  christos 
   1573  1.1.1.6  christos       if (j == elf_numsections (ibfd) && oheader->sh_type >= SHT_LOOS)
   1574  1.1.1.6  christos 	{
   1575  1.1.1.6  christos 	  /* Final attempt.  Call the backend copy function
   1576  1.1.1.6  christos 	     with a NULL input section.  */
   1577  1.1.1.6  christos 	  if (bed->elf_backend_copy_special_section_fields != NULL)
   1578  1.1.1.6  christos 	    bed->elf_backend_copy_special_section_fields (ibfd, obfd, NULL, oheader);
   1579  1.1.1.5  christos 	}
   1580  1.1.1.5  christos     }
   1581      1.1     skrll 
   1582      1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   1583      1.1     skrll }
   1584      1.1     skrll 
   1585      1.1     skrll static const char *
   1586      1.1     skrll get_segment_type (unsigned int p_type)
   1587      1.1     skrll {
   1588      1.1     skrll   const char *pt;
   1589      1.1     skrll   switch (p_type)
   1590      1.1     skrll     {
   1591      1.1     skrll     case PT_NULL: pt = "NULL"; break;
   1592      1.1     skrll     case PT_LOAD: pt = "LOAD"; break;
   1593      1.1     skrll     case PT_DYNAMIC: pt = "DYNAMIC"; break;
   1594      1.1     skrll     case PT_INTERP: pt = "INTERP"; break;
   1595      1.1     skrll     case PT_NOTE: pt = "NOTE"; break;
   1596      1.1     skrll     case PT_SHLIB: pt = "SHLIB"; break;
   1597      1.1     skrll     case PT_PHDR: pt = "PHDR"; break;
   1598      1.1     skrll     case PT_TLS: pt = "TLS"; break;
   1599      1.1     skrll     case PT_GNU_EH_FRAME: pt = "EH_FRAME"; break;
   1600      1.1     skrll     case PT_GNU_STACK: pt = "STACK"; break;
   1601      1.1     skrll     case PT_GNU_RELRO: pt = "RELRO"; break;
   1602      1.1     skrll     default: pt = NULL; break;
   1603      1.1     skrll     }
   1604      1.1     skrll   return pt;
   1605      1.1     skrll }
   1606      1.1     skrll 
   1607      1.1     skrll /* Print out the program headers.  */
   1608      1.1     skrll 
   1609      1.1     skrll bfd_boolean
   1610      1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_print_private_bfd_data (bfd *abfd, void *farg)
   1611  1.1.1.3  christos {
   1612      1.1     skrll   FILE *f = (FILE *) farg;
   1613      1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Phdr *p;
   1614      1.1     skrll   asection *s;
   1615      1.1     skrll   bfd_byte *dynbuf = NULL;
   1616      1.1     skrll 
   1617      1.1     skrll   p = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
   1618      1.1     skrll   if (p != NULL)
   1619      1.1     skrll     {
   1620      1.1     skrll       unsigned int i, c;
   1621      1.1     skrll 
   1622      1.1     skrll       fprintf (f, _("\nProgram Header:\n"));
   1623      1.1     skrll       c = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum;
   1624      1.1     skrll       for (i = 0; i < c; i++, p++)
   1625      1.1     skrll 	{
   1626      1.1     skrll 	  const char *pt = get_segment_type (p->p_type);
   1627      1.1     skrll 	  char buf[20];
   1628      1.1     skrll 
   1629      1.1     skrll 	  if (pt == NULL)
   1630      1.1     skrll 	    {
   1631      1.1     skrll 	      sprintf (buf, "0x%lx", p->p_type);
   1632      1.1     skrll 	      pt = buf;
   1633      1.1     skrll 	    }
   1634      1.1     skrll 	  fprintf (f, "%8s off    0x", pt);
   1635      1.1     skrll 	  bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_offset);
   1636      1.1     skrll 	  fprintf (f, " vaddr 0x");
   1637      1.1     skrll 	  bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_vaddr);
   1638      1.1     skrll 	  fprintf (f, " paddr 0x");
   1639      1.1     skrll 	  bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_paddr);
   1640      1.1     skrll 	  fprintf (f, " align 2**%u\n", bfd_log2 (p->p_align));
   1641      1.1     skrll 	  fprintf (f, "         filesz 0x");
   1642      1.1     skrll 	  bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_filesz);
   1643      1.1     skrll 	  fprintf (f, " memsz 0x");
   1644      1.1     skrll 	  bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_memsz);
   1645      1.1     skrll 	  fprintf (f, " flags %c%c%c",
   1646      1.1     skrll 		   (p->p_flags & PF_R) != 0 ? 'r' : '-',
   1647      1.1     skrll 		   (p->p_flags & PF_W) != 0 ? 'w' : '-',
   1648      1.1     skrll 		   (p->p_flags & PF_X) != 0 ? 'x' : '-');
   1649      1.1     skrll 	  if ((p->p_flags &~ (unsigned) (PF_R | PF_W | PF_X)) != 0)
   1650      1.1     skrll 	    fprintf (f, " %lx", p->p_flags &~ (unsigned) (PF_R | PF_W | PF_X));
   1651      1.1     skrll 	  fprintf (f, "\n");
   1652      1.1     skrll 	}
   1653      1.1     skrll     }
   1654      1.1     skrll 
   1655      1.1     skrll   s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic");
   1656      1.1     skrll   if (s != NULL)
   1657      1.1     skrll     {
   1658      1.1     skrll       unsigned int elfsec;
   1659      1.1     skrll       unsigned long shlink;
   1660      1.1     skrll       bfd_byte *extdyn, *extdynend;
   1661      1.1     skrll       size_t extdynsize;
   1662      1.1     skrll       void (*swap_dyn_in) (bfd *, const void *, Elf_Internal_Dyn *);
   1663      1.1     skrll 
   1664      1.1     skrll       fprintf (f, _("\nDynamic Section:\n"));
   1665      1.1     skrll 
   1666      1.1     skrll       if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, s, &dynbuf))
   1667      1.1     skrll 	goto error_return;
   1668      1.1     skrll 
   1669      1.1     skrll       elfsec = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (abfd, s);
   1670      1.1     skrll       if (elfsec == SHN_BAD)
   1671      1.1     skrll 	goto error_return;
   1672      1.1     skrll       shlink = elf_elfsections (abfd)[elfsec]->sh_link;
   1673      1.1     skrll 
   1674      1.1     skrll       extdynsize = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_dyn;
   1675      1.1     skrll       swap_dyn_in = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->swap_dyn_in;
   1676      1.1     skrll 
   1677  1.1.1.5  christos       extdyn = dynbuf;
   1678  1.1.1.5  christos       /* PR 17512: file: 6f427532.  */
   1679  1.1.1.5  christos       if (s->size < extdynsize)
   1680      1.1     skrll 	goto error_return;
   1681  1.1.1.5  christos       extdynend = extdyn + s->size;
   1682  1.1.1.7  christos       /* PR 17512: file: id:000006,sig:06,src:000000,op:flip4,pos:5664.
   1683  1.1.1.5  christos 	 Fix range check.  */
   1684      1.1     skrll       for (; extdyn <= (extdynend - extdynsize); extdyn += extdynsize)
   1685      1.1     skrll 	{
   1686      1.1     skrll 	  Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
   1687      1.1     skrll 	  const char *name = "";
   1688      1.1     skrll 	  char ab[20];
   1689      1.1     skrll 	  bfd_boolean stringp;
   1690      1.1     skrll 	  const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   1691      1.1     skrll 
   1692      1.1     skrll 	  (*swap_dyn_in) (abfd, extdyn, &dyn);
   1693      1.1     skrll 
   1694      1.1     skrll 	  if (dyn.d_tag == DT_NULL)
   1695      1.1     skrll 	    break;
   1696      1.1     skrll 
   1697      1.1     skrll 	  stringp = FALSE;
   1698      1.1     skrll 	  switch (dyn.d_tag)
   1699      1.1     skrll 	    {
   1700      1.1     skrll 	    default:
   1701      1.1     skrll 	      if (bed->elf_backend_get_target_dtag)
   1702      1.1     skrll 		name = (*bed->elf_backend_get_target_dtag) (dyn.d_tag);
   1703      1.1     skrll 
   1704      1.1     skrll 	      if (!strcmp (name, ""))
   1705  1.1.1.7  christos 		{
   1706      1.1     skrll 		  sprintf (ab, "%#" BFD_VMA_FMT "x", dyn.d_tag);
   1707      1.1     skrll 		  name = ab;
   1708      1.1     skrll 		}
   1709      1.1     skrll 	      break;
   1710      1.1     skrll 
   1711      1.1     skrll 	    case DT_NEEDED: name = "NEEDED"; stringp = TRUE; break;
   1712      1.1     skrll 	    case DT_PLTRELSZ: name = "PLTRELSZ"; break;
   1713      1.1     skrll 	    case DT_PLTGOT: name = "PLTGOT"; break;
   1714      1.1     skrll 	    case DT_HASH: name = "HASH"; break;
   1715      1.1     skrll 	    case DT_STRTAB: name = "STRTAB"; break;
   1716      1.1     skrll 	    case DT_SYMTAB: name = "SYMTAB"; break;
   1717      1.1     skrll 	    case DT_RELA: name = "RELA"; break;
   1718      1.1     skrll 	    case DT_RELASZ: name = "RELASZ"; break;
   1719      1.1     skrll 	    case DT_RELAENT: name = "RELAENT"; break;
   1720      1.1     skrll 	    case DT_STRSZ: name = "STRSZ"; break;
   1721      1.1     skrll 	    case DT_SYMENT: name = "SYMENT"; break;
   1722      1.1     skrll 	    case DT_INIT: name = "INIT"; break;
   1723      1.1     skrll 	    case DT_FINI: name = "FINI"; break;
   1724      1.1     skrll 	    case DT_SONAME: name = "SONAME"; stringp = TRUE; break;
   1725      1.1     skrll 	    case DT_RPATH: name = "RPATH"; stringp = TRUE; break;
   1726      1.1     skrll 	    case DT_SYMBOLIC: name = "SYMBOLIC"; break;
   1727      1.1     skrll 	    case DT_REL: name = "REL"; break;
   1728      1.1     skrll 	    case DT_RELSZ: name = "RELSZ"; break;
   1729      1.1     skrll 	    case DT_RELENT: name = "RELENT"; break;
   1730      1.1     skrll 	    case DT_PLTREL: name = "PLTREL"; break;
   1731      1.1     skrll 	    case DT_DEBUG: name = "DEBUG"; break;
   1732      1.1     skrll 	    case DT_TEXTREL: name = "TEXTREL"; break;
   1733      1.1     skrll 	    case DT_JMPREL: name = "JMPREL"; break;
   1734      1.1     skrll 	    case DT_BIND_NOW: name = "BIND_NOW"; break;
   1735      1.1     skrll 	    case DT_INIT_ARRAY: name = "INIT_ARRAY"; break;
   1736      1.1     skrll 	    case DT_FINI_ARRAY: name = "FINI_ARRAY"; break;
   1737      1.1     skrll 	    case DT_INIT_ARRAYSZ: name = "INIT_ARRAYSZ"; break;
   1738      1.1     skrll 	    case DT_FINI_ARRAYSZ: name = "FINI_ARRAYSZ"; break;
   1739      1.1     skrll 	    case DT_RUNPATH: name = "RUNPATH"; stringp = TRUE; break;
   1740      1.1     skrll 	    case DT_FLAGS: name = "FLAGS"; break;
   1741      1.1     skrll 	    case DT_PREINIT_ARRAY: name = "PREINIT_ARRAY"; break;
   1742      1.1     skrll 	    case DT_PREINIT_ARRAYSZ: name = "PREINIT_ARRAYSZ"; break;
   1743      1.1     skrll 	    case DT_CHECKSUM: name = "CHECKSUM"; break;
   1744      1.1     skrll 	    case DT_PLTPADSZ: name = "PLTPADSZ"; break;
   1745      1.1     skrll 	    case DT_MOVEENT: name = "MOVEENT"; break;
   1746      1.1     skrll 	    case DT_MOVESZ: name = "MOVESZ"; break;
   1747      1.1     skrll 	    case DT_FEATURE: name = "FEATURE"; break;
   1748      1.1     skrll 	    case DT_POSFLAG_1: name = "POSFLAG_1"; break;
   1749      1.1     skrll 	    case DT_SYMINSZ: name = "SYMINSZ"; break;
   1750      1.1     skrll 	    case DT_SYMINENT: name = "SYMINENT"; break;
   1751      1.1     skrll 	    case DT_CONFIG: name = "CONFIG"; stringp = TRUE; break;
   1752      1.1     skrll 	    case DT_DEPAUDIT: name = "DEPAUDIT"; stringp = TRUE; break;
   1753      1.1     skrll 	    case DT_AUDIT: name = "AUDIT"; stringp = TRUE; break;
   1754      1.1     skrll 	    case DT_PLTPAD: name = "PLTPAD"; break;
   1755      1.1     skrll 	    case DT_MOVETAB: name = "MOVETAB"; break;
   1756      1.1     skrll 	    case DT_SYMINFO: name = "SYMINFO"; break;
   1757      1.1     skrll 	    case DT_RELACOUNT: name = "RELACOUNT"; break;
   1758      1.1     skrll 	    case DT_RELCOUNT: name = "RELCOUNT"; break;
   1759      1.1     skrll 	    case DT_FLAGS_1: name = "FLAGS_1"; break;
   1760      1.1     skrll 	    case DT_VERSYM: name = "VERSYM"; break;
   1761      1.1     skrll 	    case DT_VERDEF: name = "VERDEF"; break;
   1762      1.1     skrll 	    case DT_VERDEFNUM: name = "VERDEFNUM"; break;
   1763      1.1     skrll 	    case DT_VERNEED: name = "VERNEED"; break;
   1764      1.1     skrll 	    case DT_VERNEEDNUM: name = "VERNEEDNUM"; break;
   1765      1.1     skrll 	    case DT_AUXILIARY: name = "AUXILIARY"; stringp = TRUE; break;
   1766      1.1     skrll 	    case DT_USED: name = "USED"; break;
   1767      1.1     skrll 	    case DT_FILTER: name = "FILTER"; stringp = TRUE; break;
   1768      1.1     skrll 	    case DT_GNU_HASH: name = "GNU_HASH"; break;
   1769      1.1     skrll 	    }
   1770      1.1     skrll 
   1771      1.1     skrll 	  fprintf (f, "  %-20s ", name);
   1772      1.1     skrll 	  if (! stringp)
   1773      1.1     skrll 	    {
   1774      1.1     skrll 	      fprintf (f, "0x");
   1775      1.1     skrll 	      bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, dyn.d_un.d_val);
   1776      1.1     skrll 	    }
   1777      1.1     skrll 	  else
   1778      1.1     skrll 	    {
   1779      1.1     skrll 	      const char *string;
   1780      1.1     skrll 	      unsigned int tagv = dyn.d_un.d_val;
   1781      1.1     skrll 
   1782      1.1     skrll 	      string = bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, shlink, tagv);
   1783      1.1     skrll 	      if (string == NULL)
   1784      1.1     skrll 		goto error_return;
   1785      1.1     skrll 	      fprintf (f, "%s", string);
   1786      1.1     skrll 	    }
   1787      1.1     skrll 	  fprintf (f, "\n");
   1788      1.1     skrll 	}
   1789      1.1     skrll 
   1790      1.1     skrll       free (dynbuf);
   1791      1.1     skrll       dynbuf = NULL;
   1792      1.1     skrll     }
   1793      1.1     skrll 
   1794      1.1     skrll   if ((elf_dynverdef (abfd) != 0 && elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef == NULL)
   1795      1.1     skrll       || (elf_dynverref (abfd) != 0 && elf_tdata (abfd)->verref == NULL))
   1796      1.1     skrll     {
   1797      1.1     skrll       if (! _bfd_elf_slurp_version_tables (abfd, FALSE))
   1798      1.1     skrll 	return FALSE;
   1799      1.1     skrll     }
   1800      1.1     skrll 
   1801      1.1     skrll   if (elf_dynverdef (abfd) != 0)
   1802      1.1     skrll     {
   1803      1.1     skrll       Elf_Internal_Verdef *t;
   1804      1.1     skrll 
   1805      1.1     skrll       fprintf (f, _("\nVersion definitions:\n"));
   1806      1.1     skrll       for (t = elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef; t != NULL; t = t->vd_nextdef)
   1807      1.1     skrll 	{
   1808      1.1     skrll 	  fprintf (f, "%d 0x%2.2x 0x%8.8lx %s\n", t->vd_ndx,
   1809      1.1     skrll 		   t->vd_flags, t->vd_hash,
   1810      1.1     skrll 		   t->vd_nodename ? t->vd_nodename : "<corrupt>");
   1811      1.1     skrll 	  if (t->vd_auxptr != NULL && t->vd_auxptr->vda_nextptr != NULL)
   1812      1.1     skrll 	    {
   1813      1.1     skrll 	      Elf_Internal_Verdaux *a;
   1814      1.1     skrll 
   1815      1.1     skrll 	      fprintf (f, "\t");
   1816      1.1     skrll 	      for (a = t->vd_auxptr->vda_nextptr;
   1817      1.1     skrll 		   a != NULL;
   1818      1.1     skrll 		   a = a->vda_nextptr)
   1819      1.1     skrll 		fprintf (f, "%s ",
   1820      1.1     skrll 			 a->vda_nodename ? a->vda_nodename : "<corrupt>");
   1821      1.1     skrll 	      fprintf (f, "\n");
   1822      1.1     skrll 	    }
   1823      1.1     skrll 	}
   1824      1.1     skrll     }
   1825      1.1     skrll 
   1826      1.1     skrll   if (elf_dynverref (abfd) != 0)
   1827      1.1     skrll     {
   1828      1.1     skrll       Elf_Internal_Verneed *t;
   1829      1.1     skrll 
   1830      1.1     skrll       fprintf (f, _("\nVersion References:\n"));
   1831      1.1     skrll       for (t = elf_tdata (abfd)->verref; t != NULL; t = t->vn_nextref)
   1832      1.1     skrll 	{
   1833      1.1     skrll 	  Elf_Internal_Vernaux *a;
   1834      1.1     skrll 
   1835      1.1     skrll 	  fprintf (f, _("  required from %s:\n"),
   1836      1.1     skrll 		   t->vn_filename ? t->vn_filename : "<corrupt>");
   1837      1.1     skrll 	  for (a = t->vn_auxptr; a != NULL; a = a->vna_nextptr)
   1838      1.1     skrll 	    fprintf (f, "    0x%8.8lx 0x%2.2x %2.2d %s\n", a->vna_hash,
   1839      1.1     skrll 		     a->vna_flags, a->vna_other,
   1840      1.1     skrll 		     a->vna_nodename ? a->vna_nodename : "<corrupt>");
   1841      1.1     skrll 	}
   1842      1.1     skrll     }
   1843      1.1     skrll 
   1844      1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   1845      1.1     skrll 
   1846      1.1     skrll  error_return:
   1847      1.1     skrll   if (dynbuf != NULL)
   1848      1.1     skrll     free (dynbuf);
   1849      1.1     skrll   return FALSE;
   1850      1.1     skrll }
   1851  1.1.1.5  christos 
   1852  1.1.1.5  christos /* Get version string.  */
   1853  1.1.1.5  christos 
   1854  1.1.1.5  christos const char *
   1855  1.1.1.5  christos _bfd_elf_get_symbol_version_string (bfd *abfd, asymbol *symbol,
   1856  1.1.1.5  christos 				    bfd_boolean *hidden)
   1857  1.1.1.5  christos {
   1858  1.1.1.5  christos   const char *version_string = NULL;
   1859  1.1.1.5  christos   if (elf_dynversym (abfd) != 0
   1860  1.1.1.5  christos       && (elf_dynverdef (abfd) != 0 || elf_dynverref (abfd) != 0))
   1861  1.1.1.5  christos     {
   1862  1.1.1.5  christos       unsigned int vernum = ((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->version;
   1863  1.1.1.5  christos 
   1864  1.1.1.5  christos       *hidden = (vernum & VERSYM_HIDDEN) != 0;
   1865  1.1.1.5  christos       vernum &= VERSYM_VERSION;
   1866  1.1.1.5  christos 
   1867  1.1.1.5  christos       if (vernum == 0)
   1868  1.1.1.8  christos 	version_string = "";
   1869  1.1.1.8  christos       else if (vernum == 1
   1870  1.1.1.8  christos 	       && (vernum > elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs
   1871  1.1.1.8  christos 		   || (elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef[0].vd_flags
   1872  1.1.1.5  christos 		       == VER_FLG_BASE)))
   1873  1.1.1.5  christos 	version_string = "Base";
   1874  1.1.1.5  christos       else if (vernum <= elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs)
   1875  1.1.1.5  christos 	version_string =
   1876  1.1.1.5  christos 	  elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef[vernum - 1].vd_nodename;
   1877  1.1.1.5  christos       else
   1878  1.1.1.5  christos 	{
   1879  1.1.1.5  christos 	  Elf_Internal_Verneed *t;
   1880  1.1.1.5  christos 
   1881  1.1.1.5  christos 	  version_string = "";
   1882  1.1.1.5  christos 	  for (t = elf_tdata (abfd)->verref;
   1883  1.1.1.5  christos 	       t != NULL;
   1884  1.1.1.5  christos 	       t = t->vn_nextref)
   1885  1.1.1.5  christos 	    {
   1886  1.1.1.5  christos 	      Elf_Internal_Vernaux *a;
   1887  1.1.1.5  christos 
   1888  1.1.1.5  christos 	      for (a = t->vn_auxptr; a != NULL; a = a->vna_nextptr)
   1889  1.1.1.5  christos 		{
   1890  1.1.1.5  christos 		  if (a->vna_other == vernum)
   1891  1.1.1.5  christos 		    {
   1892  1.1.1.5  christos 		      version_string = a->vna_nodename;
   1893  1.1.1.5  christos 		      break;
   1894  1.1.1.5  christos 		    }
   1895  1.1.1.5  christos 		}
   1896  1.1.1.5  christos 	    }
   1897  1.1.1.5  christos 	}
   1898  1.1.1.5  christos     }
   1899  1.1.1.5  christos   return version_string;
   1900  1.1.1.5  christos }
   1901      1.1     skrll 
   1902      1.1     skrll /* Display ELF-specific fields of a symbol.  */
   1903      1.1     skrll 
   1904      1.1     skrll void
   1905      1.1     skrll bfd_elf_print_symbol (bfd *abfd,
   1906      1.1     skrll 		      void *filep,
   1907      1.1     skrll 		      asymbol *symbol,
   1908      1.1     skrll 		      bfd_print_symbol_type how)
   1909  1.1.1.3  christos {
   1910      1.1     skrll   FILE *file = (FILE *) filep;
   1911      1.1     skrll   switch (how)
   1912      1.1     skrll     {
   1913      1.1     skrll     case bfd_print_symbol_name:
   1914      1.1     skrll       fprintf (file, "%s", symbol->name);
   1915      1.1     skrll       break;
   1916      1.1     skrll     case bfd_print_symbol_more:
   1917      1.1     skrll       fprintf (file, "elf ");
   1918  1.1.1.7  christos       bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, file, symbol->value);
   1919      1.1     skrll       fprintf (file, " %x", symbol->flags);
   1920      1.1     skrll       break;
   1921      1.1     skrll     case bfd_print_symbol_all:
   1922      1.1     skrll       {
   1923      1.1     skrll 	const char *section_name;
   1924      1.1     skrll 	const char *name = NULL;
   1925      1.1     skrll 	const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
   1926      1.1     skrll 	unsigned char st_other;
   1927  1.1.1.5  christos 	bfd_vma val;
   1928  1.1.1.5  christos 	const char *version_string;
   1929      1.1     skrll 	bfd_boolean hidden;
   1930      1.1     skrll 
   1931      1.1     skrll 	section_name = symbol->section ? symbol->section->name : "(*none*)";
   1932      1.1     skrll 
   1933      1.1     skrll 	bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   1934      1.1     skrll 	if (bed->elf_backend_print_symbol_all)
   1935      1.1     skrll 	  name = (*bed->elf_backend_print_symbol_all) (abfd, filep, symbol);
   1936      1.1     skrll 
   1937      1.1     skrll 	if (name == NULL)
   1938      1.1     skrll 	  {
   1939      1.1     skrll 	    name = symbol->name;
   1940      1.1     skrll 	    bfd_print_symbol_vandf (abfd, file, symbol);
   1941      1.1     skrll 	  }
   1942      1.1     skrll 
   1943      1.1     skrll 	fprintf (file, " %s\t", section_name);
   1944      1.1     skrll 	/* Print the "other" value for a symbol.  For common symbols,
   1945      1.1     skrll 	   we've already printed the size; now print the alignment.
   1946      1.1     skrll 	   For other symbols, we have no specified alignment, and
   1947      1.1     skrll 	   we've printed the address; now print the size.  */
   1948      1.1     skrll 	if (symbol->section && bfd_is_com_section (symbol->section))
   1949      1.1     skrll 	  val = ((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->internal_elf_sym.st_value;
   1950      1.1     skrll 	else
   1951      1.1     skrll 	  val = ((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->internal_elf_sym.st_size;
   1952      1.1     skrll 	bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, file, val);
   1953      1.1     skrll 
   1954  1.1.1.5  christos 	/* If we have version information, print it.  */
   1955  1.1.1.5  christos 	version_string = _bfd_elf_get_symbol_version_string (abfd,
   1956  1.1.1.5  christos 							     symbol,
   1957  1.1.1.5  christos 							     &hidden);
   1958      1.1     skrll 	if (version_string)
   1959  1.1.1.5  christos 	  {
   1960      1.1     skrll 	    if (!hidden)
   1961      1.1     skrll 	      fprintf (file, "  %-11s", version_string);
   1962      1.1     skrll 	    else
   1963      1.1     skrll 	      {
   1964      1.1     skrll 		int i;
   1965      1.1     skrll 
   1966      1.1     skrll 		fprintf (file, " (%s)", version_string);
   1967      1.1     skrll 		for (i = 10 - strlen (version_string); i > 0; --i)
   1968      1.1     skrll 		  putc (' ', file);
   1969      1.1     skrll 	      }
   1970      1.1     skrll 	  }
   1971      1.1     skrll 
   1972      1.1     skrll 	/* If the st_other field is not zero, print it.  */
   1973      1.1     skrll 	st_other = ((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->internal_elf_sym.st_other;
   1974      1.1     skrll 
   1975      1.1     skrll 	switch (st_other)
   1976      1.1     skrll 	  {
   1977      1.1     skrll 	  case 0: break;
   1978      1.1     skrll 	  case STV_INTERNAL:  fprintf (file, " .internal");  break;
   1979      1.1     skrll 	  case STV_HIDDEN:    fprintf (file, " .hidden");    break;
   1980      1.1     skrll 	  case STV_PROTECTED: fprintf (file, " .protected"); break;
   1981      1.1     skrll 	  default:
   1982      1.1     skrll 	    /* Some other non-defined flags are also present, so print
   1983      1.1     skrll 	       everything hex.  */
   1984      1.1     skrll 	    fprintf (file, " 0x%02x", (unsigned int) st_other);
   1985      1.1     skrll 	  }
   1986      1.1     skrll 
   1987      1.1     skrll 	fprintf (file, " %s", name);
   1988      1.1     skrll       }
   1989      1.1     skrll       break;
   1990      1.1     skrll     }
   1991      1.1     skrll }
   1992      1.1     skrll 
   1993      1.1     skrll /* ELF .o/exec file reading */
   1995      1.1     skrll 
   1996      1.1     skrll /* Create a new bfd section from an ELF section header.  */
   1997      1.1     skrll 
   1998      1.1     skrll bfd_boolean
   1999      1.1     skrll bfd_section_from_shdr (bfd *abfd, unsigned int shindex)
   2000      1.1     skrll {
   2001      1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
   2002      1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Ehdr *ehdr;
   2003  1.1.1.5  christos   const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
   2004  1.1.1.5  christos   const char *name;
   2005  1.1.1.5  christos   bfd_boolean ret = TRUE;
   2006  1.1.1.5  christos   static bfd_boolean * sections_being_created = NULL;
   2007      1.1     skrll   static bfd * sections_being_created_abfd = NULL;
   2008      1.1     skrll   static unsigned int nesting = 0;
   2009      1.1     skrll 
   2010      1.1     skrll   if (shindex >= elf_numsections (abfd))
   2011  1.1.1.5  christos     return FALSE;
   2012  1.1.1.5  christos 
   2013  1.1.1.5  christos   if (++ nesting > 3)
   2014  1.1.1.5  christos     {
   2015  1.1.1.5  christos       /* PR17512: A corrupt ELF binary might contain a recursive group of
   2016  1.1.1.5  christos 	 sections, with each the string indicies pointing to the next in the
   2017  1.1.1.5  christos 	 loop.  Detect this here, by refusing to load a section that we are
   2018  1.1.1.5  christos 	 already in the process of loading.  We only trigger this test if
   2019  1.1.1.5  christos 	 we have nested at least three sections deep as normal ELF binaries
   2020  1.1.1.5  christos 	 can expect to recurse at least once.
   2021  1.1.1.5  christos 
   2022  1.1.1.5  christos 	 FIXME: It would be better if this array was attached to the bfd,
   2023  1.1.1.5  christos 	 rather than being held in a static pointer.  */
   2024  1.1.1.5  christos 
   2025  1.1.1.5  christos       if (sections_being_created_abfd != abfd)
   2026  1.1.1.5  christos 	sections_being_created = NULL;
   2027  1.1.1.5  christos       if (sections_being_created == NULL)
   2028  1.1.1.5  christos 	{
   2029  1.1.1.5  christos 	  /* FIXME: It would be more efficient to attach this array to the bfd somehow.  */
   2030  1.1.1.5  christos 	  sections_being_created = (bfd_boolean *)
   2031  1.1.1.5  christos 	    bfd_zalloc (abfd, elf_numsections (abfd) * sizeof (bfd_boolean));
   2032  1.1.1.5  christos 	  sections_being_created_abfd = abfd;
   2033  1.1.1.5  christos 	}
   2034  1.1.1.7  christos       if (sections_being_created [shindex])
   2035  1.1.1.8  christos 	{
   2036  1.1.1.5  christos 	  _bfd_error_handler
   2037  1.1.1.5  christos 	    (_("%pB: warning: loop in section dependencies detected"), abfd);
   2038  1.1.1.5  christos 	  return FALSE;
   2039  1.1.1.5  christos 	}
   2040  1.1.1.5  christos       sections_being_created [shindex] = TRUE;
   2041      1.1     skrll     }
   2042      1.1     skrll 
   2043      1.1     skrll   hdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex];
   2044      1.1     skrll   ehdr = elf_elfheader (abfd);
   2045      1.1     skrll   name = bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, ehdr->e_shstrndx,
   2046  1.1.1.5  christos 					  hdr->sh_name);
   2047      1.1     skrll   if (name == NULL)
   2048      1.1     skrll     goto fail;
   2049      1.1     skrll 
   2050      1.1     skrll   bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   2051      1.1     skrll   switch (hdr->sh_type)
   2052      1.1     skrll     {
   2053  1.1.1.5  christos     case SHT_NULL:
   2054      1.1     skrll       /* Inactive section. Throw it away.  */
   2055  1.1.1.5  christos       goto success;
   2056  1.1.1.5  christos 
   2057  1.1.1.5  christos     case SHT_PROGBITS:		/* Normal section with contents.  */
   2058  1.1.1.5  christos     case SHT_NOBITS:		/* .bss section.  */
   2059      1.1     skrll     case SHT_HASH:		/* .hash section.  */
   2060      1.1     skrll     case SHT_NOTE:		/* .note section.  */
   2061      1.1     skrll     case SHT_INIT_ARRAY:	/* .init_array section.  */
   2062      1.1     skrll     case SHT_FINI_ARRAY:	/* .fini_array section.  */
   2063      1.1     skrll     case SHT_PREINIT_ARRAY:	/* .preinit_array section.  */
   2064  1.1.1.5  christos     case SHT_GNU_LIBLIST:	/* .gnu.liblist section.  */
   2065  1.1.1.5  christos     case SHT_GNU_HASH:		/* .gnu.hash section.  */
   2066      1.1     skrll       ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
   2067      1.1     skrll       goto success;
   2068      1.1     skrll 
   2069  1.1.1.5  christos     case SHT_DYNAMIC:	/* Dynamic linking information.  */
   2070  1.1.1.5  christos       if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
   2071  1.1.1.3  christos 	goto fail;
   2072  1.1.1.3  christos 
   2073  1.1.1.3  christos       if (hdr->sh_link > elf_numsections (abfd))
   2074  1.1.1.3  christos 	{
   2075  1.1.1.3  christos 	  /* PR 10478: Accept Solaris binaries with a sh_link
   2076  1.1.1.3  christos 	     field set to SHN_BEFORE or SHN_AFTER.  */
   2077  1.1.1.3  christos 	  switch (bfd_get_arch (abfd))
   2078  1.1.1.3  christos 	    {
   2079  1.1.1.3  christos 	    case bfd_arch_i386:
   2080  1.1.1.3  christos 	    case bfd_arch_sparc:
   2081  1.1.1.3  christos 	      if (hdr->sh_link == (SHN_LORESERVE & 0xffff) /* SHN_BEFORE */
   2082  1.1.1.3  christos 		  || hdr->sh_link == ((SHN_LORESERVE + 1) & 0xffff) /* SHN_AFTER */)
   2083  1.1.1.3  christos 		break;
   2084  1.1.1.5  christos 	      /* Otherwise fall through.  */
   2085  1.1.1.3  christos 	    default:
   2086  1.1.1.3  christos 	      goto fail;
   2087  1.1.1.3  christos 	    }
   2088  1.1.1.5  christos 	}
   2089  1.1.1.3  christos       else if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link] == NULL)
   2090      1.1     skrll 	goto fail;
   2091      1.1     skrll       else if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type != SHT_STRTAB)
   2092      1.1     skrll 	{
   2093      1.1     skrll 	  Elf_Internal_Shdr *dynsymhdr;
   2094      1.1     skrll 
   2095      1.1     skrll 	  /* The shared libraries distributed with hpux11 have a bogus
   2096      1.1     skrll 	     sh_link field for the ".dynamic" section.  Find the
   2097      1.1     skrll 	     string table for the ".dynsym" section instead.  */
   2098      1.1     skrll 	  if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) != 0)
   2099      1.1     skrll 	    {
   2100      1.1     skrll 	      dynsymhdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[elf_dynsymtab (abfd)];
   2101      1.1     skrll 	      hdr->sh_link = dynsymhdr->sh_link;
   2102      1.1     skrll 	    }
   2103      1.1     skrll 	  else
   2104      1.1     skrll 	    {
   2105      1.1     skrll 	      unsigned int i, num_sec;
   2106      1.1     skrll 
   2107      1.1     skrll 	      num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
   2108      1.1     skrll 	      for (i = 1; i < num_sec; i++)
   2109      1.1     skrll 		{
   2110      1.1     skrll 		  dynsymhdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
   2111      1.1     skrll 		  if (dynsymhdr->sh_type == SHT_DYNSYM)
   2112      1.1     skrll 		    {
   2113      1.1     skrll 		      hdr->sh_link = dynsymhdr->sh_link;
   2114      1.1     skrll 		      break;
   2115      1.1     skrll 		    }
   2116      1.1     skrll 		}
   2117  1.1.1.5  christos 	    }
   2118      1.1     skrll 	}
   2119  1.1.1.5  christos       goto success;
   2120      1.1     skrll 
   2121  1.1.1.5  christos     case SHT_SYMTAB:		/* A symbol table.  */
   2122      1.1     skrll       if (elf_onesymtab (abfd) == shindex)
   2123      1.1     skrll 	goto success;
   2124  1.1.1.5  christos 
   2125  1.1.1.5  christos       if (hdr->sh_entsize != bed->s->sizeof_sym)
   2126  1.1.1.2     skrll 	goto fail;
   2127  1.1.1.4  christos 
   2128  1.1.1.4  christos       if (hdr->sh_info * hdr->sh_entsize > hdr->sh_size)
   2129  1.1.1.5  christos 	{
   2130  1.1.1.4  christos 	  if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
   2131  1.1.1.4  christos 	    goto fail;
   2132  1.1.1.4  christos 	  /* Some assemblers erroneously set sh_info to one with a
   2133  1.1.1.4  christos 	     zero sh_size.  ld sees this as a global symbol count
   2134  1.1.1.5  christos 	     of (unsigned) -1.  Fix it here.  */
   2135  1.1.1.5  christos 	  hdr->sh_info = 0;
   2136  1.1.1.5  christos 	  goto success;
   2137  1.1.1.5  christos 	}
   2138  1.1.1.5  christos 
   2139  1.1.1.5  christos       /* PR 18854: A binary might contain more than one symbol table.
   2140  1.1.1.5  christos 	 Unusual, but possible.  Warn, but continue.  */
   2141  1.1.1.7  christos       if (elf_onesymtab (abfd) != 0)
   2142  1.1.1.7  christos 	{
   2143  1.1.1.8  christos 	  _bfd_error_handler
   2144  1.1.1.7  christos 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
   2145  1.1.1.5  christos 	    (_("%pB: warning: multiple symbol tables detected"
   2146  1.1.1.5  christos 	       " - ignoring the table in section %u"),
   2147  1.1.1.4  christos 	     abfd, shindex);
   2148      1.1     skrll 	  goto success;
   2149  1.1.1.5  christos 	}
   2150  1.1.1.5  christos       elf_onesymtab (abfd) = shindex;
   2151      1.1     skrll       elf_symtab_hdr (abfd) = *hdr;
   2152      1.1     skrll       elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = hdr = & elf_symtab_hdr (abfd);
   2153      1.1     skrll       abfd->flags |= HAS_SYMS;
   2154      1.1     skrll 
   2155      1.1     skrll       /* Sometimes a shared object will map in the symbol table.  If
   2156      1.1     skrll 	 SHF_ALLOC is set, and this is a shared object, then we also
   2157      1.1     skrll 	 treat this section as a BFD section.  We can not base the
   2158      1.1     skrll 	 decision purely on SHF_ALLOC, because that flag is sometimes
   2159      1.1     skrll 	 set in a relocatable object file, which would confuse the
   2160      1.1     skrll 	 linker.  */
   2161      1.1     skrll       if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0
   2162      1.1     skrll 	  && (abfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0
   2163  1.1.1.5  christos 	  && ! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
   2164      1.1     skrll 						shindex))
   2165      1.1     skrll 	goto fail;
   2166      1.1     skrll 
   2167      1.1     skrll       /* Go looking for SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX too, since if there is one we
   2168  1.1.1.5  christos 	 can't read symbols without that section loaded as well.  It
   2169  1.1.1.5  christos 	 is most likely specified by the next section header.  */
   2170  1.1.1.5  christos       {
   2171      1.1     skrll 	elf_section_list * entry;
   2172  1.1.1.5  christos 	unsigned int i, num_sec;
   2173  1.1.1.5  christos 
   2174  1.1.1.5  christos 	for (entry = elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd); entry != NULL; entry = entry->next)
   2175  1.1.1.5  christos 	  if (entry->hdr.sh_link == shindex)
   2176  1.1.1.5  christos 	    goto success;
   2177  1.1.1.5  christos 
   2178  1.1.1.5  christos 	num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
   2179  1.1.1.5  christos 	for (i = shindex + 1; i < num_sec; i++)
   2180  1.1.1.5  christos 	  {
   2181  1.1.1.5  christos 	    Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr2 = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
   2182  1.1.1.5  christos 
   2183  1.1.1.5  christos 	    if (hdr2->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX
   2184  1.1.1.5  christos 		&& hdr2->sh_link == shindex)
   2185  1.1.1.5  christos 	      break;
   2186  1.1.1.5  christos 	  }
   2187  1.1.1.5  christos 
   2188      1.1     skrll 	if (i == num_sec)
   2189      1.1     skrll 	  for (i = 1; i < shindex; i++)
   2190  1.1.1.5  christos 	    {
   2191      1.1     skrll 	      Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr2 = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
   2192      1.1     skrll 
   2193      1.1     skrll 	      if (hdr2->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX
   2194      1.1     skrll 		  && hdr2->sh_link == shindex)
   2195      1.1     skrll 		break;
   2196  1.1.1.5  christos 	    }
   2197  1.1.1.5  christos 
   2198  1.1.1.5  christos 	if (i != shindex)
   2199  1.1.1.5  christos 	  ret = bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, i);
   2200  1.1.1.5  christos 	/* else FIXME: we have failed to find the symbol table - should we issue an error ? */
   2201  1.1.1.5  christos 	goto success;
   2202  1.1.1.5  christos       }
   2203      1.1     skrll 
   2204  1.1.1.5  christos     case SHT_DYNSYM:		/* A dynamic symbol table.  */
   2205      1.1     skrll       if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == shindex)
   2206      1.1     skrll 	goto success;
   2207  1.1.1.5  christos 
   2208  1.1.1.5  christos       if (hdr->sh_entsize != bed->s->sizeof_sym)
   2209  1.1.1.4  christos 	goto fail;
   2210  1.1.1.4  christos 
   2211  1.1.1.4  christos       if (hdr->sh_info * hdr->sh_entsize > hdr->sh_size)
   2212  1.1.1.5  christos 	{
   2213  1.1.1.5  christos 	  if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
   2214  1.1.1.4  christos 	    goto fail;
   2215  1.1.1.4  christos 
   2216  1.1.1.4  christos 	  /* Some linkers erroneously set sh_info to one with a
   2217  1.1.1.4  christos 	     zero sh_size.  ld sees this as a global symbol count
   2218  1.1.1.5  christos 	     of (unsigned) -1.  Fix it here.  */
   2219  1.1.1.5  christos 	  hdr->sh_info = 0;
   2220  1.1.1.5  christos 	  goto success;
   2221  1.1.1.5  christos 	}
   2222  1.1.1.5  christos 
   2223  1.1.1.5  christos       /* PR 18854: A binary might contain more than one dynamic symbol table.
   2224  1.1.1.5  christos 	 Unusual, but possible.  Warn, but continue.  */
   2225  1.1.1.7  christos       if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) != 0)
   2226  1.1.1.7  christos 	{
   2227  1.1.1.8  christos 	  _bfd_error_handler
   2228  1.1.1.7  christos 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
   2229  1.1.1.5  christos 	    (_("%pB: warning: multiple dynamic symbol tables detected"
   2230  1.1.1.5  christos 	       " - ignoring the table in section %u"),
   2231  1.1.1.4  christos 	     abfd, shindex);
   2232      1.1     skrll 	  goto success;
   2233      1.1     skrll 	}
   2234      1.1     skrll       elf_dynsymtab (abfd) = shindex;
   2235      1.1     skrll       elf_tdata (abfd)->dynsymtab_hdr = *hdr;
   2236      1.1     skrll       elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynsymtab_hdr;
   2237      1.1     skrll       abfd->flags |= HAS_SYMS;
   2238      1.1     skrll 
   2239  1.1.1.5  christos       /* Besides being a symbol table, we also treat this as a regular
   2240  1.1.1.5  christos 	 section, so that objcopy can handle it.  */
   2241      1.1     skrll       ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
   2242  1.1.1.5  christos       goto success;
   2243  1.1.1.5  christos 
   2244  1.1.1.5  christos     case SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX:	/* Symbol section indices when >64k sections.  */
   2245      1.1     skrll       {
   2246  1.1.1.5  christos 	elf_section_list * entry;
   2247  1.1.1.5  christos 
   2248  1.1.1.5  christos 	for (entry = elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd); entry != NULL; entry = entry->next)
   2249  1.1.1.7  christos 	  if (entry->ndx == shindex)
   2250  1.1.1.5  christos 	    goto success;
   2251  1.1.1.5  christos 
   2252  1.1.1.5  christos 	entry = bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof * entry);
   2253  1.1.1.5  christos 	if (entry == NULL)
   2254  1.1.1.5  christos 	  goto fail;
   2255  1.1.1.5  christos 	entry->ndx = shindex;
   2256  1.1.1.5  christos 	entry->hdr = * hdr;
   2257  1.1.1.5  christos 	entry->next = elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd);
   2258  1.1.1.5  christos 	elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) = entry;
   2259  1.1.1.5  christos 	elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = & entry->hdr;
   2260      1.1     skrll 	goto success;
   2261  1.1.1.5  christos       }
   2262      1.1     skrll 
   2263  1.1.1.5  christos     case SHT_STRTAB:		/* A string table.  */
   2264  1.1.1.5  christos       if (hdr->bfd_section != NULL)
   2265      1.1     skrll 	goto success;
   2266      1.1     skrll 
   2267      1.1     skrll       if (ehdr->e_shstrndx == shindex)
   2268      1.1     skrll 	{
   2269  1.1.1.5  christos 	  elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr = *hdr;
   2270      1.1     skrll 	  elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = &elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr;
   2271  1.1.1.5  christos 	  goto success;
   2272      1.1     skrll 	}
   2273      1.1     skrll 
   2274      1.1     skrll       if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[elf_onesymtab (abfd)]->sh_link == shindex)
   2275      1.1     skrll 	{
   2276      1.1     skrll 	symtab_strtab:
   2277  1.1.1.5  christos 	  elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr = *hdr;
   2278      1.1     skrll 	  elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = &elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr;
   2279  1.1.1.5  christos 	  goto success;
   2280      1.1     skrll 	}
   2281      1.1     skrll 
   2282      1.1     skrll       if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[elf_dynsymtab (abfd)]->sh_link == shindex)
   2283      1.1     skrll 	{
   2284      1.1     skrll 	dynsymtab_strtab:
   2285      1.1     skrll 	  elf_tdata (abfd)->dynstrtab_hdr = *hdr;
   2286      1.1     skrll 	  hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynstrtab_hdr;
   2287      1.1     skrll 	  elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = hdr;
   2288  1.1.1.5  christos 	  /* We also treat this as a regular section, so that objcopy
   2289  1.1.1.5  christos 	     can handle it.  */
   2290  1.1.1.5  christos 	  ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
   2291      1.1     skrll 						 shindex);
   2292      1.1     skrll 	  goto success;
   2293      1.1     skrll 	}
   2294      1.1     skrll 
   2295      1.1     skrll       /* If the string table isn't one of the above, then treat it as a
   2296      1.1     skrll 	 regular section.  We need to scan all the headers to be sure,
   2297      1.1     skrll 	 just in case this strtab section appeared before the above.  */
   2298      1.1     skrll       if (elf_onesymtab (abfd) == 0 || elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0)
   2299      1.1     skrll 	{
   2300      1.1     skrll 	  unsigned int i, num_sec;
   2301      1.1     skrll 
   2302      1.1     skrll 	  num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
   2303      1.1     skrll 	  for (i = 1; i < num_sec; i++)
   2304      1.1     skrll 	    {
   2305      1.1     skrll 	      Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr2 = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
   2306      1.1     skrll 	      if (hdr2->sh_link == shindex)
   2307      1.1     skrll 		{
   2308  1.1.1.5  christos 		  /* Prevent endless recursion on broken objects.  */
   2309      1.1     skrll 		  if (i == shindex)
   2310  1.1.1.5  christos 		    goto fail;
   2311      1.1     skrll 		  if (! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, i))
   2312      1.1     skrll 		    goto fail;
   2313      1.1     skrll 		  if (elf_onesymtab (abfd) == i)
   2314      1.1     skrll 		    goto symtab_strtab;
   2315      1.1     skrll 		  if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == i)
   2316      1.1     skrll 		    goto dynsymtab_strtab;
   2317      1.1     skrll 		}
   2318  1.1.1.5  christos 	    }
   2319  1.1.1.5  christos 	}
   2320      1.1     skrll       ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
   2321      1.1     skrll       goto success;
   2322      1.1     skrll 
   2323      1.1     skrll     case SHT_REL:
   2324      1.1     skrll     case SHT_RELA:
   2325      1.1     skrll       /* *These* do a lot of work -- but build no sections!  */
   2326  1.1.1.3  christos       {
   2327      1.1     skrll 	asection *target_sect;
   2328  1.1.1.3  christos 	Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr2, **p_hdr;
   2329      1.1     skrll 	unsigned int num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
   2330      1.1     skrll 	struct bfd_elf_section_data *esdt;
   2331      1.1     skrll 
   2332      1.1     skrll 	if (hdr->sh_entsize
   2333  1.1.1.5  christos 	    != (bfd_size_type) (hdr->sh_type == SHT_REL
   2334      1.1     skrll 				? bed->s->sizeof_rel : bed->s->sizeof_rela))
   2335      1.1     skrll 	  goto fail;
   2336      1.1     skrll 
   2337      1.1     skrll 	/* Check for a bogus link to avoid crashing.  */
   2338  1.1.1.7  christos 	if (hdr->sh_link >= num_sec)
   2339  1.1.1.7  christos 	  {
   2340  1.1.1.8  christos 	    _bfd_error_handler
   2341  1.1.1.7  christos 	      /* xgettext:c-format */
   2342  1.1.1.5  christos 	      (_("%pB: invalid link %u for reloc section %s (index %u)"),
   2343  1.1.1.5  christos 	       abfd, hdr->sh_link, name, shindex);
   2344  1.1.1.5  christos 	    ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
   2345      1.1     skrll 						   shindex);
   2346      1.1     skrll 	    goto success;
   2347      1.1     skrll 	  }
   2348      1.1     skrll 
   2349      1.1     skrll 	/* For some incomprehensible reason Oracle distributes
   2350      1.1     skrll 	   libraries for Solaris in which some of the objects have
   2351      1.1     skrll 	   bogus sh_link fields.  It would be nice if we could just
   2352      1.1     skrll 	   reject them, but, unfortunately, some people need to use
   2353  1.1.1.3  christos 	   them.  We scan through the section headers; if we find only
   2354  1.1.1.3  christos 	   one suitable symbol table, we clobber the sh_link to point
   2355  1.1.1.3  christos 	   to it.  I hope this doesn't break anything.
   2356  1.1.1.3  christos 
   2357  1.1.1.3  christos 	   Don't do it on executable nor shared library.  */
   2358      1.1     skrll 	if ((abfd->flags & (DYNAMIC | EXEC_P)) == 0
   2359      1.1     skrll 	    && elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type != SHT_SYMTAB
   2360      1.1     skrll 	    && elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type != SHT_DYNSYM)
   2361      1.1     skrll 	  {
   2362      1.1     skrll 	    unsigned int scan;
   2363      1.1     skrll 	    int found;
   2364      1.1     skrll 
   2365      1.1     skrll 	    found = 0;
   2366      1.1     skrll 	    for (scan = 1; scan < num_sec; scan++)
   2367      1.1     skrll 	      {
   2368      1.1     skrll 		if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[scan]->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB
   2369      1.1     skrll 		    || elf_elfsections (abfd)[scan]->sh_type == SHT_DYNSYM)
   2370      1.1     skrll 		  {
   2371      1.1     skrll 		    if (found != 0)
   2372      1.1     skrll 		      {
   2373      1.1     skrll 			found = 0;
   2374      1.1     skrll 			break;
   2375      1.1     skrll 		      }
   2376      1.1     skrll 		    found = scan;
   2377      1.1     skrll 		  }
   2378      1.1     skrll 	      }
   2379      1.1     skrll 	    if (found != 0)
   2380      1.1     skrll 	      hdr->sh_link = found;
   2381      1.1     skrll 	  }
   2382      1.1     skrll 
   2383      1.1     skrll 	/* Get the symbol table.  */
   2384      1.1     skrll 	if ((elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB
   2385  1.1.1.5  christos 	     || elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type == SHT_DYNSYM)
   2386      1.1     skrll 	    && ! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr->sh_link))
   2387      1.1     skrll 	  goto fail;
   2388      1.1     skrll 
   2389      1.1     skrll 	/* If this reloc section does not use the main symbol table we
   2390      1.1     skrll 	   don't treat it as a reloc section.  BFD can't adequately
   2391      1.1     skrll 	   represent such a section, so at least for now, we don't
   2392  1.1.1.3  christos 	   try.  We just present it as a normal section.  We also
   2393  1.1.1.3  christos 	   can't use it as a reloc section if it points to the null
   2394      1.1     skrll 	   section, an invalid section, another reloc section, or its
   2395  1.1.1.3  christos 	   sh_link points to the null section.  */
   2396      1.1     skrll 	if (hdr->sh_link != elf_onesymtab (abfd)
   2397      1.1     skrll 	    || hdr->sh_link == SHN_UNDEF
   2398      1.1     skrll 	    || hdr->sh_info == SHN_UNDEF
   2399      1.1     skrll 	    || hdr->sh_info >= num_sec
   2400  1.1.1.5  christos 	    || elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_info]->sh_type == SHT_REL
   2401  1.1.1.5  christos 	    || elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_info]->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
   2402  1.1.1.5  christos 	  {
   2403  1.1.1.5  christos 	    ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
   2404  1.1.1.5  christos 						   shindex);
   2405      1.1     skrll 	    goto success;
   2406      1.1     skrll 	  }
   2407  1.1.1.5  christos 
   2408  1.1.1.5  christos 	if (! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr->sh_info))
   2409      1.1     skrll 	  goto fail;
   2410      1.1     skrll 
   2411  1.1.1.5  christos 	target_sect = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, hdr->sh_info);
   2412      1.1     skrll 	if (target_sect == NULL)
   2413  1.1.1.3  christos 	  goto fail;
   2414  1.1.1.3  christos 
   2415  1.1.1.3  christos 	esdt = elf_section_data (target_sect);
   2416      1.1     skrll 	if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
   2417  1.1.1.3  christos 	  p_hdr = &esdt->rela.hdr;
   2418  1.1.1.3  christos 	else
   2419  1.1.1.5  christos 	  p_hdr = &esdt->rel.hdr;
   2420  1.1.1.5  christos 
   2421  1.1.1.5  christos 	/* PR 17512: file: 0b4f81b7.  */
   2422  1.1.1.6  christos 	if (*p_hdr != NULL)
   2423  1.1.1.3  christos 	  goto fail;
   2424  1.1.1.5  christos 	hdr2 = (Elf_Internal_Shdr *) bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof (*hdr2));
   2425      1.1     skrll 	if (hdr2 == NULL)
   2426  1.1.1.3  christos 	  goto fail;
   2427      1.1     skrll 	*hdr2 = *hdr;
   2428  1.1.1.7  christos 	*p_hdr = hdr2;
   2429  1.1.1.7  christos 	elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = hdr2;
   2430      1.1     skrll 	target_sect->reloc_count += (NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (hdr)
   2431      1.1     skrll 				     * bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel);
   2432      1.1     skrll 	target_sect->flags |= SEC_RELOC;
   2433      1.1     skrll 	target_sect->relocation = NULL;
   2434      1.1     skrll 	target_sect->rel_filepos = hdr->sh_offset;
   2435      1.1     skrll 	/* In the section to which the relocations apply, mark whether
   2436  1.1.1.3  christos 	   its relocations are of the REL or RELA variety.  */
   2437  1.1.1.3  christos 	if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
   2438  1.1.1.3  christos 	  {
   2439  1.1.1.3  christos 	    if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
   2440      1.1     skrll 	      target_sect->use_rela_p = 1;
   2441  1.1.1.5  christos 	  }
   2442      1.1     skrll 	abfd->flags |= HAS_RELOC;
   2443      1.1     skrll 	goto success;
   2444      1.1     skrll       }
   2445      1.1     skrll 
   2446      1.1     skrll     case SHT_GNU_verdef:
   2447  1.1.1.5  christos       elf_dynverdef (abfd) = shindex;
   2448  1.1.1.5  christos       elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverdef_hdr = *hdr;
   2449      1.1     skrll       ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
   2450      1.1     skrll       goto success;
   2451      1.1     skrll 
   2452  1.1.1.5  christos     case SHT_GNU_versym:
   2453  1.1.1.5  christos       if (hdr->sh_entsize != sizeof (Elf_External_Versym))
   2454      1.1     skrll 	goto fail;
   2455      1.1     skrll 
   2456  1.1.1.5  christos       elf_dynversym (abfd) = shindex;
   2457  1.1.1.5  christos       elf_tdata (abfd)->dynversym_hdr = *hdr;
   2458      1.1     skrll       ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
   2459      1.1     skrll       goto success;
   2460      1.1     skrll 
   2461      1.1     skrll     case SHT_GNU_verneed:
   2462  1.1.1.5  christos       elf_dynverref (abfd) = shindex;
   2463  1.1.1.5  christos       elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverref_hdr = *hdr;
   2464      1.1     skrll       ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
   2465      1.1     skrll       goto success;
   2466  1.1.1.5  christos 
   2467      1.1     skrll     case SHT_SHLIB:
   2468      1.1     skrll       goto success;
   2469  1.1.1.5  christos 
   2470  1.1.1.5  christos     case SHT_GROUP:
   2471  1.1.1.5  christos       if (! IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER (hdr, GRP_ENTRY_SIZE))
   2472      1.1     skrll 	goto fail;
   2473  1.1.1.5  christos 
   2474  1.1.1.5  christos       if (!_bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
   2475  1.1.1.5  christos 	goto fail;
   2476      1.1     skrll 
   2477      1.1     skrll       goto success;
   2478      1.1     skrll 
   2479      1.1     skrll     default:
   2480      1.1     skrll       /* Possibly an attributes section.  */
   2481      1.1     skrll       if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_GNU_ATTRIBUTES
   2482      1.1     skrll 	  || hdr->sh_type == bed->obj_attrs_section_type)
   2483  1.1.1.5  christos 	{
   2484      1.1     skrll 	  if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
   2485  1.1.1.5  christos 	    goto fail;
   2486      1.1     skrll 	  _bfd_elf_parse_attributes (abfd, hdr);
   2487      1.1     skrll 	  goto success;
   2488      1.1     skrll 	}
   2489      1.1     skrll 
   2490  1.1.1.5  christos       /* Check for any processor-specific section types.  */
   2491      1.1     skrll       if (bed->elf_backend_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
   2492      1.1     skrll 	goto success;
   2493      1.1     skrll 
   2494      1.1     skrll       if (hdr->sh_type >= SHT_LOUSER && hdr->sh_type <= SHT_HIUSER)
   2495      1.1     skrll 	{
   2496      1.1     skrll 	  if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
   2497  1.1.1.7  christos 	    /* FIXME: How to properly handle allocated section reserved
   2498  1.1.1.7  christos 	       for applications?  */
   2499  1.1.1.8  christos 	    _bfd_error_handler
   2500  1.1.1.7  christos 	      /* xgettext:c-format */
   2501      1.1     skrll 	      (_("%pB: unknown type [%#x] section `%s'"),
   2502  1.1.1.5  christos 	       abfd, hdr->sh_type, name);
   2503  1.1.1.5  christos 	  else
   2504  1.1.1.5  christos 	    {
   2505  1.1.1.5  christos 	      /* Allow sections reserved for applications.  */
   2506  1.1.1.5  christos 	      ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
   2507  1.1.1.5  christos 						     shindex);
   2508      1.1     skrll 	      goto success;
   2509      1.1     skrll 	    }
   2510      1.1     skrll 	}
   2511      1.1     skrll       else if (hdr->sh_type >= SHT_LOPROC
   2512  1.1.1.7  christos 	       && hdr->sh_type <= SHT_HIPROC)
   2513  1.1.1.7  christos 	/* FIXME: We should handle this section.  */
   2514  1.1.1.8  christos 	_bfd_error_handler
   2515  1.1.1.7  christos 	  /* xgettext:c-format */
   2516      1.1     skrll 	  (_("%pB: unknown type [%#x] section `%s'"),
   2517      1.1     skrll 	   abfd, hdr->sh_type, name);
   2518      1.1     skrll       else if (hdr->sh_type >= SHT_LOOS && hdr->sh_type <= SHT_HIOS)
   2519      1.1     skrll 	{
   2520      1.1     skrll 	  /* Unrecognised OS-specific sections.  */
   2521      1.1     skrll 	  if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_OS_NONCONFORMING) != 0)
   2522      1.1     skrll 	    /* SHF_OS_NONCONFORMING indicates that special knowledge is
   2523  1.1.1.7  christos 	       required to correctly process the section and the file should
   2524  1.1.1.7  christos 	       be rejected with an error message.  */
   2525  1.1.1.8  christos 	    _bfd_error_handler
   2526  1.1.1.7  christos 	      /* xgettext:c-format */
   2527      1.1     skrll 	      (_("%pB: unknown type [%#x] section `%s'"),
   2528  1.1.1.5  christos 	       abfd, hdr->sh_type, name);
   2529  1.1.1.5  christos 	  else
   2530  1.1.1.5  christos 	    {
   2531  1.1.1.5  christos 	      /* Otherwise it should be processed.  */
   2532  1.1.1.5  christos 	      ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
   2533      1.1     skrll 	      goto success;
   2534      1.1     skrll 	    }
   2535      1.1     skrll 	}
   2536  1.1.1.7  christos       else
   2537  1.1.1.7  christos 	/* FIXME: We should handle this section.  */
   2538  1.1.1.8  christos 	_bfd_error_handler
   2539  1.1.1.7  christos 	  /* xgettext:c-format */
   2540      1.1     skrll 	  (_("%pB: unknown type [%#x] section `%s'"),
   2541  1.1.1.5  christos 	   abfd, hdr->sh_type, name);
   2542      1.1     skrll 
   2543      1.1     skrll       goto fail;
   2544  1.1.1.5  christos     }
   2545  1.1.1.5  christos 
   2546  1.1.1.5  christos  fail:
   2547  1.1.1.5  christos   ret = FALSE;
   2548  1.1.1.5  christos  success:
   2549  1.1.1.5  christos   if (sections_being_created && sections_being_created_abfd == abfd)
   2550  1.1.1.5  christos     sections_being_created [shindex] = FALSE;
   2551  1.1.1.5  christos   if (-- nesting == 0)
   2552  1.1.1.5  christos     {
   2553  1.1.1.5  christos       sections_being_created = NULL;
   2554  1.1.1.5  christos       sections_being_created_abfd = abfd;
   2555      1.1     skrll     }
   2556      1.1     skrll   return ret;
   2557  1.1.1.3  christos }
   2558      1.1     skrll 
   2559  1.1.1.3  christos /* Return the local symbol specified by ABFD, R_SYMNDX.  */
   2560  1.1.1.3  christos 
   2561  1.1.1.3  christos Elf_Internal_Sym *
   2562  1.1.1.3  christos bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (struct sym_cache *cache,
   2563      1.1     skrll 		       bfd *abfd,
   2564      1.1     skrll 		       unsigned long r_symndx)
   2565      1.1     skrll {
   2566      1.1     skrll   unsigned int ent = r_symndx % LOCAL_SYM_CACHE_SIZE;
   2567      1.1     skrll 
   2568      1.1     skrll   if (cache->abfd != abfd || cache->indx[ent] != r_symndx)
   2569      1.1     skrll     {
   2570      1.1     skrll       Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
   2571      1.1     skrll       unsigned char esym[sizeof (Elf64_External_Sym)];
   2572      1.1     skrll       Elf_External_Sym_Shndx eshndx;
   2573      1.1     skrll 
   2574  1.1.1.3  christos       symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
   2575      1.1     skrll       if (bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (abfd, symtab_hdr, 1, r_symndx,
   2576      1.1     skrll 				&cache->sym[ent], esym, &eshndx) == NULL)
   2577      1.1     skrll 	return NULL;
   2578      1.1     skrll 
   2579      1.1     skrll       if (cache->abfd != abfd)
   2580      1.1     skrll 	{
   2581      1.1     skrll 	  memset (cache->indx, -1, sizeof (cache->indx));
   2582      1.1     skrll 	  cache->abfd = abfd;
   2583      1.1     skrll 	}
   2584      1.1     skrll       cache->indx[ent] = r_symndx;
   2585  1.1.1.3  christos     }
   2586      1.1     skrll 
   2587      1.1     skrll   return &cache->sym[ent];
   2588      1.1     skrll }
   2589      1.1     skrll 
   2590      1.1     skrll /* Given an ELF section number, retrieve the corresponding BFD
   2591      1.1     skrll    section.  */
   2592  1.1.1.3  christos 
   2593      1.1     skrll asection *
   2594  1.1.1.3  christos bfd_section_from_elf_index (bfd *abfd, unsigned int sec_index)
   2595      1.1     skrll {
   2596  1.1.1.3  christos   if (sec_index >= elf_numsections (abfd))
   2597      1.1     skrll     return NULL;
   2598      1.1     skrll   return elf_elfsections (abfd)[sec_index]->bfd_section;
   2599      1.1     skrll }
   2600      1.1     skrll 
   2601      1.1     skrll static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_b[] =
   2602  1.1.1.7  christos {
   2603      1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".bss"), -2, SHT_NOBITS,   SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
   2604      1.1     skrll   { NULL,		    0,	0, 0,		 0 }
   2605      1.1     skrll };
   2606      1.1     skrll 
   2607      1.1     skrll static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_c[] =
   2608  1.1.1.7  christos {
   2609      1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".comment"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
   2610      1.1     skrll   { NULL,			0, 0, 0,	    0 }
   2611      1.1     skrll };
   2612      1.1     skrll 
   2613  1.1.1.7  christos static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_d[] =
   2614  1.1.1.7  christos {
   2615  1.1.1.5  christos   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".data"),		-2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
   2616  1.1.1.5  christos   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".data1"),	 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
   2617  1.1.1.5  christos   /* There are more DWARF sections than these, but they needn't be added here
   2618  1.1.1.7  christos      unless you have to cope with broken compilers that don't emit section
   2619  1.1.1.7  christos      attributes or you want to help the user writing assembler.  */
   2620  1.1.1.7  christos   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug"),	 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
   2621  1.1.1.7  christos   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_line"),	 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
   2622      1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_info"),	 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
   2623  1.1.1.7  christos   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_abbrev"),	 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
   2624  1.1.1.7  christos   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_aranges"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
   2625  1.1.1.7  christos   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".dynamic"),	 0, SHT_DYNAMIC,  SHF_ALLOC },
   2626  1.1.1.7  christos   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".dynstr"),	 0, SHT_STRTAB,	  SHF_ALLOC },
   2627      1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".dynsym"),	 0, SHT_DYNSYM,	  SHF_ALLOC },
   2628      1.1     skrll   { NULL,		       0,	 0, 0,		  0 }
   2629      1.1     skrll };
   2630      1.1     skrll 
   2631  1.1.1.7  christos static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_f[] =
   2632  1.1.1.7  christos {
   2633  1.1.1.7  christos   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".fini"),	       0, SHT_PROGBITS,	  SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
   2634      1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".fini_array"), -2, SHT_FINI_ARRAY, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
   2635      1.1     skrll   { NULL,			   0 , 0, 0,		  0 }
   2636      1.1     skrll };
   2637      1.1     skrll 
   2638      1.1     skrll static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_g[] =
   2639  1.1.1.7  christos {
   2640  1.1.1.7  christos   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.linkonce.b"), -2, SHT_NOBITS,      SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
   2641  1.1.1.7  christos   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.lto_"),	  -1, SHT_PROGBITS,    SHF_EXCLUDE },
   2642      1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".got"),		   0, SHT_PROGBITS,    SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
   2643      1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.version"),	   0, SHT_GNU_versym,  0 },
   2644  1.1.1.7  christos   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.version_d"),   0, SHT_GNU_verdef,  0 },
   2645  1.1.1.7  christos   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.version_r"),   0, SHT_GNU_verneed, 0 },
   2646  1.1.1.7  christos   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.liblist"),	   0, SHT_GNU_LIBLIST, SHF_ALLOC },
   2647  1.1.1.7  christos   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.conflict"),	   0, SHT_RELA,	       SHF_ALLOC },
   2648      1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.hash"),	   0, SHT_GNU_HASH,    SHF_ALLOC },
   2649      1.1     skrll   { NULL,			 0,	   0, 0,	       0 }
   2650      1.1     skrll };
   2651      1.1     skrll 
   2652  1.1.1.7  christos static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_h[] =
   2653  1.1.1.7  christos {
   2654      1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".hash"), 0, SHT_HASH,	 SHF_ALLOC },
   2655      1.1     skrll   { NULL,		     0, 0, 0,		 0 }
   2656      1.1     skrll };
   2657      1.1     skrll 
   2658  1.1.1.7  christos static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_i[] =
   2659  1.1.1.7  christos {
   2660  1.1.1.7  christos   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".init"),	       0, SHT_PROGBITS,	  SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
   2661  1.1.1.7  christos   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".init_array"), -2, SHT_INIT_ARRAY, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
   2662      1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".interp"),      0, SHT_PROGBITS,	  0 },
   2663      1.1     skrll   { NULL,		       0,      0, 0,		  0 }
   2664      1.1     skrll };
   2665      1.1     skrll 
   2666      1.1     skrll static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_l[] =
   2667  1.1.1.7  christos {
   2668      1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".line"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
   2669      1.1     skrll   { NULL,		     0, 0, 0,		 0 }
   2670      1.1     skrll };
   2671      1.1     skrll 
   2672      1.1     skrll static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_n[] =
   2673  1.1.1.7  christos {
   2674  1.1.1.7  christos   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".note.GNU-stack"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
   2675      1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".note"),		 -1, SHT_NOTE,	   0 },
   2676      1.1     skrll   { NULL,		     0,		  0, 0,		   0 }
   2677      1.1     skrll };
   2678      1.1     skrll 
   2679  1.1.1.7  christos static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_p[] =
   2680  1.1.1.7  christos {
   2681  1.1.1.7  christos   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".preinit_array"), -2, SHT_PREINIT_ARRAY, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
   2682      1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".plt"),		  0, SHT_PROGBITS,	SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
   2683      1.1     skrll   { NULL,		    0,		  0, 0,			0 }
   2684      1.1     skrll };
   2685      1.1     skrll 
   2686      1.1     skrll static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_r[] =
   2687      1.1     skrll {
   2688  1.1.1.7  christos   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rodata"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
   2689  1.1.1.7  christos   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rodata1"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
   2690  1.1.1.7  christos   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rela"),	  -1, SHT_RELA,	    0 },
   2691      1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rel"),	  -1, SHT_REL,	    0 },
   2692      1.1     skrll   { NULL,		    0,	   0, 0,	    0 }
   2693      1.1     skrll };
   2694      1.1     skrll 
   2695      1.1     skrll static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_s[] =
   2696      1.1     skrll {
   2697      1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".shstrtab"), 0, SHT_STRTAB, 0 },
   2698      1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".strtab"),   0, SHT_STRTAB, 0 },
   2699      1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".symtab"),   0, SHT_SYMTAB, 0 },
   2700      1.1     skrll   /* See struct bfd_elf_special_section declaration for the semantics of
   2701  1.1.1.7  christos      this special case where .prefix_length != strlen (.prefix).  */
   2702      1.1     skrll   { ".stabstr",			5,  3, SHT_STRTAB, 0 },
   2703      1.1     skrll   { NULL,			0,  0, 0,	   0 }
   2704      1.1     skrll };
   2705      1.1     skrll 
   2706  1.1.1.7  christos static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_t[] =
   2707  1.1.1.7  christos {
   2708      1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".text"),	 -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
   2709  1.1.1.7  christos   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".tbss"),	 -2, SHT_NOBITS,   SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_TLS },
   2710      1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".tdata"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_TLS },
   2711      1.1     skrll   { NULL,		      0,  0, 0,		   0 }
   2712      1.1     skrll };
   2713      1.1     skrll 
   2714  1.1.1.7  christos static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_z[] =
   2715  1.1.1.7  christos {
   2716      1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_line"),	  0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
   2717      1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_info"),	  0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
   2718  1.1.1.7  christos   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_abbrev"),  0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
   2719      1.1     skrll   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_aranges"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
   2720      1.1     skrll   { NULL,		      0,  0, 0,		   0 }
   2721  1.1.1.4  christos };
   2722      1.1     skrll 
   2723      1.1     skrll static const struct bfd_elf_special_section * const special_sections[] =
   2724      1.1     skrll {
   2725      1.1     skrll   special_sections_b,		/* 'b' */
   2726      1.1     skrll   special_sections_c,		/* 'c' */
   2727      1.1     skrll   special_sections_d,		/* 'd' */
   2728      1.1     skrll   NULL,				/* 'e' */
   2729      1.1     skrll   special_sections_f,		/* 'f' */
   2730      1.1     skrll   special_sections_g,		/* 'g' */
   2731      1.1     skrll   special_sections_h,		/* 'h' */
   2732      1.1     skrll   special_sections_i,		/* 'i' */
   2733      1.1     skrll   NULL,				/* 'j' */
   2734      1.1     skrll   NULL,				/* 'k' */
   2735      1.1     skrll   special_sections_l,		/* 'l' */
   2736      1.1     skrll   NULL,				/* 'm' */
   2737      1.1     skrll   special_sections_n,		/* 'n' */
   2738      1.1     skrll   NULL,				/* 'o' */
   2739      1.1     skrll   special_sections_p,		/* 'p' */
   2740      1.1     skrll   NULL,				/* 'q' */
   2741      1.1     skrll   special_sections_r,		/* 'r' */
   2742      1.1     skrll   special_sections_s,		/* 's' */
   2743      1.1     skrll   special_sections_t,		/* 't' */
   2744      1.1     skrll   NULL,				/* 'u' */
   2745      1.1     skrll   NULL,				/* 'v' */
   2746      1.1     skrll   NULL,				/* 'w' */
   2747      1.1     skrll   NULL,				/* 'x' */
   2748      1.1     skrll   NULL,				/* 'y' */
   2749      1.1     skrll   special_sections_z		/* 'z' */
   2750      1.1     skrll };
   2751      1.1     skrll 
   2752      1.1     skrll const struct bfd_elf_special_section *
   2753      1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_get_special_section (const char *name,
   2754      1.1     skrll 			      const struct bfd_elf_special_section *spec,
   2755      1.1     skrll 			      unsigned int rela)
   2756      1.1     skrll {
   2757      1.1     skrll   int i;
   2758      1.1     skrll   int len;
   2759      1.1     skrll 
   2760      1.1     skrll   len = strlen (name);
   2761      1.1     skrll 
   2762      1.1     skrll   for (i = 0; spec[i].prefix != NULL; i++)
   2763      1.1     skrll     {
   2764      1.1     skrll       int suffix_len;
   2765      1.1     skrll       int prefix_len = spec[i].prefix_length;
   2766      1.1     skrll 
   2767      1.1     skrll       if (len < prefix_len)
   2768      1.1     skrll 	continue;
   2769      1.1     skrll       if (memcmp (name, spec[i].prefix, prefix_len) != 0)
   2770      1.1     skrll 	continue;
   2771      1.1     skrll 
   2772      1.1     skrll       suffix_len = spec[i].suffix_length;
   2773      1.1     skrll       if (suffix_len <= 0)
   2774      1.1     skrll 	{
   2775      1.1     skrll 	  if (name[prefix_len] != 0)
   2776      1.1     skrll 	    {
   2777      1.1     skrll 	      if (suffix_len == 0)
   2778      1.1     skrll 		continue;
   2779      1.1     skrll 	      if (name[prefix_len] != '.'
   2780      1.1     skrll 		  && (suffix_len == -2
   2781      1.1     skrll 		      || (rela && spec[i].type == SHT_REL)))
   2782      1.1     skrll 		continue;
   2783      1.1     skrll 	    }
   2784      1.1     skrll 	}
   2785      1.1     skrll       else
   2786      1.1     skrll 	{
   2787      1.1     skrll 	  if (len < prefix_len + suffix_len)
   2788      1.1     skrll 	    continue;
   2789      1.1     skrll 	  if (memcmp (name + len - suffix_len,
   2790      1.1     skrll 		      spec[i].prefix + prefix_len,
   2791      1.1     skrll 		      suffix_len) != 0)
   2792      1.1     skrll 	    continue;
   2793      1.1     skrll 	}
   2794      1.1     skrll       return &spec[i];
   2795      1.1     skrll     }
   2796      1.1     skrll 
   2797      1.1     skrll   return NULL;
   2798      1.1     skrll }
   2799      1.1     skrll 
   2800      1.1     skrll const struct bfd_elf_special_section *
   2801      1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_get_sec_type_attr (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
   2802      1.1     skrll {
   2803      1.1     skrll   int i;
   2804      1.1     skrll   const struct bfd_elf_special_section *spec;
   2805      1.1     skrll   const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
   2806      1.1     skrll 
   2807      1.1     skrll   /* See if this is one of the special sections.  */
   2808      1.1     skrll   if (sec->name == NULL)
   2809      1.1     skrll     return NULL;
   2810      1.1     skrll 
   2811      1.1     skrll   bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   2812      1.1     skrll   spec = bed->special_sections;
   2813      1.1     skrll   if (spec)
   2814      1.1     skrll     {
   2815      1.1     skrll       spec = _bfd_elf_get_special_section (sec->name,
   2816      1.1     skrll 					   bed->special_sections,
   2817      1.1     skrll 					   sec->use_rela_p);
   2818      1.1     skrll       if (spec != NULL)
   2819      1.1     skrll 	return spec;
   2820      1.1     skrll     }
   2821      1.1     skrll 
   2822      1.1     skrll   if (sec->name[0] != '.')
   2823      1.1     skrll     return NULL;
   2824      1.1     skrll 
   2825      1.1     skrll   i = sec->name[1] - 'b';
   2826      1.1     skrll   if (i < 0 || i > 'z' - 'b')
   2827      1.1     skrll     return NULL;
   2828      1.1     skrll 
   2829      1.1     skrll   spec = special_sections[i];
   2830      1.1     skrll 
   2831      1.1     skrll   if (spec == NULL)
   2832      1.1     skrll     return NULL;
   2833      1.1     skrll 
   2834      1.1     skrll   return _bfd_elf_get_special_section (sec->name, spec, sec->use_rela_p);
   2835      1.1     skrll }
   2836      1.1     skrll 
   2837      1.1     skrll bfd_boolean
   2838      1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_new_section_hook (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
   2839      1.1     skrll {
   2840      1.1     skrll   struct bfd_elf_section_data *sdata;
   2841      1.1     skrll   const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
   2842      1.1     skrll   const struct bfd_elf_special_section *ssect;
   2843      1.1     skrll 
   2844      1.1     skrll   sdata = (struct bfd_elf_section_data *) sec->used_by_bfd;
   2845  1.1.1.3  christos   if (sdata == NULL)
   2846  1.1.1.7  christos     {
   2847      1.1     skrll       sdata = (struct bfd_elf_section_data *) bfd_zalloc (abfd,
   2848      1.1     skrll 							  sizeof (*sdata));
   2849      1.1     skrll       if (sdata == NULL)
   2850      1.1     skrll 	return FALSE;
   2851      1.1     skrll       sec->used_by_bfd = sdata;
   2852      1.1     skrll     }
   2853      1.1     skrll 
   2854      1.1     skrll   /* Indicate whether or not this section should use RELA relocations.  */
   2855      1.1     skrll   bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   2856      1.1     skrll   sec->use_rela_p = bed->default_use_rela_p;
   2857      1.1     skrll 
   2858      1.1     skrll   /* When we read a file, we don't need to set ELF section type and
   2859      1.1     skrll      flags.  They will be overridden in _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr
   2860      1.1     skrll      anyway.  We will set ELF section type and flags for all linker
   2861  1.1.1.4  christos      created sections.  If user specifies BFD section flags, we will
   2862  1.1.1.4  christos      set ELF section type and flags based on BFD section flags in
   2863  1.1.1.4  christos      elf_fake_sections.  Special handling for .init_array/.fini_array
   2864  1.1.1.4  christos      output sections since they may contain .ctors/.dtors input
   2865  1.1.1.4  christos      sections.  We don't want _bfd_elf_init_private_section_data to
   2866      1.1     skrll      copy ELF section type from .ctors/.dtors input sections.  */
   2867      1.1     skrll   if (abfd->direction != read_direction
   2868      1.1     skrll       || (sec->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) != 0)
   2869  1.1.1.4  christos     {
   2870  1.1.1.4  christos       ssect = (*bed->get_sec_type_attr) (abfd, sec);
   2871  1.1.1.4  christos       if (ssect != NULL
   2872  1.1.1.4  christos 	  && (!sec->flags
   2873  1.1.1.4  christos 	      || (sec->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) != 0
   2874      1.1     skrll 	      || ssect->type == SHT_INIT_ARRAY
   2875      1.1     skrll 	      || ssect->type == SHT_FINI_ARRAY))
   2876      1.1     skrll 	{
   2877      1.1     skrll 	  elf_section_type (sec) = ssect->type;
   2878      1.1     skrll 	  elf_section_flags (sec) = ssect->attr;
   2879      1.1     skrll 	}
   2880      1.1     skrll     }
   2881      1.1     skrll 
   2882      1.1     skrll   return _bfd_generic_new_section_hook (abfd, sec);
   2883      1.1     skrll }
   2884      1.1     skrll 
   2885      1.1     skrll /* Create a new bfd section from an ELF program header.
   2886      1.1     skrll 
   2887      1.1     skrll    Since program segments have no names, we generate a synthetic name
   2888      1.1     skrll    of the form segment<NUM>, where NUM is generally the index in the
   2889      1.1     skrll    program header table.  For segments that are split (see below) we
   2890      1.1     skrll    generate the names segment<NUM>a and segment<NUM>b.
   2891      1.1     skrll 
   2892      1.1     skrll    Note that some program segments may have a file size that is different than
   2893      1.1     skrll    (less than) the memory size.  All this means is that at execution the
   2894      1.1     skrll    system must allocate the amount of memory specified by the memory size,
   2895      1.1     skrll    but only initialize it with the first "file size" bytes read from the
   2896      1.1     skrll    file.  This would occur for example, with program segments consisting
   2897      1.1     skrll    of combined data+bss.
   2898      1.1     skrll 
   2899      1.1     skrll    To handle the above situation, this routine generates TWO bfd sections
   2900      1.1     skrll    for the single program segment.  The first has the length specified by
   2901      1.1     skrll    the file size of the segment, and the second has the length specified
   2902      1.1     skrll    by the difference between the two sizes.  In effect, the segment is split
   2903      1.1     skrll    into its initialized and uninitialized parts.
   2904      1.1     skrll 
   2905      1.1     skrll  */
   2906      1.1     skrll 
   2907      1.1     skrll bfd_boolean
   2908  1.1.1.3  christos _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (bfd *abfd,
   2909  1.1.1.3  christos 				 Elf_Internal_Phdr *hdr,
   2910      1.1     skrll 				 int hdr_index,
   2911      1.1     skrll 				 const char *type_name)
   2912      1.1     skrll {
   2913      1.1     skrll   asection *newsect;
   2914      1.1     skrll   char *name;
   2915      1.1     skrll   char namebuf[64];
   2916      1.1     skrll   size_t len;
   2917      1.1     skrll   int split;
   2918      1.1     skrll 
   2919      1.1     skrll   split = ((hdr->p_memsz > 0)
   2920      1.1     skrll 	    && (hdr->p_filesz > 0)
   2921      1.1     skrll 	    && (hdr->p_memsz > hdr->p_filesz));
   2922      1.1     skrll 
   2923  1.1.1.3  christos   if (hdr->p_filesz > 0)
   2924      1.1     skrll     {
   2925  1.1.1.3  christos       sprintf (namebuf, "%s%d%s", type_name, hdr_index, split ? "a" : "");
   2926      1.1     skrll       len = strlen (namebuf) + 1;
   2927      1.1     skrll       name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
   2928      1.1     skrll       if (!name)
   2929      1.1     skrll 	return FALSE;
   2930      1.1     skrll       memcpy (name, namebuf, len);
   2931      1.1     skrll       newsect = bfd_make_section (abfd, name);
   2932      1.1     skrll       if (newsect == NULL)
   2933      1.1     skrll 	return FALSE;
   2934      1.1     skrll       newsect->vma = hdr->p_vaddr;
   2935      1.1     skrll       newsect->lma = hdr->p_paddr;
   2936      1.1     skrll       newsect->size = hdr->p_filesz;
   2937      1.1     skrll       newsect->filepos = hdr->p_offset;
   2938      1.1     skrll       newsect->flags |= SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
   2939      1.1     skrll       newsect->alignment_power = bfd_log2 (hdr->p_align);
   2940      1.1     skrll       if (hdr->p_type == PT_LOAD)
   2941      1.1     skrll 	{
   2942      1.1     skrll 	  newsect->flags |= SEC_ALLOC;
   2943      1.1     skrll 	  newsect->flags |= SEC_LOAD;
   2944      1.1     skrll 	  if (hdr->p_flags & PF_X)
   2945      1.1     skrll 	    {
   2946      1.1     skrll 	      /* FIXME: all we known is that it has execute PERMISSION,
   2947      1.1     skrll 		 may be data.  */
   2948      1.1     skrll 	      newsect->flags |= SEC_CODE;
   2949      1.1     skrll 	    }
   2950      1.1     skrll 	}
   2951      1.1     skrll       if (!(hdr->p_flags & PF_W))
   2952      1.1     skrll 	{
   2953      1.1     skrll 	  newsect->flags |= SEC_READONLY;
   2954      1.1     skrll 	}
   2955      1.1     skrll     }
   2956      1.1     skrll 
   2957      1.1     skrll   if (hdr->p_memsz > hdr->p_filesz)
   2958      1.1     skrll     {
   2959  1.1.1.3  christos       bfd_vma align;
   2960      1.1     skrll 
   2961  1.1.1.3  christos       sprintf (namebuf, "%s%d%s", type_name, hdr_index, split ? "b" : "");
   2962      1.1     skrll       len = strlen (namebuf) + 1;
   2963      1.1     skrll       name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
   2964      1.1     skrll       if (!name)
   2965      1.1     skrll 	return FALSE;
   2966      1.1     skrll       memcpy (name, namebuf, len);
   2967      1.1     skrll       newsect = bfd_make_section (abfd, name);
   2968      1.1     skrll       if (newsect == NULL)
   2969      1.1     skrll 	return FALSE;
   2970      1.1     skrll       newsect->vma = hdr->p_vaddr + hdr->p_filesz;
   2971      1.1     skrll       newsect->lma = hdr->p_paddr + hdr->p_filesz;
   2972      1.1     skrll       newsect->size = hdr->p_memsz - hdr->p_filesz;
   2973      1.1     skrll       newsect->filepos = hdr->p_offset + hdr->p_filesz;
   2974      1.1     skrll       align = newsect->vma & -newsect->vma;
   2975      1.1     skrll       if (align == 0 || align > hdr->p_align)
   2976      1.1     skrll 	align = hdr->p_align;
   2977      1.1     skrll       newsect->alignment_power = bfd_log2 (align);
   2978      1.1     skrll       if (hdr->p_type == PT_LOAD)
   2979      1.1     skrll 	{
   2980      1.1     skrll 	  /* Hack for gdb.  Segments that have not been modified do
   2981      1.1     skrll 	     not have their contents written to a core file, on the
   2982      1.1     skrll 	     assumption that a debugger can find the contents in the
   2983      1.1     skrll 	     executable.  We flag this case by setting the fake
   2984      1.1     skrll 	     section size to zero.  Note that "real" bss sections will
   2985      1.1     skrll 	     always have their contents dumped to the core file.  */
   2986      1.1     skrll 	  if (bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_core)
   2987      1.1     skrll 	    newsect->size = 0;
   2988      1.1     skrll 	  newsect->flags |= SEC_ALLOC;
   2989      1.1     skrll 	  if (hdr->p_flags & PF_X)
   2990      1.1     skrll 	    newsect->flags |= SEC_CODE;
   2991      1.1     skrll 	}
   2992      1.1     skrll       if (!(hdr->p_flags & PF_W))
   2993      1.1     skrll 	newsect->flags |= SEC_READONLY;
   2994      1.1     skrll     }
   2995      1.1     skrll 
   2996      1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   2997      1.1     skrll }
   2998  1.1.1.3  christos 
   2999      1.1     skrll bfd_boolean
   3000      1.1     skrll bfd_section_from_phdr (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Phdr *hdr, int hdr_index)
   3001      1.1     skrll {
   3002      1.1     skrll   const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
   3003      1.1     skrll 
   3004      1.1     skrll   switch (hdr->p_type)
   3005  1.1.1.3  christos     {
   3006      1.1     skrll     case PT_NULL:
   3007      1.1     skrll       return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "null");
   3008  1.1.1.3  christos 
   3009      1.1     skrll     case PT_LOAD:
   3010      1.1     skrll       return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "load");
   3011  1.1.1.3  christos 
   3012      1.1     skrll     case PT_DYNAMIC:
   3013      1.1     skrll       return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "dynamic");
   3014  1.1.1.3  christos 
   3015      1.1     skrll     case PT_INTERP:
   3016      1.1     skrll       return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "interp");
   3017  1.1.1.3  christos 
   3018      1.1     skrll     case PT_NOTE:
   3019  1.1.1.7  christos       if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "note"))
   3020  1.1.1.7  christos 	return FALSE;
   3021      1.1     skrll       if (! elf_read_notes (abfd, hdr->p_offset, hdr->p_filesz,
   3022      1.1     skrll 			    hdr->p_align))
   3023      1.1     skrll 	return FALSE;
   3024      1.1     skrll       return TRUE;
   3025  1.1.1.3  christos 
   3026      1.1     skrll     case PT_SHLIB:
   3027      1.1     skrll       return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "shlib");
   3028  1.1.1.3  christos 
   3029      1.1     skrll     case PT_PHDR:
   3030      1.1     skrll       return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "phdr");
   3031  1.1.1.3  christos 
   3032      1.1     skrll     case PT_GNU_EH_FRAME:
   3033      1.1     skrll       return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index,
   3034      1.1     skrll 					      "eh_frame_hdr");
   3035  1.1.1.3  christos 
   3036      1.1     skrll     case PT_GNU_STACK:
   3037      1.1     skrll       return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "stack");
   3038  1.1.1.3  christos 
   3039      1.1     skrll     case PT_GNU_RELRO:
   3040      1.1     skrll       return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "relro");
   3041      1.1     skrll 
   3042      1.1     skrll     default:
   3043  1.1.1.3  christos       /* Check for any processor-specific program segment types.  */
   3044      1.1     skrll       bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   3045      1.1     skrll       return bed->elf_backend_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "proc");
   3046      1.1     skrll     }
   3047  1.1.1.3  christos }
   3048  1.1.1.3  christos 
   3049  1.1.1.3  christos /* Return the REL_HDR for SEC, assuming there is only a single one, either
   3050  1.1.1.3  christos    REL or RELA.  */
   3051  1.1.1.3  christos 
   3052  1.1.1.3  christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *
   3053  1.1.1.3  christos _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (asection *sec)
   3054  1.1.1.3  christos {
   3055  1.1.1.3  christos   if (elf_section_data (sec)->rel.hdr)
   3056  1.1.1.3  christos     {
   3057  1.1.1.3  christos       BFD_ASSERT (elf_section_data (sec)->rela.hdr == NULL);
   3058  1.1.1.3  christos       return elf_section_data (sec)->rel.hdr;
   3059  1.1.1.3  christos     }
   3060  1.1.1.3  christos   else
   3061  1.1.1.3  christos     return elf_section_data (sec)->rela.hdr;
   3062  1.1.1.5  christos }
   3063  1.1.1.5  christos 
   3064  1.1.1.5  christos static bfd_boolean
   3065  1.1.1.5  christos _bfd_elf_set_reloc_sh_name (bfd *abfd,
   3066  1.1.1.5  christos 			    Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr,
   3067  1.1.1.5  christos 			    const char *sec_name,
   3068  1.1.1.5  christos 			    bfd_boolean use_rela_p)
   3069  1.1.1.5  christos {
   3070  1.1.1.5  christos   char *name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd,
   3071  1.1.1.5  christos 				   sizeof ".rela" + strlen (sec_name));
   3072  1.1.1.5  christos   if (name == NULL)
   3073  1.1.1.5  christos     return FALSE;
   3074  1.1.1.5  christos 
   3075  1.1.1.5  christos   sprintf (name, "%s%s", use_rela_p ? ".rela" : ".rel", sec_name);
   3076  1.1.1.5  christos   rel_hdr->sh_name =
   3077  1.1.1.5  christos     (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (elf_shstrtab (abfd), name,
   3078  1.1.1.5  christos 					FALSE);
   3079  1.1.1.5  christos   if (rel_hdr->sh_name == (unsigned int) -1)
   3080  1.1.1.5  christos     return FALSE;
   3081  1.1.1.5  christos 
   3082  1.1.1.5  christos   return TRUE;
   3083  1.1.1.3  christos }
   3084  1.1.1.3  christos 
   3085  1.1.1.3  christos /* Allocate and initialize a section-header for a new reloc section,
   3086  1.1.1.3  christos    containing relocations against ASECT.  It is stored in RELDATA.  If
   3087      1.1     skrll    USE_RELA_P is TRUE, we use RELA relocations; otherwise, we use REL
   3088  1.1.1.5  christos    relocations.  */
   3089      1.1     skrll 
   3090  1.1.1.3  christos static bfd_boolean
   3091  1.1.1.5  christos _bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (bfd *abfd,
   3092  1.1.1.5  christos 			  struct bfd_elf_section_reloc_data *reldata,
   3093  1.1.1.5  christos 			  const char *sec_name,
   3094      1.1     skrll 			  bfd_boolean use_rela_p,
   3095  1.1.1.3  christos 			  bfd_boolean delay_st_name_p)
   3096      1.1     skrll {
   3097  1.1.1.3  christos   Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
   3098  1.1.1.3  christos   const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   3099  1.1.1.6  christos 
   3100  1.1.1.3  christos   BFD_ASSERT (reldata->hdr == NULL);
   3101      1.1     skrll   rel_hdr = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (*rel_hdr));
   3102  1.1.1.5  christos   reldata->hdr = rel_hdr;
   3103  1.1.1.5  christos 
   3104  1.1.1.5  christos   if (delay_st_name_p)
   3105  1.1.1.5  christos     rel_hdr->sh_name = (unsigned int) -1;
   3106      1.1     skrll   else if (!_bfd_elf_set_reloc_sh_name (abfd, rel_hdr, sec_name,
   3107      1.1     skrll 					use_rela_p))
   3108      1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   3109      1.1     skrll   rel_hdr->sh_type = use_rela_p ? SHT_RELA : SHT_REL;
   3110      1.1     skrll   rel_hdr->sh_entsize = (use_rela_p
   3111      1.1     skrll 			 ? bed->s->sizeof_rela
   3112      1.1     skrll 			 : bed->s->sizeof_rel);
   3113      1.1     skrll   rel_hdr->sh_addralign = (bfd_vma) 1 << bed->s->log_file_align;
   3114      1.1     skrll   rel_hdr->sh_flags = 0;
   3115      1.1     skrll   rel_hdr->sh_addr = 0;
   3116      1.1     skrll   rel_hdr->sh_size = 0;
   3117      1.1     skrll   rel_hdr->sh_offset = 0;
   3118      1.1     skrll 
   3119      1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   3120  1.1.1.3  christos }
   3121  1.1.1.3  christos 
   3122  1.1.1.3  christos /* Return the default section type based on the passed in section flags.  */
   3123  1.1.1.3  christos 
   3124  1.1.1.3  christos int
   3125  1.1.1.3  christos bfd_elf_get_default_section_type (flagword flags)
   3126  1.1.1.3  christos {
   3127  1.1.1.3  christos   if ((flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
   3128  1.1.1.3  christos       && (flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS)) == 0)
   3129  1.1.1.3  christos     return SHT_NOBITS;
   3130  1.1.1.3  christos   return SHT_PROGBITS;
   3131  1.1.1.3  christos }
   3132  1.1.1.3  christos 
   3133  1.1.1.3  christos struct fake_section_arg
   3134  1.1.1.3  christos {
   3135  1.1.1.3  christos   struct bfd_link_info *link_info;
   3136  1.1.1.3  christos   bfd_boolean failed;
   3137      1.1     skrll };
   3138      1.1     skrll 
   3139      1.1     skrll /* Set up an ELF internal section header for a section.  */
   3140  1.1.1.3  christos 
   3141      1.1     skrll static void
   3142  1.1.1.3  christos elf_fake_sections (bfd *abfd, asection *asect, void *fsarg)
   3143      1.1     skrll {
   3144  1.1.1.3  christos   struct fake_section_arg *arg = (struct fake_section_arg *)fsarg;
   3145      1.1     skrll   const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   3146      1.1     skrll   struct bfd_elf_section_data *esd = elf_section_data (asect);
   3147  1.1.1.5  christos   Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
   3148  1.1.1.5  christos   unsigned int sh_type;
   3149      1.1     skrll   const char *name = asect->name;
   3150  1.1.1.3  christos   bfd_boolean delay_st_name_p = FALSE;
   3151      1.1     skrll 
   3152      1.1     skrll   if (arg->failed)
   3153      1.1     skrll     {
   3154      1.1     skrll       /* We already failed; just get out of the bfd_map_over_sections
   3155      1.1     skrll 	 loop.  */
   3156      1.1     skrll       return;
   3157  1.1.1.3  christos     }
   3158      1.1     skrll 
   3159  1.1.1.5  christos   this_hdr = &esd->this_hdr;
   3160      1.1     skrll 
   3161  1.1.1.5  christos   if (arg->link_info)
   3162  1.1.1.5  christos     {
   3163  1.1.1.5  christos       /* ld: compress DWARF debug sections with names: .debug_*.  */
   3164  1.1.1.5  christos       if ((arg->link_info->compress_debug & COMPRESS_DEBUG)
   3165  1.1.1.5  christos 	  && (asect->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING)
   3166  1.1.1.5  christos 	  && name[1] == 'd'
   3167  1.1.1.5  christos 	  && name[6] == '_')
   3168  1.1.1.5  christos 	{
   3169  1.1.1.5  christos 	  /* Set SEC_ELF_COMPRESS to indicate this section should be
   3170  1.1.1.5  christos 	     compressed.  */
   3171  1.1.1.7  christos 	  asect->flags |= SEC_ELF_COMPRESS;
   3172  1.1.1.5  christos 
   3173  1.1.1.5  christos 	  /* If this section will be compressed, delay adding section
   3174  1.1.1.5  christos 	     name to section name section after it is compressed in
   3175  1.1.1.5  christos 	     _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load.  */
   3176  1.1.1.5  christos 	  delay_st_name_p = TRUE;
   3177  1.1.1.5  christos 	}
   3178  1.1.1.5  christos     }
   3179  1.1.1.5  christos   else if ((asect->flags & SEC_ELF_RENAME))
   3180  1.1.1.5  christos     {
   3181  1.1.1.5  christos       /* objcopy: rename output DWARF debug section.  */
   3182  1.1.1.5  christos       if ((abfd->flags & (BFD_DECOMPRESS | BFD_COMPRESS_GABI)))
   3183  1.1.1.5  christos 	{
   3184  1.1.1.5  christos 	  /* When we decompress or compress with SHF_COMPRESSED,
   3185  1.1.1.5  christos 	     convert section name from .zdebug_* to .debug_* if
   3186  1.1.1.5  christos 	     needed.  */
   3187  1.1.1.5  christos 	  if (name[1] == 'z')
   3188  1.1.1.5  christos 	    {
   3189  1.1.1.5  christos 	      char *new_name = convert_zdebug_to_debug (abfd, name);
   3190  1.1.1.5  christos 	      if (new_name == NULL)
   3191  1.1.1.5  christos 		{
   3192  1.1.1.5  christos 		  arg->failed = TRUE;
   3193  1.1.1.5  christos 		  return;
   3194  1.1.1.5  christos 		}
   3195  1.1.1.5  christos 	      name = new_name;
   3196  1.1.1.5  christos 	    }
   3197  1.1.1.5  christos 	}
   3198  1.1.1.5  christos       else if (asect->compress_status == COMPRESS_SECTION_DONE)
   3199  1.1.1.5  christos 	{
   3200  1.1.1.5  christos 	  /* PR binutils/18087: Compression does not always make a
   3201  1.1.1.5  christos 	     section smaller.  So only rename the section when
   3202  1.1.1.5  christos 	     compression has actually taken place.  If input section
   3203  1.1.1.5  christos 	     name is .zdebug_*, we should never compress it again.  */
   3204  1.1.1.5  christos 	  char *new_name = convert_debug_to_zdebug (abfd, name);
   3205  1.1.1.5  christos 	  if (new_name == NULL)
   3206  1.1.1.5  christos 	    {
   3207  1.1.1.5  christos 	      arg->failed = TRUE;
   3208  1.1.1.5  christos 	      return;
   3209  1.1.1.5  christos 	    }
   3210  1.1.1.5  christos 	  BFD_ASSERT (name[1] != 'z');
   3211  1.1.1.5  christos 	  name = new_name;
   3212  1.1.1.5  christos 	}
   3213  1.1.1.5  christos     }
   3214  1.1.1.5  christos 
   3215  1.1.1.5  christos   if (delay_st_name_p)
   3216  1.1.1.5  christos     this_hdr->sh_name = (unsigned int) -1;
   3217  1.1.1.5  christos   else
   3218  1.1.1.5  christos     {
   3219  1.1.1.5  christos       this_hdr->sh_name
   3220  1.1.1.5  christos 	= (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (elf_shstrtab (abfd),
   3221  1.1.1.5  christos 					      name, FALSE);
   3222  1.1.1.5  christos       if (this_hdr->sh_name == (unsigned int) -1)
   3223  1.1.1.5  christos 	{
   3224  1.1.1.5  christos 	  arg->failed = TRUE;
   3225      1.1     skrll 	  return;
   3226      1.1     skrll 	}
   3227      1.1     skrll     }
   3228      1.1     skrll 
   3229      1.1     skrll   /* Don't clear sh_flags. Assembler may set additional bits.  */
   3230      1.1     skrll 
   3231      1.1     skrll   if ((asect->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
   3232      1.1     skrll       || asect->user_set_vma)
   3233      1.1     skrll     this_hdr->sh_addr = asect->vma;
   3234      1.1     skrll   else
   3235      1.1     skrll     this_hdr->sh_addr = 0;
   3236      1.1     skrll 
   3237      1.1     skrll   this_hdr->sh_offset = 0;
   3238  1.1.1.5  christos   this_hdr->sh_size = asect->size;
   3239  1.1.1.5  christos   this_hdr->sh_link = 0;
   3240  1.1.1.5  christos   /* PR 17512: file: 0eb809fe, 8b0535ee.  */
   3241  1.1.1.7  christos   if (asect->alignment_power >= (sizeof (bfd_vma) * 8) - 1)
   3242  1.1.1.7  christos     {
   3243  1.1.1.8  christos       _bfd_error_handler
   3244  1.1.1.7  christos 	/* xgettext:c-format */
   3245  1.1.1.5  christos 	(_("%pB: error: alignment power %d of section `%pA' is too big"),
   3246  1.1.1.5  christos 	 abfd, asect->alignment_power, asect);
   3247  1.1.1.5  christos       arg->failed = TRUE;
   3248      1.1     skrll       return;
   3249      1.1     skrll     }
   3250      1.1     skrll   this_hdr->sh_addralign = (bfd_vma) 1 << asect->alignment_power;
   3251      1.1     skrll   /* The sh_entsize and sh_info fields may have been set already by
   3252      1.1     skrll      copy_private_section_data.  */
   3253      1.1     skrll 
   3254      1.1     skrll   this_hdr->bfd_section = asect;
   3255      1.1     skrll   this_hdr->contents = NULL;
   3256      1.1     skrll 
   3257      1.1     skrll   /* If the section type is unspecified, we set it based on
   3258      1.1     skrll      asect->flags.  */
   3259      1.1     skrll   if ((asect->flags & SEC_GROUP) != 0)
   3260  1.1.1.3  christos     sh_type = SHT_GROUP;
   3261      1.1     skrll   else
   3262      1.1     skrll     sh_type = bfd_elf_get_default_section_type (asect->flags);
   3263      1.1     skrll 
   3264      1.1     skrll   if (this_hdr->sh_type == SHT_NULL)
   3265      1.1     skrll     this_hdr->sh_type = sh_type;
   3266      1.1     skrll   else if (this_hdr->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS
   3267      1.1     skrll 	   && sh_type == SHT_PROGBITS
   3268      1.1     skrll 	   && (asect->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
   3269      1.1     skrll     {
   3270      1.1     skrll       /* Warn if we are changing a NOBITS section to PROGBITS, but
   3271      1.1     skrll 	 allow the link to proceed.  This can happen when users link
   3272  1.1.1.7  christos 	 non-bss input sections to bss output sections, or emit data
   3273  1.1.1.8  christos 	 to a bss output section via a linker script.  */
   3274      1.1     skrll       _bfd_error_handler
   3275      1.1     skrll 	(_("warning: section `%pA' type changed to PROGBITS"), asect);
   3276      1.1     skrll       this_hdr->sh_type = sh_type;
   3277      1.1     skrll     }
   3278      1.1     skrll 
   3279      1.1     skrll   switch (this_hdr->sh_type)
   3280      1.1     skrll     {
   3281      1.1     skrll     default:
   3282      1.1     skrll       break;
   3283      1.1     skrll 
   3284      1.1     skrll     case SHT_STRTAB:
   3285      1.1     skrll     case SHT_NOTE:
   3286      1.1     skrll     case SHT_NOBITS:
   3287      1.1     skrll     case SHT_PROGBITS:
   3288  1.1.1.6  christos       break;
   3289  1.1.1.6  christos 
   3290  1.1.1.6  christos     case SHT_INIT_ARRAY:
   3291  1.1.1.6  christos     case SHT_FINI_ARRAY:
   3292  1.1.1.6  christos     case SHT_PREINIT_ARRAY:
   3293  1.1.1.6  christos       this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->arch_size / 8;
   3294      1.1     skrll       break;
   3295      1.1     skrll 
   3296      1.1     skrll     case SHT_HASH:
   3297      1.1     skrll       this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_hash_entry;
   3298      1.1     skrll       break;
   3299      1.1     skrll 
   3300      1.1     skrll     case SHT_DYNSYM:
   3301      1.1     skrll       this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_sym;
   3302      1.1     skrll       break;
   3303      1.1     skrll 
   3304      1.1     skrll     case SHT_DYNAMIC:
   3305      1.1     skrll       this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_dyn;
   3306      1.1     skrll       break;
   3307      1.1     skrll 
   3308      1.1     skrll     case SHT_RELA:
   3309      1.1     skrll       if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->may_use_rela_p)
   3310      1.1     skrll 	this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_rela;
   3311      1.1     skrll       break;
   3312      1.1     skrll 
   3313      1.1     skrll      case SHT_REL:
   3314      1.1     skrll       if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->may_use_rel_p)
   3315      1.1     skrll 	this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_rel;
   3316      1.1     skrll       break;
   3317      1.1     skrll 
   3318      1.1     skrll      case SHT_GNU_versym:
   3319      1.1     skrll       this_hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf_External_Versym);
   3320      1.1     skrll       break;
   3321      1.1     skrll 
   3322      1.1     skrll      case SHT_GNU_verdef:
   3323      1.1     skrll       this_hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
   3324      1.1     skrll       /* objcopy or strip will copy over sh_info, but may not set
   3325      1.1     skrll 	 cverdefs.  The linker will set cverdefs, but sh_info will be
   3326      1.1     skrll 	 zero.  */
   3327      1.1     skrll       if (this_hdr->sh_info == 0)
   3328      1.1     skrll 	this_hdr->sh_info = elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs;
   3329      1.1     skrll       else
   3330      1.1     skrll 	BFD_ASSERT (elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs == 0
   3331      1.1     skrll 		    || this_hdr->sh_info == elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs);
   3332      1.1     skrll       break;
   3333      1.1     skrll 
   3334      1.1     skrll     case SHT_GNU_verneed:
   3335      1.1     skrll       this_hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
   3336      1.1     skrll       /* objcopy or strip will copy over sh_info, but may not set
   3337      1.1     skrll 	 cverrefs.  The linker will set cverrefs, but sh_info will be
   3338      1.1     skrll 	 zero.  */
   3339      1.1     skrll       if (this_hdr->sh_info == 0)
   3340      1.1     skrll 	this_hdr->sh_info = elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs;
   3341      1.1     skrll       else
   3342      1.1     skrll 	BFD_ASSERT (elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs == 0
   3343      1.1     skrll 		    || this_hdr->sh_info == elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs);
   3344      1.1     skrll       break;
   3345      1.1     skrll 
   3346      1.1     skrll     case SHT_GROUP:
   3347      1.1     skrll       this_hdr->sh_entsize = GRP_ENTRY_SIZE;
   3348      1.1     skrll       break;
   3349      1.1     skrll 
   3350      1.1     skrll     case SHT_GNU_HASH:
   3351      1.1     skrll       this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->arch_size == 64 ? 0 : 4;
   3352      1.1     skrll       break;
   3353      1.1     skrll     }
   3354      1.1     skrll 
   3355      1.1     skrll   if ((asect->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
   3356      1.1     skrll     this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_ALLOC;
   3357      1.1     skrll   if ((asect->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
   3358      1.1     skrll     this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_WRITE;
   3359      1.1     skrll   if ((asect->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
   3360      1.1     skrll     this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_EXECINSTR;
   3361      1.1     skrll   if ((asect->flags & SEC_MERGE) != 0)
   3362      1.1     skrll     {
   3363      1.1     skrll       this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MERGE;
   3364  1.1.1.6  christos       this_hdr->sh_entsize = asect->entsize;
   3365  1.1.1.6  christos     }
   3366      1.1     skrll   if ((asect->flags & SEC_STRINGS) != 0)
   3367      1.1     skrll     this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_STRINGS;
   3368      1.1     skrll   if ((asect->flags & SEC_GROUP) == 0 && elf_group_name (asect) != NULL)
   3369      1.1     skrll     this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_GROUP;
   3370      1.1     skrll   if ((asect->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) != 0)
   3371      1.1     skrll     {
   3372      1.1     skrll       this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_TLS;
   3373      1.1     skrll       if (asect->size == 0
   3374      1.1     skrll 	  && (asect->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) == 0)
   3375      1.1     skrll 	{
   3376      1.1     skrll 	  struct bfd_link_order *o = asect->map_tail.link_order;
   3377      1.1     skrll 
   3378      1.1     skrll 	  this_hdr->sh_size = 0;
   3379      1.1     skrll 	  if (o != NULL)
   3380      1.1     skrll 	    {
   3381      1.1     skrll 	      this_hdr->sh_size = o->offset + o->size;
   3382      1.1     skrll 	      if (this_hdr->sh_size != 0)
   3383      1.1     skrll 		this_hdr->sh_type = SHT_NOBITS;
   3384      1.1     skrll 	    }
   3385  1.1.1.3  christos 	}
   3386  1.1.1.3  christos     }
   3387  1.1.1.3  christos   if ((asect->flags & (SEC_GROUP | SEC_EXCLUDE)) == SEC_EXCLUDE)
   3388  1.1.1.3  christos     this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_EXCLUDE;
   3389  1.1.1.3  christos 
   3390  1.1.1.3  christos   /* If the section has relocs, set up a section header for the
   3391  1.1.1.3  christos      SHT_REL[A] section.  If two relocation sections are required for
   3392  1.1.1.3  christos      this section, it is up to the processor-specific back-end to
   3393  1.1.1.3  christos      create the other.  */
   3394  1.1.1.3  christos   if ((asect->flags & SEC_RELOC) != 0)
   3395  1.1.1.3  christos     {
   3396  1.1.1.3  christos       /* When doing a relocatable link, create both REL and RELA sections if
   3397  1.1.1.3  christos 	 needed.  */
   3398  1.1.1.3  christos       if (arg->link_info
   3399  1.1.1.5  christos 	  /* Do the normal setup if we wouldn't create any sections here.  */
   3400  1.1.1.5  christos 	  && esd->rel.count + esd->rela.count > 0
   3401  1.1.1.3  christos 	  && (bfd_link_relocatable (arg->link_info)
   3402  1.1.1.3  christos 	      || arg->link_info->emitrelocations))
   3403  1.1.1.7  christos 	{
   3404  1.1.1.7  christos 	  if (esd->rel.count && esd->rel.hdr == NULL
   3405  1.1.1.3  christos 	      && !_bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (abfd, &esd->rel, name,
   3406  1.1.1.3  christos 					    FALSE, delay_st_name_p))
   3407  1.1.1.3  christos 	    {
   3408  1.1.1.3  christos 	      arg->failed = TRUE;
   3409  1.1.1.3  christos 	      return;
   3410  1.1.1.7  christos 	    }
   3411  1.1.1.7  christos 	  if (esd->rela.count && esd->rela.hdr == NULL
   3412  1.1.1.3  christos 	      && !_bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (abfd, &esd->rela, name,
   3413  1.1.1.3  christos 					    TRUE, delay_st_name_p))
   3414  1.1.1.3  christos 	    {
   3415  1.1.1.3  christos 	      arg->failed = TRUE;
   3416  1.1.1.3  christos 	      return;
   3417  1.1.1.3  christos 	    }
   3418  1.1.1.3  christos 	}
   3419  1.1.1.3  christos       else if (!_bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (abfd,
   3420  1.1.1.5  christos 					  (asect->use_rela_p
   3421  1.1.1.5  christos 					   ? &esd->rela : &esd->rel),
   3422  1.1.1.5  christos 					  name,
   3423  1.1.1.7  christos 					  asect->use_rela_p,
   3424  1.1.1.3  christos 					  delay_st_name_p))
   3425  1.1.1.7  christos 	{
   3426  1.1.1.7  christos 	  arg->failed = TRUE;
   3427  1.1.1.3  christos 	  return;
   3428      1.1     skrll 	}
   3429      1.1     skrll     }
   3430      1.1     skrll 
   3431      1.1     skrll   /* Check for processor-specific section types.  */
   3432      1.1     skrll   sh_type = this_hdr->sh_type;
   3433  1.1.1.7  christos   if (bed->elf_backend_fake_sections
   3434  1.1.1.7  christos       && !(*bed->elf_backend_fake_sections) (abfd, this_hdr, asect))
   3435  1.1.1.7  christos     {
   3436  1.1.1.7  christos       arg->failed = TRUE;
   3437      1.1     skrll       return;
   3438      1.1     skrll     }
   3439      1.1     skrll 
   3440      1.1     skrll   if (sh_type == SHT_NOBITS && asect->size != 0)
   3441      1.1     skrll     {
   3442      1.1     skrll       /* Don't change the header type from NOBITS if we are being
   3443      1.1     skrll 	 called for objcopy --only-keep-debug.  */
   3444      1.1     skrll       this_hdr->sh_type = sh_type;
   3445      1.1     skrll     }
   3446  1.1.1.2     skrll }
   3447  1.1.1.2     skrll 
   3448  1.1.1.2     skrll /* Fill in the contents of a SHT_GROUP section.  Called from
   3449  1.1.1.2     skrll    _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions for gas, objcopy, and
   3450      1.1     skrll    when ELF targets use the generic linker, ld.  Called for ld -r
   3451      1.1     skrll    from bfd_elf_final_link.  */
   3452      1.1     skrll 
   3453      1.1     skrll void
   3454  1.1.1.3  christos bfd_elf_set_group_contents (bfd *abfd, asection *sec, void *failedptrarg)
   3455      1.1     skrll {
   3456      1.1     skrll   bfd_boolean *failedptr = (bfd_boolean *) failedptrarg;
   3457      1.1     skrll   asection *elt, *first;
   3458      1.1     skrll   unsigned char *loc;
   3459      1.1     skrll   bfd_boolean gas;
   3460      1.1     skrll 
   3461      1.1     skrll   /* Ignore linker created group section.  See elfNN_ia64_object_p in
   3462      1.1     skrll      elfxx-ia64.c.  */
   3463      1.1     skrll   if (((sec->flags & (SEC_GROUP | SEC_LINKER_CREATED)) != SEC_GROUP)
   3464      1.1     skrll       || *failedptr)
   3465  1.1.1.2     skrll     return;
   3466  1.1.1.2     skrll 
   3467  1.1.1.2     skrll   if (elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.sh_info == 0)
   3468  1.1.1.2     skrll     {
   3469  1.1.1.2     skrll       unsigned long symindx = 0;
   3470  1.1.1.2     skrll 
   3471  1.1.1.2     skrll       /* elf_group_id will have been set up by objcopy and the
   3472  1.1.1.2     skrll 	 generic linker.  */
   3473  1.1.1.2     skrll       if (elf_group_id (sec) != NULL)
   3474  1.1.1.2     skrll 	symindx = elf_group_id (sec)->udata.i;
   3475  1.1.1.2     skrll 
   3476  1.1.1.2     skrll       if (symindx == 0)
   3477  1.1.1.2     skrll 	{
   3478  1.1.1.2     skrll 	  /* If called from the assembler, swap_out_syms will have set up
   3479  1.1.1.2     skrll 	     elf_section_syms.  */
   3480  1.1.1.2     skrll 	  BFD_ASSERT (elf_section_syms (abfd) != NULL);
   3481  1.1.1.2     skrll 	  symindx = elf_section_syms (abfd)[sec->index]->udata.i;
   3482  1.1.1.2     skrll 	}
   3483  1.1.1.2     skrll       elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.sh_info = symindx;
   3484  1.1.1.2     skrll     }
   3485  1.1.1.2     skrll   else if (elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.sh_info == (unsigned int) -2)
   3486  1.1.1.2     skrll     {
   3487  1.1.1.2     skrll       /* The ELF backend linker sets sh_info to -2 when the group
   3488  1.1.1.7  christos 	 signature symbol is global, and thus the index can't be
   3489  1.1.1.7  christos 	 set until all local symbols are output.  */
   3490  1.1.1.7  christos       asection *igroup;
   3491  1.1.1.7  christos       struct bfd_elf_section_data *sec_data;
   3492  1.1.1.2     skrll       unsigned long symndx;
   3493  1.1.1.2     skrll       unsigned long extsymoff;
   3494  1.1.1.7  christos       struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
   3495  1.1.1.7  christos 
   3496  1.1.1.7  christos       /* The point of this little dance to the first SHF_GROUP section
   3497  1.1.1.7  christos 	 then back to the SHT_GROUP section is that this gets us to
   3498  1.1.1.7  christos 	 the SHT_GROUP in the input object.  */
   3499  1.1.1.7  christos       igroup = elf_sec_group (elf_next_in_group (sec));
   3500  1.1.1.7  christos       sec_data = elf_section_data (igroup);
   3501  1.1.1.2     skrll       symndx = sec_data->this_hdr.sh_info;
   3502  1.1.1.2     skrll       extsymoff = 0;
   3503  1.1.1.2     skrll       if (!elf_bad_symtab (igroup->owner))
   3504  1.1.1.2     skrll 	{
   3505  1.1.1.2     skrll 	  Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
   3506  1.1.1.2     skrll 
   3507  1.1.1.2     skrll 	  symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (igroup->owner)->symtab_hdr;
   3508  1.1.1.2     skrll 	  extsymoff = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
   3509  1.1.1.2     skrll 	}
   3510  1.1.1.2     skrll       h = elf_sym_hashes (igroup->owner)[symndx - extsymoff];
   3511  1.1.1.2     skrll       while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
   3512  1.1.1.2     skrll 	     || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
   3513  1.1.1.2     skrll 	h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
   3514      1.1     skrll 
   3515      1.1     skrll       elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.sh_info = h->indx;
   3516      1.1     skrll     }
   3517      1.1     skrll 
   3518      1.1     skrll   /* The contents won't be allocated for "ld -r" or objcopy.  */
   3519      1.1     skrll   gas = TRUE;
   3520      1.1     skrll   if (sec->contents == NULL)
   3521  1.1.1.3  christos     {
   3522      1.1     skrll       gas = FALSE;
   3523      1.1     skrll       sec->contents = (unsigned char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, sec->size);
   3524      1.1     skrll 
   3525      1.1     skrll       /* Arrange for the section to be written out.  */
   3526      1.1     skrll       elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents = sec->contents;
   3527      1.1     skrll       if (sec->contents == NULL)
   3528      1.1     skrll 	{
   3529      1.1     skrll 	  *failedptr = TRUE;
   3530      1.1     skrll 	  return;
   3531      1.1     skrll 	}
   3532      1.1     skrll     }
   3533      1.1     skrll 
   3534      1.1     skrll   loc = sec->contents + sec->size;
   3535      1.1     skrll 
   3536      1.1     skrll   /* Get the pointer to the first section in the group that gas
   3537      1.1     skrll      squirreled away here.  objcopy arranges for this to be set to the
   3538      1.1     skrll      start of the input section group.  */
   3539      1.1     skrll   first = elt = elf_next_in_group (sec);
   3540      1.1     skrll 
   3541      1.1     skrll   /* First element is a flag word.  Rest of section is elf section
   3542      1.1     skrll      indices for all the sections of the group.  Write them backwards
   3543      1.1     skrll      just to keep the group in the same order as given in .section
   3544      1.1     skrll      directives, not that it matters.  */
   3545      1.1     skrll   while (elt != NULL)
   3546      1.1     skrll     {
   3547      1.1     skrll       asection *s;
   3548      1.1     skrll 
   3549      1.1     skrll       s = elt;
   3550  1.1.1.3  christos       if (!gas)
   3551  1.1.1.3  christos 	s = s->output_section;
   3552  1.1.1.3  christos       if (s != NULL
   3553  1.1.1.7  christos 	  && !bfd_is_abs_section (s))
   3554  1.1.1.7  christos 	{
   3555  1.1.1.3  christos 	  struct bfd_elf_section_data *elf_sec = elf_section_data (s);
   3556  1.1.1.7  christos 	  struct bfd_elf_section_data *input_elf_sec = elf_section_data (elt);
   3557  1.1.1.7  christos 
   3558  1.1.1.7  christos 	  if (elf_sec->rel.hdr != NULL
   3559  1.1.1.7  christos 	      && (gas
   3560  1.1.1.7  christos 		  || (input_elf_sec->rel.hdr != NULL
   3561  1.1.1.7  christos 		      && input_elf_sec->rel.hdr->sh_flags & SHF_GROUP) != 0))
   3562  1.1.1.7  christos 	    {
   3563  1.1.1.7  christos 	      elf_sec->rel.hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_GROUP;
   3564  1.1.1.7  christos 	      loc -= 4;
   3565  1.1.1.7  christos 	      H_PUT_32 (abfd, elf_sec->rel.idx, loc);
   3566  1.1.1.7  christos 	    }
   3567  1.1.1.7  christos 	  if (elf_sec->rela.hdr != NULL
   3568  1.1.1.7  christos 	      && (gas
   3569  1.1.1.7  christos 		  || (input_elf_sec->rela.hdr != NULL
   3570  1.1.1.7  christos 		      && input_elf_sec->rela.hdr->sh_flags & SHF_GROUP) != 0))
   3571  1.1.1.7  christos 	    {
   3572  1.1.1.7  christos 	      elf_sec->rela.hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_GROUP;
   3573  1.1.1.7  christos 	      loc -= 4;
   3574  1.1.1.3  christos 	      H_PUT_32 (abfd, elf_sec->rela.idx, loc);
   3575  1.1.1.7  christos 	    }
   3576  1.1.1.3  christos 	  loc -= 4;
   3577      1.1     skrll 	  H_PUT_32 (abfd, elf_sec->this_idx, loc);
   3578      1.1     skrll 	}
   3579      1.1     skrll       elt = elf_next_in_group (elt);
   3580      1.1     skrll       if (elt == first)
   3581      1.1     skrll 	break;
   3582  1.1.1.7  christos     }
   3583  1.1.1.7  christos 
   3584      1.1     skrll   loc -= 4;
   3585      1.1     skrll   BFD_ASSERT (loc == sec->contents);
   3586      1.1     skrll 
   3587      1.1     skrll   H_PUT_32 (abfd, sec->flags & SEC_LINK_ONCE ? GRP_COMDAT : 0, loc);
   3588  1.1.1.7  christos }
   3589  1.1.1.7  christos 
   3590  1.1.1.7  christos /* Given NAME, the name of a relocation section stripped of its
   3591  1.1.1.5  christos    .rel/.rela prefix, return the section in ABFD to which the
   3592  1.1.1.5  christos    relocations apply.  */
   3593  1.1.1.7  christos 
   3594  1.1.1.7  christos asection *
   3595  1.1.1.7  christos _bfd_elf_plt_get_reloc_section (bfd *abfd, const char *name)
   3596  1.1.1.7  christos {
   3597  1.1.1.7  christos   /* If a target needs .got.plt section, relocations in rela.plt/rel.plt
   3598  1.1.1.7  christos      section likely apply to .got.plt or .got section.  */
   3599  1.1.1.7  christos   if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->want_got_plt
   3600  1.1.1.7  christos       && strcmp (name, ".plt") == 0)
   3601  1.1.1.7  christos     {
   3602  1.1.1.7  christos       asection *sec;
   3603  1.1.1.7  christos 
   3604  1.1.1.7  christos       name = ".got.plt";
   3605  1.1.1.7  christos       sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, name);
   3606  1.1.1.7  christos       if (sec != NULL)
   3607  1.1.1.7  christos 	return sec;
   3608  1.1.1.7  christos       name = ".got";
   3609  1.1.1.7  christos     }
   3610  1.1.1.7  christos 
   3611  1.1.1.7  christos   return bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, name);
   3612  1.1.1.7  christos }
   3613  1.1.1.7  christos 
   3614  1.1.1.7  christos /* Return the section to which RELOC_SEC applies.  */
   3615  1.1.1.7  christos 
   3616  1.1.1.5  christos static asection *
   3617  1.1.1.5  christos elf_get_reloc_section (asection *reloc_sec)
   3618  1.1.1.5  christos {
   3619  1.1.1.5  christos   const char *name;
   3620  1.1.1.7  christos   unsigned int type;
   3621  1.1.1.5  christos   bfd *abfd;
   3622  1.1.1.5  christos   const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
   3623  1.1.1.5  christos 
   3624  1.1.1.5  christos   type = elf_section_data (reloc_sec)->this_hdr.sh_type;
   3625  1.1.1.5  christos   if (type != SHT_REL && type != SHT_RELA)
   3626  1.1.1.5  christos     return NULL;
   3627  1.1.1.5  christos 
   3628  1.1.1.7  christos   /* We look up the section the relocs apply to by name.  */
   3629  1.1.1.7  christos   name = reloc_sec->name;
   3630  1.1.1.7  christos   if (strncmp (name, ".rel", 4) != 0)
   3631  1.1.1.7  christos     return NULL;
   3632  1.1.1.7  christos   name += 4;
   3633  1.1.1.5  christos   if (type == SHT_RELA && *name++ != 'a')
   3634  1.1.1.5  christos     return NULL;
   3635  1.1.1.7  christos 
   3636  1.1.1.7  christos   abfd = reloc_sec->owner;
   3637  1.1.1.5  christos   bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   3638  1.1.1.5  christos   return bed->get_reloc_section (abfd, name);
   3639      1.1     skrll }
   3640      1.1     skrll 
   3641      1.1     skrll /* Assign all ELF section numbers.  The dummy first section is handled here
   3642      1.1     skrll    too.  The link/info pointers for the standard section types are filled
   3643      1.1     skrll    in here too, while we're at it.  */
   3644      1.1     skrll 
   3645      1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   3646      1.1     skrll assign_section_numbers (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
   3647      1.1     skrll {
   3648  1.1.1.5  christos   struct elf_obj_tdata *t = elf_tdata (abfd);
   3649      1.1     skrll   asection *sec;
   3650      1.1     skrll   unsigned int section_number;
   3651  1.1.1.3  christos   Elf_Internal_Shdr **i_shdrp;
   3652      1.1     skrll   struct bfd_elf_section_data *d;
   3653      1.1     skrll   bfd_boolean need_symtab;
   3654      1.1     skrll 
   3655      1.1     skrll   section_number = 1;
   3656      1.1     skrll 
   3657      1.1     skrll   _bfd_elf_strtab_clear_all_refs (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
   3658  1.1.1.7  christos 
   3659      1.1     skrll   /* SHT_GROUP sections are in relocatable files only.  */
   3660  1.1.1.6  christos   if (link_info == NULL || !link_info->resolve_section_groups)
   3661  1.1.1.6  christos     {
   3662      1.1     skrll       size_t reloc_count = 0;
   3663      1.1     skrll 
   3664      1.1     skrll       /* Put SHT_GROUP sections first.  */
   3665      1.1     skrll       for (sec = abfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
   3666      1.1     skrll 	{
   3667      1.1     skrll 	  d = elf_section_data (sec);
   3668      1.1     skrll 
   3669      1.1     skrll 	  if (d->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_GROUP)
   3670      1.1     skrll 	    {
   3671      1.1     skrll 	      if (sec->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED)
   3672      1.1     skrll 		{
   3673      1.1     skrll 		  /* Remove the linker created SHT_GROUP sections.  */
   3674      1.1     skrll 		  bfd_section_list_remove (abfd, sec);
   3675      1.1     skrll 		  abfd->section_count--;
   3676      1.1     skrll 		}
   3677      1.1     skrll 	      else
   3678  1.1.1.6  christos 		d->this_idx = section_number++;
   3679  1.1.1.6  christos 	    }
   3680  1.1.1.6  christos 
   3681      1.1     skrll 	  /* Count relocations.  */
   3682  1.1.1.6  christos 	  reloc_count += sec->reloc_count;
   3683  1.1.1.6  christos 	}
   3684  1.1.1.6  christos 
   3685  1.1.1.6  christos       /* Clear HAS_RELOC if there are no relocations.  */
   3686      1.1     skrll       if (reloc_count == 0)
   3687      1.1     skrll 	abfd->flags &= ~HAS_RELOC;
   3688      1.1     skrll     }
   3689      1.1     skrll 
   3690      1.1     skrll   for (sec = abfd->sections; sec; sec = sec->next)
   3691      1.1     skrll     {
   3692      1.1     skrll       d = elf_section_data (sec);
   3693      1.1     skrll 
   3694  1.1.1.5  christos       if (d->this_hdr.sh_type != SHT_GROUP)
   3695  1.1.1.5  christos 	d->this_idx = section_number++;
   3696  1.1.1.3  christos       if (d->this_hdr.sh_name != (unsigned int) -1)
   3697      1.1     skrll 	_bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), d->this_hdr.sh_name);
   3698  1.1.1.3  christos       if (d->rel.hdr)
   3699  1.1.1.5  christos 	{
   3700  1.1.1.5  christos 	  d->rel.idx = section_number++;
   3701      1.1     skrll 	  if (d->rel.hdr->sh_name != (unsigned int) -1)
   3702  1.1.1.3  christos 	    _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), d->rel.hdr->sh_name);
   3703  1.1.1.3  christos 	}
   3704      1.1     skrll       else
   3705  1.1.1.3  christos 	d->rel.idx = 0;
   3706      1.1     skrll 
   3707  1.1.1.3  christos       if (d->rela.hdr)
   3708  1.1.1.5  christos 	{
   3709  1.1.1.5  christos 	  d->rela.idx = section_number++;
   3710      1.1     skrll 	  if (d->rela.hdr->sh_name != (unsigned int) -1)
   3711      1.1     skrll 	    _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), d->rela.hdr->sh_name);
   3712  1.1.1.3  christos 	}
   3713      1.1     skrll       else
   3714      1.1     skrll 	d->rela.idx = 0;
   3715  1.1.1.3  christos     }
   3716  1.1.1.3  christos 
   3717  1.1.1.3  christos   need_symtab = (bfd_get_symcount (abfd) > 0
   3718  1.1.1.3  christos 		|| (link_info == NULL
   3719  1.1.1.3  christos 		    && ((abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC | HAS_RELOC))
   3720      1.1     skrll 			== HAS_RELOC)));
   3721  1.1.1.5  christos   if (need_symtab)
   3722      1.1     skrll     {
   3723      1.1     skrll       elf_onesymtab (abfd) = section_number++;
   3724      1.1     skrll       _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), t->symtab_hdr.sh_name);
   3725  1.1.1.5  christos       if (section_number > ((SHN_LORESERVE - 2) & 0xFFFF))
   3726  1.1.1.5  christos 	{
   3727  1.1.1.5  christos 	  elf_section_list * entry;
   3728  1.1.1.5  christos 
   3729  1.1.1.5  christos 	  BFD_ASSERT (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) == NULL);
   3730  1.1.1.5  christos 
   3731  1.1.1.5  christos 	  entry = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof * entry);
   3732  1.1.1.5  christos 	  entry->ndx = section_number++;
   3733      1.1     skrll 	  elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) = entry;
   3734      1.1     skrll 	  entry->hdr.sh_name
   3735  1.1.1.5  christos 	    = (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (elf_shstrtab (abfd),
   3736      1.1     skrll 						  ".symtab_shndx", FALSE);
   3737      1.1     skrll 	  if (entry->hdr.sh_name == (unsigned int) -1)
   3738  1.1.1.5  christos 	    return FALSE;
   3739      1.1     skrll 	}
   3740      1.1     skrll       elf_strtab_sec (abfd) = section_number++;
   3741      1.1     skrll       _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), t->strtab_hdr.sh_name);
   3742  1.1.1.7  christos     }
   3743  1.1.1.7  christos 
   3744  1.1.1.7  christos   elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd) = section_number++;
   3745  1.1.1.7  christos   _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), t->shstrtab_hdr.sh_name);
   3746  1.1.1.4  christos   elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_shstrndx = elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd);
   3747  1.1.1.4  christos 
   3748  1.1.1.7  christos   if (section_number >= SHN_LORESERVE)
   3749  1.1.1.8  christos     {
   3750  1.1.1.4  christos       /* xgettext:c-format */
   3751  1.1.1.4  christos       _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: too many sections: %u"),
   3752  1.1.1.4  christos 			  abfd, section_number);
   3753  1.1.1.4  christos       return FALSE;
   3754      1.1     skrll     }
   3755      1.1     skrll 
   3756      1.1     skrll   elf_numsections (abfd) = section_number;
   3757      1.1     skrll   elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_shnum = section_number;
   3758      1.1     skrll 
   3759  1.1.1.3  christos   /* Set up the list of section header pointers, in agreement with the
   3760  1.1.1.7  christos      indices.  */
   3761      1.1     skrll   i_shdrp = (Elf_Internal_Shdr **) bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, section_number,
   3762      1.1     skrll 						sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr *));
   3763      1.1     skrll   if (i_shdrp == NULL)
   3764  1.1.1.3  christos     return FALSE;
   3765  1.1.1.7  christos 
   3766      1.1     skrll   i_shdrp[0] = (Elf_Internal_Shdr *) bfd_zalloc (abfd,
   3767      1.1     skrll 						 sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr));
   3768      1.1     skrll   if (i_shdrp[0] == NULL)
   3769      1.1     skrll     {
   3770      1.1     skrll       bfd_release (abfd, i_shdrp);
   3771      1.1     skrll       return FALSE;
   3772      1.1     skrll     }
   3773      1.1     skrll 
   3774  1.1.1.5  christos   elf_elfsections (abfd) = i_shdrp;
   3775  1.1.1.3  christos 
   3776      1.1     skrll   i_shdrp[elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd)] = &t->shstrtab_hdr;
   3777  1.1.1.5  christos   if (need_symtab)
   3778      1.1     skrll     {
   3779      1.1     skrll       i_shdrp[elf_onesymtab (abfd)] = &t->symtab_hdr;
   3780  1.1.1.5  christos       if (elf_numsections (abfd) > (SHN_LORESERVE & 0xFFFF))
   3781  1.1.1.5  christos 	{
   3782  1.1.1.5  christos 	  elf_section_list * entry = elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd);
   3783  1.1.1.5  christos 	  BFD_ASSERT (entry != NULL);
   3784      1.1     skrll 	  i_shdrp[entry->ndx] = & entry->hdr;
   3785  1.1.1.5  christos 	  entry->hdr.sh_link = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
   3786  1.1.1.5  christos 	}
   3787      1.1     skrll       i_shdrp[elf_strtab_sec (abfd)] = &t->strtab_hdr;
   3788      1.1     skrll       t->symtab_hdr.sh_link = elf_strtab_sec (abfd);
   3789      1.1     skrll     }
   3790      1.1     skrll 
   3791      1.1     skrll   for (sec = abfd->sections; sec; sec = sec->next)
   3792      1.1     skrll     {
   3793  1.1.1.3  christos       asection *s;
   3794  1.1.1.3  christos 
   3795      1.1     skrll       d = elf_section_data (sec);
   3796  1.1.1.3  christos 
   3797  1.1.1.3  christos       i_shdrp[d->this_idx] = &d->this_hdr;
   3798  1.1.1.3  christos       if (d->rel.idx != 0)
   3799  1.1.1.3  christos 	i_shdrp[d->rel.idx] = d->rel.hdr;
   3800      1.1     skrll       if (d->rela.idx != 0)
   3801      1.1     skrll 	i_shdrp[d->rela.idx] = d->rela.hdr;
   3802      1.1     skrll 
   3803      1.1     skrll       /* Fill in the sh_link and sh_info fields while we're at it.  */
   3804      1.1     skrll 
   3805      1.1     skrll       /* sh_link of a reloc section is the section index of the symbol
   3806  1.1.1.3  christos 	 table.  sh_info is the section index of the section to which
   3807      1.1     skrll 	 the relocation entries apply.  */
   3808  1.1.1.5  christos       if (d->rel.idx != 0)
   3809  1.1.1.3  christos 	{
   3810  1.1.1.5  christos 	  d->rel.hdr->sh_link = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
   3811      1.1     skrll 	  d->rel.hdr->sh_info = d->this_idx;
   3812  1.1.1.3  christos 	  d->rel.hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_INFO_LINK;
   3813      1.1     skrll 	}
   3814  1.1.1.5  christos       if (d->rela.idx != 0)
   3815  1.1.1.3  christos 	{
   3816  1.1.1.5  christos 	  d->rela.hdr->sh_link = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
   3817      1.1     skrll 	  d->rela.hdr->sh_info = d->this_idx;
   3818      1.1     skrll 	  d->rela.hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_INFO_LINK;
   3819      1.1     skrll 	}
   3820      1.1     skrll 
   3821      1.1     skrll       /* We need to set up sh_link for SHF_LINK_ORDER.  */
   3822      1.1     skrll       if ((d->this_hdr.sh_flags & SHF_LINK_ORDER) != 0)
   3823      1.1     skrll 	{
   3824      1.1     skrll 	  s = elf_linked_to_section (sec);
   3825      1.1     skrll 	  if (s)
   3826      1.1     skrll 	    {
   3827      1.1     skrll 	      /* elf_linked_to_section points to the input section.  */
   3828      1.1     skrll 	      if (link_info != NULL)
   3829  1.1.1.4  christos 		{
   3830      1.1     skrll 		  /* Check discarded linkonce section.  */
   3831      1.1     skrll 		  if (discarded_section (s))
   3832  1.1.1.7  christos 		    {
   3833  1.1.1.7  christos 		      asection *kept;
   3834  1.1.1.8  christos 		      _bfd_error_handler
   3835  1.1.1.8  christos 			/* xgettext:c-format */
   3836      1.1     skrll 			(_("%pB: sh_link of section `%pA' points to"
   3837      1.1     skrll 			   " discarded section `%pA' of `%pB'"),
   3838      1.1     skrll 			 abfd, d->this_hdr.bfd_section,
   3839      1.1     skrll 			 s, s->owner);
   3840      1.1     skrll 		      /* Point to the kept section if it has the same
   3841      1.1     skrll 			 size as the discarded one.  */
   3842      1.1     skrll 		      kept = _bfd_elf_check_kept_section (s, link_info);
   3843      1.1     skrll 		      if (kept == NULL)
   3844      1.1     skrll 			{
   3845      1.1     skrll 			  bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
   3846      1.1     skrll 			  return FALSE;
   3847      1.1     skrll 			}
   3848      1.1     skrll 		      s = kept;
   3849      1.1     skrll 		    }
   3850      1.1     skrll 
   3851      1.1     skrll 		  s = s->output_section;
   3852      1.1     skrll 		  BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
   3853      1.1     skrll 		}
   3854      1.1     skrll 	      else
   3855      1.1     skrll 		{
   3856      1.1     skrll 		  /* Handle objcopy. */
   3857  1.1.1.7  christos 		  if (s->output_section == NULL)
   3858  1.1.1.7  christos 		    {
   3859  1.1.1.8  christos 		      _bfd_error_handler
   3860  1.1.1.8  christos 			/* xgettext:c-format */
   3861      1.1     skrll 			(_("%pB: sh_link of section `%pA' points to"
   3862      1.1     skrll 			   " removed section `%pA' of `%pB'"),
   3863      1.1     skrll 			 abfd, d->this_hdr.bfd_section, s, s->owner);
   3864      1.1     skrll 		      bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
   3865      1.1     skrll 		      return FALSE;
   3866      1.1     skrll 		    }
   3867      1.1     skrll 		  s = s->output_section;
   3868      1.1     skrll 		}
   3869      1.1     skrll 	      d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
   3870      1.1     skrll 	    }
   3871      1.1     skrll 	  else
   3872      1.1     skrll 	    {
   3873      1.1     skrll 	      /* PR 290:
   3874      1.1     skrll 		 The Intel C compiler generates SHT_IA_64_UNWIND with
   3875      1.1     skrll 		 SHF_LINK_ORDER.  But it doesn't set the sh_link or
   3876      1.1     skrll 		 sh_info fields.  Hence we could get the situation
   3877      1.1     skrll 		 where s is NULL.  */
   3878      1.1     skrll 	      const struct elf_backend_data *bed
   3879      1.1     skrll 		= get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   3880  1.1.1.7  christos 	      if (bed->link_order_error_handler)
   3881  1.1.1.8  christos 		bed->link_order_error_handler
   3882      1.1     skrll 		  /* xgettext:c-format */
   3883      1.1     skrll 		  (_("%pB: warning: sh_link not set for section `%pA'"),
   3884      1.1     skrll 		   abfd, sec);
   3885      1.1     skrll 	    }
   3886      1.1     skrll 	}
   3887      1.1     skrll 
   3888      1.1     skrll       switch (d->this_hdr.sh_type)
   3889      1.1     skrll 	{
   3890      1.1     skrll 	case SHT_REL:
   3891      1.1     skrll 	case SHT_RELA:
   3892      1.1     skrll 	  /* A reloc section which we are treating as a normal BFD
   3893      1.1     skrll 	     section.  sh_link is the section index of the symbol
   3894      1.1     skrll 	     table.  sh_info is the section index of the section to
   3895      1.1     skrll 	     which the relocation entries apply.  We assume that an
   3896      1.1     skrll 	     allocated reloc section uses the dynamic symbol table.
   3897      1.1     skrll 	     FIXME: How can we be sure?  */
   3898      1.1     skrll 	  s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynsym");
   3899      1.1     skrll 	  if (s != NULL)
   3900  1.1.1.7  christos 	    d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
   3901      1.1     skrll 
   3902  1.1.1.5  christos 	  s = elf_get_reloc_section (sec);
   3903  1.1.1.5  christos 	  if (s != NULL)
   3904  1.1.1.5  christos 	    {
   3905  1.1.1.5  christos 	      d->this_hdr.sh_info = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
   3906      1.1     skrll 	      d->this_hdr.sh_flags |= SHF_INFO_LINK;
   3907      1.1     skrll 	    }
   3908      1.1     skrll 	  break;
   3909      1.1     skrll 
   3910      1.1     skrll 	case SHT_STRTAB:
   3911      1.1     skrll 	  /* We assume that a section named .stab*str is a stabs
   3912      1.1     skrll 	     string section.  We look for a section with the same name
   3913      1.1     skrll 	     but without the trailing ``str'', and set its sh_link
   3914      1.1     skrll 	     field to point to this section.  */
   3915      1.1     skrll 	  if (CONST_STRNEQ (sec->name, ".stab")
   3916      1.1     skrll 	      && strcmp (sec->name + strlen (sec->name) - 3, "str") == 0)
   3917      1.1     skrll 	    {
   3918      1.1     skrll 	      size_t len;
   3919      1.1     skrll 	      char *alc;
   3920  1.1.1.3  christos 
   3921      1.1     skrll 	      len = strlen (sec->name);
   3922      1.1     skrll 	      alc = (char *) bfd_malloc (len - 2);
   3923      1.1     skrll 	      if (alc == NULL)
   3924      1.1     skrll 		return FALSE;
   3925      1.1     skrll 	      memcpy (alc, sec->name, len - 3);
   3926      1.1     skrll 	      alc[len - 3] = '\0';
   3927      1.1     skrll 	      s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, alc);
   3928      1.1     skrll 	      free (alc);
   3929      1.1     skrll 	      if (s != NULL)
   3930      1.1     skrll 		{
   3931      1.1     skrll 		  elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_link = d->this_idx;
   3932      1.1     skrll 
   3933      1.1     skrll 		  /* This is a .stab section.  */
   3934      1.1     skrll 		  if (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_entsize == 0)
   3935      1.1     skrll 		    elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_entsize
   3936      1.1     skrll 		      = 4 + 2 * bfd_get_arch_size (abfd) / 8;
   3937      1.1     skrll 		}
   3938      1.1     skrll 	    }
   3939      1.1     skrll 	  break;
   3940      1.1     skrll 
   3941      1.1     skrll 	case SHT_DYNAMIC:
   3942      1.1     skrll 	case SHT_DYNSYM:
   3943      1.1     skrll 	case SHT_GNU_verneed:
   3944      1.1     skrll 	case SHT_GNU_verdef:
   3945      1.1     skrll 	  /* sh_link is the section header index of the string table
   3946      1.1     skrll 	     used for the dynamic entries, or the symbol table, or the
   3947      1.1     skrll 	     version strings.  */
   3948      1.1     skrll 	  s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynstr");
   3949      1.1     skrll 	  if (s != NULL)
   3950      1.1     skrll 	    d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
   3951      1.1     skrll 	  break;
   3952      1.1     skrll 
   3953      1.1     skrll 	case SHT_GNU_LIBLIST:
   3954      1.1     skrll 	  /* sh_link is the section header index of the prelink library
   3955      1.1     skrll 	     list used for the dynamic entries, or the symbol table, or
   3956      1.1     skrll 	     the version strings.  */
   3957      1.1     skrll 	  s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, (sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC)
   3958      1.1     skrll 					     ? ".dynstr" : ".gnu.libstr");
   3959      1.1     skrll 	  if (s != NULL)
   3960      1.1     skrll 	    d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
   3961      1.1     skrll 	  break;
   3962      1.1     skrll 
   3963      1.1     skrll 	case SHT_HASH:
   3964      1.1     skrll 	case SHT_GNU_HASH:
   3965      1.1     skrll 	case SHT_GNU_versym:
   3966      1.1     skrll 	  /* sh_link is the section header index of the symbol table
   3967      1.1     skrll 	     this hash table or version table is for.  */
   3968      1.1     skrll 	  s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynsym");
   3969      1.1     skrll 	  if (s != NULL)
   3970      1.1     skrll 	    d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
   3971      1.1     skrll 	  break;
   3972  1.1.1.5  christos 
   3973      1.1     skrll 	case SHT_GROUP:
   3974      1.1     skrll 	  d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
   3975      1.1     skrll 	}
   3976  1.1.1.5  christos     }
   3977  1.1.1.5  christos 
   3978  1.1.1.5  christos   /* Delay setting sh_name to _bfd_elf_write_object_contents so that
   3979  1.1.1.5  christos      _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load can convert DWARF
   3980      1.1     skrll      debug section name from .debug_* to .zdebug_* if needed.  */
   3981      1.1     skrll 
   3982      1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   3983      1.1     skrll }
   3984      1.1     skrll 
   3985      1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   3986      1.1     skrll sym_is_global (bfd *abfd, asymbol *sym)
   3987      1.1     skrll {
   3988      1.1     skrll   /* If the backend has a special mapping, use it.  */
   3989      1.1     skrll   const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   3990      1.1     skrll   if (bed->elf_backend_sym_is_global)
   3991  1.1.1.3  christos     return (*bed->elf_backend_sym_is_global) (abfd, sym);
   3992      1.1     skrll 
   3993      1.1     skrll   return ((sym->flags & (BSF_GLOBAL | BSF_WEAK | BSF_GNU_UNIQUE)) != 0
   3994      1.1     skrll 	  || bfd_is_und_section (bfd_get_section (sym))
   3995      1.1     skrll 	  || bfd_is_com_section (bfd_get_section (sym)));
   3996  1.1.1.7  christos }
   3997  1.1.1.7  christos 
   3998  1.1.1.7  christos /* Filter global symbols of ABFD to include in the import library.  All
   3999  1.1.1.7  christos    SYMCOUNT symbols of ABFD can be examined from their pointers in
   4000  1.1.1.7  christos    SYMS.  Pointers of symbols to keep should be stored contiguously at
   4001  1.1.1.7  christos    the beginning of that array.
   4002  1.1.1.7  christos 
   4003  1.1.1.7  christos    Returns the number of symbols to keep.  */
   4004  1.1.1.7  christos 
   4005  1.1.1.7  christos unsigned int
   4006  1.1.1.7  christos _bfd_elf_filter_global_symbols (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
   4007  1.1.1.7  christos 				asymbol **syms, long symcount)
   4008  1.1.1.7  christos {
   4009  1.1.1.7  christos   long src_count, dst_count = 0;
   4010  1.1.1.7  christos 
   4011  1.1.1.7  christos   for (src_count = 0; src_count < symcount; src_count++)
   4012  1.1.1.7  christos     {
   4013  1.1.1.7  christos       asymbol *sym = syms[src_count];
   4014  1.1.1.7  christos       char *name = (char *) bfd_asymbol_name (sym);
   4015  1.1.1.7  christos       struct bfd_link_hash_entry *h;
   4016  1.1.1.7  christos 
   4017  1.1.1.7  christos       if (!sym_is_global (abfd, sym))
   4018  1.1.1.7  christos 	continue;
   4019  1.1.1.7  christos 
   4020  1.1.1.7  christos       h = bfd_link_hash_lookup (info->hash, name, FALSE, FALSE, FALSE);
   4021  1.1.1.7  christos       if (h == NULL)
   4022  1.1.1.7  christos 	continue;
   4023  1.1.1.7  christos       if (h->type != bfd_link_hash_defined && h->type != bfd_link_hash_defweak)
   4024  1.1.1.7  christos 	continue;
   4025  1.1.1.7  christos       if (h->linker_def || h->ldscript_def)
   4026  1.1.1.7  christos 	continue;
   4027  1.1.1.7  christos 
   4028  1.1.1.7  christos       syms[dst_count++] = sym;
   4029  1.1.1.7  christos     }
   4030  1.1.1.7  christos 
   4031  1.1.1.7  christos   syms[dst_count] = NULL;
   4032  1.1.1.7  christos 
   4033  1.1.1.7  christos   return dst_count;
   4034      1.1     skrll }
   4035  1.1.1.4  christos 
   4036      1.1     skrll /* Don't output section symbols for sections that are not going to be
   4037      1.1     skrll    output, that are duplicates or there is no BFD section.  */
   4038      1.1     skrll 
   4039      1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   4040  1.1.1.4  christos ignore_section_sym (bfd *abfd, asymbol *sym)
   4041  1.1.1.4  christos {
   4042  1.1.1.8  christos   elf_symbol_type *type_ptr;
   4043  1.1.1.8  christos 
   4044  1.1.1.8  christos   if (sym == NULL)
   4045  1.1.1.4  christos     return FALSE;
   4046  1.1.1.4  christos 
   4047  1.1.1.4  christos   if ((sym->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) == 0)
   4048  1.1.1.8  christos     return FALSE;
   4049  1.1.1.8  christos 
   4050  1.1.1.8  christos   if (sym->section == NULL)
   4051  1.1.1.4  christos     return TRUE;
   4052  1.1.1.4  christos 
   4053  1.1.1.4  christos   type_ptr = elf_symbol_from (abfd, sym);
   4054  1.1.1.4  christos   return ((type_ptr != NULL
   4055  1.1.1.4  christos 	   && type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx != 0
   4056  1.1.1.8  christos 	   && bfd_is_abs_section (sym->section))
   4057  1.1.1.8  christos 	  || !(sym->section->owner == abfd
   4058  1.1.1.4  christos 	       || (sym->section->output_section != NULL
   4059  1.1.1.4  christos 		   && sym->section->output_section->owner == abfd
   4060      1.1     skrll 		   && sym->section->output_offset == 0)
   4061      1.1     skrll 	       || bfd_is_abs_section (sym->section)));
   4062  1.1.1.4  christos }
   4063  1.1.1.4  christos 
   4064  1.1.1.4  christos /* Map symbol from it's internal number to the external number, moving
   4065      1.1     skrll    all local symbols to be at the head of the list.  */
   4066  1.1.1.5  christos 
   4067      1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   4068      1.1     skrll elf_map_symbols (bfd *abfd, unsigned int *pnum_locals)
   4069      1.1     skrll {
   4070      1.1     skrll   unsigned int symcount = bfd_get_symcount (abfd);
   4071      1.1     skrll   asymbol **syms = bfd_get_outsymbols (abfd);
   4072      1.1     skrll   asymbol **sect_syms;
   4073      1.1     skrll   unsigned int num_locals = 0;
   4074      1.1     skrll   unsigned int num_globals = 0;
   4075  1.1.1.5  christos   unsigned int num_locals2 = 0;
   4076      1.1     skrll   unsigned int num_globals2 = 0;
   4077      1.1     skrll   unsigned int max_index = 0;
   4078      1.1     skrll   unsigned int idx;
   4079      1.1     skrll   asection *asect;
   4080      1.1     skrll   asymbol **new_syms;
   4081      1.1     skrll 
   4082      1.1     skrll #ifdef DEBUG
   4083      1.1     skrll   fprintf (stderr, "elf_map_symbols\n");
   4084      1.1     skrll   fflush (stderr);
   4085      1.1     skrll #endif
   4086      1.1     skrll 
   4087      1.1     skrll   for (asect = abfd->sections; asect; asect = asect->next)
   4088      1.1     skrll     {
   4089      1.1     skrll       if (max_index < asect->index)
   4090      1.1     skrll 	max_index = asect->index;
   4091      1.1     skrll     }
   4092  1.1.1.3  christos 
   4093      1.1     skrll   max_index++;
   4094      1.1     skrll   sect_syms = (asymbol **) bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, max_index, sizeof (asymbol *));
   4095      1.1     skrll   if (sect_syms == NULL)
   4096      1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   4097      1.1     skrll   elf_section_syms (abfd) = sect_syms;
   4098      1.1     skrll   elf_num_section_syms (abfd) = max_index;
   4099      1.1     skrll 
   4100      1.1     skrll   /* Init sect_syms entries for any section symbols we have already
   4101      1.1     skrll      decided to output.  */
   4102      1.1     skrll   for (idx = 0; idx < symcount; idx++)
   4103      1.1     skrll     {
   4104      1.1     skrll       asymbol *sym = syms[idx];
   4105      1.1     skrll 
   4106  1.1.1.4  christos       if ((sym->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) != 0
   4107  1.1.1.4  christos 	  && sym->value == 0
   4108      1.1     skrll 	  && !ignore_section_sym (abfd, sym)
   4109      1.1     skrll 	  && !bfd_is_abs_section (sym->section))
   4110      1.1     skrll 	{
   4111      1.1     skrll 	  asection *sec = sym->section;
   4112      1.1     skrll 
   4113      1.1     skrll 	  if (sec->owner != abfd)
   4114      1.1     skrll 	    sec = sec->output_section;
   4115      1.1     skrll 
   4116      1.1     skrll 	  sect_syms[sec->index] = syms[idx];
   4117      1.1     skrll 	}
   4118      1.1     skrll     }
   4119      1.1     skrll 
   4120      1.1     skrll   /* Classify all of the symbols.  */
   4121  1.1.1.4  christos   for (idx = 0; idx < symcount; idx++)
   4122      1.1     skrll     {
   4123  1.1.1.4  christos       if (sym_is_global (abfd, syms[idx]))
   4124  1.1.1.4  christos 	num_globals++;
   4125      1.1     skrll       else if (!ignore_section_sym (abfd, syms[idx]))
   4126      1.1     skrll 	num_locals++;
   4127      1.1     skrll     }
   4128      1.1     skrll 
   4129      1.1     skrll   /* We will be adding a section symbol for each normal BFD section.  Most
   4130      1.1     skrll      sections will already have a section symbol in outsymbols, but
   4131      1.1     skrll      eg. SHT_GROUP sections will not, and we need the section symbol mapped
   4132      1.1     skrll      at least in that case.  */
   4133      1.1     skrll   for (asect = abfd->sections; asect; asect = asect->next)
   4134      1.1     skrll     {
   4135      1.1     skrll       if (sect_syms[asect->index] == NULL)
   4136      1.1     skrll 	{
   4137      1.1     skrll 	  if (!sym_is_global (abfd, asect->symbol))
   4138      1.1     skrll 	    num_locals++;
   4139      1.1     skrll 	  else
   4140      1.1     skrll 	    num_globals++;
   4141      1.1     skrll 	}
   4142      1.1     skrll     }
   4143  1.1.1.3  christos 
   4144  1.1.1.7  christos   /* Now sort the symbols so the local symbols are first.  */
   4145      1.1     skrll   new_syms = (asymbol **) bfd_alloc2 (abfd, num_locals + num_globals,
   4146      1.1     skrll 				      sizeof (asymbol *));
   4147      1.1     skrll 
   4148      1.1     skrll   if (new_syms == NULL)
   4149      1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   4150      1.1     skrll 
   4151      1.1     skrll   for (idx = 0; idx < symcount; idx++)
   4152      1.1     skrll     {
   4153      1.1     skrll       asymbol *sym = syms[idx];
   4154  1.1.1.4  christos       unsigned int i;
   4155  1.1.1.4  christos 
   4156  1.1.1.4  christos       if (sym_is_global (abfd, sym))
   4157      1.1     skrll 	i = num_locals + num_globals2++;
   4158      1.1     skrll       else if (!ignore_section_sym (abfd, sym))
   4159  1.1.1.4  christos 	i = num_locals2++;
   4160      1.1     skrll       else
   4161      1.1     skrll 	continue;
   4162      1.1     skrll       new_syms[i] = sym;
   4163      1.1     skrll       sym->udata.i = i + 1;
   4164      1.1     skrll     }
   4165      1.1     skrll   for (asect = abfd->sections; asect; asect = asect->next)
   4166      1.1     skrll     {
   4167      1.1     skrll       if (sect_syms[asect->index] == NULL)
   4168      1.1     skrll 	{
   4169      1.1     skrll 	  asymbol *sym = asect->symbol;
   4170      1.1     skrll 	  unsigned int i;
   4171      1.1     skrll 
   4172      1.1     skrll 	  sect_syms[asect->index] = sym;
   4173      1.1     skrll 	  if (!sym_is_global (abfd, sym))
   4174      1.1     skrll 	    i = num_locals2++;
   4175      1.1     skrll 	  else
   4176      1.1     skrll 	    i = num_locals + num_globals2++;
   4177      1.1     skrll 	  new_syms[i] = sym;
   4178      1.1     skrll 	  sym->udata.i = i + 1;
   4179      1.1     skrll 	}
   4180      1.1     skrll     }
   4181      1.1     skrll 
   4182  1.1.1.5  christos   bfd_set_symtab (abfd, new_syms, num_locals + num_globals);
   4183      1.1     skrll 
   4184      1.1     skrll   *pnum_locals = num_locals;
   4185      1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   4186      1.1     skrll }
   4187      1.1     skrll 
   4188      1.1     skrll /* Align to the maximum file alignment that could be required for any
   4189      1.1     skrll    ELF data structure.  */
   4190      1.1     skrll 
   4191      1.1     skrll static inline file_ptr
   4192      1.1     skrll align_file_position (file_ptr off, int align)
   4193      1.1     skrll {
   4194      1.1     skrll   return (off + align - 1) & ~(align - 1);
   4195      1.1     skrll }
   4196      1.1     skrll 
   4197      1.1     skrll /* Assign a file position to a section, optionally aligning to the
   4198      1.1     skrll    required section alignment.  */
   4199      1.1     skrll 
   4200      1.1     skrll file_ptr
   4201      1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (Elf_Internal_Shdr *i_shdrp,
   4202      1.1     skrll 					   file_ptr offset,
   4203      1.1     skrll 					   bfd_boolean align)
   4204      1.1     skrll {
   4205      1.1     skrll   if (align && i_shdrp->sh_addralign > 1)
   4206      1.1     skrll     offset = BFD_ALIGN (offset, i_shdrp->sh_addralign);
   4207      1.1     skrll   i_shdrp->sh_offset = offset;
   4208      1.1     skrll   if (i_shdrp->bfd_section != NULL)
   4209      1.1     skrll     i_shdrp->bfd_section->filepos = offset;
   4210      1.1     skrll   if (i_shdrp->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
   4211      1.1     skrll     offset += i_shdrp->sh_size;
   4212      1.1     skrll   return offset;
   4213      1.1     skrll }
   4214      1.1     skrll 
   4215      1.1     skrll /* Compute the file positions we are going to put the sections at, and
   4216      1.1     skrll    otherwise prepare to begin writing out the ELF file.  If LINK_INFO
   4217      1.1     skrll    is not NULL, this is being called by the ELF backend linker.  */
   4218      1.1     skrll 
   4219      1.1     skrll bfd_boolean
   4220      1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions (bfd *abfd,
   4221      1.1     skrll 					 struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
   4222  1.1.1.3  christos {
   4223      1.1     skrll   const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   4224  1.1.1.5  christos   struct fake_section_arg fsargs;
   4225      1.1     skrll   bfd_boolean failed;
   4226  1.1.1.3  christos   struct elf_strtab_hash *strtab = NULL;
   4227      1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Shdr *shstrtab_hdr;
   4228      1.1     skrll   bfd_boolean need_symtab;
   4229      1.1     skrll 
   4230      1.1     skrll   if (abfd->output_has_begun)
   4231      1.1     skrll     return TRUE;
   4232      1.1     skrll 
   4233      1.1     skrll   /* Do any elf backend specific processing first.  */
   4234      1.1     skrll   if (bed->elf_backend_begin_write_processing)
   4235      1.1     skrll     (*bed->elf_backend_begin_write_processing) (abfd, link_info);
   4236      1.1     skrll 
   4237      1.1     skrll   if (! prep_headers (abfd))
   4238      1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   4239  1.1.1.5  christos 
   4240      1.1     skrll   /* Post process the headers if necessary.  */
   4241  1.1.1.3  christos   (*bed->elf_backend_post_process_headers) (abfd, link_info);
   4242  1.1.1.3  christos 
   4243  1.1.1.3  christos   fsargs.failed = FALSE;
   4244  1.1.1.3  christos   fsargs.link_info = link_info;
   4245      1.1     skrll   bfd_map_over_sections (abfd, elf_fake_sections, &fsargs);
   4246      1.1     skrll   if (fsargs.failed)
   4247      1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   4248      1.1     skrll 
   4249      1.1     skrll   if (!assign_section_numbers (abfd, link_info))
   4250      1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   4251  1.1.1.3  christos 
   4252  1.1.1.3  christos   /* The backend linker builds symbol table information itself.  */
   4253  1.1.1.3  christos   need_symtab = (link_info == NULL
   4254  1.1.1.3  christos 		 && (bfd_get_symcount (abfd) > 0
   4255  1.1.1.3  christos 		     || ((abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC | HAS_RELOC))
   4256      1.1     skrll 			 == HAS_RELOC)));
   4257      1.1     skrll   if (need_symtab)
   4258      1.1     skrll     {
   4259      1.1     skrll       /* Non-zero if doing a relocatable link.  */
   4260      1.1     skrll       int relocatable_p = ! (abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC));
   4261      1.1     skrll 
   4262      1.1     skrll       if (! swap_out_syms (abfd, &strtab, relocatable_p))
   4263      1.1     skrll 	return FALSE;
   4264  1.1.1.3  christos     }
   4265      1.1     skrll 
   4266      1.1     skrll   failed = FALSE;
   4267      1.1     skrll   if (link_info == NULL)
   4268      1.1     skrll     {
   4269      1.1     skrll       bfd_map_over_sections (abfd, bfd_elf_set_group_contents, &failed);
   4270      1.1     skrll       if (failed)
   4271      1.1     skrll 	return FALSE;
   4272      1.1     skrll     }
   4273      1.1     skrll 
   4274      1.1     skrll   shstrtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr;
   4275  1.1.1.6  christos   /* sh_name was set in prep_headers.  */
   4276      1.1     skrll   shstrtab_hdr->sh_type = SHT_STRTAB;
   4277  1.1.1.5  christos   shstrtab_hdr->sh_flags = bed->elf_strtab_flags;
   4278      1.1     skrll   shstrtab_hdr->sh_addr = 0;
   4279      1.1     skrll   /* sh_size is set in _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load.  */
   4280      1.1     skrll   shstrtab_hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
   4281  1.1.1.5  christos   shstrtab_hdr->sh_link = 0;
   4282      1.1     skrll   shstrtab_hdr->sh_info = 0;
   4283      1.1     skrll   /* sh_offset is set in _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load.  */
   4284      1.1     skrll   shstrtab_hdr->sh_addralign = 1;
   4285      1.1     skrll 
   4286      1.1     skrll   if (!assign_file_positions_except_relocs (abfd, link_info))
   4287  1.1.1.3  christos     return FALSE;
   4288      1.1     skrll 
   4289      1.1     skrll   if (need_symtab)
   4290      1.1     skrll     {
   4291      1.1     skrll       file_ptr off;
   4292  1.1.1.5  christos       Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
   4293      1.1     skrll 
   4294  1.1.1.5  christos       off = elf_next_file_pos (abfd);
   4295      1.1     skrll 
   4296      1.1     skrll       hdr = & elf_symtab_hdr (abfd);
   4297  1.1.1.5  christos       off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
   4298  1.1.1.5  christos 
   4299  1.1.1.5  christos       if (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) != NULL)
   4300  1.1.1.5  christos 	{
   4301  1.1.1.5  christos 	  hdr = & elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd)->hdr;
   4302  1.1.1.5  christos 	  if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
   4303  1.1.1.5  christos 	    off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
   4304      1.1     skrll 	  /* FIXME: What about other symtab_shndx sections in the list ?  */
   4305      1.1     skrll 	}
   4306      1.1     skrll 
   4307      1.1     skrll       hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr;
   4308  1.1.1.5  christos       off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
   4309      1.1     skrll 
   4310      1.1     skrll       elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = off;
   4311      1.1     skrll 
   4312      1.1     skrll       /* Now that we know where the .strtab section goes, write it
   4313  1.1.1.5  christos 	 out.  */
   4314      1.1     skrll       if (bfd_seek (abfd, hdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
   4315  1.1.1.5  christos 	  || ! _bfd_elf_strtab_emit (abfd, strtab))
   4316      1.1     skrll 	return FALSE;
   4317      1.1     skrll       _bfd_elf_strtab_free (strtab);
   4318      1.1     skrll     }
   4319      1.1     skrll 
   4320      1.1     skrll   abfd->output_has_begun = TRUE;
   4321      1.1     skrll 
   4322      1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   4323      1.1     skrll }
   4324      1.1     skrll 
   4325      1.1     skrll /* Make an initial estimate of the size of the program header.  If we
   4326      1.1     skrll    get the number wrong here, we'll redo section placement.  */
   4327      1.1     skrll 
   4328      1.1     skrll static bfd_size_type
   4329      1.1     skrll get_program_header_size (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
   4330      1.1     skrll {
   4331      1.1     skrll   size_t segs;
   4332      1.1     skrll   asection *s;
   4333      1.1     skrll   const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
   4334      1.1     skrll 
   4335      1.1     skrll   /* Assume we will need exactly two PT_LOAD segments: one for text
   4336      1.1     skrll      and one for data.  */
   4337      1.1     skrll   segs = 2;
   4338      1.1     skrll 
   4339      1.1     skrll   s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".interp");
   4340      1.1     skrll   if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
   4341      1.1     skrll     {
   4342      1.1     skrll       /* If we have a loadable interpreter section, we need a
   4343      1.1     skrll 	 PT_INTERP segment.  In this case, assume we also need a
   4344      1.1     skrll 	 PT_PHDR segment, although that may not be true for all
   4345      1.1     skrll 	 targets.  */
   4346      1.1     skrll       segs += 2;
   4347      1.1     skrll     }
   4348      1.1     skrll 
   4349      1.1     skrll   if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic") != NULL)
   4350      1.1     skrll     {
   4351      1.1     skrll       /* We need a PT_DYNAMIC segment.  */
   4352      1.1     skrll       ++segs;
   4353      1.1     skrll     }
   4354      1.1     skrll 
   4355      1.1     skrll   if (info != NULL && info->relro)
   4356      1.1     skrll     {
   4357      1.1     skrll       /* We need a PT_GNU_RELRO segment.  */
   4358      1.1     skrll       ++segs;
   4359  1.1.1.5  christos     }
   4360      1.1     skrll 
   4361      1.1     skrll   if (elf_eh_frame_hdr (abfd))
   4362      1.1     skrll     {
   4363      1.1     skrll       /* We need a PT_GNU_EH_FRAME segment.  */
   4364      1.1     skrll       ++segs;
   4365  1.1.1.5  christos     }
   4366      1.1     skrll 
   4367      1.1     skrll   if (elf_stack_flags (abfd))
   4368      1.1     skrll     {
   4369      1.1     skrll       /* We need a PT_GNU_STACK segment.  */
   4370      1.1     skrll       ++segs;
   4371      1.1     skrll     }
   4372      1.1     skrll 
   4373      1.1     skrll   for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
   4374      1.1     skrll     {
   4375      1.1     skrll       if ((s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
   4376      1.1     skrll 	  && CONST_STRNEQ (s->name, ".note"))
   4377      1.1     skrll 	{
   4378      1.1     skrll 	  /* We need a PT_NOTE segment.  */
   4379      1.1     skrll 	  ++segs;
   4380      1.1     skrll 	  /* Try to create just one PT_NOTE segment
   4381      1.1     skrll 	     for all adjacent loadable .note* sections.
   4382      1.1     skrll 	     gABI requires that within a PT_NOTE segment
   4383      1.1     skrll 	     (and also inside of each SHT_NOTE section)
   4384      1.1     skrll 	     each note is padded to a multiple of 4 size,
   4385      1.1     skrll 	     so we check whether the sections are correctly
   4386      1.1     skrll 	     aligned.  */
   4387      1.1     skrll 	  if (s->alignment_power == 2)
   4388      1.1     skrll 	    while (s->next != NULL
   4389      1.1     skrll 		   && s->next->alignment_power == 2
   4390      1.1     skrll 		   && (s->next->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
   4391      1.1     skrll 		   && CONST_STRNEQ (s->next->name, ".note"))
   4392      1.1     skrll 	      s = s->next;
   4393      1.1     skrll 	}
   4394      1.1     skrll     }
   4395      1.1     skrll 
   4396      1.1     skrll   for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
   4397      1.1     skrll     {
   4398      1.1     skrll       if (s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
   4399      1.1     skrll 	{
   4400      1.1     skrll 	  /* We need a PT_TLS segment.  */
   4401      1.1     skrll 	  ++segs;
   4402      1.1     skrll 	  break;
   4403      1.1     skrll 	}
   4404      1.1     skrll     }
   4405  1.1.1.7  christos 
   4406  1.1.1.7  christos   bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   4407  1.1.1.7  christos 
   4408  1.1.1.7  christos  if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0)
   4409  1.1.1.7  christos    {
   4410  1.1.1.7  christos      /* Add a PT_GNU_MBIND segment for each mbind section.  */
   4411  1.1.1.7  christos      unsigned int page_align_power = bfd_log2 (bed->commonpagesize);
   4412  1.1.1.7  christos      for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
   4413  1.1.1.7  christos        if (elf_section_flags (s) & SHF_GNU_MBIND)
   4414  1.1.1.7  christos 	 {
   4415  1.1.1.7  christos 	   if (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_info
   4416  1.1.1.7  christos 	       > PT_GNU_MBIND_NUM)
   4417  1.1.1.7  christos 	     {
   4418  1.1.1.8  christos 	       _bfd_error_handler
   4419  1.1.1.7  christos 		 /* xgettext:c-format */
   4420  1.1.1.7  christos 		 (_("%pB: GNU_MBIN section `%pA' has invalid sh_info field: %d"),
   4421  1.1.1.7  christos 		     abfd, s, elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_info);
   4422  1.1.1.7  christos 	       continue;
   4423  1.1.1.7  christos 	     }
   4424  1.1.1.7  christos 	   /* Align mbind section to page size.  */
   4425  1.1.1.7  christos 	   if (s->alignment_power < page_align_power)
   4426  1.1.1.7  christos 	     s->alignment_power = page_align_power;
   4427  1.1.1.7  christos 	   segs ++;
   4428  1.1.1.7  christos 	 }
   4429  1.1.1.7  christos    }
   4430  1.1.1.7  christos 
   4431      1.1     skrll  /* Let the backend count up any program headers it might need.  */
   4432      1.1     skrll  if (bed->elf_backend_additional_program_headers)
   4433      1.1     skrll     {
   4434      1.1     skrll       int a;
   4435      1.1     skrll 
   4436      1.1     skrll       a = (*bed->elf_backend_additional_program_headers) (abfd, info);
   4437      1.1     skrll       if (a == -1)
   4438      1.1     skrll 	abort ();
   4439      1.1     skrll       segs += a;
   4440      1.1     skrll     }
   4441      1.1     skrll 
   4442      1.1     skrll   return segs * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
   4443      1.1     skrll }
   4444      1.1     skrll 
   4445      1.1     skrll /* Find the segment that contains the output_section of section.  */
   4446      1.1     skrll 
   4447      1.1     skrll Elf_Internal_Phdr *
   4448      1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_find_segment_containing_section (bfd * abfd, asection * section)
   4449      1.1     skrll {
   4450      1.1     skrll   struct elf_segment_map *m;
   4451  1.1.1.5  christos   Elf_Internal_Phdr *p;
   4452      1.1     skrll 
   4453      1.1     skrll   for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd), p = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
   4454      1.1     skrll        m != NULL;
   4455      1.1     skrll        m = m->next, p++)
   4456      1.1     skrll     {
   4457      1.1     skrll       int i;
   4458      1.1     skrll 
   4459      1.1     skrll       for (i = m->count - 1; i >= 0; i--)
   4460      1.1     skrll 	if (m->sections[i] == section)
   4461      1.1     skrll 	  return p;
   4462      1.1     skrll     }
   4463      1.1     skrll 
   4464      1.1     skrll   return NULL;
   4465      1.1     skrll }
   4466      1.1     skrll 
   4467      1.1     skrll /* Create a mapping from a set of sections to a program segment.  */
   4468      1.1     skrll 
   4469      1.1     skrll static struct elf_segment_map *
   4470      1.1     skrll make_mapping (bfd *abfd,
   4471      1.1     skrll 	      asection **sections,
   4472      1.1     skrll 	      unsigned int from,
   4473      1.1     skrll 	      unsigned int to,
   4474      1.1     skrll 	      bfd_boolean phdr)
   4475      1.1     skrll {
   4476      1.1     skrll   struct elf_segment_map *m;
   4477      1.1     skrll   unsigned int i;
   4478      1.1     skrll   asection **hdrpp;
   4479      1.1     skrll   bfd_size_type amt;
   4480      1.1     skrll 
   4481  1.1.1.3  christos   amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
   4482      1.1     skrll   amt += (to - from - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
   4483      1.1     skrll   m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
   4484      1.1     skrll   if (m == NULL)
   4485      1.1     skrll     return NULL;
   4486      1.1     skrll   m->next = NULL;
   4487      1.1     skrll   m->p_type = PT_LOAD;
   4488      1.1     skrll   for (i = from, hdrpp = sections + from; i < to; i++, hdrpp++)
   4489      1.1     skrll     m->sections[i - from] = *hdrpp;
   4490      1.1     skrll   m->count = to - from;
   4491      1.1     skrll 
   4492      1.1     skrll   if (from == 0 && phdr)
   4493      1.1     skrll     {
   4494      1.1     skrll       /* Include the headers in the first PT_LOAD segment.  */
   4495      1.1     skrll       m->includes_filehdr = 1;
   4496      1.1     skrll       m->includes_phdrs = 1;
   4497      1.1     skrll     }
   4498      1.1     skrll 
   4499      1.1     skrll   return m;
   4500      1.1     skrll }
   4501      1.1     skrll 
   4502      1.1     skrll /* Create the PT_DYNAMIC segment, which includes DYNSEC.  Returns NULL
   4503      1.1     skrll    on failure.  */
   4504      1.1     skrll 
   4505      1.1     skrll struct elf_segment_map *
   4506      1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_make_dynamic_segment (bfd *abfd, asection *dynsec)
   4507      1.1     skrll {
   4508  1.1.1.3  christos   struct elf_segment_map *m;
   4509  1.1.1.7  christos 
   4510      1.1     skrll   m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd,
   4511      1.1     skrll 					     sizeof (struct elf_segment_map));
   4512      1.1     skrll   if (m == NULL)
   4513      1.1     skrll     return NULL;
   4514      1.1     skrll   m->next = NULL;
   4515      1.1     skrll   m->p_type = PT_DYNAMIC;
   4516      1.1     skrll   m->count = 1;
   4517      1.1     skrll   m->sections[0] = dynsec;
   4518      1.1     skrll 
   4519      1.1     skrll   return m;
   4520      1.1     skrll }
   4521      1.1     skrll 
   4522      1.1     skrll /* Possibly add or remove segments from the segment map.  */
   4523      1.1     skrll 
   4524      1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   4525      1.1     skrll elf_modify_segment_map (bfd *abfd,
   4526      1.1     skrll 			struct bfd_link_info *info,
   4527      1.1     skrll 			bfd_boolean remove_empty_load)
   4528      1.1     skrll {
   4529      1.1     skrll   struct elf_segment_map **m;
   4530      1.1     skrll   const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
   4531      1.1     skrll 
   4532      1.1     skrll   /* The placement algorithm assumes that non allocated sections are
   4533      1.1     skrll      not in PT_LOAD segments.  We ensure this here by removing such
   4534      1.1     skrll      sections from the segment map.  We also remove excluded
   4535  1.1.1.5  christos      sections.  Finally, any PT_LOAD segment without sections is
   4536      1.1     skrll      removed.  */
   4537      1.1     skrll   m = &elf_seg_map (abfd);
   4538      1.1     skrll   while (*m)
   4539      1.1     skrll     {
   4540      1.1     skrll       unsigned int i, new_count;
   4541      1.1     skrll 
   4542      1.1     skrll       for (new_count = 0, i = 0; i < (*m)->count; i++)
   4543      1.1     skrll 	{
   4544      1.1     skrll 	  if (((*m)->sections[i]->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) == 0
   4545      1.1     skrll 	      && (((*m)->sections[i]->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
   4546      1.1     skrll 		  || (*m)->p_type != PT_LOAD))
   4547      1.1     skrll 	    {
   4548      1.1     skrll 	      (*m)->sections[new_count] = (*m)->sections[i];
   4549      1.1     skrll 	      new_count++;
   4550      1.1     skrll 	    }
   4551      1.1     skrll 	}
   4552  1.1.1.7  christos       (*m)->count = new_count;
   4553  1.1.1.7  christos 
   4554  1.1.1.7  christos       if (remove_empty_load
   4555  1.1.1.7  christos 	  && (*m)->p_type == PT_LOAD
   4556      1.1     skrll 	  && (*m)->count == 0
   4557      1.1     skrll 	  && !(*m)->includes_phdrs)
   4558      1.1     skrll 	*m = (*m)->next;
   4559      1.1     skrll       else
   4560      1.1     skrll 	m = &(*m)->next;
   4561      1.1     skrll     }
   4562      1.1     skrll 
   4563      1.1     skrll   bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   4564      1.1     skrll   if (bed->elf_backend_modify_segment_map != NULL)
   4565      1.1     skrll     {
   4566      1.1     skrll       if (!(*bed->elf_backend_modify_segment_map) (abfd, info))
   4567      1.1     skrll 	return FALSE;
   4568      1.1     skrll     }
   4569      1.1     skrll 
   4570      1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   4571  1.1.1.8  christos }
   4572  1.1.1.8  christos 
   4573  1.1.1.8  christos #define IS_TBSS(s) \
   4574      1.1     skrll   ((s->flags & (SEC_THREAD_LOCAL | SEC_LOAD)) == SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
   4575      1.1     skrll 
   4576      1.1     skrll /* Set up a mapping from BFD sections to program segments.  */
   4577      1.1     skrll 
   4578      1.1     skrll bfd_boolean
   4579      1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_map_sections_to_segments (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
   4580      1.1     skrll {
   4581      1.1     skrll   unsigned int count;
   4582      1.1     skrll   struct elf_segment_map *m;
   4583      1.1     skrll   asection **sections = NULL;
   4584      1.1     skrll   const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   4585  1.1.1.5  christos   bfd_boolean no_user_phdrs;
   4586  1.1.1.4  christos 
   4587  1.1.1.4  christos   no_user_phdrs = elf_seg_map (abfd) == NULL;
   4588  1.1.1.4  christos 
   4589  1.1.1.4  christos   if (info != NULL)
   4590      1.1     skrll     info->user_phdrs = !no_user_phdrs;
   4591      1.1     skrll 
   4592      1.1     skrll   if (no_user_phdrs && bfd_count_sections (abfd) != 0)
   4593      1.1     skrll     {
   4594      1.1     skrll       asection *s;
   4595      1.1     skrll       unsigned int i;
   4596      1.1     skrll       struct elf_segment_map *mfirst;
   4597      1.1     skrll       struct elf_segment_map **pm;
   4598      1.1     skrll       asection *last_hdr;
   4599      1.1     skrll       bfd_vma last_size;
   4600      1.1     skrll       unsigned int phdr_index;
   4601      1.1     skrll       bfd_vma maxpagesize;
   4602      1.1     skrll       asection **hdrpp;
   4603  1.1.1.7  christos       bfd_boolean phdr_in_segment = TRUE;
   4604      1.1     skrll       bfd_boolean writable;
   4605      1.1     skrll       bfd_boolean executable;
   4606  1.1.1.7  christos       int tls_count = 0;
   4607      1.1     skrll       asection *first_tls = NULL;
   4608      1.1     skrll       asection *first_mbind = NULL;
   4609  1.1.1.3  christos       asection *dynsec, *eh_frame_hdr;
   4610  1.1.1.7  christos       bfd_size_type amt;
   4611      1.1     skrll       bfd_vma addr_mask, wrap_to = 0;
   4612      1.1     skrll       bfd_boolean linker_created_pt_phdr_segment = FALSE;
   4613      1.1     skrll 
   4614  1.1.1.3  christos       /* Select the allocated sections, and sort them.  */
   4615  1.1.1.7  christos 
   4616      1.1     skrll       sections = (asection **) bfd_malloc2 (bfd_count_sections (abfd),
   4617      1.1     skrll 					    sizeof (asection *));
   4618      1.1     skrll       if (sections == NULL)
   4619  1.1.1.3  christos 	goto error_return;
   4620  1.1.1.3  christos 
   4621  1.1.1.3  christos       /* Calculate top address, avoiding undefined behaviour of shift
   4622  1.1.1.3  christos 	 left operator when shift count is equal to size of type
   4623  1.1.1.3  christos 	 being shifted.  */
   4624  1.1.1.3  christos       addr_mask = ((bfd_vma) 1 << (bfd_arch_bits_per_address (abfd) - 1)) - 1;
   4625      1.1     skrll       addr_mask = (addr_mask << 1) + 1;
   4626      1.1     skrll 
   4627      1.1     skrll       i = 0;
   4628      1.1     skrll       for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
   4629      1.1     skrll 	{
   4630      1.1     skrll 	  if ((s->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
   4631      1.1     skrll 	    {
   4632  1.1.1.3  christos 	      sections[i] = s;
   4633  1.1.1.3  christos 	      ++i;
   4634  1.1.1.3  christos 	      /* A wrapping section potentially clashes with header.  */
   4635      1.1     skrll 	      if (((s->lma + s->size) & addr_mask) < (s->lma & addr_mask))
   4636      1.1     skrll 		wrap_to = (s->lma + s->size) & addr_mask;
   4637      1.1     skrll 	    }
   4638      1.1     skrll 	}
   4639      1.1     skrll       BFD_ASSERT (i <= bfd_count_sections (abfd));
   4640      1.1     skrll       count = i;
   4641      1.1     skrll 
   4642      1.1     skrll       qsort (sections, (size_t) count, sizeof (asection *), elf_sort_sections);
   4643      1.1     skrll 
   4644      1.1     skrll       /* Build the mapping.  */
   4645      1.1     skrll 
   4646      1.1     skrll       mfirst = NULL;
   4647      1.1     skrll       pm = &mfirst;
   4648      1.1     skrll 
   4649      1.1     skrll       /* If we have a .interp section, then create a PT_PHDR segment for
   4650      1.1     skrll 	 the program headers and a PT_INTERP segment for the .interp
   4651      1.1     skrll 	 section.  */
   4652      1.1     skrll       s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".interp");
   4653      1.1     skrll       if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
   4654  1.1.1.3  christos 	{
   4655      1.1     skrll 	  amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
   4656      1.1     skrll 	  m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
   4657      1.1     skrll 	  if (m == NULL)
   4658      1.1     skrll 	    goto error_return;
   4659  1.1.1.7  christos 	  m->next = NULL;
   4660      1.1     skrll 	  m->p_type = PT_PHDR;
   4661      1.1     skrll 	  m->p_flags = PF_R;
   4662  1.1.1.7  christos 	  m->p_flags_valid = 1;
   4663      1.1     skrll 	  m->includes_phdrs = 1;
   4664      1.1     skrll 	  linker_created_pt_phdr_segment = TRUE;
   4665      1.1     skrll 	  *pm = m;
   4666      1.1     skrll 	  pm = &m->next;
   4667  1.1.1.3  christos 
   4668      1.1     skrll 	  amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
   4669      1.1     skrll 	  m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
   4670      1.1     skrll 	  if (m == NULL)
   4671      1.1     skrll 	    goto error_return;
   4672      1.1     skrll 	  m->next = NULL;
   4673      1.1     skrll 	  m->p_type = PT_INTERP;
   4674      1.1     skrll 	  m->count = 1;
   4675      1.1     skrll 	  m->sections[0] = s;
   4676      1.1     skrll 
   4677      1.1     skrll 	  *pm = m;
   4678      1.1     skrll 	  pm = &m->next;
   4679      1.1     skrll 	}
   4680      1.1     skrll 
   4681      1.1     skrll       /* Look through the sections.  We put sections in the same program
   4682      1.1     skrll 	 segment when the start of the second section can be placed within
   4683      1.1     skrll 	 a few bytes of the end of the first section.  */
   4684      1.1     skrll       last_hdr = NULL;
   4685      1.1     skrll       last_size = 0;
   4686  1.1.1.5  christos       phdr_index = 0;
   4687  1.1.1.5  christos       maxpagesize = bed->maxpagesize;
   4688  1.1.1.5  christos       /* PR 17512: file: c8455299.
   4689  1.1.1.5  christos 	 Avoid divide-by-zero errors later on.
   4690  1.1.1.5  christos 	 FIXME: Should we abort if the maxpagesize is zero ?  */
   4691      1.1     skrll       if (maxpagesize == 0)
   4692  1.1.1.7  christos 	maxpagesize = 1;
   4693      1.1     skrll       writable = FALSE;
   4694      1.1     skrll       executable = FALSE;
   4695      1.1     skrll       dynsec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic");
   4696      1.1     skrll       if (dynsec != NULL
   4697      1.1     skrll 	  && (dynsec->flags & SEC_LOAD) == 0)
   4698      1.1     skrll 	dynsec = NULL;
   4699      1.1     skrll 
   4700      1.1     skrll       /* Deal with -Ttext or something similar such that the first section
   4701      1.1     skrll 	 is not adjacent to the program headers.  This is an
   4702      1.1     skrll 	 approximation, since at this point we don't know exactly how many
   4703      1.1     skrll 	 program headers we will need.  */
   4704  1.1.1.5  christos       if (count > 0)
   4705      1.1     skrll 	{
   4706      1.1     skrll 	  bfd_size_type phdr_size = elf_program_header_size (abfd);
   4707      1.1     skrll 
   4708  1.1.1.4  christos 	  if (phdr_size == (bfd_size_type) -1)
   4709      1.1     skrll 	    phdr_size = get_program_header_size (abfd, info);
   4710  1.1.1.3  christos 	  phdr_size += bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
   4711  1.1.1.3  christos 	  if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) == 0
   4712  1.1.1.3  christos 	      || (sections[0]->lma & addr_mask) < phdr_size
   4713  1.1.1.3  christos 	      || ((sections[0]->lma & addr_mask) % maxpagesize
   4714  1.1.1.7  christos 		  < phdr_size % maxpagesize)
   4715  1.1.1.7  christos 	      || (sections[0]->lma & addr_mask & -maxpagesize) < wrap_to)
   4716  1.1.1.7  christos 	    {
   4717  1.1.1.7  christos 	      /* PR 20815: The ELF standard says that a PT_PHDR segment, if
   4718  1.1.1.7  christos 		 present, must be included as part of the memory image of the
   4719  1.1.1.7  christos 		 program.  Ie it must be part of a PT_LOAD segment as well.
   4720  1.1.1.7  christos 		 If we have had to create our own PT_PHDR segment, but it is
   4721  1.1.1.7  christos 		 not going to be covered by the first PT_LOAD segment, then
   4722  1.1.1.7  christos 		 force the inclusion if we can...  */
   4723  1.1.1.7  christos 	      if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0
   4724  1.1.1.7  christos 		  && linker_created_pt_phdr_segment)
   4725  1.1.1.7  christos 		phdr_in_segment = TRUE;
   4726  1.1.1.7  christos 	      else
   4727      1.1     skrll 		phdr_in_segment = FALSE;
   4728      1.1     skrll 	    }
   4729      1.1     skrll 	}
   4730      1.1     skrll 
   4731      1.1     skrll       for (i = 0, hdrpp = sections; i < count; i++, hdrpp++)
   4732      1.1     skrll 	{
   4733      1.1     skrll 	  asection *hdr;
   4734      1.1     skrll 	  bfd_boolean new_segment;
   4735      1.1     skrll 
   4736      1.1     skrll 	  hdr = *hdrpp;
   4737      1.1     skrll 
   4738      1.1     skrll 	  /* See if this section and the last one will fit in the same
   4739      1.1     skrll 	     segment.  */
   4740      1.1     skrll 
   4741      1.1     skrll 	  if (last_hdr == NULL)
   4742      1.1     skrll 	    {
   4743      1.1     skrll 	      /* If we don't have a segment yet, then we don't need a new
   4744      1.1     skrll 		 one (we build the last one after this loop).  */
   4745      1.1     skrll 	      new_segment = FALSE;
   4746      1.1     skrll 	    }
   4747      1.1     skrll 	  else if (last_hdr->lma - last_hdr->vma != hdr->lma - hdr->vma)
   4748      1.1     skrll 	    {
   4749      1.1     skrll 	      /* If this section has a different relation between the
   4750      1.1     skrll 		 virtual address and the load address, then we need a new
   4751      1.1     skrll 		 segment.  */
   4752  1.1.1.3  christos 	      new_segment = TRUE;
   4753  1.1.1.3  christos 	    }
   4754  1.1.1.3  christos 	  else if (hdr->lma < last_hdr->lma + last_size
   4755  1.1.1.3  christos 		   || last_hdr->lma + last_size < last_hdr->lma)
   4756  1.1.1.3  christos 	    {
   4757  1.1.1.3  christos 	      /* If this section has a load address that makes it overlap
   4758  1.1.1.3  christos 		 the previous section, then we need a new segment.  */
   4759  1.1.1.8  christos 	      new_segment = TRUE;
   4760  1.1.1.8  christos 	    }
   4761  1.1.1.8  christos 	  else if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0
   4762  1.1.1.8  christos 		   && (((last_hdr->lma + last_size - 1) & -maxpagesize)
   4763  1.1.1.8  christos 		       == (hdr->lma & -maxpagesize)))
   4764  1.1.1.8  christos 	    {
   4765  1.1.1.8  christos 	      /* If we are demand paged then we can't map two disk
   4766  1.1.1.8  christos 		 pages onto the same memory page.  */
   4767      1.1     skrll 	      new_segment = FALSE;
   4768      1.1     skrll 	    }
   4769      1.1     skrll 	  /* In the next test we have to be careful when last_hdr->lma is close
   4770      1.1     skrll 	     to the end of the address space.  If the aligned address wraps
   4771      1.1     skrll 	     around to the start of the address space, then there are no more
   4772  1.1.1.8  christos 	     pages left in memory and it is OK to assume that the current
   4773  1.1.1.8  christos 	     section can be included in the current segment.  */
   4774  1.1.1.8  christos 	  else if ((BFD_ALIGN (last_hdr->lma + last_size, maxpagesize)
   4775  1.1.1.8  christos 		    + maxpagesize > last_hdr->lma)
   4776      1.1     skrll 		   && (BFD_ALIGN (last_hdr->lma + last_size, maxpagesize)
   4777      1.1     skrll 		       + maxpagesize <= hdr->lma))
   4778      1.1     skrll 	    {
   4779      1.1     skrll 	      /* If putting this section in this segment would force us to
   4780      1.1     skrll 		 skip a page in the segment, then we need a new segment.  */
   4781      1.1     skrll 	      new_segment = TRUE;
   4782  1.1.1.8  christos 	    }
   4783  1.1.1.5  christos 	  else if ((last_hdr->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) == 0
   4784  1.1.1.5  christos 		   && (hdr->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) != 0)
   4785  1.1.1.5  christos 	    {
   4786  1.1.1.5  christos 	      /* We don't want to put a loaded section after a
   4787  1.1.1.8  christos 		 nonloaded (ie. bss style) section in the same segment
   4788      1.1     skrll 		 as that will force the non-loaded section to be loaded.
   4789      1.1     skrll 		 Consider .tbss sections as loaded for this purpose.  */
   4790      1.1     skrll 	      new_segment = TRUE;
   4791      1.1     skrll 	    }
   4792      1.1     skrll 	  else if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) == 0)
   4793      1.1     skrll 	    {
   4794      1.1     skrll 	      /* If the file is not demand paged, which means that we
   4795      1.1     skrll 		 don't require the sections to be correctly aligned in the
   4796      1.1     skrll 		 file, then there is no other reason for a new segment.  */
   4797  1.1.1.7  christos 	      new_segment = FALSE;
   4798  1.1.1.7  christos 	    }
   4799  1.1.1.7  christos 	  else if (info != NULL
   4800  1.1.1.7  christos 		   && info->separate_code
   4801  1.1.1.7  christos 		   && executable != ((hdr->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0))
   4802  1.1.1.7  christos 	    {
   4803      1.1     skrll 	      new_segment = TRUE;
   4804  1.1.1.8  christos 	    }
   4805      1.1     skrll 	  else if (! writable
   4806      1.1     skrll 		   && (hdr->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
   4807  1.1.1.8  christos 	    {
   4808      1.1     skrll 	      /* We don't want to put a writable section in a read only
   4809      1.1     skrll 		 segment.  */
   4810      1.1     skrll 	      new_segment = TRUE;
   4811      1.1     skrll 	    }
   4812      1.1     skrll 	  else
   4813      1.1     skrll 	    {
   4814      1.1     skrll 	      /* Otherwise, we can use the same segment.  */
   4815      1.1     skrll 	      new_segment = FALSE;
   4816      1.1     skrll 	    }
   4817      1.1     skrll 
   4818      1.1     skrll 	  /* Allow interested parties a chance to override our decision.  */
   4819      1.1     skrll 	  if (last_hdr != NULL
   4820      1.1     skrll 	      && info != NULL
   4821      1.1     skrll 	      && info->callbacks->override_segment_assignment != NULL)
   4822      1.1     skrll 	    new_segment
   4823      1.1     skrll 	      = info->callbacks->override_segment_assignment (info, abfd, hdr,
   4824      1.1     skrll 							      last_hdr,
   4825      1.1     skrll 							      new_segment);
   4826      1.1     skrll 
   4827      1.1     skrll 	  if (! new_segment)
   4828      1.1     skrll 	    {
   4829  1.1.1.7  christos 	      if ((hdr->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
   4830  1.1.1.7  christos 		writable = TRUE;
   4831      1.1     skrll 	      if ((hdr->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
   4832      1.1     skrll 		executable = TRUE;
   4833  1.1.1.8  christos 	      last_hdr = hdr;
   4834      1.1     skrll 	      /* .tbss sections effectively have zero size.  */
   4835      1.1     skrll 	      last_size = !IS_TBSS (hdr) ? hdr->size : 0;
   4836      1.1     skrll 	      continue;
   4837      1.1     skrll 	    }
   4838      1.1     skrll 
   4839      1.1     skrll 	  /* We need a new program segment.  We must create a new program
   4840      1.1     skrll 	     header holding all the sections from phdr_index until hdr.  */
   4841      1.1     skrll 
   4842      1.1     skrll 	  m = make_mapping (abfd, sections, phdr_index, i, phdr_in_segment);
   4843      1.1     skrll 	  if (m == NULL)
   4844      1.1     skrll 	    goto error_return;
   4845      1.1     skrll 
   4846      1.1     skrll 	  *pm = m;
   4847      1.1     skrll 	  pm = &m->next;
   4848      1.1     skrll 
   4849      1.1     skrll 	  if ((hdr->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
   4850      1.1     skrll 	    writable = TRUE;
   4851      1.1     skrll 	  else
   4852  1.1.1.7  christos 	    writable = FALSE;
   4853  1.1.1.7  christos 
   4854  1.1.1.7  christos 	  if ((hdr->flags & SEC_CODE) == 0)
   4855  1.1.1.7  christos 	    executable = FALSE;
   4856  1.1.1.7  christos 	  else
   4857      1.1     skrll 	    executable = TRUE;
   4858      1.1     skrll 
   4859  1.1.1.8  christos 	  last_hdr = hdr;
   4860      1.1     skrll 	  /* .tbss sections effectively have zero size.  */
   4861      1.1     skrll 	  last_size = !IS_TBSS (hdr) ? hdr->size : 0;
   4862      1.1     skrll 	  phdr_index = i;
   4863      1.1     skrll 	  phdr_in_segment = FALSE;
   4864  1.1.1.3  christos 	}
   4865  1.1.1.3  christos 
   4866  1.1.1.3  christos       /* Create a final PT_LOAD program segment, but not if it's just
   4867  1.1.1.3  christos 	 for .tbss.  */
   4868  1.1.1.8  christos       if (last_hdr != NULL
   4869      1.1     skrll 	  && (i - phdr_index != 1
   4870      1.1     skrll 	      || !IS_TBSS (last_hdr)))
   4871      1.1     skrll 	{
   4872      1.1     skrll 	  m = make_mapping (abfd, sections, phdr_index, i, phdr_in_segment);
   4873      1.1     skrll 	  if (m == NULL)
   4874      1.1     skrll 	    goto error_return;
   4875      1.1     skrll 
   4876      1.1     skrll 	  *pm = m;
   4877      1.1     skrll 	  pm = &m->next;
   4878      1.1     skrll 	}
   4879      1.1     skrll 
   4880      1.1     skrll       /* If there is a .dynamic section, throw in a PT_DYNAMIC segment.  */
   4881      1.1     skrll       if (dynsec != NULL)
   4882      1.1     skrll 	{
   4883      1.1     skrll 	  m = _bfd_elf_make_dynamic_segment (abfd, dynsec);
   4884      1.1     skrll 	  if (m == NULL)
   4885      1.1     skrll 	    goto error_return;
   4886      1.1     skrll 	  *pm = m;
   4887      1.1     skrll 	  pm = &m->next;
   4888      1.1     skrll 	}
   4889      1.1     skrll 
   4890      1.1     skrll       /* For each batch of consecutive loadable .note sections,
   4891      1.1     skrll 	 add a PT_NOTE segment.  We don't use bfd_get_section_by_name,
   4892      1.1     skrll 	 because if we link together nonloadable .note sections and
   4893      1.1     skrll 	 loadable .note sections, we will generate two .note sections
   4894      1.1     skrll 	 in the output file.  FIXME: Using names for section types is
   4895      1.1     skrll 	 bogus anyhow.  */
   4896      1.1     skrll       for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
   4897      1.1     skrll 	{
   4898      1.1     skrll 	  if ((s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
   4899      1.1     skrll 	      && CONST_STRNEQ (s->name, ".note"))
   4900  1.1.1.3  christos 	    {
   4901  1.1.1.3  christos 	      asection *s2;
   4902      1.1     skrll 
   4903      1.1     skrll 	      count = 1;
   4904      1.1     skrll 	      amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
   4905      1.1     skrll 	      if (s->alignment_power == 2)
   4906      1.1     skrll 		for (s2 = s; s2->next != NULL; s2 = s2->next)
   4907      1.1     skrll 		  {
   4908      1.1     skrll 		    if (s2->next->alignment_power == 2
   4909  1.1.1.3  christos 			&& (s2->next->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
   4910  1.1.1.3  christos 			&& CONST_STRNEQ (s2->next->name, ".note")
   4911      1.1     skrll 			&& align_power (s2->lma + s2->size, 2)
   4912      1.1     skrll 			   == s2->next->lma)
   4913      1.1     skrll 		      count++;
   4914      1.1     skrll 		    else
   4915      1.1     skrll 		      break;
   4916  1.1.1.3  christos 		  }
   4917      1.1     skrll 	      amt += (count - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
   4918      1.1     skrll 	      m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
   4919      1.1     skrll 	      if (m == NULL)
   4920      1.1     skrll 		goto error_return;
   4921      1.1     skrll 	      m->next = NULL;
   4922      1.1     skrll 	      m->p_type = PT_NOTE;
   4923      1.1     skrll 	      m->count = count;
   4924      1.1     skrll 	      while (count > 1)
   4925      1.1     skrll 		{
   4926      1.1     skrll 		  m->sections[m->count - count--] = s;
   4927      1.1     skrll 		  BFD_ASSERT ((s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) == 0);
   4928      1.1     skrll 		  s = s->next;
   4929      1.1     skrll 		}
   4930      1.1     skrll 	      m->sections[m->count - 1] = s;
   4931      1.1     skrll 	      BFD_ASSERT ((s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) == 0);
   4932      1.1     skrll 	      *pm = m;
   4933      1.1     skrll 	      pm = &m->next;
   4934      1.1     skrll 	    }
   4935      1.1     skrll 	  if (s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
   4936      1.1     skrll 	    {
   4937      1.1     skrll 	      if (! tls_count)
   4938      1.1     skrll 		first_tls = s;
   4939  1.1.1.7  christos 	      tls_count++;
   4940  1.1.1.7  christos 	    }
   4941  1.1.1.7  christos 	  if (first_mbind == NULL
   4942      1.1     skrll 	      && (elf_section_flags (s) & SHF_GNU_MBIND) != 0)
   4943      1.1     skrll 	    first_mbind = s;
   4944      1.1     skrll 	}
   4945      1.1     skrll 
   4946      1.1     skrll       /* If there are any SHF_TLS output sections, add PT_TLS segment.  */
   4947      1.1     skrll       if (tls_count > 0)
   4948      1.1     skrll 	{
   4949  1.1.1.3  christos 	  amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
   4950      1.1     skrll 	  amt += (tls_count - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
   4951      1.1     skrll 	  m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
   4952      1.1     skrll 	  if (m == NULL)
   4953      1.1     skrll 	    goto error_return;
   4954      1.1     skrll 	  m->next = NULL;
   4955      1.1     skrll 	  m->p_type = PT_TLS;
   4956      1.1     skrll 	  m->count = tls_count;
   4957      1.1     skrll 	  /* Mandated PF_R.  */
   4958  1.1.1.5  christos 	  m->p_flags = PF_R;
   4959  1.1.1.3  christos 	  m->p_flags_valid = 1;
   4960      1.1     skrll 	  s = first_tls;
   4961  1.1.1.5  christos 	  for (i = 0; i < (unsigned int) tls_count; ++i)
   4962  1.1.1.5  christos 	    {
   4963  1.1.1.5  christos 	      if ((s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) == 0)
   4964  1.1.1.8  christos 		{
   4965  1.1.1.5  christos 		  _bfd_error_handler
   4966  1.1.1.5  christos 		    (_("%pB: TLS sections are not adjacent:"), abfd);
   4967  1.1.1.5  christos 		  s = first_tls;
   4968  1.1.1.5  christos 		  i = 0;
   4969  1.1.1.5  christos 		  while (i < (unsigned int) tls_count)
   4970  1.1.1.5  christos 		    {
   4971  1.1.1.8  christos 		      if ((s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) != 0)
   4972  1.1.1.5  christos 			{
   4973  1.1.1.5  christos 			  _bfd_error_handler (_("	    TLS: %pA"), s);
   4974  1.1.1.5  christos 			  i++;
   4975  1.1.1.8  christos 			}
   4976  1.1.1.5  christos 		      else
   4977  1.1.1.5  christos 			_bfd_error_handler (_("	non-TLS: %pA"), s);
   4978  1.1.1.5  christos 		      s = s->next;
   4979  1.1.1.5  christos 		    }
   4980  1.1.1.5  christos 		  bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
   4981  1.1.1.5  christos 		  goto error_return;
   4982  1.1.1.5  christos 		}
   4983      1.1     skrll 	      m->sections[i] = s;
   4984      1.1     skrll 	      s = s->next;
   4985      1.1     skrll 	    }
   4986      1.1     skrll 
   4987      1.1     skrll 	  *pm = m;
   4988      1.1     skrll 	  pm = &m->next;
   4989  1.1.1.7  christos 	}
   4990  1.1.1.7  christos 
   4991  1.1.1.7  christos       if (first_mbind && (abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0)
   4992  1.1.1.7  christos 	for (s = first_mbind; s != NULL; s = s->next)
   4993  1.1.1.7  christos 	  if ((elf_section_flags (s) & SHF_GNU_MBIND) != 0
   4994  1.1.1.7  christos 	      && (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_info
   4995  1.1.1.7  christos 		  <= PT_GNU_MBIND_NUM))
   4996  1.1.1.7  christos 	    {
   4997  1.1.1.7  christos 	      /* Mandated PF_R.  */
   4998  1.1.1.7  christos 	      unsigned long p_flags = PF_R;
   4999  1.1.1.7  christos 	      if ((s->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
   5000  1.1.1.7  christos 		p_flags |= PF_W;
   5001  1.1.1.7  christos 	      if ((s->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
   5002  1.1.1.7  christos 		p_flags |= PF_X;
   5003  1.1.1.7  christos 
   5004  1.1.1.7  christos 	      amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map) + sizeof (asection *);
   5005  1.1.1.7  christos 	      m = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
   5006  1.1.1.7  christos 	      if (m == NULL)
   5007  1.1.1.7  christos 		goto error_return;
   5008  1.1.1.7  christos 	      m->next = NULL;
   5009  1.1.1.7  christos 	      m->p_type = (PT_GNU_MBIND_LO
   5010  1.1.1.7  christos 			   + elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_info);
   5011  1.1.1.7  christos 	      m->count = 1;
   5012  1.1.1.7  christos 	      m->p_flags_valid = 1;
   5013  1.1.1.7  christos 	      m->sections[0] = s;
   5014  1.1.1.7  christos 	      m->p_flags = p_flags;
   5015  1.1.1.7  christos 
   5016  1.1.1.7  christos 	      *pm = m;
   5017  1.1.1.7  christos 	      pm = &m->next;
   5018      1.1     skrll 	    }
   5019      1.1     skrll 
   5020  1.1.1.5  christos       /* If there is a .eh_frame_hdr section, throw in a PT_GNU_EH_FRAME
   5021      1.1     skrll 	 segment.  */
   5022      1.1     skrll       eh_frame_hdr = elf_eh_frame_hdr (abfd);
   5023      1.1     skrll       if (eh_frame_hdr != NULL
   5024      1.1     skrll 	  && (eh_frame_hdr->output_section->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
   5025  1.1.1.3  christos 	{
   5026      1.1     skrll 	  amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
   5027      1.1     skrll 	  m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
   5028      1.1     skrll 	  if (m == NULL)
   5029      1.1     skrll 	    goto error_return;
   5030      1.1     skrll 	  m->next = NULL;
   5031      1.1     skrll 	  m->p_type = PT_GNU_EH_FRAME;
   5032      1.1     skrll 	  m->count = 1;
   5033      1.1     skrll 	  m->sections[0] = eh_frame_hdr->output_section;
   5034      1.1     skrll 
   5035      1.1     skrll 	  *pm = m;
   5036      1.1     skrll 	  pm = &m->next;
   5037  1.1.1.5  christos 	}
   5038      1.1     skrll 
   5039      1.1     skrll       if (elf_stack_flags (abfd))
   5040  1.1.1.3  christos 	{
   5041      1.1     skrll 	  amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
   5042      1.1     skrll 	  m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
   5043      1.1     skrll 	  if (m == NULL)
   5044      1.1     skrll 	    goto error_return;
   5045  1.1.1.5  christos 	  m->next = NULL;
   5046  1.1.1.5  christos 	  m->p_type = PT_GNU_STACK;
   5047      1.1     skrll 	  m->p_flags = elf_stack_flags (abfd);
   5048  1.1.1.5  christos 	  m->p_align = bed->stack_align;
   5049  1.1.1.5  christos 	  m->p_flags_valid = 1;
   5050  1.1.1.5  christos 	  m->p_align_valid = m->p_align != 0;
   5051  1.1.1.5  christos 	  if (info->stacksize > 0)
   5052  1.1.1.5  christos 	    {
   5053  1.1.1.5  christos 	      m->p_size = info->stacksize;
   5054      1.1     skrll 	      m->p_size_valid = 1;
   5055      1.1     skrll 	    }
   5056      1.1     skrll 
   5057      1.1     skrll 	  *pm = m;
   5058      1.1     skrll 	  pm = &m->next;
   5059      1.1     skrll 	}
   5060      1.1     skrll 
   5061      1.1     skrll       if (info != NULL && info->relro)
   5062      1.1     skrll 	{
   5063  1.1.1.4  christos 	  for (m = mfirst; m != NULL; m = m->next)
   5064  1.1.1.4  christos 	    {
   5065  1.1.1.4  christos 	      if (m->p_type == PT_LOAD
   5066  1.1.1.4  christos 		  && m->count != 0
   5067  1.1.1.4  christos 		  && m->sections[0]->vma >= info->relro_start
   5068  1.1.1.4  christos 		  && m->sections[0]->vma < info->relro_end)
   5069  1.1.1.4  christos 		{
   5070  1.1.1.4  christos 		  i = m->count;
   5071  1.1.1.4  christos 		  while (--i != (unsigned) -1)
   5072  1.1.1.4  christos 		    if ((m->sections[i]->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS))
   5073  1.1.1.4  christos 			== (SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS))
   5074  1.1.1.5  christos 		      break;
   5075      1.1     skrll 
   5076      1.1     skrll 		  if (i != (unsigned) -1)
   5077  1.1.1.4  christos 		    break;
   5078      1.1     skrll 		}
   5079      1.1     skrll 	    }
   5080      1.1     skrll 
   5081      1.1     skrll 	  /* Make a PT_GNU_RELRO segment only when it isn't empty.  */
   5082      1.1     skrll 	  if (m != NULL)
   5083  1.1.1.3  christos 	    {
   5084      1.1     skrll 	      amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
   5085      1.1     skrll 	      m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
   5086      1.1     skrll 	      if (m == NULL)
   5087      1.1     skrll 		goto error_return;
   5088      1.1     skrll 	      m->next = NULL;
   5089      1.1     skrll 	      m->p_type = PT_GNU_RELRO;
   5090      1.1     skrll 	      *pm = m;
   5091      1.1     skrll 	      pm = &m->next;
   5092      1.1     skrll 	    }
   5093      1.1     skrll 	}
   5094  1.1.1.5  christos 
   5095      1.1     skrll       free (sections);
   5096      1.1     skrll       elf_seg_map (abfd) = mfirst;
   5097      1.1     skrll     }
   5098      1.1     skrll 
   5099      1.1     skrll   if (!elf_modify_segment_map (abfd, info, no_user_phdrs))
   5100  1.1.1.5  christos     return FALSE;
   5101      1.1     skrll 
   5102  1.1.1.5  christos   for (count = 0, m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
   5103      1.1     skrll     ++count;
   5104      1.1     skrll   elf_program_header_size (abfd) = count * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
   5105      1.1     skrll 
   5106      1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   5107      1.1     skrll 
   5108      1.1     skrll  error_return:
   5109      1.1     skrll   if (sections != NULL)
   5110      1.1     skrll     free (sections);
   5111      1.1     skrll   return FALSE;
   5112      1.1     skrll }
   5113      1.1     skrll 
   5114      1.1     skrll /* Sort sections by address.  */
   5115      1.1     skrll 
   5116      1.1     skrll static int
   5117      1.1     skrll elf_sort_sections (const void *arg1, const void *arg2)
   5118      1.1     skrll {
   5119      1.1     skrll   const asection *sec1 = *(const asection **) arg1;
   5120      1.1     skrll   const asection *sec2 = *(const asection **) arg2;
   5121      1.1     skrll   bfd_size_type size1, size2;
   5122      1.1     skrll 
   5123      1.1     skrll   /* Sort by LMA first, since this is the address used to
   5124      1.1     skrll      place the section into a segment.  */
   5125      1.1     skrll   if (sec1->lma < sec2->lma)
   5126      1.1     skrll     return -1;
   5127      1.1     skrll   else if (sec1->lma > sec2->lma)
   5128      1.1     skrll     return 1;
   5129      1.1     skrll 
   5130      1.1     skrll   /* Then sort by VMA.  Normally the LMA and the VMA will be
   5131      1.1     skrll      the same, and this will do nothing.  */
   5132      1.1     skrll   if (sec1->vma < sec2->vma)
   5133      1.1     skrll     return -1;
   5134      1.1     skrll   else if (sec1->vma > sec2->vma)
   5135      1.1     skrll     return 1;
   5136      1.1     skrll 
   5137      1.1     skrll   /* Put !SEC_LOAD sections after SEC_LOAD ones.  */
   5138      1.1     skrll 
   5139      1.1     skrll #define TOEND(x) (((x)->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) == 0)
   5140      1.1     skrll 
   5141      1.1     skrll   if (TOEND (sec1))
   5142      1.1     skrll     {
   5143      1.1     skrll       if (TOEND (sec2))
   5144      1.1     skrll 	{
   5145      1.1     skrll 	  /* If the indicies are the same, do not return 0
   5146      1.1     skrll 	     here, but continue to try the next comparison.  */
   5147      1.1     skrll 	  if (sec1->target_index - sec2->target_index != 0)
   5148      1.1     skrll 	    return sec1->target_index - sec2->target_index;
   5149      1.1     skrll 	}
   5150      1.1     skrll       else
   5151      1.1     skrll 	return 1;
   5152      1.1     skrll     }
   5153      1.1     skrll   else if (TOEND (sec2))
   5154      1.1     skrll     return -1;
   5155      1.1     skrll 
   5156      1.1     skrll #undef TOEND
   5157      1.1     skrll 
   5158      1.1     skrll   /* Sort by size, to put zero sized sections
   5159      1.1     skrll      before others at the same address.  */
   5160      1.1     skrll 
   5161      1.1     skrll   size1 = (sec1->flags & SEC_LOAD) ? sec1->size : 0;
   5162      1.1     skrll   size2 = (sec2->flags & SEC_LOAD) ? sec2->size : 0;
   5163      1.1     skrll 
   5164      1.1     skrll   if (size1 < size2)
   5165      1.1     skrll     return -1;
   5166      1.1     skrll   if (size1 > size2)
   5167      1.1     skrll     return 1;
   5168      1.1     skrll 
   5169      1.1     skrll   return sec1->target_index - sec2->target_index;
   5170      1.1     skrll }
   5171      1.1     skrll 
   5172      1.1     skrll /* Ian Lance Taylor writes:
   5173      1.1     skrll 
   5174      1.1     skrll    We shouldn't be using % with a negative signed number.  That's just
   5175      1.1     skrll    not good.  We have to make sure either that the number is not
   5176      1.1     skrll    negative, or that the number has an unsigned type.  When the types
   5177      1.1     skrll    are all the same size they wind up as unsigned.  When file_ptr is a
   5178      1.1     skrll    larger signed type, the arithmetic winds up as signed long long,
   5179      1.1     skrll    which is wrong.
   5180      1.1     skrll 
   5181      1.1     skrll    What we're trying to say here is something like ``increase OFF by
   5182      1.1     skrll    the least amount that will cause it to be equal to the VMA modulo
   5183      1.1     skrll    the page size.''  */
   5184      1.1     skrll /* In other words, something like:
   5185      1.1     skrll 
   5186      1.1     skrll    vma_offset = m->sections[0]->vma % bed->maxpagesize;
   5187      1.1     skrll    off_offset = off % bed->maxpagesize;
   5188      1.1     skrll    if (vma_offset < off_offset)
   5189      1.1     skrll      adjustment = vma_offset + bed->maxpagesize - off_offset;
   5190      1.1     skrll    else
   5191  1.1.1.7  christos      adjustment = vma_offset - off_offset;
   5192      1.1     skrll 
   5193      1.1     skrll    which can be collapsed into the expression below.  */
   5194      1.1     skrll 
   5195      1.1     skrll static file_ptr
   5196  1.1.1.5  christos vma_page_aligned_bias (bfd_vma vma, ufile_ptr off, bfd_vma maxpagesize)
   5197  1.1.1.5  christos {
   5198  1.1.1.5  christos   /* PR binutils/16199: Handle an alignment of zero.  */
   5199      1.1     skrll   if (maxpagesize == 0)
   5200      1.1     skrll     maxpagesize = 1;
   5201      1.1     skrll   return ((vma - off) % maxpagesize);
   5202      1.1     skrll }
   5203      1.1     skrll 
   5204      1.1     skrll static void
   5205      1.1     skrll print_segment_map (const struct elf_segment_map *m)
   5206      1.1     skrll {
   5207      1.1     skrll   unsigned int j;
   5208      1.1     skrll   const char *pt = get_segment_type (m->p_type);
   5209      1.1     skrll   char buf[32];
   5210      1.1     skrll 
   5211      1.1     skrll   if (pt == NULL)
   5212      1.1     skrll     {
   5213      1.1     skrll       if (m->p_type >= PT_LOPROC && m->p_type <= PT_HIPROC)
   5214      1.1     skrll 	sprintf (buf, "LOPROC+%7.7x",
   5215      1.1     skrll 		 (unsigned int) (m->p_type - PT_LOPROC));
   5216      1.1     skrll       else if (m->p_type >= PT_LOOS && m->p_type <= PT_HIOS)
   5217      1.1     skrll 	sprintf (buf, "LOOS+%7.7x",
   5218      1.1     skrll 		 (unsigned int) (m->p_type - PT_LOOS));
   5219      1.1     skrll       else
   5220      1.1     skrll 	snprintf (buf, sizeof (buf), "%8.8x",
   5221      1.1     skrll 		  (unsigned int) m->p_type);
   5222  1.1.1.3  christos       pt = buf;
   5223      1.1     skrll     }
   5224      1.1     skrll   fflush (stdout);
   5225      1.1     skrll   fprintf (stderr, "%s:", pt);
   5226      1.1     skrll   for (j = 0; j < m->count; j++)
   5227  1.1.1.3  christos     fprintf (stderr, " %s", m->sections [j]->name);
   5228  1.1.1.3  christos   putc ('\n',stderr);
   5229  1.1.1.3  christos   fflush (stderr);
   5230  1.1.1.3  christos }
   5231  1.1.1.3  christos 
   5232  1.1.1.3  christos static bfd_boolean
   5233  1.1.1.3  christos write_zeros (bfd *abfd, file_ptr pos, bfd_size_type len)
   5234  1.1.1.3  christos {
   5235  1.1.1.3  christos   void *buf;
   5236  1.1.1.3  christos   bfd_boolean ret;
   5237  1.1.1.3  christos 
   5238  1.1.1.3  christos   if (bfd_seek (abfd, pos, SEEK_SET) != 0)
   5239  1.1.1.3  christos     return FALSE;
   5240  1.1.1.3  christos   buf = bfd_zmalloc (len);
   5241  1.1.1.3  christos   if (buf == NULL)
   5242  1.1.1.3  christos     return FALSE;
   5243  1.1.1.3  christos   ret = bfd_bwrite (buf, len, abfd) == len;
   5244      1.1     skrll   free (buf);
   5245      1.1     skrll   return ret;
   5246      1.1     skrll }
   5247      1.1     skrll 
   5248      1.1     skrll /* Assign file positions to the sections based on the mapping from
   5249      1.1     skrll    sections to segments.  This function also sets up some fields in
   5250      1.1     skrll    the file header.  */
   5251      1.1     skrll 
   5252      1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   5253      1.1     skrll assign_file_positions_for_load_sections (bfd *abfd,
   5254      1.1     skrll 					 struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
   5255      1.1     skrll {
   5256      1.1     skrll   const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   5257      1.1     skrll   struct elf_segment_map *m;
   5258      1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Phdr *phdrs;
   5259      1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Phdr *p;
   5260  1.1.1.7  christos   file_ptr off;
   5261      1.1     skrll   bfd_size_type maxpagesize;
   5262      1.1     skrll   unsigned int pt_load_count = 0;
   5263  1.1.1.2     skrll   unsigned int alloc;
   5264      1.1     skrll   unsigned int i, j;
   5265      1.1     skrll   bfd_vma header_pad = 0;
   5266      1.1     skrll 
   5267      1.1     skrll   if (link_info == NULL
   5268      1.1     skrll       && !_bfd_elf_map_sections_to_segments (abfd, link_info))
   5269      1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   5270  1.1.1.5  christos 
   5271  1.1.1.2     skrll   alloc = 0;
   5272  1.1.1.2     skrll   for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
   5273  1.1.1.2     skrll     {
   5274  1.1.1.2     skrll       ++alloc;
   5275  1.1.1.2     skrll       if (m->header_size)
   5276      1.1     skrll 	header_pad = m->header_size;
   5277  1.1.1.4  christos     }
   5278  1.1.1.4  christos 
   5279  1.1.1.4  christos   if (alloc)
   5280  1.1.1.4  christos     {
   5281  1.1.1.4  christos       elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phoff = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
   5282  1.1.1.4  christos       elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phentsize = bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
   5283  1.1.1.4  christos     }
   5284  1.1.1.4  christos   else
   5285  1.1.1.4  christos     {
   5286  1.1.1.4  christos       /* PR binutils/12467.  */
   5287  1.1.1.4  christos       elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phoff = 0;
   5288  1.1.1.4  christos       elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phentsize = 0;
   5289      1.1     skrll     }
   5290      1.1     skrll 
   5291  1.1.1.5  christos   elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum = alloc;
   5292  1.1.1.5  christos 
   5293      1.1     skrll   if (elf_program_header_size (abfd) == (bfd_size_type) -1)
   5294  1.1.1.5  christos     elf_program_header_size (abfd) = alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
   5295      1.1     skrll   else
   5296      1.1     skrll     BFD_ASSERT (elf_program_header_size (abfd)
   5297      1.1     skrll 		>= alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr);
   5298      1.1     skrll 
   5299  1.1.1.5  christos   if (alloc == 0)
   5300      1.1     skrll     {
   5301      1.1     skrll       elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
   5302      1.1     skrll       return TRUE;
   5303  1.1.1.5  christos     }
   5304  1.1.1.2     skrll 
   5305  1.1.1.2     skrll   /* We're writing the size in elf_program_header_size (abfd),
   5306  1.1.1.5  christos      see assign_file_positions_except_relocs, so make sure we have
   5307  1.1.1.5  christos      that amount allocated, with trailing space cleared.
   5308  1.1.1.2     skrll      The variable alloc contains the computed need, while
   5309  1.1.1.2     skrll      elf_program_header_size (abfd) contains the size used for the
   5310  1.1.1.2     skrll      layout.
   5311  1.1.1.2     skrll      See ld/emultempl/elf-generic.em:gld${EMULATION_NAME}_map_segments
   5312  1.1.1.5  christos      where the layout is forced to according to a larger size in the
   5313  1.1.1.2     skrll      last iterations for the testcase ld-elf/header.  */
   5314  1.1.1.3  christos   BFD_ASSERT (elf_program_header_size (abfd) % bed->s->sizeof_phdr
   5315  1.1.1.3  christos 	      == 0);
   5316  1.1.1.7  christos   phdrs = (Elf_Internal_Phdr *)
   5317  1.1.1.7  christos      bfd_zalloc2 (abfd,
   5318      1.1     skrll 		  (elf_program_header_size (abfd) / bed->s->sizeof_phdr),
   5319      1.1     skrll 		  sizeof (Elf_Internal_Phdr));
   5320      1.1     skrll   elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr = phdrs;
   5321      1.1     skrll   if (phdrs == NULL)
   5322      1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   5323      1.1     skrll 
   5324      1.1     skrll   maxpagesize = 1;
   5325      1.1     skrll   if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0)
   5326      1.1     skrll     maxpagesize = bed->maxpagesize;
   5327      1.1     skrll 
   5328  1.1.1.2     skrll   off = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
   5329  1.1.1.2     skrll   off += alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
   5330  1.1.1.2     skrll   if (header_pad < (bfd_vma) off)
   5331  1.1.1.2     skrll     header_pad = 0;
   5332  1.1.1.2     skrll   else
   5333      1.1     skrll     header_pad -= off;
   5334  1.1.1.5  christos   off += header_pad;
   5335      1.1     skrll 
   5336      1.1     skrll   for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd), p = phdrs, j = 0;
   5337      1.1     skrll        m != NULL;
   5338      1.1     skrll        m = m->next, p++, j++)
   5339      1.1     skrll     {
   5340      1.1     skrll       asection **secpp;
   5341      1.1     skrll       bfd_vma off_adjust;
   5342      1.1     skrll       bfd_boolean no_contents;
   5343      1.1     skrll 
   5344      1.1     skrll       /* If elf_segment_map is not from map_sections_to_segments, the
   5345      1.1     skrll 	 sections may not be correctly ordered.  NOTE: sorting should
   5346      1.1     skrll 	 not be done to the PT_NOTE section of a corefile, which may
   5347      1.1     skrll 	 contain several pseudo-sections artificially created by bfd.
   5348      1.1     skrll 	 Sorting these pseudo-sections breaks things badly.  */
   5349      1.1     skrll       if (m->count > 1
   5350      1.1     skrll 	  && !(elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_type == ET_CORE
   5351      1.1     skrll 	       && m->p_type == PT_NOTE))
   5352      1.1     skrll 	qsort (m->sections, (size_t) m->count, sizeof (asection *),
   5353      1.1     skrll 	       elf_sort_sections);
   5354      1.1     skrll 
   5355      1.1     skrll       /* An ELF segment (described by Elf_Internal_Phdr) may contain a
   5356      1.1     skrll 	 number of sections with contents contributing to both p_filesz
   5357      1.1     skrll 	 and p_memsz, followed by a number of sections with no contents
   5358      1.1     skrll 	 that just contribute to p_memsz.  In this loop, OFF tracks next
   5359      1.1     skrll 	 available file offset for PT_LOAD and PT_NOTE segments.  */
   5360      1.1     skrll       p->p_type = m->p_type;
   5361      1.1     skrll       p->p_flags = m->p_flags;
   5362      1.1     skrll 
   5363      1.1     skrll       if (m->count == 0)
   5364      1.1     skrll 	p->p_vaddr = 0;
   5365      1.1     skrll       else
   5366      1.1     skrll 	p->p_vaddr = m->sections[0]->vma - m->p_vaddr_offset;
   5367      1.1     skrll 
   5368      1.1     skrll       if (m->p_paddr_valid)
   5369      1.1     skrll 	p->p_paddr = m->p_paddr;
   5370      1.1     skrll       else if (m->count == 0)
   5371      1.1     skrll 	p->p_paddr = 0;
   5372      1.1     skrll       else
   5373      1.1     skrll 	p->p_paddr = m->sections[0]->lma - m->p_vaddr_offset;
   5374      1.1     skrll 
   5375      1.1     skrll       if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD
   5376      1.1     skrll 	  && (abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0)
   5377      1.1     skrll 	{
   5378      1.1     skrll 	  /* p_align in demand paged PT_LOAD segments effectively stores
   5379      1.1     skrll 	     the maximum page size.  When copying an executable with
   5380      1.1     skrll 	     objcopy, we set m->p_align from the input file.  Use this
   5381      1.1     skrll 	     value for maxpagesize rather than bed->maxpagesize, which
   5382      1.1     skrll 	     may be different.  Note that we use maxpagesize for PT_TLS
   5383      1.1     skrll 	     segment alignment later in this function, so we are relying
   5384      1.1     skrll 	     on at least one PT_LOAD segment appearing before a PT_TLS
   5385      1.1     skrll 	     segment.  */
   5386      1.1     skrll 	  if (m->p_align_valid)
   5387      1.1     skrll 	    maxpagesize = m->p_align;
   5388  1.1.1.7  christos 
   5389      1.1     skrll 	  p->p_align = maxpagesize;
   5390      1.1     skrll 	  pt_load_count += 1;
   5391      1.1     skrll 	}
   5392      1.1     skrll       else if (m->p_align_valid)
   5393      1.1     skrll 	p->p_align = m->p_align;
   5394      1.1     skrll       else if (m->count == 0)
   5395      1.1     skrll 	p->p_align = 1 << bed->s->log_file_align;
   5396      1.1     skrll       else
   5397      1.1     skrll 	p->p_align = 0;
   5398      1.1     skrll 
   5399      1.1     skrll       no_contents = FALSE;
   5400      1.1     skrll       off_adjust = 0;
   5401      1.1     skrll       if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD
   5402      1.1     skrll 	  && m->count > 0)
   5403      1.1     skrll 	{
   5404      1.1     skrll 	  bfd_size_type align;
   5405      1.1     skrll 	  unsigned int align_power = 0;
   5406      1.1     skrll 
   5407      1.1     skrll 	  if (m->p_align_valid)
   5408      1.1     skrll 	    align = p->p_align;
   5409      1.1     skrll 	  else
   5410      1.1     skrll 	    {
   5411      1.1     skrll 	      for (i = 0, secpp = m->sections; i < m->count; i++, secpp++)
   5412      1.1     skrll 		{
   5413      1.1     skrll 		  unsigned int secalign;
   5414      1.1     skrll 
   5415      1.1     skrll 		  secalign = bfd_get_section_alignment (abfd, *secpp);
   5416      1.1     skrll 		  if (secalign > align_power)
   5417      1.1     skrll 		    align_power = secalign;
   5418      1.1     skrll 		}
   5419      1.1     skrll 	      align = (bfd_size_type) 1 << align_power;
   5420      1.1     skrll 	      if (align < maxpagesize)
   5421      1.1     skrll 		align = maxpagesize;
   5422      1.1     skrll 	    }
   5423      1.1     skrll 
   5424      1.1     skrll 	  for (i = 0; i < m->count; i++)
   5425      1.1     skrll 	    if ((m->sections[i]->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS)) == 0)
   5426      1.1     skrll 	      /* If we aren't making room for this section, then
   5427      1.1     skrll 		 it must be SHT_NOBITS regardless of what we've
   5428      1.1     skrll 		 set via struct bfd_elf_special_section.  */
   5429      1.1     skrll 	      elf_section_type (m->sections[i]) = SHT_NOBITS;
   5430      1.1     skrll 
   5431      1.1     skrll 	  /* Find out whether this segment contains any loadable
   5432      1.1     skrll 	     sections.  */
   5433      1.1     skrll 	  no_contents = TRUE;
   5434      1.1     skrll 	  for (i = 0; i < m->count; i++)
   5435      1.1     skrll 	    if (elf_section_type (m->sections[i]) != SHT_NOBITS)
   5436      1.1     skrll 	      {
   5437      1.1     skrll 		no_contents = FALSE;
   5438      1.1     skrll 		break;
   5439  1.1.1.3  christos 	      }
   5440  1.1.1.7  christos 
   5441  1.1.1.7  christos 	  off_adjust = vma_page_aligned_bias (p->p_vaddr, off, align);
   5442  1.1.1.7  christos 
   5443  1.1.1.7  christos 	  /* Broken hardware and/or kernel require that files do not
   5444  1.1.1.7  christos 	     map the same page with different permissions on some hppa
   5445  1.1.1.7  christos 	     processors.  */
   5446  1.1.1.7  christos 	  if (pt_load_count > 1
   5447  1.1.1.7  christos 	      && bed->no_page_alias
   5448  1.1.1.7  christos 	      && (off & (maxpagesize - 1)) != 0
   5449      1.1     skrll 	      && (off & -maxpagesize) == ((off + off_adjust) & -maxpagesize))
   5450      1.1     skrll 	    off_adjust += maxpagesize;
   5451      1.1     skrll 	  off += off_adjust;
   5452      1.1     skrll 	  if (no_contents)
   5453      1.1     skrll 	    {
   5454      1.1     skrll 	      /* We shouldn't need to align the segment on disk since
   5455      1.1     skrll 		 the segment doesn't need file space, but the gABI
   5456      1.1     skrll 		 arguably requires the alignment and glibc ld.so
   5457      1.1     skrll 		 checks it.  So to comply with the alignment
   5458      1.1     skrll 		 requirement but not waste file space, we adjust
   5459      1.1     skrll 		 p_offset for just this segment.  (OFF_ADJUST is
   5460      1.1     skrll 		 subtracted from OFF later.)  This may put p_offset
   5461      1.1     skrll 		 past the end of file, but that shouldn't matter.  */
   5462      1.1     skrll 	    }
   5463      1.1     skrll 	  else
   5464      1.1     skrll 	    off_adjust = 0;
   5465      1.1     skrll 	}
   5466      1.1     skrll       /* Make sure the .dynamic section is the first section in the
   5467      1.1     skrll 	 PT_DYNAMIC segment.  */
   5468      1.1     skrll       else if (p->p_type == PT_DYNAMIC
   5469      1.1     skrll 	       && m->count > 1
   5470      1.1     skrll 	       && strcmp (m->sections[0]->name, ".dynamic") != 0)
   5471  1.1.1.8  christos 	{
   5472  1.1.1.7  christos 	  _bfd_error_handler
   5473      1.1     skrll 	    (_("%pB: The first section in the PT_DYNAMIC segment"
   5474      1.1     skrll 	       " is not the .dynamic section"),
   5475      1.1     skrll 	     abfd);
   5476      1.1     skrll 	  bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
   5477      1.1     skrll 	  return FALSE;
   5478      1.1     skrll 	}
   5479      1.1     skrll       /* Set the note section type to SHT_NOTE.  */
   5480      1.1     skrll       else if (p->p_type == PT_NOTE)
   5481      1.1     skrll 	for (i = 0; i < m->count; i++)
   5482      1.1     skrll 	  elf_section_type (m->sections[i]) = SHT_NOTE;
   5483      1.1     skrll 
   5484      1.1     skrll       p->p_offset = 0;
   5485      1.1     skrll       p->p_filesz = 0;
   5486      1.1     skrll       p->p_memsz = 0;
   5487      1.1     skrll 
   5488      1.1     skrll       if (m->includes_filehdr)
   5489      1.1     skrll 	{
   5490      1.1     skrll 	  if (!m->p_flags_valid)
   5491      1.1     skrll 	    p->p_flags |= PF_R;
   5492      1.1     skrll 	  p->p_filesz = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
   5493      1.1     skrll 	  p->p_memsz = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
   5494  1.1.1.7  christos 	  if (m->count > 0)
   5495  1.1.1.7  christos 	    {
   5496  1.1.1.7  christos 	      if (p->p_vaddr < (bfd_vma) off
   5497      1.1     skrll 		  || (!m->p_paddr_valid
   5498  1.1.1.7  christos 		      && p->p_paddr < (bfd_vma) off))
   5499  1.1.1.8  christos 		{
   5500  1.1.1.7  christos 		  _bfd_error_handler
   5501      1.1     skrll 		    (_("%pB: not enough room for program headers,"
   5502      1.1     skrll 		       " try linking with -N"),
   5503      1.1     skrll 		     abfd);
   5504      1.1     skrll 		  bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
   5505      1.1     skrll 		  return FALSE;
   5506      1.1     skrll 		}
   5507      1.1     skrll 
   5508      1.1     skrll 	      p->p_vaddr -= off;
   5509      1.1     skrll 	      if (!m->p_paddr_valid)
   5510      1.1     skrll 		p->p_paddr -= off;
   5511      1.1     skrll 	    }
   5512      1.1     skrll 	}
   5513      1.1     skrll 
   5514      1.1     skrll       if (m->includes_phdrs)
   5515      1.1     skrll 	{
   5516      1.1     skrll 	  if (!m->p_flags_valid)
   5517      1.1     skrll 	    p->p_flags |= PF_R;
   5518      1.1     skrll 
   5519      1.1     skrll 	  if (!m->includes_filehdr)
   5520      1.1     skrll 	    {
   5521      1.1     skrll 	      p->p_offset = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
   5522      1.1     skrll 
   5523      1.1     skrll 	      if (m->count > 0)
   5524      1.1     skrll 		{
   5525      1.1     skrll 		  p->p_vaddr -= off - p->p_offset;
   5526      1.1     skrll 		  if (!m->p_paddr_valid)
   5527      1.1     skrll 		    p->p_paddr -= off - p->p_offset;
   5528      1.1     skrll 		}
   5529      1.1     skrll 	    }
   5530      1.1     skrll 
   5531  1.1.1.2     skrll 	  p->p_filesz += alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
   5532  1.1.1.2     skrll 	  p->p_memsz += alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
   5533  1.1.1.2     skrll 	  if (m->count)
   5534  1.1.1.2     skrll 	    {
   5535  1.1.1.2     skrll 	      p->p_filesz += header_pad;
   5536      1.1     skrll 	      p->p_memsz += header_pad;
   5537      1.1     skrll 	    }
   5538      1.1     skrll 	}
   5539      1.1     skrll 
   5540      1.1     skrll       if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD
   5541      1.1     skrll 	  || (p->p_type == PT_NOTE && bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_core))
   5542      1.1     skrll 	{
   5543      1.1     skrll 	  if (!m->includes_filehdr && !m->includes_phdrs)
   5544      1.1     skrll 	    p->p_offset = off;
   5545      1.1     skrll 	  else
   5546      1.1     skrll 	    {
   5547      1.1     skrll 	      file_ptr adjust;
   5548      1.1     skrll 
   5549      1.1     skrll 	      adjust = off - (p->p_offset + p->p_filesz);
   5550      1.1     skrll 	      if (!no_contents)
   5551      1.1     skrll 		p->p_filesz += adjust;
   5552      1.1     skrll 	      p->p_memsz += adjust;
   5553      1.1     skrll 	    }
   5554      1.1     skrll 	}
   5555      1.1     skrll 
   5556      1.1     skrll       /* Set up p_filesz, p_memsz, p_align and p_flags from the section
   5557      1.1     skrll 	 maps.  Set filepos for sections in PT_LOAD segments, and in
   5558      1.1     skrll 	 core files, for sections in PT_NOTE segments.
   5559      1.1     skrll 	 assign_file_positions_for_non_load_sections will set filepos
   5560      1.1     skrll 	 for other sections and update p_filesz for other segments.  */
   5561      1.1     skrll       for (i = 0, secpp = m->sections; i < m->count; i++, secpp++)
   5562      1.1     skrll 	{
   5563      1.1     skrll 	  asection *sec;
   5564      1.1     skrll 	  bfd_size_type align;
   5565      1.1     skrll 	  Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
   5566      1.1     skrll 
   5567      1.1     skrll 	  sec = *secpp;
   5568      1.1     skrll 	  this_hdr = &elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr;
   5569      1.1     skrll 	  align = (bfd_size_type) 1 << bfd_get_section_alignment (abfd, sec);
   5570      1.1     skrll 
   5571      1.1     skrll 	  if ((p->p_type == PT_LOAD
   5572      1.1     skrll 	       || p->p_type == PT_TLS)
   5573      1.1     skrll 	      && (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS
   5574      1.1     skrll 		  || ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0
   5575      1.1     skrll 		      && ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) == 0
   5576  1.1.1.3  christos 			  || p->p_type == PT_TLS))))
   5577  1.1.1.3  christos 	    {
   5578  1.1.1.3  christos 	      bfd_vma p_start = p->p_paddr;
   5579  1.1.1.3  christos 	      bfd_vma p_end = p_start + p->p_memsz;
   5580  1.1.1.3  christos 	      bfd_vma s_start = sec->lma;
   5581  1.1.1.3  christos 	      bfd_vma adjust = s_start - p_end;
   5582  1.1.1.3  christos 
   5583  1.1.1.3  christos 	      if (adjust != 0
   5584      1.1     skrll 		  && (s_start < p_end
   5585  1.1.1.7  christos 		      || p_end < p_start))
   5586  1.1.1.7  christos 		{
   5587  1.1.1.8  christos 		  _bfd_error_handler
   5588  1.1.1.8  christos 		    /* xgettext:c-format */
   5589      1.1     skrll 		    (_("%pB: section %pA lma %#" PRIx64 " adjusted to %#" PRIx64),
   5590  1.1.1.3  christos 		     abfd, sec, (uint64_t) s_start, (uint64_t) p_end);
   5591      1.1     skrll 		  adjust = 0;
   5592      1.1     skrll 		  sec->lma = p_end;
   5593      1.1     skrll 		}
   5594      1.1     skrll 	      p->p_memsz += adjust;
   5595      1.1     skrll 
   5596  1.1.1.3  christos 	      if (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
   5597  1.1.1.3  christos 		{
   5598  1.1.1.3  christos 		  if (p->p_filesz + adjust < p->p_memsz)
   5599  1.1.1.7  christos 		    {
   5600  1.1.1.3  christos 		      /* We have a PROGBITS section following NOBITS ones.
   5601  1.1.1.3  christos 			 Allocate file space for the NOBITS section(s) and
   5602  1.1.1.3  christos 			 zero it.  */
   5603  1.1.1.3  christos 		      adjust = p->p_memsz - p->p_filesz;
   5604  1.1.1.3  christos 		      if (!write_zeros (abfd, off, adjust))
   5605      1.1     skrll 			return FALSE;
   5606      1.1     skrll 		    }
   5607      1.1     skrll 		  off += adjust;
   5608      1.1     skrll 		  p->p_filesz += adjust;
   5609      1.1     skrll 		}
   5610      1.1     skrll 	    }
   5611      1.1     skrll 
   5612      1.1     skrll 	  if (p->p_type == PT_NOTE && bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_core)
   5613      1.1     skrll 	    {
   5614      1.1     skrll 	      /* The section at i == 0 is the one that actually contains
   5615      1.1     skrll 		 everything.  */
   5616      1.1     skrll 	      if (i == 0)
   5617      1.1     skrll 		{
   5618      1.1     skrll 		  this_hdr->sh_offset = sec->filepos = off;
   5619      1.1     skrll 		  off += this_hdr->sh_size;
   5620      1.1     skrll 		  p->p_filesz = this_hdr->sh_size;
   5621      1.1     skrll 		  p->p_memsz = 0;
   5622      1.1     skrll 		  p->p_align = 1;
   5623      1.1     skrll 		}
   5624      1.1     skrll 	      else
   5625      1.1     skrll 		{
   5626      1.1     skrll 		  /* The rest are fake sections that shouldn't be written.  */
   5627      1.1     skrll 		  sec->filepos = 0;
   5628      1.1     skrll 		  sec->size = 0;
   5629      1.1     skrll 		  sec->flags = 0;
   5630      1.1     skrll 		  continue;
   5631      1.1     skrll 		}
   5632      1.1     skrll 	    }
   5633      1.1     skrll 	  else
   5634      1.1     skrll 	    {
   5635      1.1     skrll 	      if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD)
   5636      1.1     skrll 		{
   5637      1.1     skrll 		  this_hdr->sh_offset = sec->filepos = off;
   5638      1.1     skrll 		  if (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
   5639  1.1.1.3  christos 		    off += this_hdr->sh_size;
   5640  1.1.1.3  christos 		}
   5641  1.1.1.3  christos 	      else if (this_hdr->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS
   5642  1.1.1.3  christos 		       && (this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) != 0
   5643  1.1.1.3  christos 		       && this_hdr->sh_offset == 0)
   5644  1.1.1.3  christos 		{
   5645  1.1.1.3  christos 		  /* This is a .tbss section that didn't get a PT_LOAD.
   5646  1.1.1.3  christos 		     (See _bfd_elf_map_sections_to_segments "Create a
   5647  1.1.1.3  christos 		     final PT_LOAD".)  Set sh_offset to the value it
   5648  1.1.1.3  christos 		     would have if we had created a zero p_filesz and
   5649  1.1.1.3  christos 		     p_memsz PT_LOAD header for the section.  This
   5650  1.1.1.3  christos 		     also makes the PT_TLS header have the same
   5651  1.1.1.3  christos 		     p_offset value.  */
   5652  1.1.1.3  christos 		  bfd_vma adjust = vma_page_aligned_bias (this_hdr->sh_addr,
   5653  1.1.1.3  christos 							  off, align);
   5654      1.1     skrll 		  this_hdr->sh_offset = sec->filepos = off + adjust;
   5655      1.1     skrll 		}
   5656      1.1     skrll 
   5657      1.1     skrll 	      if (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
   5658      1.1     skrll 		{
   5659      1.1     skrll 		  p->p_filesz += this_hdr->sh_size;
   5660      1.1     skrll 		  /* A load section without SHF_ALLOC is something like
   5661      1.1     skrll 		     a note section in a PT_NOTE segment.  These take
   5662      1.1     skrll 		     file space but are not loaded into memory.  */
   5663      1.1     skrll 		  if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
   5664      1.1     skrll 		    p->p_memsz += this_hdr->sh_size;
   5665      1.1     skrll 		}
   5666      1.1     skrll 	      else if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
   5667      1.1     skrll 		{
   5668      1.1     skrll 		  if (p->p_type == PT_TLS)
   5669      1.1     skrll 		    p->p_memsz += this_hdr->sh_size;
   5670      1.1     skrll 
   5671      1.1     skrll 		  /* .tbss is special.  It doesn't contribute to p_memsz of
   5672      1.1     skrll 		     normal segments.  */
   5673      1.1     skrll 		  else if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) == 0)
   5674      1.1     skrll 		    p->p_memsz += this_hdr->sh_size;
   5675      1.1     skrll 		}
   5676      1.1     skrll 
   5677      1.1     skrll 	      if (align > p->p_align
   5678      1.1     skrll 		  && !m->p_align_valid
   5679      1.1     skrll 		  && (p->p_type != PT_LOAD
   5680      1.1     skrll 		      || (abfd->flags & D_PAGED) == 0))
   5681      1.1     skrll 		p->p_align = align;
   5682      1.1     skrll 	    }
   5683      1.1     skrll 
   5684      1.1     skrll 	  if (!m->p_flags_valid)
   5685      1.1     skrll 	    {
   5686      1.1     skrll 	      p->p_flags |= PF_R;
   5687      1.1     skrll 	      if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_EXECINSTR) != 0)
   5688      1.1     skrll 		p->p_flags |= PF_X;
   5689      1.1     skrll 	      if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_WRITE) != 0)
   5690      1.1     skrll 		p->p_flags |= PF_W;
   5691  1.1.1.5  christos 	    }
   5692      1.1     skrll 	}
   5693      1.1     skrll 
   5694      1.1     skrll       off -= off_adjust;
   5695      1.1     skrll 
   5696      1.1     skrll       /* Check that all sections are in a PT_LOAD segment.
   5697  1.1.1.3  christos 	 Don't check funky gdb generated core files.  */
   5698  1.1.1.3  christos       if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD && bfd_get_format (abfd) != bfd_core)
   5699      1.1     skrll 	{
   5700  1.1.1.3  christos 	  bfd_boolean check_vma = TRUE;
   5701  1.1.1.3  christos 
   5702  1.1.1.3  christos 	  for (i = 1; i < m->count; i++)
   5703  1.1.1.3  christos 	    if (m->sections[i]->vma == m->sections[i - 1]->vma
   5704  1.1.1.3  christos 		&& ELF_SECTION_SIZE (&(elf_section_data (m->sections[i])
   5705  1.1.1.3  christos 				       ->this_hdr), p) != 0
   5706      1.1     skrll 		&& ELF_SECTION_SIZE (&(elf_section_data (m->sections[i - 1])
   5707  1.1.1.3  christos 				       ->this_hdr), p) != 0)
   5708  1.1.1.3  christos 	      {
   5709  1.1.1.3  christos 		/* Looks like we have overlays packed into the segment.  */
   5710      1.1     skrll 		check_vma = FALSE;
   5711  1.1.1.3  christos 		break;
   5712  1.1.1.3  christos 	      }
   5713  1.1.1.3  christos 
   5714  1.1.1.3  christos 	  for (i = 0; i < m->count; i++)
   5715  1.1.1.3  christos 	    {
   5716  1.1.1.3  christos 	      Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
   5717  1.1.1.3  christos 	      asection *sec;
   5718  1.1.1.3  christos 
   5719  1.1.1.3  christos 	      sec = m->sections[i];
   5720  1.1.1.3  christos 	      this_hdr = &(elf_section_data(sec)->this_hdr);
   5721  1.1.1.3  christos 	      if (!ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT_1 (this_hdr, p, check_vma, 0)
   5722  1.1.1.7  christos 		  && !ELF_TBSS_SPECIAL (this_hdr, p))
   5723  1.1.1.7  christos 		{
   5724  1.1.1.8  christos 		  _bfd_error_handler
   5725  1.1.1.3  christos 		    /* xgettext:c-format */
   5726  1.1.1.3  christos 		    (_("%pB: section `%pA' can't be allocated in segment %d"),
   5727  1.1.1.3  christos 		     abfd, sec, j);
   5728  1.1.1.3  christos 		  print_segment_map (m);
   5729  1.1.1.3  christos 		}
   5730      1.1     skrll 	    }
   5731      1.1     skrll 	}
   5732  1.1.1.5  christos     }
   5733      1.1     skrll 
   5734      1.1     skrll   elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = off;
   5735      1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   5736      1.1     skrll }
   5737      1.1     skrll 
   5738      1.1     skrll /* Assign file positions for the other sections.  */
   5739      1.1     skrll 
   5740      1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   5741      1.1     skrll assign_file_positions_for_non_load_sections (bfd *abfd,
   5742      1.1     skrll 					     struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
   5743      1.1     skrll {
   5744  1.1.1.5  christos   const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   5745      1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Shdr **i_shdrpp;
   5746      1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Shdr **hdrpp, **end_hdrpp;
   5747      1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Phdr *phdrs;
   5748  1.1.1.4  christos   Elf_Internal_Phdr *p;
   5749      1.1     skrll   struct elf_segment_map *m;
   5750      1.1     skrll   struct elf_segment_map *hdrs_segment;
   5751      1.1     skrll   bfd_vma filehdr_vaddr, filehdr_paddr;
   5752      1.1     skrll   bfd_vma phdrs_vaddr, phdrs_paddr;
   5753      1.1     skrll   file_ptr off;
   5754      1.1     skrll   unsigned int count;
   5755  1.1.1.5  christos 
   5756  1.1.1.5  christos   i_shdrpp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
   5757  1.1.1.5  christos   end_hdrpp = i_shdrpp + elf_numsections (abfd);
   5758      1.1     skrll   off = elf_next_file_pos (abfd);
   5759      1.1     skrll   for (hdrpp = i_shdrpp + 1; hdrpp < end_hdrpp; hdrpp++)
   5760      1.1     skrll     {
   5761      1.1     skrll       Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
   5762      1.1     skrll 
   5763      1.1     skrll       hdr = *hdrpp;
   5764      1.1     skrll       if (hdr->bfd_section != NULL
   5765      1.1     skrll 	  && (hdr->bfd_section->filepos != 0
   5766      1.1     skrll 	      || (hdr->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS
   5767      1.1     skrll 		  && hdr->contents == NULL)))
   5768      1.1     skrll 	BFD_ASSERT (hdr->sh_offset == hdr->bfd_section->filepos);
   5769  1.1.1.4  christos       else if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
   5770  1.1.1.7  christos 	{
   5771  1.1.1.7  christos 	  if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
   5772  1.1.1.8  christos 	    _bfd_error_handler
   5773  1.1.1.4  christos 	      /* xgettext:c-format */
   5774  1.1.1.4  christos 	      (_("%pB: warning: allocated section `%s' not in segment"),
   5775  1.1.1.4  christos 	       abfd,
   5776  1.1.1.4  christos 	       (hdr->bfd_section == NULL
   5777      1.1     skrll 		? "*unknown*"
   5778      1.1     skrll 		: hdr->bfd_section->name));
   5779      1.1     skrll 	  /* We don't need to page align empty sections.  */
   5780      1.1     skrll 	  if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0 && hdr->sh_size != 0)
   5781      1.1     skrll 	    off += vma_page_aligned_bias (hdr->sh_addr, off,
   5782      1.1     skrll 					  bed->maxpagesize);
   5783      1.1     skrll 	  else
   5784      1.1     skrll 	    off += vma_page_aligned_bias (hdr->sh_addr, off,
   5785      1.1     skrll 					  hdr->sh_addralign);
   5786      1.1     skrll 	  off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off,
   5787      1.1     skrll 							   FALSE);
   5788      1.1     skrll 	}
   5789  1.1.1.5  christos       else if (((hdr->sh_type == SHT_REL || hdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
   5790  1.1.1.5  christos 		&& hdr->bfd_section == NULL)
   5791  1.1.1.5  christos 	       || (hdr->bfd_section != NULL
   5792  1.1.1.5  christos 		   && (hdr->bfd_section->flags & SEC_ELF_COMPRESS))
   5793  1.1.1.5  christos 		   /* Compress DWARF debug sections.  */
   5794  1.1.1.5  christos 	       || hdr == i_shdrpp[elf_onesymtab (abfd)]
   5795  1.1.1.5  christos 	       || (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) != NULL
   5796  1.1.1.5  christos 		   && hdr == i_shdrpp[elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd)->ndx])
   5797      1.1     skrll 	       || hdr == i_shdrpp[elf_strtab_sec (abfd)]
   5798      1.1     skrll 	       || hdr == i_shdrpp[elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd)])
   5799      1.1     skrll 	hdr->sh_offset = -1;
   5800      1.1     skrll       else
   5801      1.1     skrll 	off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
   5802      1.1     skrll     }
   5803      1.1     skrll 
   5804      1.1     skrll   /* Now that we have set the section file positions, we can set up
   5805      1.1     skrll      the file positions for the non PT_LOAD segments.  */
   5806      1.1     skrll   count = 0;
   5807      1.1     skrll   filehdr_vaddr = 0;
   5808      1.1     skrll   filehdr_paddr = 0;
   5809  1.1.1.4  christos   phdrs_vaddr = bed->maxpagesize + bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
   5810      1.1     skrll   phdrs_paddr = 0;
   5811  1.1.1.5  christos   hdrs_segment = NULL;
   5812      1.1     skrll   phdrs = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
   5813      1.1     skrll   for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd), p = phdrs; m != NULL; m = m->next, p++)
   5814      1.1     skrll     {
   5815      1.1     skrll       ++count;
   5816      1.1     skrll       if (p->p_type != PT_LOAD)
   5817      1.1     skrll 	continue;
   5818      1.1     skrll 
   5819      1.1     skrll       if (m->includes_filehdr)
   5820      1.1     skrll 	{
   5821      1.1     skrll 	  filehdr_vaddr = p->p_vaddr;
   5822      1.1     skrll 	  filehdr_paddr = p->p_paddr;
   5823      1.1     skrll 	}
   5824      1.1     skrll       if (m->includes_phdrs)
   5825      1.1     skrll 	{
   5826      1.1     skrll 	  phdrs_vaddr = p->p_vaddr;
   5827      1.1     skrll 	  phdrs_paddr = p->p_paddr;
   5828  1.1.1.4  christos 	  if (m->includes_filehdr)
   5829      1.1     skrll 	    {
   5830      1.1     skrll 	      hdrs_segment = m;
   5831      1.1     skrll 	      phdrs_vaddr += bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
   5832      1.1     skrll 	      phdrs_paddr += bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
   5833      1.1     skrll 	    }
   5834      1.1     skrll 	}
   5835  1.1.1.4  christos     }
   5836  1.1.1.4  christos 
   5837  1.1.1.4  christos   if (hdrs_segment != NULL && link_info != NULL)
   5838  1.1.1.4  christos     {
   5839  1.1.1.4  christos       /* There is a segment that contains both the file headers and the
   5840  1.1.1.4  christos 	 program headers, so provide a symbol __ehdr_start pointing there.
   5841  1.1.1.4  christos 	 A program can use this to examine itself robustly.  */
   5842  1.1.1.4  christos 
   5843  1.1.1.4  christos       struct elf_link_hash_entry *hash
   5844  1.1.1.4  christos 	= elf_link_hash_lookup (elf_hash_table (link_info), "__ehdr_start",
   5845  1.1.1.4  christos 				FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
   5846  1.1.1.4  christos       /* If the symbol was referenced and not defined, define it.  */
   5847  1.1.1.4  christos       if (hash != NULL
   5848  1.1.1.4  christos 	  && (hash->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new
   5849  1.1.1.4  christos 	      || hash->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
   5850  1.1.1.4  christos 	      || hash->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
   5851  1.1.1.4  christos 	      || hash->root.type == bfd_link_hash_common))
   5852  1.1.1.4  christos 	{
   5853  1.1.1.4  christos 	  asection *s = NULL;
   5854  1.1.1.4  christos 	  if (hdrs_segment->count != 0)
   5855  1.1.1.4  christos 	    /* The segment contains sections, so use the first one.  */
   5856  1.1.1.4  christos 	    s = hdrs_segment->sections[0];
   5857  1.1.1.5  christos 	  else
   5858  1.1.1.4  christos 	    /* Use the first (i.e. lowest-addressed) section in any segment.  */
   5859  1.1.1.4  christos 	    for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
   5860  1.1.1.4  christos 	      if (m->count != 0)
   5861  1.1.1.4  christos 		{
   5862  1.1.1.4  christos 		  s = m->sections[0];
   5863  1.1.1.4  christos 		  break;
   5864  1.1.1.4  christos 		}
   5865  1.1.1.4  christos 
   5866  1.1.1.4  christos 	  if (s != NULL)
   5867  1.1.1.4  christos 	    {
   5868  1.1.1.4  christos 	      hash->root.u.def.value = filehdr_vaddr - s->vma;
   5869  1.1.1.4  christos 	      hash->root.u.def.section = s;
   5870  1.1.1.4  christos 	    }
   5871  1.1.1.4  christos 	  else
   5872  1.1.1.4  christos 	    {
   5873  1.1.1.4  christos 	      hash->root.u.def.value = filehdr_vaddr;
   5874  1.1.1.4  christos 	      hash->root.u.def.section = bfd_abs_section_ptr;
   5875  1.1.1.4  christos 	    }
   5876  1.1.1.4  christos 
   5877  1.1.1.4  christos 	  hash->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
   5878  1.1.1.4  christos 	  hash->def_regular = 1;
   5879  1.1.1.4  christos 	  hash->non_elf = 0;
   5880  1.1.1.4  christos 	}
   5881  1.1.1.5  christos     }
   5882      1.1     skrll 
   5883      1.1     skrll   for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd), p = phdrs; m != NULL; m = m->next, p++)
   5884      1.1     skrll     {
   5885  1.1.1.8  christos       if (p->p_type == PT_GNU_RELRO)
   5886  1.1.1.8  christos 	{
   5887      1.1     skrll 	  bfd_vma start, end;
   5888      1.1     skrll 	  bfd_boolean ok;
   5889      1.1     skrll 
   5890      1.1     skrll 	  if (link_info != NULL)
   5891  1.1.1.8  christos 	    {
   5892  1.1.1.8  christos 	      /* During linking the range of the RELRO segment is passed
   5893  1.1.1.8  christos 		 in link_info.  Note that there may be padding between
   5894  1.1.1.8  christos 		 relro_start and the first RELRO section.  */
   5895  1.1.1.8  christos 	      start = link_info->relro_start;
   5896  1.1.1.8  christos 	      end = link_info->relro_end;
   5897  1.1.1.8  christos 	    }
   5898  1.1.1.8  christos 	  else if (m->count != 0)
   5899  1.1.1.8  christos 	    {
   5900  1.1.1.8  christos 	      if (!m->p_size_valid)
   5901  1.1.1.8  christos 		abort ();
   5902  1.1.1.8  christos 	      start = m->sections[0]->vma;
   5903  1.1.1.8  christos 	      end = start + m->p_size;
   5904  1.1.1.8  christos 	    }
   5905  1.1.1.8  christos 	  else
   5906  1.1.1.8  christos 	    {
   5907  1.1.1.8  christos 	      start = 0;
   5908  1.1.1.8  christos 	      end = 0;
   5909  1.1.1.8  christos 	    }
   5910  1.1.1.8  christos 
   5911  1.1.1.8  christos 	  ok = FALSE;
   5912  1.1.1.8  christos 	  if (start < end)
   5913  1.1.1.8  christos 	    {
   5914  1.1.1.8  christos 	      struct elf_segment_map *lm;
   5915  1.1.1.8  christos 	      const Elf_Internal_Phdr *lp;
   5916  1.1.1.8  christos 	      unsigned int i;
   5917  1.1.1.8  christos 
   5918  1.1.1.5  christos 	      /* Find a LOAD segment containing a section in the RELRO
   5919  1.1.1.4  christos 		 segment.  */
   5920  1.1.1.4  christos 	      for (lm = elf_seg_map (abfd), lp = phdrs;
   5921      1.1     skrll 		   lm != NULL;
   5922      1.1     skrll 		   lm = lm->next, lp++)
   5923  1.1.1.4  christos 		{
   5924  1.1.1.8  christos 		  if (lp->p_type == PT_LOAD
   5925  1.1.1.8  christos 		      && lm->count != 0
   5926  1.1.1.8  christos 		      && (lm->sections[lm->count - 1]->vma
   5927  1.1.1.8  christos 			  + (!IS_TBSS (lm->sections[lm->count - 1])
   5928  1.1.1.8  christos 			     ? lm->sections[lm->count - 1]->size
   5929      1.1     skrll 			     : 0)) > start
   5930      1.1     skrll 		      && lm->sections[0]->vma < end)
   5931  1.1.1.4  christos 		    break;
   5932  1.1.1.8  christos 		}
   5933      1.1     skrll 
   5934  1.1.1.8  christos 	      if (lm != NULL)
   5935  1.1.1.8  christos 		{
   5936  1.1.1.8  christos 		  /* Find the section starting the RELRO segment.  */
   5937  1.1.1.8  christos 		  for (i = 0; i < lm->count; i++)
   5938  1.1.1.8  christos 		    {
   5939  1.1.1.8  christos 		      asection *s = lm->sections[i];
   5940  1.1.1.8  christos 		      if (s->vma >= start
   5941  1.1.1.8  christos 			  && s->vma < end
   5942  1.1.1.8  christos 			  && s->size != 0)
   5943      1.1     skrll 			break;
   5944  1.1.1.8  christos 		    }
   5945  1.1.1.8  christos 
   5946  1.1.1.8  christos 		  if (i < lm->count)
   5947  1.1.1.8  christos 		    {
   5948  1.1.1.8  christos 		      p->p_vaddr = lm->sections[i]->vma;
   5949  1.1.1.8  christos 		      p->p_paddr = lm->sections[i]->lma;
   5950  1.1.1.8  christos 		      p->p_offset = lm->sections[i]->filepos;
   5951  1.1.1.8  christos 		      p->p_memsz = end - p->p_vaddr;
   5952  1.1.1.8  christos 		      p->p_filesz = p->p_memsz;
   5953  1.1.1.8  christos 
   5954  1.1.1.8  christos 		      /* The RELRO segment typically ends a few bytes
   5955  1.1.1.8  christos 			 into .got.plt but other layouts are possible.
   5956  1.1.1.8  christos 			 In cases where the end does not match any
   5957  1.1.1.8  christos 			 loaded section (for instance is in file
   5958  1.1.1.8  christos 			 padding), trim p_filesz back to correspond to
   5959  1.1.1.8  christos 			 the end of loaded section contents.  */
   5960  1.1.1.8  christos 		      if (p->p_filesz > lp->p_vaddr + lp->p_filesz - p->p_vaddr)
   5961  1.1.1.8  christos 			p->p_filesz = lp->p_vaddr + lp->p_filesz - p->p_vaddr;
   5962  1.1.1.8  christos 
   5963  1.1.1.8  christos 		      /* Preserve the alignment and flags if they are
   5964  1.1.1.8  christos 			 valid.  The gold linker generates RW/4 for
   5965  1.1.1.8  christos 			 the PT_GNU_RELRO section.  It is better for
   5966  1.1.1.8  christos 			 objcopy/strip to honor these attributes
   5967  1.1.1.8  christos 			 otherwise gdb will choke when using separate
   5968  1.1.1.8  christos 			 debug files.  */
   5969  1.1.1.8  christos 		      if (!m->p_align_valid)
   5970  1.1.1.8  christos 			p->p_align = 1;
   5971  1.1.1.8  christos 		      if (!m->p_flags_valid)
   5972  1.1.1.8  christos 			p->p_flags = PF_R;
   5973  1.1.1.8  christos 		      ok = TRUE;
   5974      1.1     skrll 		    }
   5975  1.1.1.8  christos 		}
   5976  1.1.1.8  christos 	    }
   5977  1.1.1.8  christos 	  if (link_info != NULL)
   5978  1.1.1.8  christos 	    BFD_ASSERT (ok);
   5979      1.1     skrll 	  if (!ok)
   5980  1.1.1.5  christos 	    memset (p, 0, sizeof *p);
   5981  1.1.1.5  christos 	}
   5982  1.1.1.5  christos       else if (p->p_type == PT_GNU_STACK)
   5983  1.1.1.5  christos 	{
   5984  1.1.1.5  christos 	  if (m->p_size_valid)
   5985      1.1     skrll 	    p->p_memsz = m->p_size;
   5986      1.1     skrll 	}
   5987  1.1.1.5  christos       else if (m->count != 0)
   5988  1.1.1.7  christos 	{
   5989      1.1     skrll 	  unsigned int i;
   5990      1.1     skrll 
   5991      1.1     skrll 	  if (p->p_type != PT_LOAD
   5992      1.1     skrll 	      && (p->p_type != PT_NOTE
   5993  1.1.1.7  christos 		  || bfd_get_format (abfd) != bfd_core))
   5994  1.1.1.7  christos 	    {
   5995  1.1.1.7  christos 	      /* A user specified segment layout may include a PHDR
   5996  1.1.1.7  christos 		 segment that overlaps with a LOAD segment...  */
   5997  1.1.1.7  christos 	      if (p->p_type == PT_PHDR)
   5998  1.1.1.7  christos 		{
   5999  1.1.1.7  christos 		  m->count = 0;
   6000  1.1.1.7  christos 		  continue;
   6001  1.1.1.5  christos 		}
   6002  1.1.1.5  christos 
   6003  1.1.1.5  christos 	      if (m->includes_filehdr || m->includes_phdrs)
   6004  1.1.1.7  christos 		{
   6005  1.1.1.8  christos 		  /* PR 17512: file: 2195325e.  */
   6006  1.1.1.7  christos 		  _bfd_error_handler
   6007  1.1.1.7  christos 		    (_("%pB: error: non-load segment %d includes file header "
   6008  1.1.1.5  christos 		       "and/or program header"),
   6009  1.1.1.5  christos 		     abfd, (int) (p - phdrs));
   6010      1.1     skrll 		  return FALSE;
   6011  1.1.1.3  christos 		}
   6012      1.1     skrll 
   6013  1.1.1.3  christos 	      p->p_filesz = 0;
   6014  1.1.1.3  christos 	      p->p_offset = m->sections[0]->filepos;
   6015  1.1.1.3  christos 	      for (i = m->count; i-- != 0;)
   6016  1.1.1.3  christos 		{
   6017  1.1.1.3  christos 		  asection *sect = m->sections[i];
   6018  1.1.1.3  christos 		  Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr = &elf_section_data (sect)->this_hdr;
   6019  1.1.1.3  christos 		  if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
   6020  1.1.1.3  christos 		    {
   6021  1.1.1.3  christos 		      p->p_filesz = (sect->filepos - m->sections[0]->filepos
   6022  1.1.1.3  christos 				     + hdr->sh_size);
   6023  1.1.1.3  christos 		      break;
   6024      1.1     skrll 		    }
   6025      1.1     skrll 		}
   6026      1.1     skrll 	    }
   6027      1.1     skrll 	}
   6028      1.1     skrll       else if (m->includes_filehdr)
   6029      1.1     skrll 	{
   6030      1.1     skrll 	  p->p_vaddr = filehdr_vaddr;
   6031      1.1     skrll 	  if (! m->p_paddr_valid)
   6032      1.1     skrll 	    p->p_paddr = filehdr_paddr;
   6033      1.1     skrll 	}
   6034      1.1     skrll       else if (m->includes_phdrs)
   6035      1.1     skrll 	{
   6036      1.1     skrll 	  p->p_vaddr = phdrs_vaddr;
   6037      1.1     skrll 	  if (! m->p_paddr_valid)
   6038      1.1     skrll 	    p->p_paddr = phdrs_paddr;
   6039      1.1     skrll 	}
   6040  1.1.1.5  christos     }
   6041      1.1     skrll 
   6042      1.1     skrll   elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = off;
   6043      1.1     skrll 
   6044      1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   6045  1.1.1.5  christos }
   6046  1.1.1.5  christos 
   6047  1.1.1.5  christos static elf_section_list *
   6048  1.1.1.5  christos find_section_in_list (unsigned int i, elf_section_list * list)
   6049  1.1.1.5  christos {
   6050  1.1.1.5  christos   for (;list != NULL; list = list->next)
   6051  1.1.1.5  christos     if (list->ndx == i)
   6052  1.1.1.5  christos       break;
   6053  1.1.1.5  christos   return list;
   6054      1.1     skrll }
   6055      1.1     skrll 
   6056      1.1     skrll /* Work out the file positions of all the sections.  This is called by
   6057      1.1     skrll    _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions.  All the section sizes and
   6058      1.1     skrll    VMAs must be known before this is called.
   6059      1.1     skrll 
   6060      1.1     skrll    Reloc sections come in two flavours: Those processed specially as
   6061      1.1     skrll    "side-channel" data attached to a section to which they apply, and
   6062      1.1     skrll    those that bfd doesn't process as relocations.  The latter sort are
   6063      1.1     skrll    stored in a normal bfd section by bfd_section_from_shdr.   We don't
   6064      1.1     skrll    consider the former sort here, unless they form part of the loadable
   6065      1.1     skrll    image.  Reloc sections not assigned here will be handled later by
   6066      1.1     skrll    assign_file_positions_for_relocs.
   6067      1.1     skrll 
   6068      1.1     skrll    We also don't set the positions of the .symtab and .strtab here.  */
   6069      1.1     skrll 
   6070      1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   6071      1.1     skrll assign_file_positions_except_relocs (bfd *abfd,
   6072      1.1     skrll 				     struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
   6073      1.1     skrll {
   6074      1.1     skrll   struct elf_obj_tdata *tdata = elf_tdata (abfd);
   6075      1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (abfd);
   6076      1.1     skrll   const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   6077      1.1     skrll 
   6078      1.1     skrll   if ((abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC)) == 0
   6079      1.1     skrll       && bfd_get_format (abfd) != bfd_core)
   6080      1.1     skrll     {
   6081      1.1     skrll       Elf_Internal_Shdr ** const i_shdrpp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
   6082      1.1     skrll       unsigned int num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
   6083  1.1.1.5  christos       Elf_Internal_Shdr **hdrpp;
   6084      1.1     skrll       unsigned int i;
   6085      1.1     skrll       file_ptr off;
   6086      1.1     skrll 
   6087      1.1     skrll       /* Start after the ELF header.  */
   6088      1.1     skrll       off = i_ehdrp->e_ehsize;
   6089      1.1     skrll 
   6090      1.1     skrll       /* We are not creating an executable, which means that we are
   6091      1.1     skrll 	 not creating a program header, and that the actual order of
   6092      1.1     skrll 	 the sections in the file is unimportant.  */
   6093      1.1     skrll       for (i = 1, hdrpp = i_shdrpp + 1; i < num_sec; i++, hdrpp++)
   6094      1.1     skrll 	{
   6095      1.1     skrll 	  Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
   6096      1.1     skrll 
   6097      1.1     skrll 	  hdr = *hdrpp;
   6098  1.1.1.5  christos 	  if (((hdr->sh_type == SHT_REL || hdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
   6099  1.1.1.5  christos 	       && hdr->bfd_section == NULL)
   6100  1.1.1.5  christos 	      || (hdr->bfd_section != NULL
   6101  1.1.1.5  christos 		  && (hdr->bfd_section->flags & SEC_ELF_COMPRESS))
   6102  1.1.1.5  christos 		  /* Compress DWARF debug sections.  */
   6103  1.1.1.5  christos 	      || i == elf_onesymtab (abfd)
   6104  1.1.1.5  christos 	      || (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) != NULL
   6105  1.1.1.5  christos 		  && hdr == i_shdrpp[elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd)->ndx])
   6106      1.1     skrll 	      || i == elf_strtab_sec (abfd)
   6107      1.1     skrll 	      || i == elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd))
   6108      1.1     skrll 	    {
   6109      1.1     skrll 	      hdr->sh_offset = -1;
   6110      1.1     skrll 	    }
   6111      1.1     skrll 	  else
   6112  1.1.1.5  christos 	    off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
   6113  1.1.1.5  christos 	}
   6114      1.1     skrll 
   6115      1.1     skrll       elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = off;
   6116      1.1     skrll     }
   6117      1.1     skrll   else
   6118      1.1     skrll     {
   6119      1.1     skrll       unsigned int alloc;
   6120      1.1     skrll 
   6121      1.1     skrll       /* Assign file positions for the loaded sections based on the
   6122      1.1     skrll 	 assignment of sections to segments.  */
   6123      1.1     skrll       if (!assign_file_positions_for_load_sections (abfd, link_info))
   6124      1.1     skrll 	return FALSE;
   6125      1.1     skrll 
   6126      1.1     skrll       /* And for non-load sections.  */
   6127      1.1     skrll       if (!assign_file_positions_for_non_load_sections (abfd, link_info))
   6128      1.1     skrll 	return FALSE;
   6129      1.1     skrll 
   6130      1.1     skrll       if (bed->elf_backend_modify_program_headers != NULL)
   6131      1.1     skrll 	{
   6132      1.1     skrll 	  if (!(*bed->elf_backend_modify_program_headers) (abfd, link_info))
   6133      1.1     skrll 	    return FALSE;
   6134  1.1.1.5  christos 	}
   6135  1.1.1.5  christos 
   6136  1.1.1.5  christos       /* Set e_type in ELF header to ET_EXEC for -pie -Ttext-segment=.  */
   6137  1.1.1.5  christos       if (link_info != NULL && bfd_link_pie (link_info))
   6138  1.1.1.5  christos 	{
   6139  1.1.1.5  christos 	  unsigned int num_segments = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum;
   6140  1.1.1.5  christos 	  Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
   6141  1.1.1.5  christos 	  Elf_Internal_Phdr *end_segment = &segment[num_segments];
   6142  1.1.1.5  christos 
   6143  1.1.1.5  christos 	  /* Find the lowest p_vaddr in PT_LOAD segments.  */
   6144  1.1.1.5  christos 	  bfd_vma p_vaddr = (bfd_vma) -1;
   6145  1.1.1.5  christos 	  for (; segment < end_segment; segment++)
   6146  1.1.1.5  christos 	    if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD && p_vaddr > segment->p_vaddr)
   6147  1.1.1.5  christos 	      p_vaddr = segment->p_vaddr;
   6148  1.1.1.5  christos 
   6149  1.1.1.5  christos 	  /* Set e_type to ET_EXEC if the lowest p_vaddr in PT_LOAD
   6150  1.1.1.5  christos 	     segments is non-zero.  */
   6151  1.1.1.5  christos 	  if (p_vaddr)
   6152  1.1.1.5  christos 	    i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_EXEC;
   6153      1.1     skrll 	}
   6154  1.1.1.8  christos 
   6155  1.1.1.7  christos       /* Write out the program headers.  */
   6156  1.1.1.7  christos       alloc = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum;
   6157  1.1.1.7  christos       if (alloc == 0)
   6158  1.1.1.7  christos 	return TRUE;
   6159  1.1.1.7  christos 
   6160  1.1.1.7  christos       /* PR ld/20815 - Check that the program header segment, if present, will
   6161  1.1.1.7  christos 	 be loaded into memory.  FIXME: The check below is not sufficient as
   6162  1.1.1.7  christos 	 really all PT_LOAD segments should be checked before issuing an error
   6163  1.1.1.7  christos 	 message.  Plus the PHDR segment does not have to be the first segment
   6164  1.1.1.7  christos 	 in the program header table.  But this version of the check should
   6165  1.1.1.7  christos 	 catch all real world use cases.
   6166  1.1.1.7  christos 
   6167  1.1.1.7  christos 	 FIXME: We used to have code here to sort the PT_LOAD segments into
   6168  1.1.1.7  christos 	 ascending order, as per the ELF spec.  But this breaks some programs,
   6169  1.1.1.7  christos 	 including the Linux kernel.  But really either the spec should be
   6170  1.1.1.7  christos 	 changed or the programs updated.  */
   6171  1.1.1.8  christos       if (alloc > 1
   6172  1.1.1.8  christos 	  && tdata->phdr[0].p_type == PT_PHDR
   6173  1.1.1.8  christos 	  && (bed->elf_backend_allow_non_load_phdr == NULL
   6174  1.1.1.7  christos 	      || !bed->elf_backend_allow_non_load_phdr (abfd, tdata->phdr,
   6175  1.1.1.7  christos 							alloc))
   6176  1.1.1.8  christos 	  && tdata->phdr[1].p_type == PT_LOAD
   6177  1.1.1.8  christos 	  && (tdata->phdr[1].p_vaddr > tdata->phdr[0].p_vaddr
   6178  1.1.1.7  christos 	      || (tdata->phdr[1].p_vaddr + tdata->phdr[1].p_memsz
   6179  1.1.1.7  christos 		  < tdata->phdr[0].p_vaddr + tdata->phdr[0].p_memsz)))
   6180  1.1.1.7  christos 	{
   6181  1.1.1.7  christos 	  /* The fix for this error is usually to edit the linker script being
   6182  1.1.1.8  christos 	     used and set up the program headers manually.  Either that or
   6183  1.1.1.8  christos 	     leave room for the headers at the start of the SECTIONS.  */
   6184  1.1.1.7  christos 	  _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: error: PHDR segment not covered"
   6185  1.1.1.7  christos 				" by LOAD segment"),
   6186  1.1.1.7  christos 			      abfd);
   6187  1.1.1.7  christos 	  return FALSE;
   6188      1.1     skrll 	}
   6189      1.1     skrll 
   6190      1.1     skrll       if (bfd_seek (abfd, (bfd_signed_vma) bed->s->sizeof_ehdr, SEEK_SET) != 0
   6191      1.1     skrll 	  || bed->s->write_out_phdrs (abfd, tdata->phdr, alloc) != 0)
   6192      1.1     skrll 	return FALSE;
   6193      1.1     skrll     }
   6194      1.1     skrll 
   6195      1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   6196      1.1     skrll }
   6197      1.1     skrll 
   6198      1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   6199  1.1.1.3  christos prep_headers (bfd *abfd)
   6200      1.1     skrll {
   6201      1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdrp;	/* Elf file header, internal form.  */
   6202      1.1     skrll   struct elf_strtab_hash *shstrtab;
   6203      1.1     skrll   const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   6204      1.1     skrll 
   6205      1.1     skrll   i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (abfd);
   6206      1.1     skrll 
   6207      1.1     skrll   shstrtab = _bfd_elf_strtab_init ();
   6208      1.1     skrll   if (shstrtab == NULL)
   6209      1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   6210      1.1     skrll 
   6211      1.1     skrll   elf_shstrtab (abfd) = shstrtab;
   6212      1.1     skrll 
   6213      1.1     skrll   i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_MAG0] = ELFMAG0;
   6214      1.1     skrll   i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_MAG1] = ELFMAG1;
   6215      1.1     skrll   i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_MAG2] = ELFMAG2;
   6216      1.1     skrll   i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_MAG3] = ELFMAG3;
   6217      1.1     skrll 
   6218      1.1     skrll   i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_CLASS] = bed->s->elfclass;
   6219      1.1     skrll   i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_DATA] =
   6220      1.1     skrll     bfd_big_endian (abfd) ? ELFDATA2MSB : ELFDATA2LSB;
   6221      1.1     skrll   i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_VERSION] = bed->s->ev_current;
   6222      1.1     skrll 
   6223      1.1     skrll   if ((abfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0)
   6224      1.1     skrll     i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_DYN;
   6225      1.1     skrll   else if ((abfd->flags & EXEC_P) != 0)
   6226      1.1     skrll     i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_EXEC;
   6227      1.1     skrll   else if (bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_core)
   6228      1.1     skrll     i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_CORE;
   6229      1.1     skrll   else
   6230      1.1     skrll     i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_REL;
   6231      1.1     skrll 
   6232      1.1     skrll   switch (bfd_get_arch (abfd))
   6233      1.1     skrll     {
   6234      1.1     skrll     case bfd_arch_unknown:
   6235      1.1     skrll       i_ehdrp->e_machine = EM_NONE;
   6236      1.1     skrll       break;
   6237      1.1     skrll 
   6238      1.1     skrll       /* There used to be a long list of cases here, each one setting
   6239      1.1     skrll 	 e_machine to the same EM_* macro #defined as ELF_MACHINE_CODE
   6240      1.1     skrll 	 in the corresponding bfd definition.  To avoid duplication,
   6241      1.1     skrll 	 the switch was removed.  Machines that need special handling
   6242      1.1     skrll 	 can generally do it in elf_backend_final_write_processing(),
   6243      1.1     skrll 	 unless they need the information earlier than the final write.
   6244      1.1     skrll 	 Such need can generally be supplied by replacing the tests for
   6245      1.1     skrll 	 e_machine with the conditions used to determine it.  */
   6246      1.1     skrll     default:
   6247      1.1     skrll       i_ehdrp->e_machine = bed->elf_machine_code;
   6248      1.1     skrll     }
   6249      1.1     skrll 
   6250      1.1     skrll   i_ehdrp->e_version = bed->s->ev_current;
   6251      1.1     skrll   i_ehdrp->e_ehsize = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
   6252      1.1     skrll 
   6253      1.1     skrll   /* No program header, for now.  */
   6254      1.1     skrll   i_ehdrp->e_phoff = 0;
   6255      1.1     skrll   i_ehdrp->e_phentsize = 0;
   6256      1.1     skrll   i_ehdrp->e_phnum = 0;
   6257      1.1     skrll 
   6258      1.1     skrll   /* Each bfd section is section header entry.  */
   6259      1.1     skrll   i_ehdrp->e_entry = bfd_get_start_address (abfd);
   6260      1.1     skrll   i_ehdrp->e_shentsize = bed->s->sizeof_shdr;
   6261      1.1     skrll 
   6262      1.1     skrll   /* If we're building an executable, we'll need a program header table.  */
   6263      1.1     skrll   if (abfd->flags & EXEC_P)
   6264      1.1     skrll     /* It all happens later.  */
   6265      1.1     skrll     ;
   6266      1.1     skrll   else
   6267      1.1     skrll     {
   6268      1.1     skrll       i_ehdrp->e_phentsize = 0;
   6269      1.1     skrll       i_ehdrp->e_phoff = 0;
   6270      1.1     skrll     }
   6271      1.1     skrll 
   6272      1.1     skrll   elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr.sh_name =
   6273      1.1     skrll     (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (shstrtab, ".symtab", FALSE);
   6274      1.1     skrll   elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr.sh_name =
   6275      1.1     skrll     (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (shstrtab, ".strtab", FALSE);
   6276      1.1     skrll   elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr.sh_name =
   6277  1.1.1.5  christos     (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (shstrtab, ".shstrtab", FALSE);
   6278      1.1     skrll   if (elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr.sh_name == (unsigned int) -1
   6279      1.1     skrll       || elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr.sh_name == (unsigned int) -1
   6280      1.1     skrll       || elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr.sh_name == (unsigned int) -1)
   6281      1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   6282      1.1     skrll 
   6283      1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   6284      1.1     skrll }
   6285  1.1.1.5  christos 
   6286      1.1     skrll /* Assign file positions for all the reloc sections which are not part
   6287  1.1.1.5  christos    of the loadable file image, and the file position of section headers.  */
   6288  1.1.1.5  christos 
   6289      1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   6290      1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load (bfd *abfd)
   6291  1.1.1.5  christos {
   6292  1.1.1.5  christos   file_ptr off;
   6293  1.1.1.5  christos   Elf_Internal_Shdr **shdrpp, **end_shdrpp;
   6294  1.1.1.5  christos   Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdrp;
   6295      1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdrp;
   6296  1.1.1.5  christos   const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
   6297      1.1     skrll 
   6298  1.1.1.5  christos   off = elf_next_file_pos (abfd);
   6299  1.1.1.5  christos 
   6300  1.1.1.5  christos   shdrpp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
   6301      1.1     skrll   end_shdrpp = shdrpp + elf_numsections (abfd);
   6302      1.1     skrll   for (shdrpp++; shdrpp < end_shdrpp; shdrpp++)
   6303  1.1.1.5  christos     {
   6304  1.1.1.5  christos       shdrp = *shdrpp;
   6305  1.1.1.5  christos       if (shdrp->sh_offset == -1)
   6306  1.1.1.5  christos 	{
   6307  1.1.1.5  christos 	  asection *sec = shdrp->bfd_section;
   6308  1.1.1.5  christos 	  bfd_boolean is_rel = (shdrp->sh_type == SHT_REL
   6309  1.1.1.5  christos 				|| shdrp->sh_type == SHT_RELA);
   6310  1.1.1.5  christos 	  if (is_rel
   6311  1.1.1.5  christos 	      || (sec != NULL && (sec->flags & SEC_ELF_COMPRESS)))
   6312  1.1.1.5  christos 	    {
   6313  1.1.1.5  christos 	      if (!is_rel)
   6314  1.1.1.5  christos 		{
   6315  1.1.1.5  christos 		  const char *name = sec->name;
   6316  1.1.1.5  christos 		  struct bfd_elf_section_data *d;
   6317  1.1.1.5  christos 
   6318  1.1.1.5  christos 		  /* Compress DWARF debug sections.  */
   6319  1.1.1.5  christos 		  if (!bfd_compress_section (abfd, sec,
   6320  1.1.1.5  christos 					     shdrp->contents))
   6321  1.1.1.5  christos 		    return FALSE;
   6322  1.1.1.5  christos 
   6323  1.1.1.5  christos 		  if (sec->compress_status == COMPRESS_SECTION_DONE
   6324  1.1.1.5  christos 		      && (abfd->flags & BFD_COMPRESS_GABI) == 0)
   6325  1.1.1.5  christos 		    {
   6326  1.1.1.5  christos 		      /* If section is compressed with zlib-gnu, convert
   6327  1.1.1.5  christos 			 section name from .debug_* to .zdebug_*.  */
   6328  1.1.1.5  christos 		      char *new_name
   6329  1.1.1.5  christos 			= convert_debug_to_zdebug (abfd, name);
   6330  1.1.1.5  christos 		      if (new_name == NULL)
   6331  1.1.1.5  christos 			return FALSE;
   6332  1.1.1.7  christos 		      name = new_name;
   6333  1.1.1.5  christos 		    }
   6334  1.1.1.5  christos 		  /* Add section name to section name section.  */
   6335  1.1.1.5  christos 		  if (shdrp->sh_name != (unsigned int) -1)
   6336  1.1.1.5  christos 		    abort ();
   6337  1.1.1.5  christos 		  shdrp->sh_name
   6338  1.1.1.5  christos 		    = (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (elf_shstrtab (abfd),
   6339  1.1.1.5  christos 							  name, FALSE);
   6340  1.1.1.7  christos 		  d = elf_section_data (sec);
   6341  1.1.1.5  christos 
   6342  1.1.1.5  christos 		  /* Add reloc section name to section name section.  */
   6343  1.1.1.5  christos 		  if (d->rel.hdr
   6344  1.1.1.5  christos 		      && !_bfd_elf_set_reloc_sh_name (abfd,
   6345  1.1.1.5  christos 						      d->rel.hdr,
   6346  1.1.1.5  christos 						      name, FALSE))
   6347  1.1.1.5  christos 		    return FALSE;
   6348  1.1.1.5  christos 		  if (d->rela.hdr
   6349  1.1.1.5  christos 		      && !_bfd_elf_set_reloc_sh_name (abfd,
   6350  1.1.1.5  christos 						      d->rela.hdr,
   6351  1.1.1.5  christos 						      name, TRUE))
   6352  1.1.1.5  christos 		    return FALSE;
   6353  1.1.1.5  christos 
   6354  1.1.1.5  christos 		  /* Update section size and contents.  */
   6355  1.1.1.5  christos 		  shdrp->sh_size = sec->size;
   6356  1.1.1.5  christos 		  shdrp->contents = sec->contents;
   6357  1.1.1.5  christos 		  shdrp->bfd_section->contents = NULL;
   6358  1.1.1.5  christos 		}
   6359  1.1.1.5  christos 	      off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (shdrp,
   6360  1.1.1.5  christos 							       off,
   6361  1.1.1.5  christos 							       TRUE);
   6362      1.1     skrll 	    }
   6363      1.1     skrll 	}
   6364  1.1.1.5  christos     }
   6365  1.1.1.5  christos 
   6366  1.1.1.5  christos   /* Place section name section after DWARF debug sections have been
   6367  1.1.1.5  christos      compressed.  */
   6368  1.1.1.5  christos   _bfd_elf_strtab_finalize (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
   6369  1.1.1.5  christos   shdrp = &elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr;
   6370  1.1.1.5  christos   shdrp->sh_size = _bfd_elf_strtab_size (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
   6371  1.1.1.5  christos   off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (shdrp, off, TRUE);
   6372  1.1.1.5  christos 
   6373  1.1.1.5  christos   /* Place the section headers.  */
   6374  1.1.1.5  christos   i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (abfd);
   6375  1.1.1.5  christos   bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   6376  1.1.1.5  christos   off = align_file_position (off, 1 << bed->s->log_file_align);
   6377  1.1.1.5  christos   i_ehdrp->e_shoff = off;
   6378  1.1.1.5  christos   off += i_ehdrp->e_shnum * i_ehdrp->e_shentsize;
   6379  1.1.1.5  christos   elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = off;
   6380      1.1     skrll 
   6381      1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   6382      1.1     skrll }
   6383      1.1     skrll 
   6384      1.1     skrll bfd_boolean
   6385      1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_write_object_contents (bfd *abfd)
   6386      1.1     skrll {
   6387      1.1     skrll   const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   6388      1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Shdr **i_shdrp;
   6389  1.1.1.5  christos   bfd_boolean failed;
   6390      1.1     skrll   unsigned int count, num_sec;
   6391      1.1     skrll   struct elf_obj_tdata *t;
   6392      1.1     skrll 
   6393      1.1     skrll   if (! abfd->output_has_begun
   6394      1.1     skrll       && ! _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions (abfd, NULL))
   6395      1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   6396      1.1     skrll 
   6397      1.1     skrll   i_shdrp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
   6398      1.1     skrll 
   6399      1.1     skrll   failed = FALSE;
   6400      1.1     skrll   bfd_map_over_sections (abfd, bed->s->write_relocs, &failed);
   6401      1.1     skrll   if (failed)
   6402  1.1.1.5  christos     return FALSE;
   6403  1.1.1.5  christos 
   6404      1.1     skrll   if (!_bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load (abfd))
   6405      1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   6406      1.1     skrll 
   6407      1.1     skrll   /* After writing the headers, we need to write the sections too...  */
   6408      1.1     skrll   num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
   6409  1.1.1.5  christos   for (count = 1; count < num_sec; count++)
   6410  1.1.1.5  christos     {
   6411  1.1.1.5  christos       i_shdrp[count]->sh_name
   6412      1.1     skrll 	= _bfd_elf_strtab_offset (elf_shstrtab (abfd),
   6413  1.1.1.8  christos 				  i_shdrp[count]->sh_name);
   6414  1.1.1.8  christos       if (bed->elf_backend_section_processing)
   6415      1.1     skrll 	if (!(*bed->elf_backend_section_processing) (abfd, i_shdrp[count]))
   6416      1.1     skrll 	  return FALSE;
   6417      1.1     skrll       if (i_shdrp[count]->contents)
   6418      1.1     skrll 	{
   6419      1.1     skrll 	  bfd_size_type amt = i_shdrp[count]->sh_size;
   6420      1.1     skrll 
   6421      1.1     skrll 	  if (bfd_seek (abfd, i_shdrp[count]->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
   6422      1.1     skrll 	      || bfd_bwrite (i_shdrp[count]->contents, amt, abfd) != amt)
   6423      1.1     skrll 	    return FALSE;
   6424      1.1     skrll 	}
   6425      1.1     skrll     }
   6426  1.1.1.5  christos 
   6427      1.1     skrll   /* Write out the section header names.  */
   6428  1.1.1.5  christos   t = elf_tdata (abfd);
   6429      1.1     skrll   if (elf_shstrtab (abfd) != NULL
   6430      1.1     skrll       && (bfd_seek (abfd, t->shstrtab_hdr.sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
   6431      1.1     skrll 	  || !_bfd_elf_strtab_emit (abfd, elf_shstrtab (abfd))))
   6432      1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   6433  1.1.1.5  christos 
   6434      1.1     skrll   if (bed->elf_backend_final_write_processing)
   6435      1.1     skrll     (*bed->elf_backend_final_write_processing) (abfd, elf_linker (abfd));
   6436      1.1     skrll 
   6437      1.1     skrll   if (!bed->s->write_shdrs_and_ehdr (abfd))
   6438      1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   6439  1.1.1.5  christos 
   6440  1.1.1.5  christos   /* This is last since write_shdrs_and_ehdr can touch i_shdrp[0].  */
   6441      1.1     skrll   if (t->o->build_id.after_write_object_contents != NULL)
   6442      1.1     skrll     return (*t->o->build_id.after_write_object_contents) (abfd);
   6443      1.1     skrll 
   6444      1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   6445      1.1     skrll }
   6446      1.1     skrll 
   6447      1.1     skrll bfd_boolean
   6448      1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_write_corefile_contents (bfd *abfd)
   6449      1.1     skrll {
   6450      1.1     skrll   /* Hopefully this can be done just like an object file.  */
   6451      1.1     skrll   return _bfd_elf_write_object_contents (abfd);
   6452      1.1     skrll }
   6453      1.1     skrll 
   6454      1.1     skrll /* Given a section, search the header to find them.  */
   6455      1.1     skrll 
   6456      1.1     skrll unsigned int
   6457      1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_section *asect)
   6458  1.1.1.3  christos {
   6459      1.1     skrll   const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
   6460      1.1     skrll   unsigned int sec_index;
   6461      1.1     skrll 
   6462      1.1     skrll   if (elf_section_data (asect) != NULL
   6463      1.1     skrll       && elf_section_data (asect)->this_idx != 0)
   6464      1.1     skrll     return elf_section_data (asect)->this_idx;
   6465  1.1.1.3  christos 
   6466      1.1     skrll   if (bfd_is_abs_section (asect))
   6467  1.1.1.3  christos     sec_index = SHN_ABS;
   6468      1.1     skrll   else if (bfd_is_com_section (asect))
   6469  1.1.1.3  christos     sec_index = SHN_COMMON;
   6470      1.1     skrll   else if (bfd_is_und_section (asect))
   6471  1.1.1.3  christos     sec_index = SHN_UNDEF;
   6472      1.1     skrll   else
   6473      1.1     skrll     sec_index = SHN_BAD;
   6474      1.1     skrll 
   6475      1.1     skrll   bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   6476  1.1.1.3  christos   if (bed->elf_backend_section_from_bfd_section)
   6477      1.1     skrll     {
   6478      1.1     skrll       int retval = sec_index;
   6479      1.1     skrll 
   6480      1.1     skrll       if ((*bed->elf_backend_section_from_bfd_section) (abfd, asect, &retval))
   6481      1.1     skrll 	return retval;
   6482  1.1.1.3  christos     }
   6483      1.1     skrll 
   6484      1.1     skrll   if (sec_index == SHN_BAD)
   6485  1.1.1.3  christos     bfd_set_error (bfd_error_nonrepresentable_section);
   6486      1.1     skrll 
   6487      1.1     skrll   return sec_index;
   6488      1.1     skrll }
   6489      1.1     skrll 
   6490      1.1     skrll /* Given a BFD symbol, return the index in the ELF symbol table, or -1
   6491      1.1     skrll    on error.  */
   6492      1.1     skrll 
   6493      1.1     skrll int
   6494      1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_symbol_from_bfd_symbol (bfd *abfd, asymbol **asym_ptr_ptr)
   6495      1.1     skrll {
   6496      1.1     skrll   asymbol *asym_ptr = *asym_ptr_ptr;
   6497      1.1     skrll   int idx;
   6498      1.1     skrll   flagword flags = asym_ptr->flags;
   6499      1.1     skrll 
   6500      1.1     skrll   /* When gas creates relocations against local labels, it creates its
   6501      1.1     skrll      own symbol for the section, but does put the symbol into the
   6502      1.1     skrll      symbol chain, so udata is 0.  When the linker is generating
   6503      1.1     skrll      relocatable output, this section symbol may be for one of the
   6504      1.1     skrll      input sections rather than the output section.  */
   6505      1.1     skrll   if (asym_ptr->udata.i == 0
   6506      1.1     skrll       && (flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM)
   6507      1.1     skrll       && asym_ptr->section)
   6508      1.1     skrll     {
   6509      1.1     skrll       asection *sec;
   6510      1.1     skrll       int indx;
   6511      1.1     skrll 
   6512      1.1     skrll       sec = asym_ptr->section;
   6513      1.1     skrll       if (sec->owner != abfd && sec->output_section != NULL)
   6514      1.1     skrll 	sec = sec->output_section;
   6515      1.1     skrll       if (sec->owner == abfd
   6516      1.1     skrll 	  && (indx = sec->index) < elf_num_section_syms (abfd)
   6517      1.1     skrll 	  && elf_section_syms (abfd)[indx] != NULL)
   6518      1.1     skrll 	asym_ptr->udata.i = elf_section_syms (abfd)[indx]->udata.i;
   6519      1.1     skrll     }
   6520      1.1     skrll 
   6521      1.1     skrll   idx = asym_ptr->udata.i;
   6522      1.1     skrll 
   6523      1.1     skrll   if (idx == 0)
   6524      1.1     skrll     {
   6525  1.1.1.7  christos       /* This case can occur when using --strip-symbol on a symbol
   6526  1.1.1.7  christos 	 which is used in a relocation entry.  */
   6527  1.1.1.8  christos       _bfd_error_handler
   6528      1.1     skrll 	/* xgettext:c-format */
   6529      1.1     skrll 	(_("%pB: symbol `%s' required but not present"),
   6530      1.1     skrll 	 abfd, bfd_asymbol_name (asym_ptr));
   6531      1.1     skrll       bfd_set_error (bfd_error_no_symbols);
   6532      1.1     skrll       return -1;
   6533      1.1     skrll     }
   6534      1.1     skrll 
   6535      1.1     skrll #if DEBUG & 4
   6536  1.1.1.7  christos   {
   6537  1.1.1.7  christos     fprintf (stderr,
   6538      1.1     skrll 	     "elf_symbol_from_bfd_symbol 0x%.8lx, name = %s, sym num = %d, flags = 0x%.8x\n",
   6539      1.1     skrll 	     (long) asym_ptr, asym_ptr->name, idx, flags);
   6540      1.1     skrll     fflush (stderr);
   6541      1.1     skrll   }
   6542      1.1     skrll #endif
   6543      1.1     skrll 
   6544      1.1     skrll   return idx;
   6545      1.1     skrll }
   6546      1.1     skrll 
   6547      1.1     skrll /* Rewrite program header information.  */
   6548      1.1     skrll 
   6549      1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   6550      1.1     skrll rewrite_elf_program_header (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
   6551      1.1     skrll {
   6552      1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Ehdr *iehdr;
   6553      1.1     skrll   struct elf_segment_map *map;
   6554      1.1     skrll   struct elf_segment_map *map_first;
   6555      1.1     skrll   struct elf_segment_map **pointer_to_map;
   6556      1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment;
   6557      1.1     skrll   asection *section;
   6558      1.1     skrll   unsigned int i;
   6559      1.1     skrll   unsigned int num_segments;
   6560      1.1     skrll   bfd_boolean phdr_included = FALSE;
   6561      1.1     skrll   bfd_boolean p_paddr_valid;
   6562      1.1     skrll   bfd_vma maxpagesize;
   6563      1.1     skrll   struct elf_segment_map *phdr_adjust_seg = NULL;
   6564      1.1     skrll   unsigned int phdr_adjust_num = 0;
   6565      1.1     skrll   const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
   6566      1.1     skrll 
   6567      1.1     skrll   bed = get_elf_backend_data (ibfd);
   6568      1.1     skrll   iehdr = elf_elfheader (ibfd);
   6569      1.1     skrll 
   6570      1.1     skrll   map_first = NULL;
   6571      1.1     skrll   pointer_to_map = &map_first;
   6572      1.1     skrll 
   6573      1.1     skrll   num_segments = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_phnum;
   6574      1.1     skrll   maxpagesize = get_elf_backend_data (obfd)->maxpagesize;
   6575      1.1     skrll 
   6576      1.1     skrll   /* Returns the end address of the segment + 1.  */
   6577      1.1     skrll #define SEGMENT_END(segment, start)					\
   6578      1.1     skrll   (start + (segment->p_memsz > segment->p_filesz			\
   6579      1.1     skrll 	    ? segment->p_memsz : segment->p_filesz))
   6580      1.1     skrll 
   6581      1.1     skrll #define SECTION_SIZE(section, segment)					\
   6582      1.1     skrll   (((section->flags & (SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL))		\
   6583      1.1     skrll     != SEC_THREAD_LOCAL || segment->p_type == PT_TLS)			\
   6584      1.1     skrll    ? section->size : 0)
   6585      1.1     skrll 
   6586      1.1     skrll   /* Returns TRUE if the given section is contained within
   6587      1.1     skrll      the given segment.  VMA addresses are compared.  */
   6588      1.1     skrll #define IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA(section, segment)				\
   6589      1.1     skrll   (section->vma >= segment->p_vaddr					\
   6590      1.1     skrll    && (section->vma + SECTION_SIZE (section, segment)			\
   6591      1.1     skrll        <= (SEGMENT_END (segment, segment->p_vaddr))))
   6592      1.1     skrll 
   6593      1.1     skrll   /* Returns TRUE if the given section is contained within
   6594      1.1     skrll      the given segment.  LMA addresses are compared.  */
   6595      1.1     skrll #define IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA(section, segment, base)			\
   6596      1.1     skrll   (section->lma >= base							\
   6597      1.1     skrll    && (section->lma + SECTION_SIZE (section, segment)			\
   6598      1.1     skrll        <= SEGMENT_END (segment, base)))
   6599      1.1     skrll 
   6600      1.1     skrll   /* Handle PT_NOTE segment.  */
   6601      1.1     skrll #define IS_NOTE(p, s)							\
   6602      1.1     skrll   (p->p_type == PT_NOTE							\
   6603      1.1     skrll    && elf_section_type (s) == SHT_NOTE					\
   6604      1.1     skrll    && (bfd_vma) s->filepos >= p->p_offset				\
   6605      1.1     skrll    && ((bfd_vma) s->filepos + s->size					\
   6606      1.1     skrll        <= p->p_offset + p->p_filesz))
   6607      1.1     skrll 
   6608      1.1     skrll   /* Special case: corefile "NOTE" section containing regs, prpsinfo
   6609      1.1     skrll      etc.  */
   6610      1.1     skrll #define IS_COREFILE_NOTE(p, s)						\
   6611      1.1     skrll   (IS_NOTE (p, s)							\
   6612      1.1     skrll    && bfd_get_format (ibfd) == bfd_core					\
   6613      1.1     skrll    && s->vma == 0							\
   6614      1.1     skrll    && s->lma == 0)
   6615      1.1     skrll 
   6616      1.1     skrll   /* The complicated case when p_vaddr is 0 is to handle the Solaris
   6617      1.1     skrll      linker, which generates a PT_INTERP section with p_vaddr and
   6618      1.1     skrll      p_memsz set to 0.  */
   6619      1.1     skrll #define IS_SOLARIS_PT_INTERP(p, s)					\
   6620      1.1     skrll   (p->p_vaddr == 0							\
   6621      1.1     skrll    && p->p_paddr == 0							\
   6622      1.1     skrll    && p->p_memsz == 0							\
   6623      1.1     skrll    && p->p_filesz > 0							\
   6624      1.1     skrll    && (s->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) != 0				\
   6625      1.1     skrll    && s->size > 0							\
   6626      1.1     skrll    && (bfd_vma) s->filepos >= p->p_offset				\
   6627      1.1     skrll    && ((bfd_vma) s->filepos + s->size					\
   6628      1.1     skrll        <= p->p_offset + p->p_filesz))
   6629      1.1     skrll 
   6630      1.1     skrll   /* Decide if the given section should be included in the given segment.
   6631      1.1     skrll      A section will be included if:
   6632      1.1     skrll        1. It is within the address space of the segment -- we use the LMA
   6633  1.1.1.4  christos 	  if that is set for the segment and the VMA otherwise,
   6634      1.1     skrll        2. It is an allocated section or a NOTE section in a PT_NOTE
   6635      1.1     skrll 	  segment.
   6636      1.1     skrll        3. There is an output section associated with it,
   6637      1.1     skrll        4. The section has not already been allocated to a previous segment.
   6638      1.1     skrll        5. PT_GNU_STACK segments do not include any sections.
   6639      1.1     skrll        6. PT_TLS segment includes only SHF_TLS sections.
   6640      1.1     skrll        7. SHF_TLS sections are only in PT_TLS or PT_LOAD segments.
   6641      1.1     skrll        8. PT_DYNAMIC should not contain empty sections at the beginning
   6642      1.1     skrll 	  (with the possible exception of .dynamic).  */
   6643      1.1     skrll #define IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT(section, segment, bed)		\
   6644      1.1     skrll   ((((segment->p_paddr							\
   6645      1.1     skrll       ? IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA (section, segment, segment->p_paddr)	\
   6646      1.1     skrll       : IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA (section, segment))				\
   6647      1.1     skrll      && (section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)				\
   6648      1.1     skrll     || IS_NOTE (segment, section))					\
   6649      1.1     skrll    && segment->p_type != PT_GNU_STACK					\
   6650      1.1     skrll    && (segment->p_type != PT_TLS					\
   6651      1.1     skrll        || (section->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL))				\
   6652      1.1     skrll    && (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD					\
   6653      1.1     skrll        || segment->p_type == PT_TLS					\
   6654      1.1     skrll        || (section->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) == 0)			\
   6655      1.1     skrll    && (segment->p_type != PT_DYNAMIC					\
   6656      1.1     skrll        || SECTION_SIZE (section, segment) > 0				\
   6657      1.1     skrll        || (segment->p_paddr						\
   6658      1.1     skrll 	   ? segment->p_paddr != section->lma				\
   6659      1.1     skrll 	   : segment->p_vaddr != section->vma)				\
   6660  1.1.1.8  christos        || (strcmp (bfd_get_section_name (ibfd, section), ".dynamic")	\
   6661      1.1     skrll 	   == 0))							\
   6662      1.1     skrll    && (segment->p_type != PT_LOAD || !section->segment_mark))
   6663      1.1     skrll 
   6664      1.1     skrll /* If the output section of a section in the input segment is NULL,
   6665      1.1     skrll    it is removed from the corresponding output segment.   */
   6666      1.1     skrll #define INCLUDE_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT(section, segment, bed)		\
   6667      1.1     skrll   (IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT (section, segment, bed)		\
   6668      1.1     skrll    && section->output_section != NULL)
   6669      1.1     skrll 
   6670      1.1     skrll   /* Returns TRUE iff seg1 starts after the end of seg2.  */
   6671      1.1     skrll #define SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT(seg1, seg2, field)			\
   6672      1.1     skrll   (seg1->field >= SEGMENT_END (seg2, seg2->field))
   6673      1.1     skrll 
   6674      1.1     skrll   /* Returns TRUE iff seg1 and seg2 overlap. Segments overlap iff both
   6675      1.1     skrll      their VMA address ranges and their LMA address ranges overlap.
   6676      1.1     skrll      It is possible to have overlapping VMA ranges without overlapping LMA
   6677      1.1     skrll      ranges.  RedBoot images for example can have both .data and .bss mapped
   6678      1.1     skrll      to the same VMA range, but with the .data section mapped to a different
   6679      1.1     skrll      LMA.  */
   6680      1.1     skrll #define SEGMENT_OVERLAPS(seg1, seg2)					\
   6681      1.1     skrll   (   !(SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg1, seg2, p_vaddr)			\
   6682      1.1     skrll 	|| SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg2, seg1, p_vaddr))			\
   6683      1.1     skrll    && !(SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg1, seg2, p_paddr)			\
   6684      1.1     skrll 	|| SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg2, seg1, p_paddr)))
   6685      1.1     skrll 
   6686      1.1     skrll   /* Initialise the segment mark field.  */
   6687      1.1     skrll   for (section = ibfd->sections; section != NULL; section = section->next)
   6688      1.1     skrll     section->segment_mark = FALSE;
   6689      1.1     skrll 
   6690      1.1     skrll   /* The Solaris linker creates program headers in which all the
   6691      1.1     skrll      p_paddr fields are zero.  When we try to objcopy or strip such a
   6692      1.1     skrll      file, we get confused.  Check for this case, and if we find it
   6693      1.1     skrll      don't set the p_paddr_valid fields.  */
   6694      1.1     skrll   p_paddr_valid = FALSE;
   6695      1.1     skrll   for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
   6696      1.1     skrll        i < num_segments;
   6697      1.1     skrll        i++, segment++)
   6698      1.1     skrll     if (segment->p_paddr != 0)
   6699      1.1     skrll       {
   6700      1.1     skrll 	p_paddr_valid = TRUE;
   6701      1.1     skrll 	break;
   6702      1.1     skrll       }
   6703      1.1     skrll 
   6704      1.1     skrll   /* Scan through the segments specified in the program header
   6705      1.1     skrll      of the input BFD.  For this first scan we look for overlaps
   6706      1.1     skrll      in the loadable segments.  These can be created by weird
   6707      1.1     skrll      parameters to objcopy.  Also, fix some solaris weirdness.  */
   6708      1.1     skrll   for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
   6709      1.1     skrll        i < num_segments;
   6710      1.1     skrll        i++, segment++)
   6711      1.1     skrll     {
   6712      1.1     skrll       unsigned int j;
   6713      1.1     skrll       Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment2;
   6714      1.1     skrll 
   6715      1.1     skrll       if (segment->p_type == PT_INTERP)
   6716      1.1     skrll 	for (section = ibfd->sections; section; section = section->next)
   6717      1.1     skrll 	  if (IS_SOLARIS_PT_INTERP (segment, section))
   6718      1.1     skrll 	    {
   6719      1.1     skrll 	      /* Mininal change so that the normal section to segment
   6720      1.1     skrll 		 assignment code will work.  */
   6721      1.1     skrll 	      segment->p_vaddr = section->vma;
   6722      1.1     skrll 	      break;
   6723      1.1     skrll 	    }
   6724      1.1     skrll 
   6725      1.1     skrll       if (segment->p_type != PT_LOAD)
   6726      1.1     skrll 	{
   6727      1.1     skrll 	  /* Remove PT_GNU_RELRO segment.  */
   6728      1.1     skrll 	  if (segment->p_type == PT_GNU_RELRO)
   6729      1.1     skrll 	    segment->p_type = PT_NULL;
   6730      1.1     skrll 	  continue;
   6731      1.1     skrll 	}
   6732      1.1     skrll 
   6733      1.1     skrll       /* Determine if this segment overlaps any previous segments.  */
   6734      1.1     skrll       for (j = 0, segment2 = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr; j < i; j++, segment2++)
   6735      1.1     skrll 	{
   6736      1.1     skrll 	  bfd_signed_vma extra_length;
   6737      1.1     skrll 
   6738      1.1     skrll 	  if (segment2->p_type != PT_LOAD
   6739      1.1     skrll 	      || !SEGMENT_OVERLAPS (segment, segment2))
   6740      1.1     skrll 	    continue;
   6741      1.1     skrll 
   6742      1.1     skrll 	  /* Merge the two segments together.  */
   6743      1.1     skrll 	  if (segment2->p_vaddr < segment->p_vaddr)
   6744      1.1     skrll 	    {
   6745      1.1     skrll 	      /* Extend SEGMENT2 to include SEGMENT and then delete
   6746      1.1     skrll 		 SEGMENT.  */
   6747      1.1     skrll 	      extra_length = (SEGMENT_END (segment, segment->p_vaddr)
   6748      1.1     skrll 			      - SEGMENT_END (segment2, segment2->p_vaddr));
   6749      1.1     skrll 
   6750      1.1     skrll 	      if (extra_length > 0)
   6751      1.1     skrll 		{
   6752      1.1     skrll 		  segment2->p_memsz += extra_length;
   6753      1.1     skrll 		  segment2->p_filesz += extra_length;
   6754      1.1     skrll 		}
   6755      1.1     skrll 
   6756      1.1     skrll 	      segment->p_type = PT_NULL;
   6757      1.1     skrll 
   6758      1.1     skrll 	      /* Since we have deleted P we must restart the outer loop.  */
   6759      1.1     skrll 	      i = 0;
   6760      1.1     skrll 	      segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
   6761      1.1     skrll 	      break;
   6762      1.1     skrll 	    }
   6763      1.1     skrll 	  else
   6764      1.1     skrll 	    {
   6765      1.1     skrll 	      /* Extend SEGMENT to include SEGMENT2 and then delete
   6766      1.1     skrll 		 SEGMENT2.  */
   6767      1.1     skrll 	      extra_length = (SEGMENT_END (segment2, segment2->p_vaddr)
   6768      1.1     skrll 			      - SEGMENT_END (segment, segment->p_vaddr));
   6769      1.1     skrll 
   6770      1.1     skrll 	      if (extra_length > 0)
   6771      1.1     skrll 		{
   6772      1.1     skrll 		  segment->p_memsz += extra_length;
   6773      1.1     skrll 		  segment->p_filesz += extra_length;
   6774      1.1     skrll 		}
   6775      1.1     skrll 
   6776      1.1     skrll 	      segment2->p_type = PT_NULL;
   6777      1.1     skrll 	    }
   6778      1.1     skrll 	}
   6779      1.1     skrll     }
   6780      1.1     skrll 
   6781      1.1     skrll   /* The second scan attempts to assign sections to segments.  */
   6782      1.1     skrll   for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
   6783      1.1     skrll        i < num_segments;
   6784      1.1     skrll        i++, segment++)
   6785      1.1     skrll     {
   6786      1.1     skrll       unsigned int section_count;
   6787      1.1     skrll       asection **sections;
   6788  1.1.1.8  christos       asection *output_section;
   6789  1.1.1.8  christos       unsigned int isec;
   6790      1.1     skrll       asection *matching_lma;
   6791      1.1     skrll       asection *suggested_lma;
   6792      1.1     skrll       unsigned int j;
   6793      1.1     skrll       bfd_size_type amt;
   6794      1.1     skrll       asection *first_section;
   6795      1.1     skrll 
   6796      1.1     skrll       if (segment->p_type == PT_NULL)
   6797      1.1     skrll 	continue;
   6798      1.1     skrll 
   6799      1.1     skrll       first_section = NULL;
   6800      1.1     skrll       /* Compute how many sections might be placed into this segment.  */
   6801      1.1     skrll       for (section = ibfd->sections, section_count = 0;
   6802      1.1     skrll 	   section != NULL;
   6803      1.1     skrll 	   section = section->next)
   6804      1.1     skrll 	{
   6805      1.1     skrll 	  /* Find the first section in the input segment, which may be
   6806      1.1     skrll 	     removed from the corresponding output segment.   */
   6807      1.1     skrll 	  if (IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT (section, segment, bed))
   6808      1.1     skrll 	    {
   6809      1.1     skrll 	      if (first_section == NULL)
   6810      1.1     skrll 		first_section = section;
   6811      1.1     skrll 	      if (section->output_section != NULL)
   6812      1.1     skrll 		++section_count;
   6813      1.1     skrll 	    }
   6814      1.1     skrll 	}
   6815      1.1     skrll 
   6816      1.1     skrll       /* Allocate a segment map big enough to contain
   6817      1.1     skrll 	 all of the sections we have selected.  */
   6818  1.1.1.3  christos       amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
   6819      1.1     skrll       amt += ((bfd_size_type) section_count - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
   6820      1.1     skrll       map = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (obfd, amt);
   6821      1.1     skrll       if (map == NULL)
   6822      1.1     skrll 	return FALSE;
   6823      1.1     skrll 
   6824      1.1     skrll       /* Initialise the fields of the segment map.  Default to
   6825      1.1     skrll 	 using the physical address of the segment in the input BFD.  */
   6826      1.1     skrll       map->next = NULL;
   6827      1.1     skrll       map->p_type = segment->p_type;
   6828      1.1     skrll       map->p_flags = segment->p_flags;
   6829      1.1     skrll       map->p_flags_valid = 1;
   6830      1.1     skrll 
   6831      1.1     skrll       /* If the first section in the input segment is removed, there is
   6832      1.1     skrll 	 no need to preserve segment physical address in the corresponding
   6833      1.1     skrll 	 output segment.  */
   6834      1.1     skrll       if (!first_section || first_section->output_section != NULL)
   6835      1.1     skrll 	{
   6836      1.1     skrll 	  map->p_paddr = segment->p_paddr;
   6837      1.1     skrll 	  map->p_paddr_valid = p_paddr_valid;
   6838      1.1     skrll 	}
   6839      1.1     skrll 
   6840      1.1     skrll       /* Determine if this segment contains the ELF file header
   6841      1.1     skrll 	 and if it contains the program headers themselves.  */
   6842      1.1     skrll       map->includes_filehdr = (segment->p_offset == 0
   6843      1.1     skrll 			       && segment->p_filesz >= iehdr->e_ehsize);
   6844      1.1     skrll       map->includes_phdrs = 0;
   6845      1.1     skrll 
   6846      1.1     skrll       if (!phdr_included || segment->p_type != PT_LOAD)
   6847      1.1     skrll 	{
   6848      1.1     skrll 	  map->includes_phdrs =
   6849      1.1     skrll 	    (segment->p_offset <= (bfd_vma) iehdr->e_phoff
   6850      1.1     skrll 	     && (segment->p_offset + segment->p_filesz
   6851      1.1     skrll 		 >= ((bfd_vma) iehdr->e_phoff
   6852      1.1     skrll 		     + iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize)));
   6853      1.1     skrll 
   6854      1.1     skrll 	  if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD && map->includes_phdrs)
   6855      1.1     skrll 	    phdr_included = TRUE;
   6856      1.1     skrll 	}
   6857      1.1     skrll 
   6858      1.1     skrll       if (section_count == 0)
   6859      1.1     skrll 	{
   6860      1.1     skrll 	  /* Special segments, such as the PT_PHDR segment, may contain
   6861  1.1.1.7  christos 	     no sections, but ordinary, loadable segments should contain
   6862  1.1.1.7  christos 	     something.  They are allowed by the ELF spec however, so only
   6863  1.1.1.7  christos 	     a warning is produced.
   6864  1.1.1.7  christos 	     There is however the valid use case of embedded systems which
   6865  1.1.1.7  christos 	     have segments with p_filesz of 0 and a p_memsz > 0 to initialize
   6866  1.1.1.7  christos 	     flash memory with zeros.  No warning is shown for that case.  */
   6867  1.1.1.7  christos 	  if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD
   6868  1.1.1.8  christos 	      && (segment->p_filesz > 0 || segment->p_memsz == 0))
   6869  1.1.1.8  christos 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
   6870  1.1.1.8  christos 	    _bfd_error_handler
   6871  1.1.1.8  christos 	      (_("%pB: warning: empty loadable segment detected"
   6872      1.1     skrll 		 " at vaddr=%#" PRIx64 ", is this intentional?"),
   6873      1.1     skrll 	       ibfd, (uint64_t) segment->p_vaddr);
   6874      1.1     skrll 
   6875      1.1     skrll 	  map->count = 0;
   6876      1.1     skrll 	  *pointer_to_map = map;
   6877      1.1     skrll 	  pointer_to_map = &map->next;
   6878      1.1     skrll 
   6879      1.1     skrll 	  continue;
   6880      1.1     skrll 	}
   6881      1.1     skrll 
   6882      1.1     skrll       /* Now scan the sections in the input BFD again and attempt
   6883      1.1     skrll 	 to add their corresponding output sections to the segment map.
   6884      1.1     skrll 	 The problem here is how to handle an output section which has
   6885      1.1     skrll 	 been moved (ie had its LMA changed).  There are four possibilities:
   6886      1.1     skrll 
   6887      1.1     skrll 	 1. None of the sections have been moved.
   6888      1.1     skrll 	    In this case we can continue to use the segment LMA from the
   6889      1.1     skrll 	    input BFD.
   6890      1.1     skrll 
   6891      1.1     skrll 	 2. All of the sections have been moved by the same amount.
   6892      1.1     skrll 	    In this case we can change the segment's LMA to match the LMA
   6893      1.1     skrll 	    of the first section.
   6894      1.1     skrll 
   6895      1.1     skrll 	 3. Some of the sections have been moved, others have not.
   6896      1.1     skrll 	    In this case those sections which have not been moved can be
   6897      1.1     skrll 	    placed in the current segment which will have to have its size,
   6898      1.1     skrll 	    and possibly its LMA changed, and a new segment or segments will
   6899      1.1     skrll 	    have to be created to contain the other sections.
   6900      1.1     skrll 
   6901      1.1     skrll 	 4. The sections have been moved, but not by the same amount.
   6902      1.1     skrll 	    In this case we can change the segment's LMA to match the LMA
   6903      1.1     skrll 	    of the first section and we will have to create a new segment
   6904      1.1     skrll 	    or segments to contain the other sections.
   6905      1.1     skrll 
   6906      1.1     skrll 	 In order to save time, we allocate an array to hold the section
   6907      1.1     skrll 	 pointers that we are interested in.  As these sections get assigned
   6908  1.1.1.3  christos 	 to a segment, they are removed from this array.  */
   6909      1.1     skrll 
   6910      1.1     skrll       sections = (asection **) bfd_malloc2 (section_count, sizeof (asection *));
   6911      1.1     skrll       if (sections == NULL)
   6912      1.1     skrll 	return FALSE;
   6913      1.1     skrll 
   6914      1.1     skrll       /* Step One: Scan for segment vs section LMA conflicts.
   6915      1.1     skrll 	 Also add the sections to the section array allocated above.
   6916      1.1     skrll 	 Also add the sections to the current segment.  In the common
   6917      1.1     skrll 	 case, where the sections have not been moved, this means that
   6918      1.1     skrll 	 we have completely filled the segment, and there is nothing
   6919  1.1.1.8  christos 	 more to do.  */
   6920  1.1.1.8  christos       isec = 0;
   6921      1.1     skrll       matching_lma = NULL;
   6922  1.1.1.6  christos       suggested_lma = NULL;
   6923      1.1     skrll 
   6924      1.1     skrll       for (section = first_section, j = 0;
   6925      1.1     skrll 	   section != NULL;
   6926      1.1     skrll 	   section = section->next)
   6927      1.1     skrll 	{
   6928      1.1     skrll 	  if (INCLUDE_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (section, segment, bed))
   6929      1.1     skrll 	    {
   6930      1.1     skrll 	      output_section = section->output_section;
   6931      1.1     skrll 
   6932      1.1     skrll 	      sections[j++] = section;
   6933      1.1     skrll 
   6934      1.1     skrll 	      /* The Solaris native linker always sets p_paddr to 0.
   6935      1.1     skrll 		 We try to catch that case here, and set it to the
   6936      1.1     skrll 		 correct value.  Note - some backends require that
   6937      1.1     skrll 		 p_paddr be left as zero.  */
   6938      1.1     skrll 	      if (!p_paddr_valid
   6939      1.1     skrll 		  && segment->p_vaddr != 0
   6940      1.1     skrll 		  && !bed->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero
   6941  1.1.1.8  christos 		  && isec == 0
   6942  1.1.1.8  christos 		  && output_section->lma != 0
   6943  1.1.1.8  christos 		  && (align_power (segment->p_vaddr
   6944  1.1.1.8  christos 				   + (map->includes_filehdr
   6945  1.1.1.8  christos 				      ? iehdr->e_ehsize : 0)
   6946  1.1.1.8  christos 				   + (map->includes_phdrs
   6947  1.1.1.8  christos 				      ? iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize
   6948  1.1.1.8  christos 				      : 0),
   6949      1.1     skrll 				   output_section->alignment_power)
   6950      1.1     skrll 		      == output_section->vma))
   6951      1.1     skrll 		map->p_paddr = segment->p_vaddr;
   6952      1.1     skrll 
   6953      1.1     skrll 	      /* Match up the physical address of the segment with the
   6954      1.1     skrll 		 LMA address of the output section.  */
   6955      1.1     skrll 	      if (IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA (output_section, segment, map->p_paddr)
   6956      1.1     skrll 		  || IS_COREFILE_NOTE (segment, section)
   6957      1.1     skrll 		  || (bed->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero
   6958  1.1.1.8  christos 		      && IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA (output_section, segment)))
   6959  1.1.1.8  christos 		{
   6960  1.1.1.8  christos 		  if (matching_lma == NULL
   6961      1.1     skrll 		      || output_section->lma < matching_lma->lma)
   6962      1.1     skrll 		    matching_lma = output_section;
   6963      1.1     skrll 
   6964      1.1     skrll 		  /* We assume that if the section fits within the segment
   6965      1.1     skrll 		     then it does not overlap any other section within that
   6966      1.1     skrll 		     segment.  */
   6967  1.1.1.8  christos 		  map->sections[isec++] = output_section;
   6968  1.1.1.8  christos 		}
   6969      1.1     skrll 	      else if (suggested_lma == NULL)
   6970      1.1     skrll 		suggested_lma = output_section;
   6971      1.1     skrll 
   6972      1.1     skrll 	      if (j == section_count)
   6973      1.1     skrll 		break;
   6974      1.1     skrll 	    }
   6975      1.1     skrll 	}
   6976      1.1     skrll 
   6977      1.1     skrll       BFD_ASSERT (j == section_count);
   6978      1.1     skrll 
   6979      1.1     skrll       /* Step Two: Adjust the physical address of the current segment,
   6980      1.1     skrll 	 if necessary.  */
   6981      1.1     skrll       if (isec == section_count)
   6982      1.1     skrll 	{
   6983      1.1     skrll 	  /* All of the sections fitted within the segment as currently
   6984      1.1     skrll 	     specified.  This is the default case.  Add the segment to
   6985      1.1     skrll 	     the list of built segments and carry on to process the next
   6986      1.1     skrll 	     program header in the input BFD.  */
   6987      1.1     skrll 	  map->count = section_count;
   6988      1.1     skrll 	  *pointer_to_map = map;
   6989      1.1     skrll 	  pointer_to_map = &map->next;
   6990      1.1     skrll 
   6991  1.1.1.8  christos 	  if (p_paddr_valid
   6992      1.1     skrll 	      && !bed->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero
   6993      1.1     skrll 	      && matching_lma->lma != map->p_paddr
   6994      1.1     skrll 	      && !map->includes_filehdr
   6995      1.1     skrll 	      && !map->includes_phdrs)
   6996      1.1     skrll 	    /* There is some padding before the first section in the
   6997  1.1.1.8  christos 	       segment.  So, we must account for that in the output
   6998      1.1     skrll 	       segment's vma.  */
   6999      1.1     skrll 	    map->p_vaddr_offset = matching_lma->lma - map->p_paddr;
   7000      1.1     skrll 
   7001      1.1     skrll 	  free (sections);
   7002      1.1     skrll 	  continue;
   7003      1.1     skrll 	}
   7004  1.1.1.8  christos       else
   7005  1.1.1.8  christos 	{
   7006  1.1.1.8  christos 	  /* Change the current segment's physical address to match
   7007  1.1.1.8  christos 	     the LMA of the first section that fitted, or if no
   7008  1.1.1.8  christos 	     section fitted, the first section.  */
   7009  1.1.1.8  christos 	  if (matching_lma == NULL)
   7010  1.1.1.8  christos 	    matching_lma = suggested_lma;
   7011      1.1     skrll 
   7012      1.1     skrll 	  map->p_paddr = matching_lma->lma;
   7013      1.1     skrll 
   7014  1.1.1.8  christos 	  /* Offset the segment physical address from the lma
   7015      1.1     skrll 	     to allow for space taken up by elf headers.  */
   7016  1.1.1.8  christos 	  if (map->includes_phdrs)
   7017  1.1.1.8  christos 	    {
   7018  1.1.1.8  christos 	      map->p_paddr -= iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize;
   7019  1.1.1.8  christos 
   7020  1.1.1.8  christos 	      /* iehdr->e_phnum is just an estimate of the number
   7021  1.1.1.8  christos 		 of program headers that we will need.  Make a note
   7022  1.1.1.8  christos 		 here of the number we used and the segment we chose
   7023  1.1.1.8  christos 		 to hold these headers, so that we can adjust the
   7024  1.1.1.8  christos 		 offset when we know the correct value.  */
   7025      1.1     skrll 	      phdr_adjust_num = iehdr->e_phnum;
   7026      1.1     skrll 	      phdr_adjust_seg = map;
   7027  1.1.1.8  christos 	    }
   7028      1.1     skrll 
   7029  1.1.1.8  christos 	  if (map->includes_filehdr)
   7030  1.1.1.8  christos 	    {
   7031  1.1.1.8  christos 	      bfd_vma align = (bfd_vma) 1 << matching_lma->alignment_power;
   7032  1.1.1.8  christos 	      map->p_paddr -= iehdr->e_ehsize;
   7033  1.1.1.8  christos 	      /* We've subtracted off the size of headers from the
   7034  1.1.1.8  christos 		 first section lma, but there may have been some
   7035  1.1.1.8  christos 		 alignment padding before that section too.  Try to
   7036  1.1.1.8  christos 		 account for that by adjusting the segment lma down to
   7037  1.1.1.8  christos 		 the same alignment.  */
   7038  1.1.1.8  christos 	      if (segment->p_align != 0 && segment->p_align < align)
   7039      1.1     skrll 		align = segment->p_align;
   7040      1.1     skrll 	      map->p_paddr &= -align;
   7041      1.1     skrll 	    }
   7042      1.1     skrll 	}
   7043      1.1     skrll 
   7044      1.1     skrll       /* Step Three: Loop over the sections again, this time assigning
   7045      1.1     skrll 	 those that fit to the current segment and removing them from the
   7046      1.1     skrll 	 sections array; but making sure not to leave large gaps.  Once all
   7047      1.1     skrll 	 possible sections have been assigned to the current segment it is
   7048      1.1     skrll 	 added to the list of built segments and if sections still remain
   7049      1.1     skrll 	 to be assigned, a new segment is constructed before repeating
   7050      1.1     skrll 	 the loop.  */
   7051      1.1     skrll       isec = 0;
   7052      1.1     skrll       do
   7053  1.1.1.8  christos 	{
   7054      1.1     skrll 	  map->count = 0;
   7055      1.1     skrll 	  suggested_lma = NULL;
   7056      1.1     skrll 
   7057      1.1     skrll 	  /* Fill the current segment with sections that fit.  */
   7058      1.1     skrll 	  for (j = 0; j < section_count; j++)
   7059      1.1     skrll 	    {
   7060      1.1     skrll 	      section = sections[j];
   7061      1.1     skrll 
   7062      1.1     skrll 	      if (section == NULL)
   7063      1.1     skrll 		continue;
   7064      1.1     skrll 
   7065      1.1     skrll 	      output_section = section->output_section;
   7066      1.1     skrll 
   7067      1.1     skrll 	      BFD_ASSERT (output_section != NULL);
   7068      1.1     skrll 
   7069      1.1     skrll 	      if (IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA (output_section, segment, map->p_paddr)
   7070      1.1     skrll 		  || IS_COREFILE_NOTE (segment, section))
   7071      1.1     skrll 		{
   7072      1.1     skrll 		  if (map->count == 0)
   7073      1.1     skrll 		    {
   7074      1.1     skrll 		      /* If the first section in a segment does not start at
   7075  1.1.1.8  christos 			 the beginning of the segment, then something is
   7076  1.1.1.8  christos 			 wrong.  */
   7077  1.1.1.8  christos 		      if (align_power (map->p_paddr
   7078  1.1.1.8  christos 				       + (map->includes_filehdr
   7079  1.1.1.8  christos 					  ? iehdr->e_ehsize : 0)
   7080  1.1.1.8  christos 				       + (map->includes_phdrs
   7081  1.1.1.8  christos 					  ? iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize
   7082  1.1.1.8  christos 					  : 0),
   7083      1.1     skrll 				       output_section->alignment_power)
   7084      1.1     skrll 			  != output_section->lma)
   7085      1.1     skrll 			abort ();
   7086      1.1     skrll 		    }
   7087      1.1     skrll 		  else
   7088      1.1     skrll 		    {
   7089      1.1     skrll 		      asection *prev_sec;
   7090      1.1     skrll 
   7091      1.1     skrll 		      prev_sec = map->sections[map->count - 1];
   7092      1.1     skrll 
   7093      1.1     skrll 		      /* If the gap between the end of the previous section
   7094      1.1     skrll 			 and the start of this section is more than
   7095      1.1     skrll 			 maxpagesize then we need to start a new segment.  */
   7096      1.1     skrll 		      if ((BFD_ALIGN (prev_sec->lma + prev_sec->size,
   7097      1.1     skrll 				      maxpagesize)
   7098      1.1     skrll 			   < BFD_ALIGN (output_section->lma, maxpagesize))
   7099      1.1     skrll 			  || (prev_sec->lma + prev_sec->size
   7100  1.1.1.8  christos 			      > output_section->lma))
   7101  1.1.1.8  christos 			{
   7102      1.1     skrll 			  if (suggested_lma == NULL)
   7103      1.1     skrll 			    suggested_lma = output_section;
   7104      1.1     skrll 
   7105      1.1     skrll 			  continue;
   7106      1.1     skrll 			}
   7107      1.1     skrll 		    }
   7108      1.1     skrll 
   7109      1.1     skrll 		  map->sections[map->count++] = output_section;
   7110  1.1.1.8  christos 		  ++isec;
   7111  1.1.1.8  christos 		  sections[j] = NULL;
   7112      1.1     skrll 		  if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD)
   7113  1.1.1.8  christos 		    section->segment_mark = TRUE;
   7114  1.1.1.8  christos 		}
   7115      1.1     skrll 	      else if (suggested_lma == NULL)
   7116      1.1     skrll 		suggested_lma = output_section;
   7117      1.1     skrll 	    }
   7118      1.1     skrll 
   7119      1.1     skrll 	  BFD_ASSERT (map->count > 0);
   7120      1.1     skrll 
   7121      1.1     skrll 	  /* Add the current segment to the list of built segments.  */
   7122      1.1     skrll 	  *pointer_to_map = map;
   7123      1.1     skrll 	  pointer_to_map = &map->next;
   7124      1.1     skrll 
   7125      1.1     skrll 	  if (isec < section_count)
   7126      1.1     skrll 	    {
   7127      1.1     skrll 	      /* We still have not allocated all of the sections to
   7128      1.1     skrll 		 segments.  Create a new segment here, initialise it
   7129      1.1     skrll 		 and carry on looping.  */
   7130  1.1.1.4  christos 	      amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
   7131      1.1     skrll 	      amt += ((bfd_size_type) section_count - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
   7132      1.1     skrll 	      map = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (obfd, amt);
   7133      1.1     skrll 	      if (map == NULL)
   7134      1.1     skrll 		{
   7135      1.1     skrll 		  free (sections);
   7136      1.1     skrll 		  return FALSE;
   7137      1.1     skrll 		}
   7138      1.1     skrll 
   7139      1.1     skrll 	      /* Initialise the fields of the segment map.  Set the physical
   7140      1.1     skrll 		 physical address to the LMA of the first section that has
   7141      1.1     skrll 		 not yet been assigned.  */
   7142      1.1     skrll 	      map->next = NULL;
   7143      1.1     skrll 	      map->p_type = segment->p_type;
   7144  1.1.1.8  christos 	      map->p_flags = segment->p_flags;
   7145      1.1     skrll 	      map->p_flags_valid = 1;
   7146      1.1     skrll 	      map->p_paddr = suggested_lma->lma;
   7147      1.1     skrll 	      map->p_paddr_valid = p_paddr_valid;
   7148      1.1     skrll 	      map->includes_filehdr = 0;
   7149      1.1     skrll 	      map->includes_phdrs = 0;
   7150      1.1     skrll 	    }
   7151      1.1     skrll 	}
   7152      1.1     skrll       while (isec < section_count);
   7153      1.1     skrll 
   7154      1.1     skrll       free (sections);
   7155  1.1.1.5  christos     }
   7156      1.1     skrll 
   7157      1.1     skrll   elf_seg_map (obfd) = map_first;
   7158      1.1     skrll 
   7159      1.1     skrll   /* If we had to estimate the number of program headers that were
   7160      1.1     skrll      going to be needed, then check our estimate now and adjust
   7161      1.1     skrll      the offset if necessary.  */
   7162      1.1     skrll   if (phdr_adjust_seg != NULL)
   7163      1.1     skrll     {
   7164      1.1     skrll       unsigned int count;
   7165      1.1     skrll 
   7166      1.1     skrll       for (count = 0, map = map_first; map != NULL; map = map->next)
   7167      1.1     skrll 	count++;
   7168      1.1     skrll 
   7169      1.1     skrll       if (count > phdr_adjust_num)
   7170  1.1.1.8  christos 	phdr_adjust_seg->p_paddr
   7171  1.1.1.8  christos 	  -= (count - phdr_adjust_num) * iehdr->e_phentsize;
   7172  1.1.1.8  christos 
   7173  1.1.1.8  christos       for (map = map_first; map != NULL; map = map->next)
   7174  1.1.1.8  christos 	if (map->p_type == PT_PHDR)
   7175  1.1.1.8  christos 	  {
   7176  1.1.1.8  christos 	    bfd_vma adjust
   7177  1.1.1.8  christos 	      = phdr_adjust_seg->includes_filehdr ? iehdr->e_ehsize : 0;
   7178  1.1.1.8  christos 	    map->p_paddr = phdr_adjust_seg->p_paddr + adjust;
   7179      1.1     skrll 	    break;
   7180      1.1     skrll 	  }
   7181      1.1     skrll     }
   7182      1.1     skrll 
   7183      1.1     skrll #undef SEGMENT_END
   7184      1.1     skrll #undef SECTION_SIZE
   7185      1.1     skrll #undef IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA
   7186      1.1     skrll #undef IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA
   7187      1.1     skrll #undef IS_NOTE
   7188      1.1     skrll #undef IS_COREFILE_NOTE
   7189      1.1     skrll #undef IS_SOLARIS_PT_INTERP
   7190      1.1     skrll #undef IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT
   7191      1.1     skrll #undef INCLUDE_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT
   7192      1.1     skrll #undef SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT
   7193      1.1     skrll #undef SEGMENT_OVERLAPS
   7194      1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   7195      1.1     skrll }
   7196      1.1     skrll 
   7197      1.1     skrll /* Copy ELF program header information.  */
   7198      1.1     skrll 
   7199      1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   7200      1.1     skrll copy_elf_program_header (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
   7201      1.1     skrll {
   7202      1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Ehdr *iehdr;
   7203      1.1     skrll   struct elf_segment_map *map;
   7204      1.1     skrll   struct elf_segment_map *map_first;
   7205      1.1     skrll   struct elf_segment_map **pointer_to_map;
   7206      1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment;
   7207      1.1     skrll   unsigned int i;
   7208      1.1     skrll   unsigned int num_segments;
   7209      1.1     skrll   bfd_boolean phdr_included = FALSE;
   7210      1.1     skrll   bfd_boolean p_paddr_valid;
   7211      1.1     skrll 
   7212      1.1     skrll   iehdr = elf_elfheader (ibfd);
   7213      1.1     skrll 
   7214      1.1     skrll   map_first = NULL;
   7215      1.1     skrll   pointer_to_map = &map_first;
   7216      1.1     skrll 
   7217      1.1     skrll   /* If all the segment p_paddr fields are zero, don't set
   7218      1.1     skrll      map->p_paddr_valid.  */
   7219      1.1     skrll   p_paddr_valid = FALSE;
   7220      1.1     skrll   num_segments = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_phnum;
   7221      1.1     skrll   for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
   7222      1.1     skrll        i < num_segments;
   7223      1.1     skrll        i++, segment++)
   7224      1.1     skrll     if (segment->p_paddr != 0)
   7225      1.1     skrll       {
   7226      1.1     skrll 	p_paddr_valid = TRUE;
   7227      1.1     skrll 	break;
   7228      1.1     skrll       }
   7229      1.1     skrll 
   7230      1.1     skrll   for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
   7231      1.1     skrll        i < num_segments;
   7232      1.1     skrll        i++, segment++)
   7233      1.1     skrll     {
   7234      1.1     skrll       asection *section;
   7235      1.1     skrll       unsigned int section_count;
   7236      1.1     skrll       bfd_size_type amt;
   7237  1.1.1.3  christos       Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
   7238      1.1     skrll       asection *first_section = NULL;
   7239      1.1     skrll       asection *lowest_section;
   7240      1.1     skrll 
   7241      1.1     skrll       /* Compute how many sections are in this segment.  */
   7242      1.1     skrll       for (section = ibfd->sections, section_count = 0;
   7243      1.1     skrll 	   section != NULL;
   7244      1.1     skrll 	   section = section->next)
   7245  1.1.1.3  christos 	{
   7246      1.1     skrll 	  this_hdr = &(elf_section_data(section)->this_hdr);
   7247  1.1.1.3  christos 	  if (ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (this_hdr, segment))
   7248  1.1.1.3  christos 	    {
   7249      1.1     skrll 	      if (first_section == NULL)
   7250      1.1     skrll 		first_section = section;
   7251      1.1     skrll 	      section_count++;
   7252      1.1     skrll 	    }
   7253      1.1     skrll 	}
   7254      1.1     skrll 
   7255      1.1     skrll       /* Allocate a segment map big enough to contain
   7256      1.1     skrll 	 all of the sections we have selected.  */
   7257      1.1     skrll       amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
   7258  1.1.1.3  christos       if (section_count != 0)
   7259      1.1     skrll 	amt += ((bfd_size_type) section_count - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
   7260      1.1     skrll       map = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (obfd, amt);
   7261      1.1     skrll       if (map == NULL)
   7262      1.1     skrll 	return FALSE;
   7263      1.1     skrll 
   7264      1.1     skrll       /* Initialize the fields of the output segment map with the
   7265      1.1     skrll 	 input segment.  */
   7266      1.1     skrll       map->next = NULL;
   7267      1.1     skrll       map->p_type = segment->p_type;
   7268      1.1     skrll       map->p_flags = segment->p_flags;
   7269      1.1     skrll       map->p_flags_valid = 1;
   7270      1.1     skrll       map->p_paddr = segment->p_paddr;
   7271      1.1     skrll       map->p_paddr_valid = p_paddr_valid;
   7272      1.1     skrll       map->p_align = segment->p_align;
   7273      1.1     skrll       map->p_align_valid = 1;
   7274  1.1.1.5  christos       map->p_vaddr_offset = 0;
   7275  1.1.1.5  christos 
   7276      1.1     skrll       if (map->p_type == PT_GNU_RELRO
   7277      1.1     skrll 	  || map->p_type == PT_GNU_STACK)
   7278      1.1     skrll 	{
   7279      1.1     skrll 	  /* The PT_GNU_RELRO segment may contain the first a few
   7280  1.1.1.5  christos 	     bytes in the .got.plt section even if the whole .got.plt
   7281  1.1.1.5  christos 	     section isn't in the PT_GNU_RELRO segment.  We won't
   7282  1.1.1.5  christos 	     change the size of the PT_GNU_RELRO segment.
   7283  1.1.1.3  christos 	     Similarly, PT_GNU_STACK size is significant on uclinux
   7284      1.1     skrll 	     systems.    */
   7285      1.1     skrll 	  map->p_size = segment->p_memsz;
   7286      1.1     skrll 	  map->p_size_valid = 1;
   7287      1.1     skrll 	}
   7288      1.1     skrll 
   7289      1.1     skrll       /* Determine if this segment contains the ELF file header
   7290      1.1     skrll 	 and if it contains the program headers themselves.  */
   7291      1.1     skrll       map->includes_filehdr = (segment->p_offset == 0
   7292      1.1     skrll 			       && segment->p_filesz >= iehdr->e_ehsize);
   7293      1.1     skrll 
   7294      1.1     skrll       map->includes_phdrs = 0;
   7295      1.1     skrll       if (! phdr_included || segment->p_type != PT_LOAD)
   7296      1.1     skrll 	{
   7297      1.1     skrll 	  map->includes_phdrs =
   7298      1.1     skrll 	    (segment->p_offset <= (bfd_vma) iehdr->e_phoff
   7299      1.1     skrll 	     && (segment->p_offset + segment->p_filesz
   7300      1.1     skrll 		 >= ((bfd_vma) iehdr->e_phoff
   7301      1.1     skrll 		     + iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize)));
   7302      1.1     skrll 
   7303      1.1     skrll 	  if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD && map->includes_phdrs)
   7304      1.1     skrll 	    phdr_included = TRUE;
   7305  1.1.1.5  christos 	}
   7306      1.1     skrll 
   7307      1.1     skrll       lowest_section = NULL;
   7308      1.1     skrll       if (section_count != 0)
   7309      1.1     skrll 	{
   7310      1.1     skrll 	  unsigned int isec = 0;
   7311      1.1     skrll 
   7312      1.1     skrll 	  for (section = first_section;
   7313      1.1     skrll 	       section != NULL;
   7314      1.1     skrll 	       section = section->next)
   7315  1.1.1.3  christos 	    {
   7316      1.1     skrll 	      this_hdr = &(elf_section_data(section)->this_hdr);
   7317      1.1     skrll 	      if (ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (this_hdr, segment))
   7318  1.1.1.3  christos 		{
   7319  1.1.1.3  christos 		  map->sections[isec++] = section->output_section;
   7320  1.1.1.3  christos 		  if ((section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
   7321  1.1.1.3  christos 		    {
   7322  1.1.1.5  christos 		      bfd_vma seg_off;
   7323  1.1.1.5  christos 
   7324  1.1.1.5  christos 		      if (lowest_section == NULL
   7325  1.1.1.5  christos 			  || section->lma < lowest_section->lma)
   7326  1.1.1.3  christos 			lowest_section = section;
   7327  1.1.1.3  christos 
   7328  1.1.1.3  christos 		      /* Section lmas are set up from PT_LOAD header
   7329  1.1.1.3  christos 			 p_paddr in _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr.
   7330  1.1.1.3  christos 			 If this header has a p_paddr that disagrees
   7331  1.1.1.3  christos 			 with the section lma, flag the p_paddr as
   7332  1.1.1.3  christos 			 invalid.  */
   7333  1.1.1.3  christos 		      if ((section->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
   7334  1.1.1.3  christos 			seg_off = this_hdr->sh_offset - segment->p_offset;
   7335  1.1.1.3  christos 		      else
   7336  1.1.1.3  christos 			seg_off = this_hdr->sh_addr - segment->p_vaddr;
   7337  1.1.1.3  christos 		      if (section->lma - segment->p_paddr != seg_off)
   7338      1.1     skrll 			map->p_paddr_valid = FALSE;
   7339      1.1     skrll 		    }
   7340      1.1     skrll 		  if (isec == section_count)
   7341      1.1     skrll 		    break;
   7342      1.1     skrll 		}
   7343      1.1     skrll 	    }
   7344  1.1.1.3  christos 	}
   7345  1.1.1.3  christos 
   7346  1.1.1.3  christos       if (map->includes_filehdr && lowest_section != NULL)
   7347  1.1.1.4  christos 	/* We need to keep the space used by the headers fixed.  */
   7348  1.1.1.3  christos 	map->header_size = lowest_section->vma - segment->p_vaddr;
   7349  1.1.1.3  christos 
   7350  1.1.1.3  christos       if (!map->includes_phdrs
   7351  1.1.1.3  christos 	  && !map->includes_filehdr
   7352  1.1.1.3  christos 	  && map->p_paddr_valid)
   7353  1.1.1.3  christos 	/* There is some other padding before the first section.  */
   7354  1.1.1.3  christos 	map->p_vaddr_offset = ((lowest_section ? lowest_section->lma : 0)
   7355      1.1     skrll 			       - segment->p_paddr);
   7356      1.1     skrll 
   7357      1.1     skrll       map->count = section_count;
   7358      1.1     skrll       *pointer_to_map = map;
   7359      1.1     skrll       pointer_to_map = &map->next;
   7360  1.1.1.5  christos     }
   7361      1.1     skrll 
   7362      1.1     skrll   elf_seg_map (obfd) = map_first;
   7363      1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   7364      1.1     skrll }
   7365      1.1     skrll 
   7366      1.1     skrll /* Copy private BFD data.  This copies or rewrites ELF program header
   7367      1.1     skrll    information.  */
   7368      1.1     skrll 
   7369      1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   7370      1.1     skrll copy_private_bfd_data (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
   7371      1.1     skrll {
   7372      1.1     skrll   if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
   7373      1.1     skrll       || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
   7374      1.1     skrll     return TRUE;
   7375      1.1     skrll 
   7376      1.1     skrll   if (elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr == NULL)
   7377      1.1     skrll     return TRUE;
   7378      1.1     skrll 
   7379      1.1     skrll   if (ibfd->xvec == obfd->xvec)
   7380      1.1     skrll     {
   7381      1.1     skrll       /* Check to see if any sections in the input BFD
   7382      1.1     skrll 	 covered by ELF program header have changed.  */
   7383      1.1     skrll       Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment;
   7384      1.1     skrll       asection *section, *osec;
   7385      1.1     skrll       unsigned int i, num_segments;
   7386      1.1     skrll       Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
   7387      1.1     skrll       const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
   7388      1.1     skrll 
   7389      1.1     skrll       bed = get_elf_backend_data (ibfd);
   7390      1.1     skrll 
   7391      1.1     skrll       /* Regenerate the segment map if p_paddr is set to 0.  */
   7392      1.1     skrll       if (bed->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero)
   7393      1.1     skrll 	goto rewrite;
   7394      1.1     skrll 
   7395      1.1     skrll       /* Initialize the segment mark field.  */
   7396      1.1     skrll       for (section = obfd->sections; section != NULL;
   7397      1.1     skrll 	   section = section->next)
   7398      1.1     skrll 	section->segment_mark = FALSE;
   7399      1.1     skrll 
   7400      1.1     skrll       num_segments = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_phnum;
   7401      1.1     skrll       for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
   7402      1.1     skrll 	   i < num_segments;
   7403      1.1     skrll 	   i++, segment++)
   7404      1.1     skrll 	{
   7405      1.1     skrll 	  /* PR binutils/3535.  The Solaris linker always sets the p_paddr
   7406      1.1     skrll 	     and p_memsz fields of special segments (DYNAMIC, INTERP) to 0
   7407      1.1     skrll 	     which severly confuses things, so always regenerate the segment
   7408      1.1     skrll 	     map in this case.  */
   7409      1.1     skrll 	  if (segment->p_paddr == 0
   7410      1.1     skrll 	      && segment->p_memsz == 0
   7411      1.1     skrll 	      && (segment->p_type == PT_INTERP || segment->p_type == PT_DYNAMIC))
   7412      1.1     skrll 	    goto rewrite;
   7413      1.1     skrll 
   7414      1.1     skrll 	  for (section = ibfd->sections;
   7415      1.1     skrll 	       section != NULL; section = section->next)
   7416      1.1     skrll 	    {
   7417      1.1     skrll 	      /* We mark the output section so that we know it comes
   7418      1.1     skrll 		 from the input BFD.  */
   7419      1.1     skrll 	      osec = section->output_section;
   7420      1.1     skrll 	      if (osec)
   7421      1.1     skrll 		osec->segment_mark = TRUE;
   7422      1.1     skrll 
   7423  1.1.1.3  christos 	      /* Check if this section is covered by the segment.  */
   7424      1.1     skrll 	      this_hdr = &(elf_section_data(section)->this_hdr);
   7425      1.1     skrll 	      if (ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (this_hdr, segment))
   7426      1.1     skrll 		{
   7427      1.1     skrll 		  /* FIXME: Check if its output section is changed or
   7428      1.1     skrll 		     removed.  What else do we need to check?  */
   7429      1.1     skrll 		  if (osec == NULL
   7430      1.1     skrll 		      || section->flags != osec->flags
   7431      1.1     skrll 		      || section->lma != osec->lma
   7432      1.1     skrll 		      || section->vma != osec->vma
   7433      1.1     skrll 		      || section->size != osec->size
   7434      1.1     skrll 		      || section->rawsize != osec->rawsize
   7435      1.1     skrll 		      || section->alignment_power != osec->alignment_power)
   7436      1.1     skrll 		    goto rewrite;
   7437      1.1     skrll 		}
   7438      1.1     skrll 	    }
   7439      1.1     skrll 	}
   7440      1.1     skrll 
   7441      1.1     skrll       /* Check to see if any output section do not come from the
   7442      1.1     skrll 	 input BFD.  */
   7443      1.1     skrll       for (section = obfd->sections; section != NULL;
   7444  1.1.1.7  christos 	   section = section->next)
   7445      1.1     skrll 	{
   7446      1.1     skrll 	  if (!section->segment_mark)
   7447      1.1     skrll 	    goto rewrite;
   7448      1.1     skrll 	  else
   7449      1.1     skrll 	    section->segment_mark = FALSE;
   7450      1.1     skrll 	}
   7451      1.1     skrll 
   7452      1.1     skrll       return copy_elf_program_header (ibfd, obfd);
   7453      1.1     skrll     }
   7454  1.1.1.4  christos 
   7455  1.1.1.4  christos rewrite:
   7456  1.1.1.4  christos   if (ibfd->xvec == obfd->xvec)
   7457  1.1.1.4  christos     {
   7458  1.1.1.4  christos       /* When rewriting program header, set the output maxpagesize to
   7459  1.1.1.4  christos 	 the maximum alignment of input PT_LOAD segments.  */
   7460  1.1.1.4  christos       Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment;
   7461  1.1.1.4  christos       unsigned int i;
   7462  1.1.1.4  christos       unsigned int num_segments = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_phnum;
   7463  1.1.1.4  christos       bfd_vma maxpagesize = 0;
   7464  1.1.1.4  christos 
   7465  1.1.1.4  christos       for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
   7466  1.1.1.4  christos 	   i < num_segments;
   7467  1.1.1.4  christos 	   i++, segment++)
   7468  1.1.1.5  christos 	if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD
   7469  1.1.1.5  christos 	    && maxpagesize < segment->p_align)
   7470  1.1.1.5  christos 	  {
   7471  1.1.1.7  christos 	    /* PR 17512: file: f17299af.  */
   7472  1.1.1.8  christos 	    if (segment->p_align > (bfd_vma) 1 << ((sizeof (bfd_vma) * 8) - 2))
   7473  1.1.1.8  christos 	      /* xgettext:c-format */
   7474  1.1.1.8  christos 	      _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: warning: segment alignment of %#"
   7475  1.1.1.5  christos 				    PRIx64 " is too large"),
   7476  1.1.1.5  christos 				  ibfd, (uint64_t) segment->p_align);
   7477  1.1.1.5  christos 	    else
   7478  1.1.1.4  christos 	      maxpagesize = segment->p_align;
   7479  1.1.1.4  christos 	  }
   7480  1.1.1.4  christos 
   7481  1.1.1.4  christos       if (maxpagesize != get_elf_backend_data (obfd)->maxpagesize)
   7482  1.1.1.4  christos 	bfd_emul_set_maxpagesize (bfd_get_target (obfd), maxpagesize);
   7483      1.1     skrll     }
   7484      1.1     skrll 
   7485      1.1     skrll   return rewrite_elf_program_header (ibfd, obfd);
   7486      1.1     skrll }
   7487      1.1     skrll 
   7488      1.1     skrll /* Initialize private output section information from input section.  */
   7489      1.1     skrll 
   7490      1.1     skrll bfd_boolean
   7491      1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_init_private_section_data (bfd *ibfd,
   7492      1.1     skrll 				    asection *isec,
   7493      1.1     skrll 				    bfd *obfd,
   7494      1.1     skrll 				    asection *osec,
   7495      1.1     skrll 				    struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
   7496      1.1     skrll 
   7497  1.1.1.5  christos {
   7498  1.1.1.5  christos   Elf_Internal_Shdr *ihdr, *ohdr;
   7499      1.1     skrll   bfd_boolean final_link = (link_info != NULL
   7500      1.1     skrll 			    && !bfd_link_relocatable (link_info));
   7501      1.1     skrll 
   7502      1.1     skrll   if (ibfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour
   7503      1.1     skrll       || obfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
   7504  1.1.1.4  christos     return TRUE;
   7505  1.1.1.4  christos 
   7506  1.1.1.3  christos   BFD_ASSERT (elf_section_data (osec) != NULL);
   7507  1.1.1.3  christos 
   7508  1.1.1.3  christos   /* For objcopy and relocatable link, don't copy the output ELF
   7509  1.1.1.3  christos      section type from input if the output BFD section flags have been
   7510      1.1     skrll      set to something different.  For a final link allow some flags
   7511  1.1.1.3  christos      that the linker clears to differ.  */
   7512  1.1.1.3  christos   if (elf_section_type (osec) == SHT_NULL
   7513  1.1.1.3  christos       && (osec->flags == isec->flags
   7514  1.1.1.3  christos 	  || (final_link
   7515      1.1     skrll 	      && ((osec->flags ^ isec->flags)
   7516      1.1     skrll 		  & ~(SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES | SEC_RELOC)) == 0)))
   7517      1.1     skrll     elf_section_type (osec) = elf_section_type (isec);
   7518      1.1     skrll 
   7519      1.1     skrll   /* FIXME: Is this correct for all OS/PROC specific flags?  */
   7520      1.1     skrll   elf_section_flags (osec) |= (elf_section_flags (isec)
   7521  1.1.1.7  christos 			       & (SHF_MASKOS | SHF_MASKPROC));
   7522  1.1.1.7  christos 
   7523  1.1.1.7  christos   /* Copy sh_info from input for mbind section.  */
   7524  1.1.1.7  christos   if (elf_section_flags (isec) & SHF_GNU_MBIND)
   7525  1.1.1.7  christos     elf_section_data (osec)->this_hdr.sh_info
   7526      1.1     skrll       = elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.sh_info;
   7527      1.1     skrll 
   7528      1.1     skrll   /* Set things up for objcopy and relocatable link.  The output
   7529      1.1     skrll      SHT_GROUP section will have its elf_next_in_group pointing back
   7530  1.1.1.7  christos      to the input group members.  Ignore linker created group section.
   7531  1.1.1.7  christos      See elfNN_ia64_object_p in elfxx-ia64.c.  */
   7532  1.1.1.7  christos   if ((link_info == NULL
   7533  1.1.1.7  christos        || !link_info->resolve_section_groups)
   7534  1.1.1.7  christos       && (elf_sec_group (isec) == NULL
   7535  1.1.1.7  christos 	  || (elf_sec_group (isec)->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) == 0))
   7536  1.1.1.7  christos     {
   7537  1.1.1.7  christos       if (elf_section_flags (isec) & SHF_GROUP)
   7538  1.1.1.7  christos 	elf_section_flags (osec) |= SHF_GROUP;
   7539      1.1     skrll       elf_next_in_group (osec) = elf_next_in_group (isec);
   7540      1.1     skrll       elf_section_data (osec)->group = elf_section_data (isec)->group;
   7541  1.1.1.7  christos     }
   7542  1.1.1.7  christos 
   7543  1.1.1.7  christos   /* If not decompress, preserve SHF_COMPRESSED.  */
   7544  1.1.1.7  christos   if (!final_link && (ibfd->flags & BFD_DECOMPRESS) == 0)
   7545  1.1.1.7  christos     elf_section_flags (osec) |= (elf_section_flags (isec)
   7546      1.1     skrll 				 & SHF_COMPRESSED);
   7547      1.1     skrll 
   7548      1.1     skrll   ihdr = &elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr;
   7549      1.1     skrll 
   7550      1.1     skrll   /* We need to handle elf_linked_to_section for SHF_LINK_ORDER. We
   7551      1.1     skrll      don't use the output section of the linked-to section since it
   7552      1.1     skrll      may be NULL at this point.  */
   7553      1.1     skrll   if ((ihdr->sh_flags & SHF_LINK_ORDER) != 0)
   7554      1.1     skrll     {
   7555      1.1     skrll       ohdr = &elf_section_data (osec)->this_hdr;
   7556      1.1     skrll       ohdr->sh_flags |= SHF_LINK_ORDER;
   7557      1.1     skrll       elf_linked_to_section (osec) = elf_linked_to_section (isec);
   7558      1.1     skrll     }
   7559      1.1     skrll 
   7560      1.1     skrll   osec->use_rela_p = isec->use_rela_p;
   7561      1.1     skrll 
   7562      1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   7563      1.1     skrll }
   7564      1.1     skrll 
   7565      1.1     skrll /* Copy private section information.  This copies over the entsize
   7566      1.1     skrll    field, and sometimes the info field.  */
   7567      1.1     skrll 
   7568      1.1     skrll bfd_boolean
   7569      1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_copy_private_section_data (bfd *ibfd,
   7570      1.1     skrll 				    asection *isec,
   7571      1.1     skrll 				    bfd *obfd,
   7572      1.1     skrll 				    asection *osec)
   7573      1.1     skrll {
   7574      1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Shdr *ihdr, *ohdr;
   7575      1.1     skrll 
   7576      1.1     skrll   if (ibfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour
   7577      1.1     skrll       || obfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
   7578      1.1     skrll     return TRUE;
   7579      1.1     skrll 
   7580      1.1     skrll   ihdr = &elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr;
   7581      1.1     skrll   ohdr = &elf_section_data (osec)->this_hdr;
   7582      1.1     skrll 
   7583      1.1     skrll   ohdr->sh_entsize = ihdr->sh_entsize;
   7584      1.1     skrll 
   7585      1.1     skrll   if (ihdr->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB
   7586      1.1     skrll       || ihdr->sh_type == SHT_DYNSYM
   7587      1.1     skrll       || ihdr->sh_type == SHT_GNU_verneed
   7588      1.1     skrll       || ihdr->sh_type == SHT_GNU_verdef)
   7589      1.1     skrll     ohdr->sh_info = ihdr->sh_info;
   7590      1.1     skrll 
   7591      1.1     skrll   return _bfd_elf_init_private_section_data (ibfd, isec, obfd, osec,
   7592      1.1     skrll 					     NULL);
   7593  1.1.1.3  christos }
   7594  1.1.1.3  christos 
   7595  1.1.1.3  christos /* Look at all the SHT_GROUP sections in IBFD, making any adjustments
   7596  1.1.1.3  christos    necessary if we are removing either the SHT_GROUP section or any of
   7597  1.1.1.3  christos    the group member sections.  DISCARDED is the value that a section's
   7598  1.1.1.3  christos    output_section has if the section will be discarded, NULL when this
   7599      1.1     skrll    function is called from objcopy, bfd_abs_section_ptr when called
   7600      1.1     skrll    from the linker.  */
   7601  1.1.1.3  christos 
   7602      1.1     skrll bfd_boolean
   7603      1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_fixup_group_sections (bfd *ibfd, asection *discarded)
   7604      1.1     skrll {
   7605      1.1     skrll   asection *isec;
   7606  1.1.1.3  christos 
   7607      1.1     skrll   for (isec = ibfd->sections; isec != NULL; isec = isec->next)
   7608      1.1     skrll     if (elf_section_type (isec) == SHT_GROUP)
   7609      1.1     skrll       {
   7610  1.1.1.3  christos 	asection *first = elf_next_in_group (isec);
   7611  1.1.1.3  christos 	asection *s = first;
   7612      1.1     skrll 	bfd_size_type removed = 0;
   7613      1.1     skrll 
   7614  1.1.1.3  christos 	while (s != NULL)
   7615  1.1.1.3  christos 	  {
   7616  1.1.1.3  christos 	    /* If this member section is being output but the
   7617  1.1.1.3  christos 	       SHT_GROUP section is not, then clear the group info
   7618  1.1.1.3  christos 	       set up by _bfd_elf_copy_private_section_data.  */
   7619      1.1     skrll 	    if (s->output_section != discarded
   7620      1.1     skrll 		&& isec->output_section == discarded)
   7621      1.1     skrll 	      {
   7622      1.1     skrll 		elf_section_flags (s->output_section) &= ~SHF_GROUP;
   7623  1.1.1.3  christos 		elf_group_name (s->output_section) = NULL;
   7624  1.1.1.3  christos 	      }
   7625  1.1.1.3  christos 	    /* Conversely, if the member section is not being output
   7626  1.1.1.3  christos 	       but the SHT_GROUP section is, then adjust its size.  */
   7627  1.1.1.8  christos 	    else if (s->output_section == discarded
   7628  1.1.1.8  christos 		     && isec->output_section != discarded)
   7629  1.1.1.8  christos 	      {
   7630  1.1.1.8  christos 		struct bfd_elf_section_data *elf_sec = elf_section_data (s);
   7631  1.1.1.8  christos 		removed += 4;
   7632  1.1.1.8  christos 		if (elf_sec->rel.hdr != NULL
   7633  1.1.1.8  christos 		    && (elf_sec->rel.hdr->sh_flags & SHF_GROUP) != 0)
   7634  1.1.1.8  christos 		  removed += 4;
   7635  1.1.1.8  christos 		if (elf_sec->rela.hdr != NULL
   7636  1.1.1.8  christos 		    && (elf_sec->rela.hdr->sh_flags & SHF_GROUP) != 0)
   7637      1.1     skrll 		  removed += 4;
   7638      1.1     skrll 	      }
   7639      1.1     skrll 	    s = elf_next_in_group (s);
   7640      1.1     skrll 	    if (s == first)
   7641  1.1.1.3  christos 	      break;
   7642  1.1.1.3  christos 	  }
   7643  1.1.1.3  christos 	if (removed != 0)
   7644  1.1.1.3  christos 	  {
   7645  1.1.1.3  christos 	    if (discarded != NULL)
   7646  1.1.1.8  christos 	      {
   7647  1.1.1.3  christos 		/* If we've been called for ld -r, then we need to
   7648  1.1.1.3  christos 		   adjust the input section size.  */
   7649  1.1.1.3  christos 		if (isec->rawsize == 0)
   7650  1.1.1.8  christos 		  isec->rawsize = isec->size;
   7651  1.1.1.8  christos 		isec->size = isec->rawsize - removed;
   7652  1.1.1.8  christos 		if (isec->size <= 4)
   7653  1.1.1.8  christos 		  {
   7654  1.1.1.8  christos 		    isec->size = 0;
   7655  1.1.1.3  christos 		    isec->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
   7656  1.1.1.3  christos 		  }
   7657  1.1.1.3  christos 	      }
   7658  1.1.1.3  christos 	    else
   7659  1.1.1.3  christos 	      {
   7660  1.1.1.3  christos 		/* Adjust the output section size when called from
   7661  1.1.1.8  christos 		   objcopy. */
   7662  1.1.1.8  christos 		isec->output_section->size -= removed;
   7663  1.1.1.8  christos 		if (isec->output_section->size <= 4)
   7664  1.1.1.8  christos 		  {
   7665  1.1.1.8  christos 		    isec->output_section->size = 0;
   7666  1.1.1.3  christos 		    isec->output_section->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
   7667  1.1.1.3  christos 		  }
   7668      1.1     skrll 	      }
   7669      1.1     skrll 	  }
   7670      1.1     skrll       }
   7671      1.1     skrll 
   7672      1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   7673  1.1.1.3  christos }
   7674  1.1.1.3  christos 
   7675  1.1.1.3  christos /* Copy private header information.  */
   7676  1.1.1.3  christos 
   7677  1.1.1.3  christos bfd_boolean
   7678  1.1.1.3  christos _bfd_elf_copy_private_header_data (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
   7679  1.1.1.3  christos {
   7680  1.1.1.3  christos   if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
   7681  1.1.1.3  christos       || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
   7682  1.1.1.3  christos     return TRUE;
   7683  1.1.1.3  christos 
   7684  1.1.1.3  christos   /* Copy over private BFD data if it has not already been copied.
   7685  1.1.1.3  christos      This must be done here, rather than in the copy_private_bfd_data
   7686  1.1.1.3  christos      entry point, because the latter is called after the section
   7687  1.1.1.5  christos      contents have been set, which means that the program headers have
   7688  1.1.1.3  christos      already been worked out.  */
   7689  1.1.1.3  christos   if (elf_seg_map (obfd) == NULL && elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr != NULL)
   7690  1.1.1.3  christos     {
   7691  1.1.1.3  christos       if (! copy_private_bfd_data (ibfd, obfd))
   7692  1.1.1.3  christos 	return FALSE;
   7693  1.1.1.3  christos     }
   7694  1.1.1.3  christos 
   7695  1.1.1.3  christos   return _bfd_elf_fixup_group_sections (ibfd, NULL);
   7696      1.1     skrll }
   7697      1.1     skrll 
   7698      1.1     skrll /* Copy private symbol information.  If this symbol is in a section
   7699      1.1     skrll    which we did not map into a BFD section, try to map the section
   7700      1.1     skrll    index correctly.  We use special macro definitions for the mapped
   7701      1.1     skrll    section indices; these definitions are interpreted by the
   7702      1.1     skrll    swap_out_syms function.  */
   7703      1.1     skrll 
   7704      1.1     skrll #define MAP_ONESYMTAB (SHN_HIOS + 1)
   7705      1.1     skrll #define MAP_DYNSYMTAB (SHN_HIOS + 2)
   7706      1.1     skrll #define MAP_STRTAB    (SHN_HIOS + 3)
   7707      1.1     skrll #define MAP_SHSTRTAB  (SHN_HIOS + 4)
   7708      1.1     skrll #define MAP_SYM_SHNDX (SHN_HIOS + 5)
   7709      1.1     skrll 
   7710      1.1     skrll bfd_boolean
   7711      1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_copy_private_symbol_data (bfd *ibfd,
   7712      1.1     skrll 				   asymbol *isymarg,
   7713      1.1     skrll 				   bfd *obfd,
   7714      1.1     skrll 				   asymbol *osymarg)
   7715      1.1     skrll {
   7716      1.1     skrll   elf_symbol_type *isym, *osym;
   7717      1.1     skrll 
   7718      1.1     skrll   if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
   7719      1.1     skrll       || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
   7720      1.1     skrll     return TRUE;
   7721      1.1     skrll 
   7722      1.1     skrll   isym = elf_symbol_from (ibfd, isymarg);
   7723      1.1     skrll   osym = elf_symbol_from (obfd, osymarg);
   7724      1.1     skrll 
   7725      1.1     skrll   if (isym != NULL
   7726      1.1     skrll       && isym->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx != 0
   7727      1.1     skrll       && osym != NULL
   7728      1.1     skrll       && bfd_is_abs_section (isym->symbol.section))
   7729      1.1     skrll     {
   7730      1.1     skrll       unsigned int shndx;
   7731      1.1     skrll 
   7732      1.1     skrll       shndx = isym->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx;
   7733      1.1     skrll       if (shndx == elf_onesymtab (ibfd))
   7734      1.1     skrll 	shndx = MAP_ONESYMTAB;
   7735  1.1.1.5  christos       else if (shndx == elf_dynsymtab (ibfd))
   7736      1.1     skrll 	shndx = MAP_DYNSYMTAB;
   7737  1.1.1.5  christos       else if (shndx == elf_strtab_sec (ibfd))
   7738      1.1     skrll 	shndx = MAP_STRTAB;
   7739  1.1.1.5  christos       else if (shndx == elf_shstrtab_sec (ibfd))
   7740      1.1     skrll 	shndx = MAP_SHSTRTAB;
   7741      1.1     skrll       else if (find_section_in_list (shndx, elf_symtab_shndx_list (ibfd)))
   7742      1.1     skrll 	shndx = MAP_SYM_SHNDX;
   7743      1.1     skrll       osym->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx = shndx;
   7744      1.1     skrll     }
   7745      1.1     skrll 
   7746      1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   7747      1.1     skrll }
   7748      1.1     skrll 
   7749      1.1     skrll /* Swap out the symbols.  */
   7750      1.1     skrll 
   7751  1.1.1.5  christos static bfd_boolean
   7752      1.1     skrll swap_out_syms (bfd *abfd,
   7753      1.1     skrll 	       struct elf_strtab_hash **sttp,
   7754      1.1     skrll 	       int relocatable_p)
   7755      1.1     skrll {
   7756      1.1     skrll   const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
   7757  1.1.1.5  christos   int symcount;
   7758      1.1     skrll   asymbol **syms;
   7759      1.1     skrll   struct elf_strtab_hash *stt;
   7760      1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
   7761  1.1.1.5  christos   Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_shndx_hdr;
   7762      1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Shdr *symstrtab_hdr;
   7763      1.1     skrll   struct elf_sym_strtab *symstrtab;
   7764  1.1.1.5  christos   bfd_byte *outbound_syms;
   7765  1.1.1.5  christos   bfd_byte *outbound_shndx;
   7766      1.1     skrll   unsigned long outbound_syms_index;
   7767  1.1.1.5  christos   unsigned long outbound_shndx_index;
   7768      1.1     skrll   int idx;
   7769      1.1     skrll   unsigned int num_locals;
   7770      1.1     skrll   bfd_size_type amt;
   7771  1.1.1.5  christos   bfd_boolean name_local_sections;
   7772      1.1     skrll 
   7773      1.1     skrll   if (!elf_map_symbols (abfd, &num_locals))
   7774      1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   7775  1.1.1.5  christos 
   7776      1.1     skrll   /* Dump out the symtabs.  */
   7777      1.1     skrll   stt = _bfd_elf_strtab_init ();
   7778      1.1     skrll   if (stt == NULL)
   7779      1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   7780      1.1     skrll 
   7781      1.1     skrll   bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   7782      1.1     skrll   symcount = bfd_get_symcount (abfd);
   7783      1.1     skrll   symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
   7784      1.1     skrll   symtab_hdr->sh_type = SHT_SYMTAB;
   7785  1.1.1.5  christos   symtab_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_sym;
   7786      1.1     skrll   symtab_hdr->sh_size = symtab_hdr->sh_entsize * (symcount + 1);
   7787      1.1     skrll   symtab_hdr->sh_info = num_locals + 1;
   7788      1.1     skrll   symtab_hdr->sh_addralign = (bfd_vma) 1 << bed->s->log_file_align;
   7789      1.1     skrll 
   7790      1.1     skrll   symstrtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr;
   7791  1.1.1.5  christos   symstrtab_hdr->sh_type = SHT_STRTAB;
   7792  1.1.1.5  christos 
   7793  1.1.1.5  christos   /* Allocate buffer to swap out the .strtab section.  */
   7794  1.1.1.5  christos   symstrtab = (struct elf_sym_strtab *) bfd_malloc ((symcount + 1)
   7795  1.1.1.5  christos 						    * sizeof (*symstrtab));
   7796  1.1.1.5  christos   if (symstrtab == NULL)
   7797  1.1.1.5  christos     {
   7798  1.1.1.5  christos       _bfd_elf_strtab_free (stt);
   7799  1.1.1.5  christos       return FALSE;
   7800  1.1.1.3  christos     }
   7801  1.1.1.7  christos 
   7802      1.1     skrll   outbound_syms = (bfd_byte *) bfd_alloc2 (abfd, 1 + symcount,
   7803      1.1     skrll 					   bed->s->sizeof_sym);
   7804  1.1.1.5  christos   if (outbound_syms == NULL)
   7805  1.1.1.5  christos     {
   7806  1.1.1.5  christos error_return:
   7807      1.1     skrll       _bfd_elf_strtab_free (stt);
   7808      1.1     skrll       free (symstrtab);
   7809      1.1     skrll       return FALSE;
   7810  1.1.1.5  christos     }
   7811      1.1     skrll   symtab_hdr->contents = outbound_syms;
   7812      1.1     skrll   outbound_syms_index = 0;
   7813  1.1.1.5  christos 
   7814  1.1.1.5  christos   outbound_shndx = NULL;
   7815  1.1.1.5  christos   outbound_shndx_index = 0;
   7816      1.1     skrll 
   7817  1.1.1.5  christos   if (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd))
   7818  1.1.1.5  christos     {
   7819      1.1     skrll       symtab_shndx_hdr = & elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd)->hdr;
   7820  1.1.1.5  christos       if (symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_name != 0)
   7821  1.1.1.5  christos 	{
   7822  1.1.1.5  christos 	  amt = (bfd_size_type) (1 + symcount) * sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
   7823  1.1.1.5  christos 	  outbound_shndx =  (bfd_byte *)
   7824  1.1.1.5  christos 	    bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, 1 + symcount, sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx));
   7825      1.1     skrll 	  if (outbound_shndx == NULL)
   7826  1.1.1.5  christos 	    goto error_return;
   7827  1.1.1.5  christos 
   7828  1.1.1.5  christos 	  symtab_shndx_hdr->contents = outbound_shndx;
   7829  1.1.1.5  christos 	  symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_type = SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX;
   7830  1.1.1.5  christos 	  symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_size = amt;
   7831  1.1.1.5  christos 	  symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_addralign = sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
   7832  1.1.1.5  christos 	  symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
   7833      1.1     skrll 	}
   7834      1.1     skrll       /* FIXME: What about any other headers in the list ?  */
   7835      1.1     skrll     }
   7836      1.1     skrll 
   7837      1.1     skrll   /* Now generate the data (for "contents").  */
   7838      1.1     skrll   {
   7839      1.1     skrll     /* Fill in zeroth symbol and swap it out.  */
   7840      1.1     skrll     Elf_Internal_Sym sym;
   7841      1.1     skrll     sym.st_name = 0;
   7842      1.1     skrll     sym.st_value = 0;
   7843      1.1     skrll     sym.st_size = 0;
   7844      1.1     skrll     sym.st_info = 0;
   7845  1.1.1.4  christos     sym.st_other = 0;
   7846  1.1.1.5  christos     sym.st_shndx = SHN_UNDEF;
   7847  1.1.1.5  christos     sym.st_target_internal = 0;
   7848  1.1.1.5  christos     symstrtab[0].sym = sym;
   7849  1.1.1.5  christos     symstrtab[0].dest_index = outbound_syms_index;
   7850      1.1     skrll     symstrtab[0].destshndx_index = outbound_shndx_index;
   7851  1.1.1.5  christos     outbound_syms_index++;
   7852      1.1     skrll     if (outbound_shndx != NULL)
   7853      1.1     skrll       outbound_shndx_index++;
   7854      1.1     skrll   }
   7855      1.1     skrll 
   7856      1.1     skrll   name_local_sections
   7857      1.1     skrll     = (bed->elf_backend_name_local_section_symbols
   7858      1.1     skrll        && bed->elf_backend_name_local_section_symbols (abfd));
   7859  1.1.1.5  christos 
   7860      1.1     skrll   syms = bfd_get_outsymbols (abfd);
   7861      1.1     skrll   for (idx = 0; idx < symcount;)
   7862      1.1     skrll     {
   7863      1.1     skrll       Elf_Internal_Sym sym;
   7864      1.1     skrll       bfd_vma value = syms[idx]->value;
   7865      1.1     skrll       elf_symbol_type *type_ptr;
   7866      1.1     skrll       flagword flags = syms[idx]->flags;
   7867      1.1     skrll       int type;
   7868      1.1     skrll 
   7869      1.1     skrll       if (!name_local_sections
   7870      1.1     skrll 	  && (flags & (BSF_SECTION_SYM | BSF_GLOBAL)) == BSF_SECTION_SYM)
   7871  1.1.1.5  christos 	{
   7872      1.1     skrll 	  /* Local section symbols have no name.  */
   7873      1.1     skrll 	  sym.st_name = (unsigned long) -1;
   7874      1.1     skrll 	}
   7875  1.1.1.5  christos       else
   7876  1.1.1.5  christos 	{
   7877  1.1.1.5  christos 	  /* Call _bfd_elf_strtab_offset after _bfd_elf_strtab_finalize
   7878  1.1.1.5  christos 	     to get the final offset for st_name.  */
   7879  1.1.1.5  christos 	  sym.st_name
   7880      1.1     skrll 	    = (unsigned long) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (stt, syms[idx]->name,
   7881  1.1.1.5  christos 						   FALSE);
   7882      1.1     skrll 	  if (sym.st_name == (unsigned long) -1)
   7883      1.1     skrll 	    goto error_return;
   7884      1.1     skrll 	}
   7885      1.1     skrll 
   7886      1.1     skrll       type_ptr = elf_symbol_from (abfd, syms[idx]);
   7887      1.1     skrll 
   7888      1.1     skrll       if ((flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) == 0
   7889      1.1     skrll 	  && bfd_is_com_section (syms[idx]->section))
   7890      1.1     skrll 	{
   7891      1.1     skrll 	  /* ELF common symbols put the alignment into the `value' field,
   7892      1.1     skrll 	     and the size into the `size' field.  This is backwards from
   7893      1.1     skrll 	     how BFD handles it, so reverse it here.  */
   7894      1.1     skrll 	  sym.st_size = value;
   7895      1.1     skrll 	  if (type_ptr == NULL
   7896      1.1     skrll 	      || type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_value == 0)
   7897      1.1     skrll 	    sym.st_value = value >= 16 ? 16 : (1 << bfd_log2 (value));
   7898      1.1     skrll 	  else
   7899      1.1     skrll 	    sym.st_value = type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_value;
   7900      1.1     skrll 	  sym.st_shndx = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section
   7901      1.1     skrll 	    (abfd, syms[idx]->section);
   7902      1.1     skrll 	}
   7903      1.1     skrll       else
   7904      1.1     skrll 	{
   7905      1.1     skrll 	  asection *sec = syms[idx]->section;
   7906      1.1     skrll 	  unsigned int shndx;
   7907      1.1     skrll 
   7908      1.1     skrll 	  if (sec->output_section)
   7909      1.1     skrll 	    {
   7910      1.1     skrll 	      value += sec->output_offset;
   7911      1.1     skrll 	      sec = sec->output_section;
   7912      1.1     skrll 	    }
   7913      1.1     skrll 
   7914      1.1     skrll 	  /* Don't add in the section vma for relocatable output.  */
   7915      1.1     skrll 	  if (! relocatable_p)
   7916      1.1     skrll 	    value += sec->vma;
   7917      1.1     skrll 	  sym.st_value = value;
   7918      1.1     skrll 	  sym.st_size = type_ptr ? type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_size : 0;
   7919      1.1     skrll 
   7920      1.1     skrll 	  if (bfd_is_abs_section (sec)
   7921      1.1     skrll 	      && type_ptr != NULL
   7922      1.1     skrll 	      && type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx != 0)
   7923      1.1     skrll 	    {
   7924      1.1     skrll 	      /* This symbol is in a real ELF section which we did
   7925      1.1     skrll 		 not create as a BFD section.  Undo the mapping done
   7926      1.1     skrll 		 by copy_private_symbol_data.  */
   7927      1.1     skrll 	      shndx = type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx;
   7928      1.1     skrll 	      switch (shndx)
   7929      1.1     skrll 		{
   7930      1.1     skrll 		case MAP_ONESYMTAB:
   7931      1.1     skrll 		  shndx = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
   7932      1.1     skrll 		  break;
   7933      1.1     skrll 		case MAP_DYNSYMTAB:
   7934      1.1     skrll 		  shndx = elf_dynsymtab (abfd);
   7935  1.1.1.5  christos 		  break;
   7936      1.1     skrll 		case MAP_STRTAB:
   7937      1.1     skrll 		  shndx = elf_strtab_sec (abfd);
   7938  1.1.1.5  christos 		  break;
   7939      1.1     skrll 		case MAP_SHSTRTAB:
   7940      1.1     skrll 		  shndx = elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd);
   7941  1.1.1.5  christos 		  break;
   7942  1.1.1.5  christos 		case MAP_SYM_SHNDX:
   7943      1.1     skrll 		  if (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd))
   7944      1.1     skrll 		    shndx = elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd)->ndx;
   7945  1.1.1.4  christos 		  break;
   7946      1.1     skrll 		default:
   7947      1.1     skrll 		  shndx = SHN_ABS;
   7948      1.1     skrll 		  break;
   7949      1.1     skrll 		}
   7950      1.1     skrll 	    }
   7951      1.1     skrll 	  else
   7952      1.1     skrll 	    {
   7953      1.1     skrll 	      shndx = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (abfd, sec);
   7954      1.1     skrll 
   7955      1.1     skrll 	      if (shndx == SHN_BAD)
   7956      1.1     skrll 		{
   7957      1.1     skrll 		  asection *sec2;
   7958      1.1     skrll 
   7959      1.1     skrll 		  /* Writing this would be a hell of a lot easier if
   7960      1.1     skrll 		     we had some decent documentation on bfd, and
   7961      1.1     skrll 		     knew what to expect of the library, and what to
   7962      1.1     skrll 		     demand of applications.  For example, it
   7963      1.1     skrll 		     appears that `objcopy' might not set the
   7964      1.1     skrll 		     section of a symbol to be a section that is
   7965  1.1.1.7  christos 		     actually in the output file.  */
   7966  1.1.1.7  christos 		  sec2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, sec->name);
   7967  1.1.1.7  christos 		  if (sec2 != NULL)
   7968      1.1     skrll 		    shndx = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (abfd, sec2);
   7969  1.1.1.7  christos 		  if (shndx == SHN_BAD)
   7970  1.1.1.8  christos 		    {
   7971  1.1.1.8  christos 		      /* xgettext:c-format */
   7972  1.1.1.8  christos 		      _bfd_error_handler
   7973  1.1.1.8  christos 			(_("unable to find equivalent output section"
   7974  1.1.1.8  christos 			   " for symbol '%s' from section '%s'"),
   7975      1.1     skrll 			 syms[idx]->name ? syms[idx]->name : "<Local sym>",
   7976  1.1.1.5  christos 			 sec->name);
   7977      1.1     skrll 		      bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
   7978      1.1     skrll 		      goto error_return;
   7979      1.1     skrll 		    }
   7980      1.1     skrll 		}
   7981      1.1     skrll 	    }
   7982      1.1     skrll 
   7983      1.1     skrll 	  sym.st_shndx = shndx;
   7984      1.1     skrll 	}
   7985      1.1     skrll 
   7986  1.1.1.3  christos       if ((flags & BSF_THREAD_LOCAL) != 0)
   7987  1.1.1.3  christos 	type = STT_TLS;
   7988      1.1     skrll       else if ((flags & BSF_GNU_INDIRECT_FUNCTION) != 0)
   7989      1.1     skrll 	type = STT_GNU_IFUNC;
   7990      1.1     skrll       else if ((flags & BSF_FUNCTION) != 0)
   7991      1.1     skrll 	type = STT_FUNC;
   7992      1.1     skrll       else if ((flags & BSF_OBJECT) != 0)
   7993      1.1     skrll 	type = STT_OBJECT;
   7994      1.1     skrll       else if ((flags & BSF_RELC) != 0)
   7995      1.1     skrll 	type = STT_RELC;
   7996      1.1     skrll       else if ((flags & BSF_SRELC) != 0)
   7997      1.1     skrll 	type = STT_SRELC;
   7998      1.1     skrll       else
   7999      1.1     skrll 	type = STT_NOTYPE;
   8000      1.1     skrll 
   8001      1.1     skrll       if (syms[idx]->section->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
   8002      1.1     skrll 	type = STT_TLS;
   8003      1.1     skrll 
   8004      1.1     skrll       /* Processor-specific types.  */
   8005      1.1     skrll       if (type_ptr != NULL
   8006      1.1     skrll 	  && bed->elf_backend_get_symbol_type)
   8007      1.1     skrll 	type = ((*bed->elf_backend_get_symbol_type)
   8008      1.1     skrll 		(&type_ptr->internal_elf_sym, type));
   8009      1.1     skrll 
   8010      1.1     skrll       if (flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM)
   8011      1.1     skrll 	{
   8012      1.1     skrll 	  if (flags & BSF_GLOBAL)
   8013      1.1     skrll 	    sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION);
   8014      1.1     skrll 	  else
   8015      1.1     skrll 	    sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_LOCAL, STT_SECTION);
   8016      1.1     skrll 	}
   8017  1.1.1.6  christos       else if (bfd_is_com_section (syms[idx]->section))
   8018  1.1.1.6  christos 	{
   8019  1.1.1.6  christos 	  if (type != STT_TLS)
   8020  1.1.1.6  christos 	    {
   8021  1.1.1.6  christos 	      if ((abfd->flags & BFD_CONVERT_ELF_COMMON))
   8022  1.1.1.6  christos 		type = ((abfd->flags & BFD_USE_ELF_STT_COMMON)
   8023  1.1.1.6  christos 			? STT_COMMON : STT_OBJECT);
   8024  1.1.1.6  christos 	      else
   8025  1.1.1.6  christos 		type = ((flags & BSF_ELF_COMMON) != 0
   8026  1.1.1.6  christos 			? STT_COMMON : STT_OBJECT);
   8027      1.1     skrll 	    }
   8028      1.1     skrll 	  sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, type);
   8029      1.1     skrll 	}
   8030      1.1     skrll       else if (bfd_is_und_section (syms[idx]->section))
   8031      1.1     skrll 	sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (((flags & BSF_WEAK)
   8032      1.1     skrll 				    ? STB_WEAK
   8033      1.1     skrll 				    : STB_GLOBAL),
   8034      1.1     skrll 				   type);
   8035      1.1     skrll       else if (flags & BSF_FILE)
   8036      1.1     skrll 	sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_LOCAL, STT_FILE);
   8037      1.1     skrll       else
   8038      1.1     skrll 	{
   8039      1.1     skrll 	  int bind = STB_LOCAL;
   8040      1.1     skrll 
   8041  1.1.1.3  christos 	  if (flags & BSF_LOCAL)
   8042  1.1.1.3  christos 	    bind = STB_LOCAL;
   8043      1.1     skrll 	  else if (flags & BSF_GNU_UNIQUE)
   8044      1.1     skrll 	    bind = STB_GNU_UNIQUE;
   8045      1.1     skrll 	  else if (flags & BSF_WEAK)
   8046      1.1     skrll 	    bind = STB_WEAK;
   8047      1.1     skrll 	  else if (flags & BSF_GLOBAL)
   8048      1.1     skrll 	    bind = STB_GLOBAL;
   8049      1.1     skrll 
   8050      1.1     skrll 	  sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (bind, type);
   8051      1.1     skrll 	}
   8052  1.1.1.4  christos 
   8053  1.1.1.4  christos       if (type_ptr != NULL)
   8054  1.1.1.4  christos 	{
   8055  1.1.1.4  christos 	  sym.st_other = type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_other;
   8056  1.1.1.4  christos 	  sym.st_target_internal
   8057      1.1     skrll 	    = type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_target_internal;
   8058  1.1.1.4  christos 	}
   8059  1.1.1.4  christos       else
   8060  1.1.1.4  christos 	{
   8061  1.1.1.4  christos 	  sym.st_other = 0;
   8062      1.1     skrll 	  sym.st_target_internal = 0;
   8063  1.1.1.5  christos 	}
   8064  1.1.1.5  christos 
   8065  1.1.1.5  christos       idx++;
   8066  1.1.1.5  christos       symstrtab[idx].sym = sym;
   8067  1.1.1.5  christos       symstrtab[idx].dest_index = outbound_syms_index;
   8068  1.1.1.5  christos       symstrtab[idx].destshndx_index = outbound_shndx_index;
   8069      1.1     skrll 
   8070  1.1.1.5  christos       outbound_syms_index++;
   8071      1.1     skrll       if (outbound_shndx != NULL)
   8072      1.1     skrll 	outbound_shndx_index++;
   8073  1.1.1.5  christos     }
   8074  1.1.1.5  christos 
   8075  1.1.1.5  christos   /* Finalize the .strtab section.  */
   8076  1.1.1.5  christos   _bfd_elf_strtab_finalize (stt);
   8077  1.1.1.5  christos 
   8078  1.1.1.5  christos   /* Swap out the .strtab section.  */
   8079  1.1.1.5  christos   for (idx = 0; idx <= symcount; idx++)
   8080  1.1.1.5  christos     {
   8081  1.1.1.5  christos       struct elf_sym_strtab *elfsym = &symstrtab[idx];
   8082  1.1.1.5  christos       if (elfsym->sym.st_name == (unsigned long) -1)
   8083  1.1.1.5  christos 	elfsym->sym.st_name = 0;
   8084  1.1.1.5  christos       else
   8085  1.1.1.5  christos 	elfsym->sym.st_name = _bfd_elf_strtab_offset (stt,
   8086  1.1.1.5  christos 						      elfsym->sym.st_name);
   8087  1.1.1.5  christos       bed->s->swap_symbol_out (abfd, &elfsym->sym,
   8088  1.1.1.5  christos 			       (outbound_syms
   8089  1.1.1.5  christos 				+ (elfsym->dest_index
   8090  1.1.1.5  christos 				   * bed->s->sizeof_sym)),
   8091  1.1.1.5  christos 			       (outbound_shndx
   8092  1.1.1.5  christos 				+ (elfsym->destshndx_index
   8093  1.1.1.5  christos 				   * sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx))));
   8094  1.1.1.5  christos     }
   8095      1.1     skrll   free (symstrtab);
   8096  1.1.1.5  christos 
   8097      1.1     skrll   *sttp = stt;
   8098  1.1.1.6  christos   symstrtab_hdr->sh_size = _bfd_elf_strtab_size (stt);
   8099      1.1     skrll   symstrtab_hdr->sh_type = SHT_STRTAB;
   8100      1.1     skrll   symstrtab_hdr->sh_flags = bed->elf_strtab_flags;
   8101      1.1     skrll   symstrtab_hdr->sh_addr = 0;
   8102      1.1     skrll   symstrtab_hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
   8103      1.1     skrll   symstrtab_hdr->sh_link = 0;
   8104      1.1     skrll   symstrtab_hdr->sh_info = 0;
   8105      1.1     skrll   symstrtab_hdr->sh_addralign = 1;
   8106      1.1     skrll 
   8107      1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   8108      1.1     skrll }
   8109      1.1     skrll 
   8110      1.1     skrll /* Return the number of bytes required to hold the symtab vector.
   8111      1.1     skrll 
   8112      1.1     skrll    Note that we base it on the count plus 1, since we will null terminate
   8113      1.1     skrll    the vector allocated based on this size.  However, the ELF symbol table
   8114      1.1     skrll    always has a dummy entry as symbol #0, so it ends up even.  */
   8115      1.1     skrll 
   8116      1.1     skrll long
   8117      1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_get_symtab_upper_bound (bfd *abfd)
   8118      1.1     skrll {
   8119      1.1     skrll   long symcount;
   8120      1.1     skrll   long symtab_size;
   8121      1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
   8122      1.1     skrll 
   8123      1.1     skrll   symcount = hdr->sh_size / get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_sym;
   8124      1.1     skrll   symtab_size = (symcount + 1) * (sizeof (asymbol *));
   8125      1.1     skrll   if (symcount > 0)
   8126      1.1     skrll     symtab_size -= sizeof (asymbol *);
   8127      1.1     skrll 
   8128      1.1     skrll   return symtab_size;
   8129      1.1     skrll }
   8130      1.1     skrll 
   8131      1.1     skrll long
   8132      1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_get_dynamic_symtab_upper_bound (bfd *abfd)
   8133      1.1     skrll {
   8134      1.1     skrll   long symcount;
   8135      1.1     skrll   long symtab_size;
   8136      1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynsymtab_hdr;
   8137      1.1     skrll 
   8138      1.1     skrll   if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0)
   8139      1.1     skrll     {
   8140      1.1     skrll       bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
   8141      1.1     skrll       return -1;
   8142      1.1     skrll     }
   8143      1.1     skrll 
   8144      1.1     skrll   symcount = hdr->sh_size / get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_sym;
   8145      1.1     skrll   symtab_size = (symcount + 1) * (sizeof (asymbol *));
   8146      1.1     skrll   if (symcount > 0)
   8147      1.1     skrll     symtab_size -= sizeof (asymbol *);
   8148      1.1     skrll 
   8149      1.1     skrll   return symtab_size;
   8150      1.1     skrll }
   8151      1.1     skrll 
   8152      1.1     skrll long
   8153      1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_get_reloc_upper_bound (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
   8154      1.1     skrll 				sec_ptr asect)
   8155      1.1     skrll {
   8156      1.1     skrll   return (asect->reloc_count + 1) * sizeof (arelent *);
   8157      1.1     skrll }
   8158      1.1     skrll 
   8159      1.1     skrll /* Canonicalize the relocs.  */
   8160      1.1     skrll 
   8161      1.1     skrll long
   8162      1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_canonicalize_reloc (bfd *abfd,
   8163      1.1     skrll 			     sec_ptr section,
   8164      1.1     skrll 			     arelent **relptr,
   8165      1.1     skrll 			     asymbol **symbols)
   8166      1.1     skrll {
   8167      1.1     skrll   arelent *tblptr;
   8168      1.1     skrll   unsigned int i;
   8169      1.1     skrll   const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   8170      1.1     skrll 
   8171      1.1     skrll   if (! bed->s->slurp_reloc_table (abfd, section, symbols, FALSE))
   8172      1.1     skrll     return -1;
   8173      1.1     skrll 
   8174      1.1     skrll   tblptr = section->relocation;
   8175      1.1     skrll   for (i = 0; i < section->reloc_count; i++)
   8176      1.1     skrll     *relptr++ = tblptr++;
   8177      1.1     skrll 
   8178      1.1     skrll   *relptr = NULL;
   8179      1.1     skrll 
   8180      1.1     skrll   return section->reloc_count;
   8181      1.1     skrll }
   8182      1.1     skrll 
   8183      1.1     skrll long
   8184      1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_canonicalize_symtab (bfd *abfd, asymbol **allocation)
   8185      1.1     skrll {
   8186      1.1     skrll   const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   8187      1.1     skrll   long symcount = bed->s->slurp_symbol_table (abfd, allocation, FALSE);
   8188      1.1     skrll 
   8189      1.1     skrll   if (symcount >= 0)
   8190      1.1     skrll     bfd_get_symcount (abfd) = symcount;
   8191      1.1     skrll   return symcount;
   8192      1.1     skrll }
   8193      1.1     skrll 
   8194      1.1     skrll long
   8195      1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_canonicalize_dynamic_symtab (bfd *abfd,
   8196      1.1     skrll 				      asymbol **allocation)
   8197      1.1     skrll {
   8198      1.1     skrll   const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   8199      1.1     skrll   long symcount = bed->s->slurp_symbol_table (abfd, allocation, TRUE);
   8200      1.1     skrll 
   8201      1.1     skrll   if (symcount >= 0)
   8202      1.1     skrll     bfd_get_dynamic_symcount (abfd) = symcount;
   8203      1.1     skrll   return symcount;
   8204      1.1     skrll }
   8205      1.1     skrll 
   8206      1.1     skrll /* Return the size required for the dynamic reloc entries.  Any loadable
   8207      1.1     skrll    section that was actually installed in the BFD, and has type SHT_REL
   8208      1.1     skrll    or SHT_RELA, and uses the dynamic symbol table, is considered to be a
   8209      1.1     skrll    dynamic reloc section.  */
   8210      1.1     skrll 
   8211      1.1     skrll long
   8212      1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_get_dynamic_reloc_upper_bound (bfd *abfd)
   8213      1.1     skrll {
   8214      1.1     skrll   long ret;
   8215      1.1     skrll   asection *s;
   8216      1.1     skrll 
   8217      1.1     skrll   if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0)
   8218      1.1     skrll     {
   8219      1.1     skrll       bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
   8220      1.1     skrll       return -1;
   8221      1.1     skrll     }
   8222      1.1     skrll 
   8223      1.1     skrll   ret = sizeof (arelent *);
   8224      1.1     skrll   for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
   8225      1.1     skrll     if (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_link == elf_dynsymtab (abfd)
   8226      1.1     skrll 	&& (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_REL
   8227      1.1     skrll 	    || elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_RELA))
   8228      1.1     skrll       ret += ((s->size / elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_entsize)
   8229      1.1     skrll 	      * sizeof (arelent *));
   8230      1.1     skrll 
   8231      1.1     skrll   return ret;
   8232      1.1     skrll }
   8233      1.1     skrll 
   8234      1.1     skrll /* Canonicalize the dynamic relocation entries.  Note that we return the
   8235      1.1     skrll    dynamic relocations as a single block, although they are actually
   8236      1.1     skrll    associated with particular sections; the interface, which was
   8237      1.1     skrll    designed for SunOS style shared libraries, expects that there is only
   8238      1.1     skrll    one set of dynamic relocs.  Any loadable section that was actually
   8239      1.1     skrll    installed in the BFD, and has type SHT_REL or SHT_RELA, and uses the
   8240      1.1     skrll    dynamic symbol table, is considered to be a dynamic reloc section.  */
   8241      1.1     skrll 
   8242      1.1     skrll long
   8243      1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_canonicalize_dynamic_reloc (bfd *abfd,
   8244      1.1     skrll 				     arelent **storage,
   8245      1.1     skrll 				     asymbol **syms)
   8246      1.1     skrll {
   8247      1.1     skrll   bfd_boolean (*slurp_relocs) (bfd *, asection *, asymbol **, bfd_boolean);
   8248      1.1     skrll   asection *s;
   8249      1.1     skrll   long ret;
   8250      1.1     skrll 
   8251      1.1     skrll   if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0)
   8252      1.1     skrll     {
   8253      1.1     skrll       bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
   8254      1.1     skrll       return -1;
   8255      1.1     skrll     }
   8256      1.1     skrll 
   8257      1.1     skrll   slurp_relocs = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->slurp_reloc_table;
   8258      1.1     skrll   ret = 0;
   8259      1.1     skrll   for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
   8260      1.1     skrll     {
   8261      1.1     skrll       if (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_link == elf_dynsymtab (abfd)
   8262      1.1     skrll 	  && (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_REL
   8263      1.1     skrll 	      || elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_RELA))
   8264      1.1     skrll 	{
   8265      1.1     skrll 	  arelent *p;
   8266      1.1     skrll 	  long count, i;
   8267      1.1     skrll 
   8268      1.1     skrll 	  if (! (*slurp_relocs) (abfd, s, syms, TRUE))
   8269      1.1     skrll 	    return -1;
   8270      1.1     skrll 	  count = s->size / elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_entsize;
   8271      1.1     skrll 	  p = s->relocation;
   8272      1.1     skrll 	  for (i = 0; i < count; i++)
   8273      1.1     skrll 	    *storage++ = p++;
   8274      1.1     skrll 	  ret += count;
   8275      1.1     skrll 	}
   8276      1.1     skrll     }
   8277      1.1     skrll 
   8278      1.1     skrll   *storage = NULL;
   8279      1.1     skrll 
   8280      1.1     skrll   return ret;
   8281      1.1     skrll }
   8282      1.1     skrll 
   8283      1.1     skrll /* Read in the version information.  */
   8285      1.1     skrll 
   8286      1.1     skrll bfd_boolean
   8287      1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_slurp_version_tables (bfd *abfd, bfd_boolean default_imported_symver)
   8288      1.1     skrll {
   8289      1.1     skrll   bfd_byte *contents = NULL;
   8290      1.1     skrll   unsigned int freeidx = 0;
   8291      1.1     skrll 
   8292      1.1     skrll   if (elf_dynverref (abfd) != 0)
   8293      1.1     skrll     {
   8294      1.1     skrll       Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
   8295      1.1     skrll       Elf_External_Verneed *everneed;
   8296      1.1     skrll       Elf_Internal_Verneed *iverneed;
   8297      1.1     skrll       unsigned int i;
   8298      1.1     skrll       bfd_byte *contents_end;
   8299  1.1.1.7  christos 
   8300  1.1.1.7  christos       hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverref_hdr;
   8301      1.1     skrll 
   8302  1.1.1.5  christos       if (hdr->sh_info == 0
   8303  1.1.1.7  christos 	  || hdr->sh_info > hdr->sh_size / sizeof (Elf_External_Verneed))
   8304  1.1.1.8  christos 	{
   8305  1.1.1.5  christos error_return_bad_verref:
   8306      1.1     skrll 	  _bfd_error_handler
   8307      1.1     skrll 	    (_("%pB: .gnu.version_r invalid entry"), abfd);
   8308      1.1     skrll 	  bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
   8309      1.1     skrll error_return_verref:
   8310      1.1     skrll 	  elf_tdata (abfd)->verref = NULL;
   8311  1.1.1.5  christos 	  elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs = 0;
   8312  1.1.1.5  christos 	  goto error_return;
   8313  1.1.1.5  christos 	}
   8314  1.1.1.5  christos 
   8315  1.1.1.5  christos       contents = (bfd_byte *) bfd_malloc (hdr->sh_size);
   8316      1.1     skrll       if (contents == NULL)
   8317      1.1     skrll 	goto error_return_verref;
   8318      1.1     skrll 
   8319      1.1     skrll       if (bfd_seek (abfd, hdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
   8320  1.1.1.5  christos 	  || bfd_bread (contents, hdr->sh_size, abfd) != hdr->sh_size)
   8321  1.1.1.7  christos 	goto error_return_verref;
   8322  1.1.1.5  christos 
   8323  1.1.1.5  christos       elf_tdata (abfd)->verref = (Elf_Internal_Verneed *)
   8324      1.1     skrll 	bfd_alloc2 (abfd, hdr->sh_info, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verneed));
   8325      1.1     skrll 
   8326      1.1     skrll       if (elf_tdata (abfd)->verref == NULL)
   8327      1.1     skrll 	goto error_return_verref;
   8328      1.1     skrll 
   8329      1.1     skrll       BFD_ASSERT (sizeof (Elf_External_Verneed)
   8330      1.1     skrll 		  == sizeof (Elf_External_Vernaux));
   8331      1.1     skrll       contents_end = contents + hdr->sh_size - sizeof (Elf_External_Verneed);
   8332      1.1     skrll       everneed = (Elf_External_Verneed *) contents;
   8333      1.1     skrll       iverneed = elf_tdata (abfd)->verref;
   8334      1.1     skrll       for (i = 0; i < hdr->sh_info; i++, iverneed++)
   8335      1.1     skrll 	{
   8336      1.1     skrll 	  Elf_External_Vernaux *evernaux;
   8337      1.1     skrll 	  Elf_Internal_Vernaux *ivernaux;
   8338      1.1     skrll 	  unsigned int j;
   8339      1.1     skrll 
   8340      1.1     skrll 	  _bfd_elf_swap_verneed_in (abfd, everneed, iverneed);
   8341      1.1     skrll 
   8342      1.1     skrll 	  iverneed->vn_bfd = abfd;
   8343      1.1     skrll 
   8344      1.1     skrll 	  iverneed->vn_filename =
   8345  1.1.1.5  christos 	    bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, hdr->sh_link,
   8346      1.1     skrll 					     iverneed->vn_file);
   8347      1.1     skrll 	  if (iverneed->vn_filename == NULL)
   8348      1.1     skrll 	    goto error_return_bad_verref;
   8349      1.1     skrll 
   8350      1.1     skrll 	  if (iverneed->vn_cnt == 0)
   8351  1.1.1.3  christos 	    iverneed->vn_auxptr = NULL;
   8352  1.1.1.7  christos 	  else
   8353  1.1.1.7  christos 	    {
   8354      1.1     skrll 	      iverneed->vn_auxptr = (struct elf_internal_vernaux *)
   8355      1.1     skrll 		  bfd_alloc2 (abfd, iverneed->vn_cnt,
   8356      1.1     skrll 			      sizeof (Elf_Internal_Vernaux));
   8357      1.1     skrll 	      if (iverneed->vn_auxptr == NULL)
   8358      1.1     skrll 		goto error_return_verref;
   8359      1.1     skrll 	    }
   8360  1.1.1.5  christos 
   8361      1.1     skrll 	  if (iverneed->vn_aux
   8362      1.1     skrll 	      > (size_t) (contents_end - (bfd_byte *) everneed))
   8363      1.1     skrll 	    goto error_return_bad_verref;
   8364      1.1     skrll 
   8365      1.1     skrll 	  evernaux = ((Elf_External_Vernaux *)
   8366      1.1     skrll 		      ((bfd_byte *) everneed + iverneed->vn_aux));
   8367      1.1     skrll 	  ivernaux = iverneed->vn_auxptr;
   8368      1.1     skrll 	  for (j = 0; j < iverneed->vn_cnt; j++, ivernaux++)
   8369      1.1     skrll 	    {
   8370      1.1     skrll 	      _bfd_elf_swap_vernaux_in (abfd, evernaux, ivernaux);
   8371      1.1     skrll 
   8372      1.1     skrll 	      ivernaux->vna_nodename =
   8373  1.1.1.5  christos 		bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, hdr->sh_link,
   8374  1.1.1.5  christos 						 ivernaux->vna_name);
   8375  1.1.1.5  christos 	      if (ivernaux->vna_nodename == NULL)
   8376  1.1.1.5  christos 		goto error_return_bad_verref;
   8377      1.1     skrll 
   8378  1.1.1.5  christos 	      if (ivernaux->vna_other > freeidx)
   8379  1.1.1.5  christos 		freeidx = ivernaux->vna_other;
   8380  1.1.1.5  christos 
   8381  1.1.1.5  christos 	      ivernaux->vna_nextptr = NULL;
   8382  1.1.1.5  christos 	      if (ivernaux->vna_next == 0)
   8383  1.1.1.5  christos 		{
   8384      1.1     skrll 		  iverneed->vn_cnt = j + 1;
   8385      1.1     skrll 		  break;
   8386      1.1     skrll 		}
   8387      1.1     skrll 	      if (j + 1 < iverneed->vn_cnt)
   8388      1.1     skrll 		ivernaux->vna_nextptr = ivernaux + 1;
   8389  1.1.1.5  christos 
   8390      1.1     skrll 	      if (ivernaux->vna_next
   8391      1.1     skrll 		  > (size_t) (contents_end - (bfd_byte *) evernaux))
   8392      1.1     skrll 		goto error_return_bad_verref;
   8393      1.1     skrll 
   8394      1.1     skrll 	      evernaux = ((Elf_External_Vernaux *)
   8395  1.1.1.5  christos 			  ((bfd_byte *) evernaux + ivernaux->vna_next));
   8396  1.1.1.5  christos 	    }
   8397  1.1.1.5  christos 
   8398      1.1     skrll 	  iverneed->vn_nextref = NULL;
   8399      1.1     skrll 	  if (iverneed->vn_next == 0)
   8400      1.1     skrll 	    break;
   8401      1.1     skrll 	  if (i + 1 < hdr->sh_info)
   8402      1.1     skrll 	    iverneed->vn_nextref = iverneed + 1;
   8403  1.1.1.5  christos 
   8404      1.1     skrll 	  if (iverneed->vn_next
   8405      1.1     skrll 	      > (size_t) (contents_end - (bfd_byte *) everneed))
   8406      1.1     skrll 	    goto error_return_bad_verref;
   8407      1.1     skrll 
   8408  1.1.1.5  christos 	  everneed = ((Elf_External_Verneed *)
   8409      1.1     skrll 		      ((bfd_byte *) everneed + iverneed->vn_next));
   8410      1.1     skrll 	}
   8411      1.1     skrll       elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs = i;
   8412      1.1     skrll 
   8413      1.1     skrll       free (contents);
   8414      1.1     skrll       contents = NULL;
   8415      1.1     skrll     }
   8416      1.1     skrll 
   8417      1.1     skrll   if (elf_dynverdef (abfd) != 0)
   8418      1.1     skrll     {
   8419      1.1     skrll       Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
   8420      1.1     skrll       Elf_External_Verdef *everdef;
   8421      1.1     skrll       Elf_Internal_Verdef *iverdef;
   8422      1.1     skrll       Elf_Internal_Verdef *iverdefarr;
   8423      1.1     skrll       Elf_Internal_Verdef iverdefmem;
   8424      1.1     skrll       unsigned int i;
   8425      1.1     skrll       unsigned int maxidx;
   8426      1.1     skrll       bfd_byte *contents_end_def, *contents_end_aux;
   8427  1.1.1.5  christos 
   8428  1.1.1.5  christos       hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverdef_hdr;
   8429  1.1.1.5  christos 
   8430  1.1.1.7  christos       if (hdr->sh_info == 0 || hdr->sh_size < sizeof (Elf_External_Verdef))
   8431  1.1.1.8  christos 	{
   8432  1.1.1.5  christos 	error_return_bad_verdef:
   8433  1.1.1.5  christos 	  _bfd_error_handler
   8434  1.1.1.5  christos 	    (_("%pB: .gnu.version_d invalid entry"), abfd);
   8435  1.1.1.5  christos 	  bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
   8436  1.1.1.5  christos 	error_return_verdef:
   8437  1.1.1.5  christos 	  elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef = NULL;
   8438  1.1.1.5  christos 	  elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs = 0;
   8439  1.1.1.3  christos 	  goto error_return;
   8440      1.1     skrll 	}
   8441  1.1.1.5  christos 
   8442      1.1     skrll       contents = (bfd_byte *) bfd_malloc (hdr->sh_size);
   8443      1.1     skrll       if (contents == NULL)
   8444  1.1.1.5  christos 	goto error_return_verdef;
   8445      1.1     skrll       if (bfd_seek (abfd, hdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
   8446      1.1     skrll 	  || bfd_bread (contents, hdr->sh_size, abfd) != hdr->sh_size)
   8447      1.1     skrll 	goto error_return_verdef;
   8448      1.1     skrll 
   8449      1.1     skrll       BFD_ASSERT (sizeof (Elf_External_Verdef)
   8450      1.1     skrll 		  >= sizeof (Elf_External_Verdaux));
   8451      1.1     skrll       contents_end_def = contents + hdr->sh_size
   8452      1.1     skrll 			 - sizeof (Elf_External_Verdef);
   8453      1.1     skrll       contents_end_aux = contents + hdr->sh_size
   8454      1.1     skrll 			 - sizeof (Elf_External_Verdaux);
   8455      1.1     skrll 
   8456      1.1     skrll       /* We know the number of entries in the section but not the maximum
   8457      1.1     skrll 	 index.  Therefore we have to run through all entries and find
   8458      1.1     skrll 	 the maximum.  */
   8459      1.1     skrll       everdef = (Elf_External_Verdef *) contents;
   8460      1.1     skrll       maxidx = 0;
   8461      1.1     skrll       for (i = 0; i < hdr->sh_info; ++i)
   8462  1.1.1.5  christos 	{
   8463  1.1.1.5  christos 	  _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_in (abfd, everdef, &iverdefmem);
   8464      1.1     skrll 
   8465      1.1     skrll 	  if ((iverdefmem.vd_ndx & ((unsigned) VERSYM_VERSION)) == 0)
   8466      1.1     skrll 	    goto error_return_bad_verdef;
   8467  1.1.1.5  christos 	  if ((iverdefmem.vd_ndx & ((unsigned) VERSYM_VERSION)) > maxidx)
   8468  1.1.1.5  christos 	    maxidx = iverdefmem.vd_ndx & ((unsigned) VERSYM_VERSION);
   8469  1.1.1.5  christos 
   8470      1.1     skrll 	  if (iverdefmem.vd_next == 0)
   8471      1.1     skrll 	    break;
   8472  1.1.1.5  christos 
   8473      1.1     skrll 	  if (iverdefmem.vd_next
   8474      1.1     skrll 	      > (size_t) (contents_end_def - (bfd_byte *) everdef))
   8475      1.1     skrll 	    goto error_return_bad_verdef;
   8476      1.1     skrll 
   8477      1.1     skrll 	  everdef = ((Elf_External_Verdef *)
   8478      1.1     skrll 		     ((bfd_byte *) everdef + iverdefmem.vd_next));
   8479      1.1     skrll 	}
   8480      1.1     skrll 
   8481      1.1     skrll       if (default_imported_symver)
   8482      1.1     skrll 	{
   8483      1.1     skrll 	  if (freeidx > maxidx)
   8484      1.1     skrll 	    maxidx = ++freeidx;
   8485  1.1.1.5  christos 	  else
   8486  1.1.1.3  christos 	    freeidx = ++maxidx;
   8487  1.1.1.5  christos 	}
   8488      1.1     skrll 
   8489  1.1.1.5  christos       elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef = (Elf_Internal_Verdef *)
   8490      1.1     skrll 	bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, maxidx, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdef));
   8491      1.1     skrll       if (elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef == NULL)
   8492      1.1     skrll 	goto error_return_verdef;
   8493      1.1     skrll 
   8494      1.1     skrll       elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs = maxidx;
   8495      1.1     skrll 
   8496      1.1     skrll       everdef = (Elf_External_Verdef *) contents;
   8497      1.1     skrll       iverdefarr = elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef;
   8498      1.1     skrll       for (i = 0; i < hdr->sh_info; i++)
   8499      1.1     skrll 	{
   8500      1.1     skrll 	  Elf_External_Verdaux *everdaux;
   8501      1.1     skrll 	  Elf_Internal_Verdaux *iverdaux;
   8502      1.1     skrll 	  unsigned int j;
   8503      1.1     skrll 
   8504  1.1.1.5  christos 	  _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_in (abfd, everdef, &iverdefmem);
   8505      1.1     skrll 
   8506      1.1     skrll 	  if ((iverdefmem.vd_ndx & VERSYM_VERSION) == 0)
   8507  1.1.1.5  christos 	    goto error_return_bad_verdef;
   8508      1.1     skrll 
   8509      1.1     skrll 	  iverdef = &iverdefarr[(iverdefmem.vd_ndx & VERSYM_VERSION) - 1];
   8510      1.1     skrll 	  memcpy (iverdef, &iverdefmem, offsetof (Elf_Internal_Verdef, vd_bfd));
   8511      1.1     skrll 
   8512      1.1     skrll 	  iverdef->vd_bfd = abfd;
   8513      1.1     skrll 
   8514      1.1     skrll 	  if (iverdef->vd_cnt == 0)
   8515  1.1.1.3  christos 	    iverdef->vd_auxptr = NULL;
   8516  1.1.1.7  christos 	  else
   8517  1.1.1.7  christos 	    {
   8518      1.1     skrll 	      iverdef->vd_auxptr = (struct elf_internal_verdaux *)
   8519      1.1     skrll 		  bfd_alloc2 (abfd, iverdef->vd_cnt,
   8520      1.1     skrll 			      sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdaux));
   8521      1.1     skrll 	      if (iverdef->vd_auxptr == NULL)
   8522      1.1     skrll 		goto error_return_verdef;
   8523      1.1     skrll 	    }
   8524  1.1.1.5  christos 
   8525      1.1     skrll 	  if (iverdef->vd_aux
   8526      1.1     skrll 	      > (size_t) (contents_end_aux - (bfd_byte *) everdef))
   8527      1.1     skrll 	    goto error_return_bad_verdef;
   8528      1.1     skrll 
   8529      1.1     skrll 	  everdaux = ((Elf_External_Verdaux *)
   8530      1.1     skrll 		      ((bfd_byte *) everdef + iverdef->vd_aux));
   8531      1.1     skrll 	  iverdaux = iverdef->vd_auxptr;
   8532      1.1     skrll 	  for (j = 0; j < iverdef->vd_cnt; j++, iverdaux++)
   8533      1.1     skrll 	    {
   8534      1.1     skrll 	      _bfd_elf_swap_verdaux_in (abfd, everdaux, iverdaux);
   8535      1.1     skrll 
   8536      1.1     skrll 	      iverdaux->vda_nodename =
   8537  1.1.1.5  christos 		bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, hdr->sh_link,
   8538      1.1     skrll 						 iverdaux->vda_name);
   8539  1.1.1.5  christos 	      if (iverdaux->vda_nodename == NULL)
   8540  1.1.1.5  christos 		goto error_return_bad_verdef;
   8541  1.1.1.5  christos 
   8542  1.1.1.5  christos 	      iverdaux->vda_nextptr = NULL;
   8543  1.1.1.5  christos 	      if (iverdaux->vda_next == 0)
   8544  1.1.1.5  christos 		{
   8545      1.1     skrll 		  iverdef->vd_cnt = j + 1;
   8546      1.1     skrll 		  break;
   8547      1.1     skrll 		}
   8548      1.1     skrll 	      if (j + 1 < iverdef->vd_cnt)
   8549      1.1     skrll 		iverdaux->vda_nextptr = iverdaux + 1;
   8550  1.1.1.5  christos 
   8551      1.1     skrll 	      if (iverdaux->vda_next
   8552      1.1     skrll 		  > (size_t) (contents_end_aux - (bfd_byte *) everdaux))
   8553      1.1     skrll 		goto error_return_bad_verdef;
   8554      1.1     skrll 
   8555      1.1     skrll 	      everdaux = ((Elf_External_Verdaux *)
   8556  1.1.1.5  christos 			  ((bfd_byte *) everdaux + iverdaux->vda_next));
   8557      1.1     skrll 	    }
   8558      1.1     skrll 
   8559      1.1     skrll 	  iverdef->vd_nodename = NULL;
   8560  1.1.1.5  christos 	  if (iverdef->vd_cnt)
   8561  1.1.1.5  christos 	    iverdef->vd_nodename = iverdef->vd_auxptr->vda_nodename;
   8562  1.1.1.5  christos 
   8563      1.1     skrll 	  iverdef->vd_nextdef = NULL;
   8564      1.1     skrll 	  if (iverdef->vd_next == 0)
   8565      1.1     skrll 	    break;
   8566      1.1     skrll 	  if ((size_t) (iverdef - iverdefarr) + 1 < maxidx)
   8567      1.1     skrll 	    iverdef->vd_nextdef = iverdef + 1;
   8568      1.1     skrll 
   8569      1.1     skrll 	  everdef = ((Elf_External_Verdef *)
   8570      1.1     skrll 		     ((bfd_byte *) everdef + iverdef->vd_next));
   8571      1.1     skrll 	}
   8572      1.1     skrll 
   8573      1.1     skrll       free (contents);
   8574      1.1     skrll       contents = NULL;
   8575      1.1     skrll     }
   8576      1.1     skrll   else if (default_imported_symver)
   8577      1.1     skrll     {
   8578      1.1     skrll       if (freeidx < 3)
   8579      1.1     skrll 	freeidx = 3;
   8580  1.1.1.3  christos       else
   8581  1.1.1.7  christos 	freeidx++;
   8582      1.1     skrll 
   8583      1.1     skrll       elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef = (Elf_Internal_Verdef *)
   8584      1.1     skrll 	  bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, freeidx, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdef));
   8585      1.1     skrll       if (elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef == NULL)
   8586      1.1     skrll 	goto error_return;
   8587      1.1     skrll 
   8588      1.1     skrll       elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs = freeidx;
   8589      1.1     skrll     }
   8590      1.1     skrll 
   8591      1.1     skrll   /* Create a default version based on the soname.  */
   8592      1.1     skrll   if (default_imported_symver)
   8593      1.1     skrll     {
   8594  1.1.1.5  christos       Elf_Internal_Verdef *iverdef;
   8595      1.1     skrll       Elf_Internal_Verdaux *iverdaux;
   8596      1.1     skrll 
   8597      1.1     skrll       iverdef = &elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef[freeidx - 1];
   8598      1.1     skrll 
   8599      1.1     skrll       iverdef->vd_version = VER_DEF_CURRENT;
   8600      1.1     skrll       iverdef->vd_flags = 0;
   8601      1.1     skrll       iverdef->vd_ndx = freeidx;
   8602      1.1     skrll       iverdef->vd_cnt = 1;
   8603      1.1     skrll 
   8604      1.1     skrll       iverdef->vd_bfd = abfd;
   8605      1.1     skrll 
   8606      1.1     skrll       iverdef->vd_nodename = bfd_elf_get_dt_soname (abfd);
   8607  1.1.1.5  christos       if (iverdef->vd_nodename == NULL)
   8608  1.1.1.5  christos 	goto error_return_verdef;
   8609      1.1     skrll       iverdef->vd_nextdef = NULL;
   8610      1.1     skrll       iverdef->vd_auxptr = ((struct elf_internal_verdaux *)
   8611      1.1     skrll 			    bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdaux)));
   8612      1.1     skrll       if (iverdef->vd_auxptr == NULL)
   8613      1.1     skrll 	goto error_return_verdef;
   8614      1.1     skrll 
   8615      1.1     skrll       iverdaux = iverdef->vd_auxptr;
   8616      1.1     skrll       iverdaux->vda_nodename = iverdef->vd_nodename;
   8617      1.1     skrll     }
   8618      1.1     skrll 
   8619      1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   8620      1.1     skrll 
   8621      1.1     skrll  error_return:
   8622      1.1     skrll   if (contents != NULL)
   8623      1.1     skrll     free (contents);
   8624      1.1     skrll   return FALSE;
   8625      1.1     skrll }
   8626      1.1     skrll 
   8627      1.1     skrll asymbol *
   8629  1.1.1.5  christos _bfd_elf_make_empty_symbol (bfd *abfd)
   8630      1.1     skrll {
   8631      1.1     skrll   elf_symbol_type *newsym;
   8632  1.1.1.5  christos 
   8633  1.1.1.5  christos   newsym = (elf_symbol_type *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof * newsym);
   8634      1.1     skrll   if (!newsym)
   8635      1.1     skrll     return NULL;
   8636      1.1     skrll   newsym->symbol.the_bfd = abfd;
   8637      1.1     skrll   return &newsym->symbol;
   8638      1.1     skrll }
   8639      1.1     skrll 
   8640      1.1     skrll void
   8641      1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_get_symbol_info (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
   8642      1.1     skrll 			  asymbol *symbol,
   8643      1.1     skrll 			  symbol_info *ret)
   8644      1.1     skrll {
   8645      1.1     skrll   bfd_symbol_info (symbol, ret);
   8646      1.1     skrll }
   8647      1.1     skrll 
   8648      1.1     skrll /* Return whether a symbol name implies a local symbol.  Most targets
   8649      1.1     skrll    use this function for the is_local_label_name entry point, but some
   8650      1.1     skrll    override it.  */
   8651      1.1     skrll 
   8652      1.1     skrll bfd_boolean
   8653      1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_is_local_label_name (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
   8654      1.1     skrll 			      const char *name)
   8655      1.1     skrll {
   8656      1.1     skrll   /* Normal local symbols start with ``.L''.  */
   8657      1.1     skrll   if (name[0] == '.' && name[1] == 'L')
   8658      1.1     skrll     return TRUE;
   8659      1.1     skrll 
   8660      1.1     skrll   /* At least some SVR4 compilers (e.g., UnixWare 2.1 cc) generate
   8661      1.1     skrll      DWARF debugging symbols starting with ``..''.  */
   8662      1.1     skrll   if (name[0] == '.' && name[1] == '.')
   8663      1.1     skrll     return TRUE;
   8664      1.1     skrll 
   8665      1.1     skrll   /* gcc will sometimes generate symbols beginning with ``_.L_'' when
   8666      1.1     skrll      emitting DWARF debugging output.  I suspect this is actually a
   8667      1.1     skrll      small bug in gcc (it calls ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL when it should call
   8668      1.1     skrll      ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL, and this causes the leading
   8669      1.1     skrll      underscore to be emitted on some ELF targets).  For ease of use,
   8670  1.1.1.5  christos      we treat such symbols as local.  */
   8671  1.1.1.5  christos   if (name[0] == '_' && name[1] == '.' && name[2] == 'L' && name[3] == '_')
   8672  1.1.1.5  christos     return TRUE;
   8673  1.1.1.5  christos 
   8674  1.1.1.7  christos   /* Treat assembler generated fake symbols, dollar local labels and
   8675  1.1.1.5  christos      forward-backward labels (aka local labels) as locals.
   8676  1.1.1.5  christos      These labels have the form:
   8677  1.1.1.5  christos 
   8678  1.1.1.5  christos        L0^A.*				       (fake symbols)
   8679  1.1.1.5  christos 
   8680  1.1.1.5  christos        [.]?L[0123456789]+{^A|^B}[0123456789]*  (local labels)
   8681  1.1.1.5  christos 
   8682  1.1.1.5  christos      Versions which start with .L will have already been matched above,
   8683  1.1.1.5  christos      so we only need to match the rest.  */
   8684  1.1.1.5  christos   if (name[0] == 'L' && ISDIGIT (name[1]))
   8685  1.1.1.5  christos     {
   8686  1.1.1.5  christos       bfd_boolean ret = FALSE;
   8687  1.1.1.5  christos       const char * p;
   8688  1.1.1.5  christos       char c;
   8689  1.1.1.5  christos 
   8690  1.1.1.5  christos       for (p = name + 2; (c = *p); p++)
   8691  1.1.1.5  christos 	{
   8692  1.1.1.5  christos 	  if (c == 1 || c == 2)
   8693  1.1.1.5  christos 	    {
   8694  1.1.1.5  christos 	      if (c == 1 && p == name + 2)
   8695  1.1.1.5  christos 		/* A fake symbol.  */
   8696  1.1.1.5  christos 		return TRUE;
   8697  1.1.1.5  christos 
   8698  1.1.1.5  christos 	      /* FIXME: We are being paranoid here and treating symbols like
   8699  1.1.1.5  christos 		 L0^Bfoo as if there were non-local, on the grounds that the
   8700  1.1.1.5  christos 		 assembler will never generate them.  But can any symbol
   8701  1.1.1.5  christos 		 containing an ASCII value in the range 1-31 ever be anything
   8702  1.1.1.5  christos 		 other than some kind of local ?  */
   8703  1.1.1.5  christos 	      ret = TRUE;
   8704  1.1.1.5  christos 	    }
   8705  1.1.1.5  christos 
   8706  1.1.1.5  christos 	  if (! ISDIGIT (c))
   8707  1.1.1.5  christos 	    {
   8708  1.1.1.5  christos 	      ret = FALSE;
   8709  1.1.1.5  christos 	      break;
   8710  1.1.1.5  christos 	    }
   8711      1.1     skrll 	}
   8712      1.1     skrll       return ret;
   8713      1.1     skrll     }
   8714      1.1     skrll 
   8715      1.1     skrll   return FALSE;
   8716      1.1     skrll }
   8717      1.1     skrll 
   8718      1.1     skrll alent *
   8719      1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_get_lineno (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
   8720      1.1     skrll 		     asymbol *symbol ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
   8721      1.1     skrll {
   8722      1.1     skrll   abort ();
   8723      1.1     skrll   return NULL;
   8724      1.1     skrll }
   8725      1.1     skrll 
   8726      1.1     skrll bfd_boolean
   8727      1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_set_arch_mach (bfd *abfd,
   8728      1.1     skrll 			enum bfd_architecture arch,
   8729      1.1     skrll 			unsigned long machine)
   8730      1.1     skrll {
   8731      1.1     skrll   /* If this isn't the right architecture for this backend, and this
   8732      1.1     skrll      isn't the generic backend, fail.  */
   8733      1.1     skrll   if (arch != get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->arch
   8734      1.1     skrll       && arch != bfd_arch_unknown
   8735      1.1     skrll       && get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->arch != bfd_arch_unknown)
   8736      1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   8737      1.1     skrll 
   8738      1.1     skrll   return bfd_default_set_arch_mach (abfd, arch, machine);
   8739      1.1     skrll }
   8740      1.1     skrll 
   8741      1.1     skrll /* Find the nearest line to a particular section and offset,
   8742      1.1     skrll    for error reporting.  */
   8743  1.1.1.5  christos 
   8744      1.1     skrll bfd_boolean
   8745      1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_find_nearest_line (bfd *abfd,
   8746      1.1     skrll 			    asymbol **symbols,
   8747  1.1.1.5  christos 			    asection *section,
   8748  1.1.1.5  christos 			    bfd_vma offset,
   8749  1.1.1.4  christos 			    const char **filename_ptr,
   8750      1.1     skrll 			    const char **functionname_ptr,
   8751      1.1     skrll 			    unsigned int *line_ptr,
   8752  1.1.1.5  christos 			    unsigned int *discriminator_ptr)
   8753      1.1     skrll {
   8754  1.1.1.5  christos   bfd_boolean found;
   8755  1.1.1.5  christos 
   8756  1.1.1.5  christos   if (_bfd_dwarf2_find_nearest_line (abfd, symbols, NULL, section, offset,
   8757  1.1.1.5  christos 				     filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
   8758  1.1.1.5  christos 				     line_ptr, discriminator_ptr,
   8759  1.1.1.5  christos 				     dwarf_debug_sections, 0,
   8760      1.1     skrll 				     &elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info)
   8761      1.1     skrll       || _bfd_dwarf1_find_nearest_line (abfd, symbols, section, offset,
   8762  1.1.1.5  christos 					filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
   8763  1.1.1.5  christos 					line_ptr))
   8764  1.1.1.5  christos     {
   8765      1.1     skrll       if (!*functionname_ptr)
   8766      1.1     skrll 	_bfd_elf_find_function (abfd, symbols, section, offset,
   8767      1.1     skrll 				*filename_ptr ? NULL : filename_ptr,
   8768      1.1     skrll 				functionname_ptr);
   8769      1.1     skrll       return TRUE;
   8770      1.1     skrll     }
   8771      1.1     skrll 
   8772      1.1     skrll   if (! _bfd_stab_section_find_nearest_line (abfd, symbols, section, offset,
   8773      1.1     skrll 					     &found, filename_ptr,
   8774      1.1     skrll 					     functionname_ptr, line_ptr,
   8775      1.1     skrll 					     &elf_tdata (abfd)->line_info))
   8776      1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   8777      1.1     skrll   if (found && (*functionname_ptr || *line_ptr))
   8778      1.1     skrll     return TRUE;
   8779  1.1.1.5  christos 
   8780  1.1.1.5  christos   if (symbols == NULL)
   8781      1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   8782      1.1     skrll 
   8783      1.1     skrll   if (! _bfd_elf_find_function (abfd, symbols, section, offset,
   8784      1.1     skrll 				filename_ptr, functionname_ptr))
   8785      1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   8786      1.1     skrll 
   8787      1.1     skrll   *line_ptr = 0;
   8788      1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   8789      1.1     skrll }
   8790      1.1     skrll 
   8791      1.1     skrll /* Find the line for a symbol.  */
   8792      1.1     skrll 
   8793  1.1.1.5  christos bfd_boolean
   8794  1.1.1.5  christos _bfd_elf_find_line (bfd *abfd, asymbol **symbols, asymbol *symbol,
   8795  1.1.1.5  christos 		    const char **filename_ptr, unsigned int *line_ptr)
   8796  1.1.1.5  christos {
   8797      1.1     skrll   return _bfd_dwarf2_find_nearest_line (abfd, symbols, symbol, NULL, 0,
   8798      1.1     skrll 					filename_ptr, NULL, line_ptr, NULL,
   8799      1.1     skrll 					dwarf_debug_sections, 0,
   8800      1.1     skrll 					&elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info);
   8801      1.1     skrll }
   8802      1.1     skrll 
   8803      1.1     skrll /* After a call to bfd_find_nearest_line, successive calls to
   8804      1.1     skrll    bfd_find_inliner_info can be used to get source information about
   8805      1.1     skrll    each level of function inlining that terminated at the address
   8806      1.1     skrll    passed to bfd_find_nearest_line.  Currently this is only supported
   8807      1.1     skrll    for DWARF2 with appropriate DWARF3 extensions. */
   8808      1.1     skrll 
   8809      1.1     skrll bfd_boolean
   8810      1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_find_inliner_info (bfd *abfd,
   8811      1.1     skrll 			    const char **filename_ptr,
   8812      1.1     skrll 			    const char **functionname_ptr,
   8813      1.1     skrll 			    unsigned int *line_ptr)
   8814      1.1     skrll {
   8815      1.1     skrll   bfd_boolean found;
   8816      1.1     skrll   found = _bfd_dwarf2_find_inliner_info (abfd, filename_ptr,
   8817      1.1     skrll 					 functionname_ptr, line_ptr,
   8818      1.1     skrll 					 & elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info);
   8819      1.1     skrll   return found;
   8820      1.1     skrll }
   8821      1.1     skrll 
   8822      1.1     skrll int
   8823      1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_sizeof_headers (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
   8824  1.1.1.5  christos {
   8825      1.1     skrll   const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   8826  1.1.1.5  christos   int ret = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
   8827      1.1     skrll 
   8828      1.1     skrll   if (!bfd_link_relocatable (info))
   8829      1.1     skrll     {
   8830      1.1     skrll       bfd_size_type phdr_size = elf_program_header_size (abfd);
   8831      1.1     skrll 
   8832      1.1     skrll       if (phdr_size == (bfd_size_type) -1)
   8833  1.1.1.5  christos 	{
   8834      1.1     skrll 	  struct elf_segment_map *m;
   8835      1.1     skrll 
   8836      1.1     skrll 	  phdr_size = 0;
   8837      1.1     skrll 	  for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
   8838      1.1     skrll 	    phdr_size += bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
   8839      1.1     skrll 
   8840  1.1.1.5  christos 	  if (phdr_size == 0)
   8841      1.1     skrll 	    phdr_size = get_program_header_size (abfd, info);
   8842      1.1     skrll 	}
   8843      1.1     skrll 
   8844      1.1     skrll       elf_program_header_size (abfd) = phdr_size;
   8845      1.1     skrll       ret += phdr_size;
   8846      1.1     skrll     }
   8847      1.1     skrll 
   8848      1.1     skrll   return ret;
   8849      1.1     skrll }
   8850      1.1     skrll 
   8851      1.1     skrll bfd_boolean
   8852      1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_set_section_contents (bfd *abfd,
   8853      1.1     skrll 			       sec_ptr section,
   8854      1.1     skrll 			       const void *location,
   8855  1.1.1.5  christos 			       file_ptr offset,
   8856      1.1     skrll 			       bfd_size_type count)
   8857      1.1     skrll {
   8858      1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
   8859      1.1     skrll   file_ptr pos;
   8860      1.1     skrll 
   8861  1.1.1.5  christos   if (! abfd->output_has_begun
   8862  1.1.1.5  christos       && ! _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions (abfd, NULL))
   8863  1.1.1.5  christos     return FALSE;
   8864      1.1     skrll 
   8865  1.1.1.5  christos   if (!count)
   8866  1.1.1.5  christos     return TRUE;
   8867  1.1.1.5  christos 
   8868  1.1.1.5  christos   hdr = &elf_section_data (section)->this_hdr;
   8869  1.1.1.5  christos   if (hdr->sh_offset == (file_ptr) -1)
   8870  1.1.1.5  christos     {
   8871  1.1.1.5  christos       /* We must compress this section.  Write output to the buffer.  */
   8872  1.1.1.5  christos       unsigned char *contents = hdr->contents;
   8873  1.1.1.5  christos       if ((offset + count) > hdr->sh_size
   8874  1.1.1.5  christos 	  || (section->flags & SEC_ELF_COMPRESS) == 0
   8875  1.1.1.5  christos 	  || contents == NULL)
   8876      1.1     skrll 	abort ();
   8877      1.1     skrll       memcpy (contents + offset, location, count);
   8878      1.1     skrll       return TRUE;
   8879      1.1     skrll     }
   8880      1.1     skrll   pos = hdr->sh_offset + offset;
   8881      1.1     skrll   if (bfd_seek (abfd, pos, SEEK_SET) != 0
   8882      1.1     skrll       || bfd_bwrite (location, count, abfd) != count)
   8883      1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   8884  1.1.1.8  christos 
   8885      1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   8886      1.1     skrll }
   8887      1.1     skrll 
   8888      1.1     skrll bfd_boolean
   8889      1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_no_info_to_howto (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
   8890  1.1.1.8  christos 			   arelent *cache_ptr ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
   8891      1.1     skrll 			   Elf_Internal_Rela *dst ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
   8892      1.1     skrll {
   8893      1.1     skrll   abort ();
   8894      1.1     skrll   return FALSE;
   8895      1.1     skrll }
   8896      1.1     skrll 
   8897      1.1     skrll /* Try to convert a non-ELF reloc into an ELF one.  */
   8898      1.1     skrll 
   8899      1.1     skrll bfd_boolean
   8900      1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_validate_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *areloc)
   8901      1.1     skrll {
   8902      1.1     skrll   /* Check whether we really have an ELF howto.  */
   8903      1.1     skrll 
   8904      1.1     skrll   if ((*areloc->sym_ptr_ptr)->the_bfd->xvec != abfd->xvec)
   8905      1.1     skrll     {
   8906      1.1     skrll       bfd_reloc_code_real_type code;
   8907      1.1     skrll       reloc_howto_type *howto;
   8908      1.1     skrll 
   8909      1.1     skrll       /* Alien reloc: Try to determine its type to replace it with an
   8910      1.1     skrll 	 equivalent ELF reloc.  */
   8911      1.1     skrll 
   8912      1.1     skrll       if (areloc->howto->pc_relative)
   8913      1.1     skrll 	{
   8914      1.1     skrll 	  switch (areloc->howto->bitsize)
   8915      1.1     skrll 	    {
   8916      1.1     skrll 	    case 8:
   8917      1.1     skrll 	      code = BFD_RELOC_8_PCREL;
   8918      1.1     skrll 	      break;
   8919      1.1     skrll 	    case 12:
   8920      1.1     skrll 	      code = BFD_RELOC_12_PCREL;
   8921      1.1     skrll 	      break;
   8922      1.1     skrll 	    case 16:
   8923      1.1     skrll 	      code = BFD_RELOC_16_PCREL;
   8924      1.1     skrll 	      break;
   8925      1.1     skrll 	    case 24:
   8926      1.1     skrll 	      code = BFD_RELOC_24_PCREL;
   8927      1.1     skrll 	      break;
   8928      1.1     skrll 	    case 32:
   8929      1.1     skrll 	      code = BFD_RELOC_32_PCREL;
   8930      1.1     skrll 	      break;
   8931      1.1     skrll 	    case 64:
   8932      1.1     skrll 	      code = BFD_RELOC_64_PCREL;
   8933      1.1     skrll 	      break;
   8934      1.1     skrll 	    default:
   8935      1.1     skrll 	      goto fail;
   8936      1.1     skrll 	    }
   8937      1.1     skrll 
   8938      1.1     skrll 	  howto = bfd_reloc_type_lookup (abfd, code);
   8939      1.1     skrll 
   8940      1.1     skrll 	  if (areloc->howto->pcrel_offset != howto->pcrel_offset)
   8941      1.1     skrll 	    {
   8942      1.1     skrll 	      if (howto->pcrel_offset)
   8943      1.1     skrll 		areloc->addend += areloc->address;
   8944      1.1     skrll 	      else
   8945      1.1     skrll 		areloc->addend -= areloc->address; /* addend is unsigned!! */
   8946      1.1     skrll 	    }
   8947      1.1     skrll 	}
   8948      1.1     skrll       else
   8949      1.1     skrll 	{
   8950      1.1     skrll 	  switch (areloc->howto->bitsize)
   8951      1.1     skrll 	    {
   8952      1.1     skrll 	    case 8:
   8953      1.1     skrll 	      code = BFD_RELOC_8;
   8954      1.1     skrll 	      break;
   8955      1.1     skrll 	    case 14:
   8956      1.1     skrll 	      code = BFD_RELOC_14;
   8957      1.1     skrll 	      break;
   8958      1.1     skrll 	    case 16:
   8959      1.1     skrll 	      code = BFD_RELOC_16;
   8960      1.1     skrll 	      break;
   8961      1.1     skrll 	    case 26:
   8962      1.1     skrll 	      code = BFD_RELOC_26;
   8963      1.1     skrll 	      break;
   8964      1.1     skrll 	    case 32:
   8965      1.1     skrll 	      code = BFD_RELOC_32;
   8966      1.1     skrll 	      break;
   8967      1.1     skrll 	    case 64:
   8968      1.1     skrll 	      code = BFD_RELOC_64;
   8969      1.1     skrll 	      break;
   8970      1.1     skrll 	    default:
   8971      1.1     skrll 	      goto fail;
   8972      1.1     skrll 	    }
   8973      1.1     skrll 
   8974      1.1     skrll 	  howto = bfd_reloc_type_lookup (abfd, code);
   8975      1.1     skrll 	}
   8976      1.1     skrll 
   8977      1.1     skrll       if (howto)
   8978      1.1     skrll 	areloc->howto = howto;
   8979      1.1     skrll       else
   8980      1.1     skrll 	goto fail;
   8981      1.1     skrll     }
   8982  1.1.1.8  christos 
   8983  1.1.1.8  christos   return TRUE;
   8984  1.1.1.8  christos 
   8985      1.1     skrll  fail:
   8986      1.1     skrll   /* xgettext:c-format */
   8987      1.1     skrll   _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: %s unsupported"),
   8988      1.1     skrll 		      abfd, areloc->howto->name);
   8989      1.1     skrll   bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
   8990      1.1     skrll   return FALSE;
   8991      1.1     skrll }
   8992  1.1.1.4  christos 
   8993  1.1.1.4  christos bfd_boolean
   8994      1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_close_and_cleanup (bfd *abfd)
   8995  1.1.1.5  christos {
   8996      1.1     skrll   struct elf_obj_tdata *tdata = elf_tdata (abfd);
   8997  1.1.1.4  christos   if (bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_object && tdata != NULL)
   8998      1.1     skrll     {
   8999      1.1     skrll       if (elf_tdata (abfd)->o != NULL && elf_shstrtab (abfd) != NULL)
   9000      1.1     skrll 	_bfd_elf_strtab_free (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
   9001      1.1     skrll       _bfd_dwarf2_cleanup_debug_info (abfd, &tdata->dwarf2_find_line_info);
   9002      1.1     skrll     }
   9003      1.1     skrll 
   9004      1.1     skrll   return _bfd_generic_close_and_cleanup (abfd);
   9005      1.1     skrll }
   9006      1.1     skrll 
   9007      1.1     skrll /* For Rel targets, we encode meaningful data for BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_ENTRY
   9008      1.1     skrll    in the relocation's offset.  Thus we cannot allow any sort of sanity
   9009      1.1     skrll    range-checking to interfere.  There is nothing else to do in processing
   9010      1.1     skrll    this reloc.  */
   9011      1.1     skrll 
   9012      1.1     skrll bfd_reloc_status_type
   9013      1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_rel_vtable_reloc_fn
   9014      1.1     skrll   (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, arelent *re ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
   9015      1.1     skrll    struct bfd_symbol *symbol ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
   9016      1.1     skrll    void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, asection *is ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
   9017      1.1     skrll    bfd *obfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, char **errmsg ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
   9018      1.1     skrll {
   9019      1.1     skrll   return bfd_reloc_ok;
   9020      1.1     skrll }
   9021      1.1     skrll 
   9022      1.1     skrll /* Elf core file support.  Much of this only works on native
   9024  1.1.1.3  christos    toolchains, since we rely on knowing the
   9025  1.1.1.3  christos    machine-dependent procfs structure in order to pick
   9026      1.1     skrll    out details about the corefile.  */
   9027      1.1     skrll 
   9028      1.1     skrll #ifdef HAVE_SYS_PROCFS_H
   9029  1.1.1.3  christos /* Needed for new procfs interface on sparc-solaris.  */
   9030  1.1.1.3  christos # define _STRUCTURED_PROC 1
   9031      1.1     skrll # include <sys/procfs.h>
   9032      1.1     skrll #endif
   9033      1.1     skrll 
   9034      1.1     skrll /* Return a PID that identifies a "thread" for threaded cores, or the
   9035  1.1.1.3  christos    PID of the main process for non-threaded cores.  */
   9036  1.1.1.3  christos 
   9037  1.1.1.5  christos static int
   9038  1.1.1.3  christos elfcore_make_pid (bfd *abfd)
   9039  1.1.1.5  christos {
   9040  1.1.1.3  christos   int pid;
   9041  1.1.1.3  christos 
   9042      1.1     skrll   pid = elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid;
   9043      1.1     skrll   if (pid == 0)
   9044      1.1     skrll     pid = elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid;
   9045      1.1     skrll 
   9046      1.1     skrll   return pid;
   9047      1.1     skrll }
   9048      1.1     skrll 
   9049      1.1     skrll /* If there isn't a section called NAME, make one, using
   9050      1.1     skrll    data from SECT.  Note, this function will generate a
   9051      1.1     skrll    reference to NAME, so you shouldn't deallocate or
   9052      1.1     skrll    overwrite it.  */
   9053      1.1     skrll 
   9054      1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   9055      1.1     skrll elfcore_maybe_make_sect (bfd *abfd, char *name, asection *sect)
   9056      1.1     skrll {
   9057      1.1     skrll   asection *sect2;
   9058      1.1     skrll 
   9059      1.1     skrll   if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, name) != NULL)
   9060      1.1     skrll     return TRUE;
   9061      1.1     skrll 
   9062      1.1     skrll   sect2 = bfd_make_section_with_flags (abfd, name, sect->flags);
   9063      1.1     skrll   if (sect2 == NULL)
   9064      1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   9065      1.1     skrll 
   9066      1.1     skrll   sect2->size = sect->size;
   9067      1.1     skrll   sect2->filepos = sect->filepos;
   9068      1.1     skrll   sect2->alignment_power = sect->alignment_power;
   9069      1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   9070      1.1     skrll }
   9071      1.1     skrll 
   9072      1.1     skrll /* Create a pseudosection containing SIZE bytes at FILEPOS.  This
   9073  1.1.1.7  christos    actually creates up to two pseudosections:
   9074      1.1     skrll    - For the single-threaded case, a section named NAME, unless
   9075      1.1     skrll      such a section already exists.
   9076      1.1     skrll    - For the multi-threaded case, a section named "NAME/PID", where
   9077      1.1     skrll      PID is elfcore_make_pid (abfd).
   9078      1.1     skrll    Both pseudosections have identical contents.  */
   9079      1.1     skrll bfd_boolean
   9080      1.1     skrll _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (bfd *abfd,
   9081      1.1     skrll 				 char *name,
   9082      1.1     skrll 				 size_t size,
   9083      1.1     skrll 				 ufile_ptr filepos)
   9084      1.1     skrll {
   9085      1.1     skrll   char buf[100];
   9086      1.1     skrll   char *threaded_name;
   9087      1.1     skrll   size_t len;
   9088      1.1     skrll   asection *sect;
   9089  1.1.1.3  christos 
   9090      1.1     skrll   /* Build the section name.  */
   9091      1.1     skrll 
   9092      1.1     skrll   sprintf (buf, "%s/%d", name, elfcore_make_pid (abfd));
   9093      1.1     skrll   len = strlen (buf) + 1;
   9094      1.1     skrll   threaded_name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
   9095      1.1     skrll   if (threaded_name == NULL)
   9096      1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   9097      1.1     skrll   memcpy (threaded_name, buf, len);
   9098      1.1     skrll 
   9099      1.1     skrll   sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, threaded_name,
   9100      1.1     skrll 					     SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
   9101      1.1     skrll   if (sect == NULL)
   9102      1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   9103      1.1     skrll   sect->size = size;
   9104      1.1     skrll   sect->filepos = filepos;
   9105      1.1     skrll   sect->alignment_power = 2;
   9106      1.1     skrll 
   9107      1.1     skrll   return elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, name, sect);
   9108      1.1     skrll }
   9109      1.1     skrll 
   9110      1.1     skrll /* prstatus_t exists on:
   9111      1.1     skrll      solaris 2.5+
   9112      1.1     skrll      linux 2.[01] + glibc
   9113      1.1     skrll      unixware 4.2
   9114      1.1     skrll */
   9115      1.1     skrll 
   9116      1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T)
   9117      1.1     skrll 
   9118      1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   9119      1.1     skrll elfcore_grok_prstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   9120      1.1     skrll {
   9121      1.1     skrll   size_t size;
   9122      1.1     skrll   int offset;
   9123      1.1     skrll 
   9124      1.1     skrll   if (note->descsz == sizeof (prstatus_t))
   9125      1.1     skrll     {
   9126      1.1     skrll       prstatus_t prstat;
   9127      1.1     skrll 
   9128      1.1     skrll       size = sizeof (prstat.pr_reg);
   9129  1.1.1.5  christos       offset   = offsetof (prstatus_t, pr_reg);
   9130  1.1.1.5  christos       memcpy (&prstat, note->descdata, sizeof (prstat));
   9131  1.1.1.5  christos 
   9132  1.1.1.5  christos       /* Do not overwrite the core signal if it
   9133      1.1     skrll 	 has already been set by another thread.  */
   9134      1.1     skrll       if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal == 0)
   9135      1.1     skrll 	elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = prstat.pr_cursig;
   9136      1.1     skrll       if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid == 0)
   9137      1.1     skrll 	elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = prstat.pr_pid;
   9138      1.1     skrll 
   9139      1.1     skrll       /* pr_who exists on:
   9140      1.1     skrll 	 solaris 2.5+
   9141  1.1.1.5  christos 	 unixware 4.2
   9142  1.1.1.3  christos 	 pr_who doesn't exist on:
   9143  1.1.1.5  christos 	 linux 2.[01]
   9144      1.1     skrll 	 */
   9145      1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T_PR_WHO)
   9146      1.1     skrll       elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = prstat.pr_who;
   9147      1.1     skrll #else
   9148      1.1     skrll       elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = prstat.pr_pid;
   9149      1.1     skrll #endif
   9150      1.1     skrll     }
   9151      1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T)
   9152      1.1     skrll   else if (note->descsz == sizeof (prstatus32_t))
   9153      1.1     skrll     {
   9154      1.1     skrll       /* 64-bit host, 32-bit corefile */
   9155      1.1     skrll       prstatus32_t prstat;
   9156      1.1     skrll 
   9157      1.1     skrll       size = sizeof (prstat.pr_reg);
   9158  1.1.1.5  christos       offset   = offsetof (prstatus32_t, pr_reg);
   9159  1.1.1.5  christos       memcpy (&prstat, note->descdata, sizeof (prstat));
   9160  1.1.1.5  christos 
   9161  1.1.1.5  christos       /* Do not overwrite the core signal if it
   9162      1.1     skrll 	 has already been set by another thread.  */
   9163      1.1     skrll       if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal == 0)
   9164      1.1     skrll 	elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = prstat.pr_cursig;
   9165      1.1     skrll       if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid == 0)
   9166      1.1     skrll 	elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = prstat.pr_pid;
   9167      1.1     skrll 
   9168      1.1     skrll       /* pr_who exists on:
   9169      1.1     skrll 	 solaris 2.5+
   9170  1.1.1.5  christos 	 unixware 4.2
   9171  1.1.1.3  christos 	 pr_who doesn't exist on:
   9172  1.1.1.5  christos 	 linux 2.[01]
   9173      1.1     skrll 	 */
   9174      1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T_PR_WHO)
   9175      1.1     skrll       elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = prstat.pr_who;
   9176      1.1     skrll #else
   9177      1.1     skrll       elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = prstat.pr_pid;
   9178      1.1     skrll #endif
   9179      1.1     skrll     }
   9180      1.1     skrll #endif /* HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T */
   9181      1.1     skrll   else
   9182      1.1     skrll     {
   9183      1.1     skrll       /* Fail - we don't know how to handle any other
   9184      1.1     skrll 	 note size (ie. data object type).  */
   9185      1.1     skrll       return TRUE;
   9186      1.1     skrll     }
   9187      1.1     skrll 
   9188      1.1     skrll   /* Make a ".reg/999" section and a ".reg" section.  */
   9189      1.1     skrll   return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg",
   9190      1.1     skrll 					  size, note->descpos + offset);
   9191      1.1     skrll }
   9192      1.1     skrll #endif /* defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T) */
   9193      1.1     skrll 
   9194      1.1     skrll /* Create a pseudosection containing the exact contents of NOTE.  */
   9195      1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   9196      1.1     skrll elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (bfd *abfd,
   9197      1.1     skrll 				 char *name,
   9198      1.1     skrll 				 Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   9199      1.1     skrll {
   9200      1.1     skrll   return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd, name,
   9201      1.1     skrll 					  note->descsz, note->descpos);
   9202      1.1     skrll }
   9203      1.1     skrll 
   9204      1.1     skrll /* There isn't a consistent prfpregset_t across platforms,
   9205      1.1     skrll    but it doesn't matter, because we don't have to pick this
   9206      1.1     skrll    data structure apart.  */
   9207      1.1     skrll 
   9208      1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   9209      1.1     skrll elfcore_grok_prfpreg (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   9210      1.1     skrll {
   9211      1.1     skrll   return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
   9212      1.1     skrll }
   9213      1.1     skrll 
   9214      1.1     skrll /* Linux dumps the Intel SSE regs in a note named "LINUX" with a note
   9215      1.1     skrll    type of NT_PRXFPREG.  Just include the whole note's contents
   9216      1.1     skrll    literally.  */
   9217      1.1     skrll 
   9218      1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   9219  1.1.1.3  christos elfcore_grok_prxfpreg (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   9220  1.1.1.3  christos {
   9221  1.1.1.3  christos   return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-xfp", note);
   9222  1.1.1.3  christos }
   9223  1.1.1.3  christos 
   9224  1.1.1.3  christos /* Linux dumps the Intel XSAVE extended state in a note named "LINUX"
   9225  1.1.1.3  christos    with a note type of NT_X86_XSTATE.  Just include the whole note's
   9226  1.1.1.3  christos    contents literally.  */
   9227  1.1.1.3  christos 
   9228  1.1.1.3  christos static bfd_boolean
   9229      1.1     skrll elfcore_grok_xstatereg (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   9230      1.1     skrll {
   9231      1.1     skrll   return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-xstate", note);
   9232      1.1     skrll }
   9233      1.1     skrll 
   9234      1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   9235      1.1     skrll elfcore_grok_ppc_vmx (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   9236      1.1     skrll {
   9237      1.1     skrll   return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-vmx", note);
   9238      1.1     skrll }
   9239      1.1     skrll 
   9240      1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   9241  1.1.1.3  christos elfcore_grok_ppc_vsx (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   9242  1.1.1.3  christos {
   9243  1.1.1.3  christos   return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-vsx", note);
   9244  1.1.1.3  christos }
   9245  1.1.1.3  christos 
   9246  1.1.1.3  christos static bfd_boolean
   9247  1.1.1.3  christos elfcore_grok_s390_high_gprs (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   9248  1.1.1.3  christos {
   9249  1.1.1.3  christos   return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-high-gprs", note);
   9250  1.1.1.3  christos }
   9251  1.1.1.3  christos 
   9252  1.1.1.3  christos static bfd_boolean
   9253  1.1.1.3  christos elfcore_grok_s390_timer (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   9254  1.1.1.3  christos {
   9255  1.1.1.3  christos   return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-timer", note);
   9256  1.1.1.3  christos }
   9257  1.1.1.3  christos 
   9258  1.1.1.3  christos static bfd_boolean
   9259  1.1.1.3  christos elfcore_grok_s390_todcmp (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   9260  1.1.1.3  christos {
   9261  1.1.1.3  christos   return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-todcmp", note);
   9262  1.1.1.3  christos }
   9263  1.1.1.3  christos 
   9264  1.1.1.3  christos static bfd_boolean
   9265  1.1.1.3  christos elfcore_grok_s390_todpreg (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   9266  1.1.1.3  christos {
   9267  1.1.1.3  christos   return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-todpreg", note);
   9268  1.1.1.3  christos }
   9269  1.1.1.3  christos 
   9270  1.1.1.3  christos static bfd_boolean
   9271  1.1.1.3  christos elfcore_grok_s390_ctrs (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   9272  1.1.1.3  christos {
   9273  1.1.1.3  christos   return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-ctrs", note);
   9274  1.1.1.3  christos }
   9275  1.1.1.3  christos 
   9276  1.1.1.3  christos static bfd_boolean
   9277  1.1.1.4  christos elfcore_grok_s390_prefix (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   9278  1.1.1.4  christos {
   9279  1.1.1.4  christos   return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-prefix", note);
   9280  1.1.1.4  christos }
   9281  1.1.1.4  christos 
   9282  1.1.1.4  christos static bfd_boolean
   9283  1.1.1.4  christos elfcore_grok_s390_last_break (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   9284  1.1.1.4  christos {
   9285  1.1.1.4  christos   return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-last-break", note);
   9286  1.1.1.4  christos }
   9287  1.1.1.4  christos 
   9288  1.1.1.4  christos static bfd_boolean
   9289  1.1.1.4  christos elfcore_grok_s390_system_call (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   9290  1.1.1.5  christos {
   9291  1.1.1.5  christos   return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-system-call", note);
   9292  1.1.1.5  christos }
   9293  1.1.1.5  christos 
   9294  1.1.1.5  christos static bfd_boolean
   9295  1.1.1.5  christos elfcore_grok_s390_tdb (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   9296  1.1.1.5  christos {
   9297  1.1.1.5  christos   return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-tdb", note);
   9298  1.1.1.5  christos }
   9299  1.1.1.5  christos 
   9300  1.1.1.5  christos static bfd_boolean
   9301  1.1.1.5  christos elfcore_grok_s390_vxrs_low (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   9302  1.1.1.5  christos {
   9303  1.1.1.5  christos   return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-vxrs-low", note);
   9304  1.1.1.5  christos }
   9305  1.1.1.5  christos 
   9306  1.1.1.5  christos static bfd_boolean
   9307  1.1.1.5  christos elfcore_grok_s390_vxrs_high (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   9308  1.1.1.7  christos {
   9309  1.1.1.7  christos   return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-vxrs-high", note);
   9310  1.1.1.7  christos }
   9311  1.1.1.7  christos 
   9312  1.1.1.7  christos static bfd_boolean
   9313  1.1.1.7  christos elfcore_grok_s390_gs_cb (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   9314  1.1.1.7  christos {
   9315  1.1.1.7  christos   return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-gs-cb", note);
   9316  1.1.1.7  christos }
   9317  1.1.1.7  christos 
   9318  1.1.1.7  christos static bfd_boolean
   9319  1.1.1.7  christos elfcore_grok_s390_gs_bc (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   9320  1.1.1.4  christos {
   9321  1.1.1.4  christos   return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-gs-bc", note);
   9322  1.1.1.4  christos }
   9323  1.1.1.4  christos 
   9324  1.1.1.4  christos static bfd_boolean
   9325  1.1.1.5  christos elfcore_grok_arm_vfp (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   9326  1.1.1.5  christos {
   9327  1.1.1.5  christos   return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-arm-vfp", note);
   9328  1.1.1.5  christos }
   9329  1.1.1.5  christos 
   9330  1.1.1.5  christos static bfd_boolean
   9331  1.1.1.5  christos elfcore_grok_aarch_tls (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   9332  1.1.1.5  christos {
   9333  1.1.1.5  christos   return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-aarch-tls", note);
   9334  1.1.1.5  christos }
   9335  1.1.1.5  christos 
   9336  1.1.1.5  christos static bfd_boolean
   9337  1.1.1.5  christos elfcore_grok_aarch_hw_break (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   9338  1.1.1.5  christos {
   9339  1.1.1.5  christos   return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-aarch-hw-break", note);
   9340  1.1.1.5  christos }
   9341  1.1.1.5  christos 
   9342  1.1.1.5  christos static bfd_boolean
   9343      1.1     skrll elfcore_grok_aarch_hw_watch (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   9344      1.1     skrll {
   9345      1.1     skrll   return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-aarch-hw-watch", note);
   9346      1.1     skrll }
   9347      1.1     skrll 
   9348      1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T)
   9349      1.1     skrll typedef prpsinfo_t   elfcore_psinfo_t;
   9350      1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T)		/* Sparc64 cross Sparc32 */
   9351      1.1     skrll typedef prpsinfo32_t elfcore_psinfo32_t;
   9352      1.1     skrll #endif
   9353      1.1     skrll #endif
   9354      1.1     skrll 
   9355      1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
   9356      1.1     skrll typedef psinfo_t   elfcore_psinfo_t;
   9357      1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T)		/* Sparc64 cross Sparc32 */
   9358      1.1     skrll typedef psinfo32_t elfcore_psinfo32_t;
   9359      1.1     skrll #endif
   9360      1.1     skrll #endif
   9361      1.1     skrll 
   9362      1.1     skrll /* return a malloc'ed copy of a string at START which is at
   9363      1.1     skrll    most MAX bytes long, possibly without a terminating '\0'.
   9364      1.1     skrll    the copy will always have a terminating '\0'.  */
   9365  1.1.1.3  christos 
   9366      1.1     skrll char *
   9367      1.1     skrll _bfd_elfcore_strndup (bfd *abfd, char *start, size_t max)
   9368      1.1     skrll {
   9369      1.1     skrll   char *dups;
   9370      1.1     skrll   char *end = (char *) memchr (start, '\0', max);
   9371      1.1     skrll   size_t len;
   9372      1.1     skrll 
   9373  1.1.1.3  christos   if (end == NULL)
   9374      1.1     skrll     len = max;
   9375      1.1     skrll   else
   9376      1.1     skrll     len = end - start;
   9377      1.1     skrll 
   9378      1.1     skrll   dups = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len + 1);
   9379      1.1     skrll   if (dups == NULL)
   9380      1.1     skrll     return NULL;
   9381      1.1     skrll 
   9382      1.1     skrll   memcpy (dups, start, len);
   9383      1.1     skrll   dups[len] = '\0';
   9384      1.1     skrll 
   9385      1.1     skrll   return dups;
   9386      1.1     skrll }
   9387      1.1     skrll 
   9388      1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
   9389      1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   9390      1.1     skrll elfcore_grok_psinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   9391      1.1     skrll {
   9392      1.1     skrll   if (note->descsz == sizeof (elfcore_psinfo_t))
   9393  1.1.1.3  christos     {
   9394  1.1.1.5  christos       elfcore_psinfo_t psinfo;
   9395  1.1.1.3  christos 
   9396  1.1.1.5  christos       memcpy (&psinfo, note->descdata, sizeof (psinfo));
   9397      1.1     skrll 
   9398      1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T_PR_PID) || defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T_PR_PID)
   9399      1.1     skrll       elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = psinfo.pr_pid;
   9400  1.1.1.5  christos #endif
   9401      1.1     skrll       elf_tdata (abfd)->core->program
   9402      1.1     skrll 	= _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, psinfo.pr_fname,
   9403      1.1     skrll 				sizeof (psinfo.pr_fname));
   9404      1.1     skrll 
   9405      1.1     skrll       elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
   9406      1.1     skrll 	= _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, psinfo.pr_psargs,
   9407      1.1     skrll 				sizeof (psinfo.pr_psargs));
   9408      1.1     skrll     }
   9409      1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T)
   9410      1.1     skrll   else if (note->descsz == sizeof (elfcore_psinfo32_t))
   9411      1.1     skrll     {
   9412  1.1.1.3  christos       /* 64-bit host, 32-bit corefile */
   9413  1.1.1.5  christos       elfcore_psinfo32_t psinfo;
   9414  1.1.1.3  christos 
   9415  1.1.1.5  christos       memcpy (&psinfo, note->descdata, sizeof (psinfo));
   9416      1.1     skrll 
   9417      1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T_PR_PID) || defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T_PR_PID)
   9418      1.1     skrll       elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = psinfo.pr_pid;
   9419  1.1.1.5  christos #endif
   9420      1.1     skrll       elf_tdata (abfd)->core->program
   9421      1.1     skrll 	= _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, psinfo.pr_fname,
   9422      1.1     skrll 				sizeof (psinfo.pr_fname));
   9423      1.1     skrll 
   9424      1.1     skrll       elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
   9425      1.1     skrll 	= _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, psinfo.pr_psargs,
   9426      1.1     skrll 				sizeof (psinfo.pr_psargs));
   9427      1.1     skrll     }
   9428      1.1     skrll #endif
   9429      1.1     skrll 
   9430      1.1     skrll   else
   9431      1.1     skrll     {
   9432      1.1     skrll       /* Fail - we don't know how to handle any other
   9433      1.1     skrll 	 note size (ie. data object type).  */
   9434      1.1     skrll       return TRUE;
   9435      1.1     skrll     }
   9436      1.1     skrll 
   9437  1.1.1.5  christos   /* Note that for some reason, a spurious space is tacked
   9438      1.1     skrll      onto the end of the args in some (at least one anyway)
   9439      1.1     skrll      implementations, so strip it off if it exists.  */
   9440      1.1     skrll 
   9441      1.1     skrll   {
   9442      1.1     skrll     char *command = elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command;
   9443      1.1     skrll     int n = strlen (command);
   9444      1.1     skrll 
   9445      1.1     skrll     if (0 < n && command[n - 1] == ' ')
   9446      1.1     skrll       command[n - 1] = '\0';
   9447      1.1     skrll   }
   9448      1.1     skrll 
   9449      1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   9450      1.1     skrll }
   9451      1.1     skrll #endif /* defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T) */
   9452      1.1     skrll 
   9453      1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T)
   9454      1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   9455      1.1     skrll elfcore_grok_pstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   9456      1.1     skrll {
   9457      1.1     skrll   if (note->descsz == sizeof (pstatus_t)
   9458      1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_PXSTATUS_T)
   9459      1.1     skrll       || note->descsz == sizeof (pxstatus_t)
   9460      1.1     skrll #endif
   9461      1.1     skrll       )
   9462  1.1.1.5  christos     {
   9463      1.1     skrll       pstatus_t pstat;
   9464      1.1     skrll 
   9465      1.1     skrll       memcpy (&pstat, note->descdata, sizeof (pstat));
   9466      1.1     skrll 
   9467      1.1     skrll       elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = pstat.pr_pid;
   9468      1.1     skrll     }
   9469      1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS32_T)
   9470      1.1     skrll   else if (note->descsz == sizeof (pstatus32_t))
   9471      1.1     skrll     {
   9472  1.1.1.5  christos       /* 64-bit host, 32-bit corefile */
   9473      1.1     skrll       pstatus32_t pstat;
   9474      1.1     skrll 
   9475      1.1     skrll       memcpy (&pstat, note->descdata, sizeof (pstat));
   9476      1.1     skrll 
   9477      1.1     skrll       elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = pstat.pr_pid;
   9478      1.1     skrll     }
   9479      1.1     skrll #endif
   9480      1.1     skrll   /* Could grab some more details from the "representative"
   9481      1.1     skrll      lwpstatus_t in pstat.pr_lwp, but we'll catch it all in an
   9482      1.1     skrll      NT_LWPSTATUS note, presumably.  */
   9483      1.1     skrll 
   9484      1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   9485      1.1     skrll }
   9486      1.1     skrll #endif /* defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T) */
   9487      1.1     skrll 
   9488      1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T)
   9489      1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   9490      1.1     skrll elfcore_grok_lwpstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   9491      1.1     skrll {
   9492      1.1     skrll   lwpstatus_t lwpstat;
   9493      1.1     skrll   char buf[100];
   9494      1.1     skrll   char *name;
   9495      1.1     skrll   size_t len;
   9496      1.1     skrll   asection *sect;
   9497      1.1     skrll 
   9498      1.1     skrll   if (note->descsz != sizeof (lwpstat)
   9499      1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_LWPXSTATUS_T)
   9500      1.1     skrll       && note->descsz != sizeof (lwpxstatus_t)
   9501      1.1     skrll #endif
   9502  1.1.1.5  christos       )
   9503  1.1.1.3  christos     return TRUE;
   9504  1.1.1.3  christos 
   9505  1.1.1.5  christos   memcpy (&lwpstat, note->descdata, sizeof (lwpstat));
   9506  1.1.1.5  christos 
   9507      1.1     skrll   elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = lwpstat.pr_lwpid;
   9508      1.1     skrll   /* Do not overwrite the core signal if it has already been set by
   9509      1.1     skrll      another thread.  */
   9510      1.1     skrll   if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal == 0)
   9511      1.1     skrll     elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = lwpstat.pr_cursig;
   9512      1.1     skrll 
   9513      1.1     skrll   /* Make a ".reg/999" section.  */
   9514      1.1     skrll 
   9515      1.1     skrll   sprintf (buf, ".reg/%d", elfcore_make_pid (abfd));
   9516      1.1     skrll   len = strlen (buf) + 1;
   9517      1.1     skrll   name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
   9518      1.1     skrll   if (name == NULL)
   9519      1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   9520      1.1     skrll   memcpy (name, buf, len);
   9521      1.1     skrll 
   9522      1.1     skrll   sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
   9523      1.1     skrll   if (sect == NULL)
   9524      1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   9525      1.1     skrll 
   9526      1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_CONTEXT)
   9527      1.1     skrll   sect->size = sizeof (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.gregs);
   9528      1.1     skrll   sect->filepos = note->descpos
   9529      1.1     skrll     + offsetof (lwpstatus_t, pr_context.uc_mcontext.gregs);
   9530      1.1     skrll #endif
   9531      1.1     skrll 
   9532      1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_REG)
   9533      1.1     skrll   sect->size = sizeof (lwpstat.pr_reg);
   9534      1.1     skrll   sect->filepos = note->descpos + offsetof (lwpstatus_t, pr_reg);
   9535      1.1     skrll #endif
   9536      1.1     skrll 
   9537      1.1     skrll   sect->alignment_power = 2;
   9538      1.1     skrll 
   9539      1.1     skrll   if (!elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, ".reg", sect))
   9540      1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   9541      1.1     skrll 
   9542      1.1     skrll   /* Make a ".reg2/999" section */
   9543      1.1     skrll 
   9544      1.1     skrll   sprintf (buf, ".reg2/%d", elfcore_make_pid (abfd));
   9545      1.1     skrll   len = strlen (buf) + 1;
   9546      1.1     skrll   name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
   9547      1.1     skrll   if (name == NULL)
   9548      1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   9549      1.1     skrll   memcpy (name, buf, len);
   9550      1.1     skrll 
   9551      1.1     skrll   sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
   9552      1.1     skrll   if (sect == NULL)
   9553      1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   9554      1.1     skrll 
   9555      1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_CONTEXT)
   9556      1.1     skrll   sect->size = sizeof (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.fpregs);
   9557      1.1     skrll   sect->filepos = note->descpos
   9558      1.1     skrll     + offsetof (lwpstatus_t, pr_context.uc_mcontext.fpregs);
   9559      1.1     skrll #endif
   9560      1.1     skrll 
   9561      1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_FPREG)
   9562      1.1     skrll   sect->size = sizeof (lwpstat.pr_fpreg);
   9563      1.1     skrll   sect->filepos = note->descpos + offsetof (lwpstatus_t, pr_fpreg);
   9564      1.1     skrll #endif
   9565      1.1     skrll 
   9566      1.1     skrll   sect->alignment_power = 2;
   9567      1.1     skrll 
   9568      1.1     skrll   return elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, ".reg2", sect);
   9569      1.1     skrll }
   9570      1.1     skrll #endif /* defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T) */
   9571      1.1     skrll 
   9572      1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   9573      1.1     skrll elfcore_grok_win32pstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   9574      1.1     skrll {
   9575      1.1     skrll   char buf[30];
   9576      1.1     skrll   char *name;
   9577      1.1     skrll   size_t len;
   9578      1.1     skrll   asection *sect;
   9579      1.1     skrll   int type;
   9580      1.1     skrll   int is_active_thread;
   9581      1.1     skrll   bfd_vma base_addr;
   9582      1.1     skrll 
   9583      1.1     skrll   if (note->descsz < 728)
   9584      1.1     skrll     return TRUE;
   9585      1.1     skrll 
   9586      1.1     skrll   if (! CONST_STRNEQ (note->namedata, "win32"))
   9587      1.1     skrll     return TRUE;
   9588      1.1     skrll 
   9589  1.1.1.5  christos   type = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata);
   9590      1.1     skrll 
   9591  1.1.1.5  christos   switch (type)
   9592      1.1     skrll     {
   9593  1.1.1.5  christos     case 1 /* NOTE_INFO_PROCESS */:
   9594      1.1     skrll       /* FIXME: need to add ->core->command.  */
   9595      1.1     skrll       /* process_info.pid */
   9596      1.1     skrll       elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 8);
   9597      1.1     skrll       /* process_info.signal */
   9598      1.1     skrll       elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 12);
   9599      1.1     skrll       break;
   9600      1.1     skrll 
   9601      1.1     skrll     case 2 /* NOTE_INFO_THREAD */:
   9602  1.1.1.3  christos       /* Make a ".reg/999" section.  */
   9603      1.1     skrll       /* thread_info.tid */
   9604      1.1     skrll       sprintf (buf, ".reg/%ld", (long) bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 8));
   9605      1.1     skrll 
   9606      1.1     skrll       len = strlen (buf) + 1;
   9607      1.1     skrll       name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
   9608      1.1     skrll       if (name == NULL)
   9609      1.1     skrll 	return FALSE;
   9610      1.1     skrll 
   9611      1.1     skrll       memcpy (name, buf, len);
   9612      1.1     skrll 
   9613      1.1     skrll       sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
   9614      1.1     skrll       if (sect == NULL)
   9615      1.1     skrll 	return FALSE;
   9616      1.1     skrll 
   9617      1.1     skrll       /* sizeof (thread_info.thread_context) */
   9618      1.1     skrll       sect->size = 716;
   9619      1.1     skrll       /* offsetof (thread_info.thread_context) */
   9620      1.1     skrll       sect->filepos = note->descpos + 12;
   9621      1.1     skrll       sect->alignment_power = 2;
   9622      1.1     skrll 
   9623      1.1     skrll       /* thread_info.is_active_thread */
   9624      1.1     skrll       is_active_thread = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 8);
   9625      1.1     skrll 
   9626      1.1     skrll       if (is_active_thread)
   9627      1.1     skrll 	if (! elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, ".reg", sect))
   9628      1.1     skrll 	  return FALSE;
   9629      1.1     skrll       break;
   9630      1.1     skrll 
   9631      1.1     skrll     case 3 /* NOTE_INFO_MODULE */:
   9632      1.1     skrll       /* Make a ".module/xxxxxxxx" section.  */
   9633  1.1.1.3  christos       /* module_info.base_address */
   9634      1.1     skrll       base_addr = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 4);
   9635      1.1     skrll       sprintf (buf, ".module/%08lx", (unsigned long) base_addr);
   9636      1.1     skrll 
   9637      1.1     skrll       len = strlen (buf) + 1;
   9638      1.1     skrll       name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
   9639      1.1     skrll       if (name == NULL)
   9640      1.1     skrll 	return FALSE;
   9641      1.1     skrll 
   9642      1.1     skrll       memcpy (name, buf, len);
   9643      1.1     skrll 
   9644      1.1     skrll       sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
   9645      1.1     skrll 
   9646      1.1     skrll       if (sect == NULL)
   9647      1.1     skrll 	return FALSE;
   9648      1.1     skrll 
   9649      1.1     skrll       sect->size = note->descsz;
   9650      1.1     skrll       sect->filepos = note->descpos;
   9651      1.1     skrll       sect->alignment_power = 2;
   9652      1.1     skrll       break;
   9653      1.1     skrll 
   9654      1.1     skrll     default:
   9655      1.1     skrll       return TRUE;
   9656      1.1     skrll     }
   9657      1.1     skrll 
   9658      1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   9659      1.1     skrll }
   9660      1.1     skrll 
   9661      1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   9662      1.1     skrll elfcore_grok_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   9663      1.1     skrll {
   9664      1.1     skrll   const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   9665      1.1     skrll 
   9666      1.1     skrll   switch (note->type)
   9667      1.1     skrll     {
   9668      1.1     skrll     default:
   9669      1.1     skrll       return TRUE;
   9670      1.1     skrll 
   9671      1.1     skrll     case NT_PRSTATUS:
   9672      1.1     skrll       if (bed->elf_backend_grok_prstatus)
   9673      1.1     skrll 	if ((*bed->elf_backend_grok_prstatus) (abfd, note))
   9674      1.1     skrll 	  return TRUE;
   9675      1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T)
   9676      1.1     skrll       return elfcore_grok_prstatus (abfd, note);
   9677      1.1     skrll #else
   9678      1.1     skrll       return TRUE;
   9679      1.1     skrll #endif
   9680      1.1     skrll 
   9681      1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T)
   9682      1.1     skrll     case NT_PSTATUS:
   9683      1.1     skrll       return elfcore_grok_pstatus (abfd, note);
   9684      1.1     skrll #endif
   9685      1.1     skrll 
   9686      1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T)
   9687      1.1     skrll     case NT_LWPSTATUS:
   9688      1.1     skrll       return elfcore_grok_lwpstatus (abfd, note);
   9689      1.1     skrll #endif
   9690      1.1     skrll 
   9691      1.1     skrll     case NT_FPREGSET:		/* FIXME: rename to NT_PRFPREG */
   9692      1.1     skrll       return elfcore_grok_prfpreg (abfd, note);
   9693      1.1     skrll 
   9694      1.1     skrll     case NT_WIN32PSTATUS:
   9695      1.1     skrll       return elfcore_grok_win32pstatus (abfd, note);
   9696      1.1     skrll 
   9697      1.1     skrll     case NT_PRXFPREG:		/* Linux SSE extension */
   9698      1.1     skrll       if (note->namesz == 6
   9699  1.1.1.3  christos 	  && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
   9700  1.1.1.3  christos 	return elfcore_grok_prxfpreg (abfd, note);
   9701  1.1.1.3  christos       else
   9702  1.1.1.3  christos 	return TRUE;
   9703  1.1.1.3  christos 
   9704  1.1.1.3  christos     case NT_X86_XSTATE:		/* Linux XSAVE extension */
   9705  1.1.1.3  christos       if (note->namesz == 6
   9706      1.1     skrll 	  && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
   9707      1.1     skrll 	return elfcore_grok_xstatereg (abfd, note);
   9708      1.1     skrll       else
   9709      1.1     skrll 	return TRUE;
   9710      1.1     skrll 
   9711      1.1     skrll     case NT_PPC_VMX:
   9712      1.1     skrll       if (note->namesz == 6
   9713      1.1     skrll 	  && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
   9714      1.1     skrll 	return elfcore_grok_ppc_vmx (abfd, note);
   9715  1.1.1.7  christos       else
   9716  1.1.1.7  christos 	return TRUE;
   9717      1.1     skrll 
   9718  1.1.1.7  christos     case NT_PPC_VSX:
   9719      1.1     skrll       if (note->namesz == 6
   9720  1.1.1.3  christos 	  && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
   9721  1.1.1.3  christos 	return elfcore_grok_ppc_vsx (abfd, note);
   9722  1.1.1.7  christos       else
   9723  1.1.1.7  christos 	return TRUE;
   9724  1.1.1.3  christos 
   9725  1.1.1.7  christos     case NT_S390_HIGH_GPRS:
   9726  1.1.1.3  christos       if (note->namesz == 6
   9727  1.1.1.3  christos 	  && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
   9728  1.1.1.3  christos 	return elfcore_grok_s390_high_gprs (abfd, note);
   9729  1.1.1.7  christos       else
   9730  1.1.1.7  christos 	return TRUE;
   9731  1.1.1.3  christos 
   9732  1.1.1.7  christos     case NT_S390_TIMER:
   9733  1.1.1.3  christos       if (note->namesz == 6
   9734  1.1.1.3  christos 	  && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
   9735  1.1.1.3  christos 	return elfcore_grok_s390_timer (abfd, note);
   9736  1.1.1.7  christos       else
   9737  1.1.1.7  christos 	return TRUE;
   9738  1.1.1.3  christos 
   9739  1.1.1.7  christos     case NT_S390_TODCMP:
   9740  1.1.1.3  christos       if (note->namesz == 6
   9741  1.1.1.3  christos 	  && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
   9742  1.1.1.3  christos 	return elfcore_grok_s390_todcmp (abfd, note);
   9743  1.1.1.7  christos       else
   9744  1.1.1.7  christos 	return TRUE;
   9745  1.1.1.3  christos 
   9746  1.1.1.7  christos     case NT_S390_TODPREG:
   9747  1.1.1.3  christos       if (note->namesz == 6
   9748  1.1.1.3  christos 	  && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
   9749  1.1.1.3  christos 	return elfcore_grok_s390_todpreg (abfd, note);
   9750  1.1.1.7  christos       else
   9751  1.1.1.7  christos 	return TRUE;
   9752  1.1.1.3  christos 
   9753  1.1.1.7  christos     case NT_S390_CTRS:
   9754  1.1.1.3  christos       if (note->namesz == 6
   9755  1.1.1.3  christos 	  && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
   9756  1.1.1.3  christos 	return elfcore_grok_s390_ctrs (abfd, note);
   9757  1.1.1.7  christos       else
   9758  1.1.1.7  christos 	return TRUE;
   9759  1.1.1.3  christos 
   9760  1.1.1.7  christos     case NT_S390_PREFIX:
   9761  1.1.1.3  christos       if (note->namesz == 6
   9762  1.1.1.4  christos 	  && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
   9763  1.1.1.4  christos 	return elfcore_grok_s390_prefix (abfd, note);
   9764  1.1.1.7  christos       else
   9765  1.1.1.7  christos 	return TRUE;
   9766  1.1.1.4  christos 
   9767  1.1.1.7  christos     case NT_S390_LAST_BREAK:
   9768  1.1.1.4  christos       if (note->namesz == 6
   9769  1.1.1.4  christos 	  && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
   9770  1.1.1.4  christos 	return elfcore_grok_s390_last_break (abfd, note);
   9771  1.1.1.7  christos       else
   9772  1.1.1.7  christos 	return TRUE;
   9773  1.1.1.4  christos 
   9774  1.1.1.7  christos     case NT_S390_SYSTEM_CALL:
   9775  1.1.1.4  christos       if (note->namesz == 6
   9776  1.1.1.5  christos 	  && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
   9777  1.1.1.5  christos 	return elfcore_grok_s390_system_call (abfd, note);
   9778  1.1.1.7  christos       else
   9779  1.1.1.7  christos 	return TRUE;
   9780  1.1.1.5  christos 
   9781  1.1.1.7  christos     case NT_S390_TDB:
   9782  1.1.1.5  christos       if (note->namesz == 6
   9783  1.1.1.5  christos 	  && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
   9784  1.1.1.5  christos 	return elfcore_grok_s390_tdb (abfd, note);
   9785  1.1.1.5  christos       else
   9786  1.1.1.5  christos 	return TRUE;
   9787  1.1.1.5  christos 
   9788  1.1.1.5  christos     case NT_S390_VXRS_LOW:
   9789  1.1.1.5  christos       if (note->namesz == 6
   9790  1.1.1.5  christos 	  && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
   9791  1.1.1.5  christos 	return elfcore_grok_s390_vxrs_low (abfd, note);
   9792  1.1.1.5  christos       else
   9793  1.1.1.5  christos 	return TRUE;
   9794  1.1.1.5  christos 
   9795  1.1.1.5  christos     case NT_S390_VXRS_HIGH:
   9796  1.1.1.5  christos       if (note->namesz == 6
   9797  1.1.1.7  christos 	  && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
   9798  1.1.1.7  christos 	return elfcore_grok_s390_vxrs_high (abfd, note);
   9799  1.1.1.7  christos       else
   9800  1.1.1.7  christos 	return TRUE;
   9801  1.1.1.7  christos 
   9802  1.1.1.7  christos     case NT_S390_GS_CB:
   9803  1.1.1.7  christos       if (note->namesz == 6
   9804  1.1.1.7  christos 	  && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
   9805  1.1.1.7  christos 	return elfcore_grok_s390_gs_cb (abfd, note);
   9806  1.1.1.7  christos       else
   9807  1.1.1.7  christos 	return TRUE;
   9808  1.1.1.7  christos 
   9809  1.1.1.7  christos     case NT_S390_GS_BC:
   9810  1.1.1.7  christos       if (note->namesz == 6
   9811  1.1.1.4  christos 	  && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
   9812  1.1.1.4  christos 	return elfcore_grok_s390_gs_bc (abfd, note);
   9813  1.1.1.4  christos       else
   9814  1.1.1.4  christos 	return TRUE;
   9815  1.1.1.4  christos 
   9816  1.1.1.4  christos     case NT_ARM_VFP:
   9817  1.1.1.4  christos       if (note->namesz == 6
   9818  1.1.1.5  christos 	  && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
   9819  1.1.1.5  christos 	return elfcore_grok_arm_vfp (abfd, note);
   9820  1.1.1.5  christos       else
   9821  1.1.1.5  christos 	return TRUE;
   9822  1.1.1.5  christos 
   9823  1.1.1.5  christos     case NT_ARM_TLS:
   9824  1.1.1.5  christos       if (note->namesz == 6
   9825  1.1.1.5  christos 	  && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
   9826  1.1.1.5  christos 	return elfcore_grok_aarch_tls (abfd, note);
   9827  1.1.1.5  christos       else
   9828  1.1.1.5  christos 	return TRUE;
   9829  1.1.1.5  christos 
   9830  1.1.1.5  christos     case NT_ARM_HW_BREAK:
   9831  1.1.1.5  christos       if (note->namesz == 6
   9832  1.1.1.5  christos 	  && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
   9833  1.1.1.5  christos 	return elfcore_grok_aarch_hw_break (abfd, note);
   9834  1.1.1.5  christos       else
   9835  1.1.1.5  christos 	return TRUE;
   9836  1.1.1.5  christos 
   9837  1.1.1.5  christos     case NT_ARM_HW_WATCH:
   9838  1.1.1.5  christos       if (note->namesz == 6
   9839      1.1     skrll 	  && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
   9840      1.1     skrll 	return elfcore_grok_aarch_hw_watch (abfd, note);
   9841      1.1     skrll       else
   9842      1.1     skrll 	return TRUE;
   9843      1.1     skrll 
   9844      1.1     skrll     case NT_PRPSINFO:
   9845      1.1     skrll     case NT_PSINFO:
   9846      1.1     skrll       if (bed->elf_backend_grok_psinfo)
   9847      1.1     skrll 	if ((*bed->elf_backend_grok_psinfo) (abfd, note))
   9848      1.1     skrll 	  return TRUE;
   9849      1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
   9850      1.1     skrll       return elfcore_grok_psinfo (abfd, note);
   9851      1.1     skrll #else
   9852      1.1     skrll       return TRUE;
   9853      1.1     skrll #endif
   9854      1.1     skrll 
   9855      1.1     skrll     case NT_AUXV:
   9856      1.1     skrll       {
   9857      1.1     skrll 	asection *sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".auxv",
   9858      1.1     skrll 							     SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
   9859      1.1     skrll 
   9860      1.1     skrll 	if (sect == NULL)
   9861      1.1     skrll 	  return FALSE;
   9862      1.1     skrll 	sect->size = note->descsz;
   9863  1.1.1.5  christos 	sect->filepos = note->descpos;
   9864  1.1.1.5  christos 	sect->alignment_power = 1 + bfd_get_arch_size (abfd) / 32;
   9865  1.1.1.5  christos 
   9866  1.1.1.5  christos 	return TRUE;
   9867  1.1.1.5  christos       }
   9868  1.1.1.5  christos 
   9869  1.1.1.5  christos     case NT_FILE:
   9870  1.1.1.5  christos       return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.linuxcore.file",
   9871  1.1.1.6  christos 					      note);
   9872      1.1     skrll 
   9873      1.1     skrll     case NT_SIGINFO:
   9874      1.1     skrll       return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.linuxcore.siginfo",
   9875      1.1     skrll 					      note);
   9876      1.1     skrll 
   9877      1.1     skrll     }
   9878  1.1.1.5  christos }
   9879  1.1.1.5  christos 
   9880  1.1.1.5  christos static bfd_boolean
   9881  1.1.1.5  christos elfobj_grok_gnu_build_id (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   9882  1.1.1.5  christos {
   9883  1.1.1.5  christos   struct bfd_build_id* build_id;
   9884  1.1.1.5  christos 
   9885      1.1     skrll   if (note->descsz == 0)
   9886      1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   9887  1.1.1.5  christos 
   9888  1.1.1.5  christos   build_id = bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof (struct bfd_build_id) - 1 + note->descsz);
   9889  1.1.1.5  christos   if (build_id == NULL)
   9890      1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   9891      1.1     skrll 
   9892      1.1     skrll   build_id->size = note->descsz;
   9893      1.1     skrll   memcpy (build_id->data, note->descdata, note->descsz);
   9894      1.1     skrll   abfd->build_id = build_id;
   9895      1.1     skrll 
   9896      1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   9897      1.1     skrll }
   9898      1.1     skrll 
   9899      1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   9900      1.1     skrll elfobj_grok_gnu_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   9901      1.1     skrll {
   9902  1.1.1.7  christos   switch (note->type)
   9903  1.1.1.7  christos     {
   9904  1.1.1.7  christos     default:
   9905      1.1     skrll       return TRUE;
   9906      1.1     skrll 
   9907      1.1     skrll     case NT_GNU_PROPERTY_TYPE_0:
   9908      1.1     skrll       return _bfd_elf_parse_gnu_properties (abfd, note);
   9909      1.1     skrll 
   9910      1.1     skrll     case NT_GNU_BUILD_ID:
   9911  1.1.1.4  christos       return elfobj_grok_gnu_build_id (abfd, note);
   9912  1.1.1.4  christos     }
   9913  1.1.1.4  christos }
   9914  1.1.1.4  christos 
   9915  1.1.1.4  christos static bfd_boolean
   9916  1.1.1.4  christos elfobj_grok_stapsdt_note_1 (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   9917  1.1.1.4  christos {
   9918  1.1.1.4  christos   struct sdt_note *cur =
   9919  1.1.1.4  christos     (struct sdt_note *) bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof (struct sdt_note)
   9920  1.1.1.4  christos 				   + note->descsz);
   9921  1.1.1.4  christos 
   9922  1.1.1.4  christos   cur->next = (struct sdt_note *) (elf_tdata (abfd))->sdt_note_head;
   9923  1.1.1.4  christos   cur->size = (bfd_size_type) note->descsz;
   9924  1.1.1.4  christos   memcpy (cur->data, note->descdata, note->descsz);
   9925  1.1.1.4  christos 
   9926  1.1.1.4  christos   elf_tdata (abfd)->sdt_note_head = cur;
   9927  1.1.1.4  christos 
   9928  1.1.1.4  christos   return TRUE;
   9929  1.1.1.4  christos }
   9930  1.1.1.4  christos 
   9931  1.1.1.4  christos static bfd_boolean
   9932  1.1.1.4  christos elfobj_grok_stapsdt_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   9933  1.1.1.4  christos {
   9934  1.1.1.4  christos   switch (note->type)
   9935  1.1.1.4  christos     {
   9936  1.1.1.4  christos     case NT_STAPSDT:
   9937  1.1.1.4  christos       return elfobj_grok_stapsdt_note_1 (abfd, note);
   9938  1.1.1.4  christos 
   9939  1.1.1.4  christos     default:
   9940  1.1.1.6  christos       return TRUE;
   9941  1.1.1.6  christos     }
   9942  1.1.1.6  christos }
   9943  1.1.1.6  christos 
   9944  1.1.1.7  christos static bfd_boolean
   9945  1.1.1.7  christos elfcore_grok_freebsd_psinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   9946  1.1.1.7  christos {
   9947  1.1.1.7  christos   size_t offset;
   9948  1.1.1.7  christos 
   9949  1.1.1.7  christos   switch (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS])
   9950  1.1.1.7  christos     {
   9951  1.1.1.7  christos     case ELFCLASS32:
   9952  1.1.1.7  christos       if (note->descsz < 108)
   9953  1.1.1.7  christos 	return FALSE;
   9954  1.1.1.7  christos       break;
   9955  1.1.1.7  christos 
   9956  1.1.1.7  christos     case ELFCLASS64:
   9957  1.1.1.7  christos       if (note->descsz < 120)
   9958  1.1.1.7  christos 	return FALSE;
   9959  1.1.1.7  christos       break;
   9960  1.1.1.7  christos 
   9961  1.1.1.6  christos     default:
   9962  1.1.1.6  christos       return FALSE;
   9963  1.1.1.7  christos     }
   9964  1.1.1.6  christos 
   9965  1.1.1.6  christos   /* Check for version 1 in pr_version.  */
   9966  1.1.1.6  christos   if (bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata) != 1)
   9967  1.1.1.7  christos     return FALSE;
   9968  1.1.1.7  christos 
   9969  1.1.1.7  christos   offset = 4;
   9970  1.1.1.6  christos 
   9971  1.1.1.6  christos   /* Skip over pr_psinfosz. */
   9972  1.1.1.6  christos   if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS] == ELFCLASS32)
   9973  1.1.1.6  christos     offset += 4;
   9974  1.1.1.6  christos   else
   9975  1.1.1.6  christos     {
   9976  1.1.1.6  christos       offset += 4;	/* Padding before pr_psinfosz. */
   9977  1.1.1.6  christos       offset += 8;
   9978  1.1.1.6  christos     }
   9979  1.1.1.6  christos 
   9980  1.1.1.6  christos   /* pr_fname is PRFNAMESZ (16) + 1 bytes in size.  */
   9981  1.1.1.6  christos   elf_tdata (abfd)->core->program
   9982  1.1.1.6  christos     = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + offset, 17);
   9983  1.1.1.7  christos   offset += 17;
   9984  1.1.1.7  christos 
   9985  1.1.1.7  christos   /* pr_psargs is PRARGSZ (80) + 1 bytes in size.  */
   9986  1.1.1.7  christos   elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
   9987  1.1.1.7  christos     = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + offset, 81);
   9988  1.1.1.7  christos   offset += 81;
   9989  1.1.1.7  christos 
   9990  1.1.1.7  christos   /* Padding before pr_pid.  */
   9991  1.1.1.7  christos   offset += 2;
   9992  1.1.1.7  christos 
   9993  1.1.1.7  christos   /* The pr_pid field was added in version "1a".  */
   9994  1.1.1.6  christos   if (note->descsz < offset + 4)
   9995  1.1.1.6  christos     return TRUE;
   9996  1.1.1.6  christos 
   9997  1.1.1.6  christos   elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid
   9998  1.1.1.6  christos     = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + offset);
   9999  1.1.1.6  christos 
   10000  1.1.1.6  christos   return TRUE;
   10001  1.1.1.6  christos }
   10002  1.1.1.6  christos 
   10003  1.1.1.7  christos static bfd_boolean
   10004  1.1.1.6  christos elfcore_grok_freebsd_prstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   10005  1.1.1.7  christos {
   10006  1.1.1.7  christos   size_t offset;
   10007  1.1.1.7  christos   size_t size;
   10008  1.1.1.7  christos   size_t min_size;
   10009  1.1.1.7  christos 
   10010  1.1.1.7  christos   /* Compute offset of pr_getregsz, skipping over pr_statussz.
   10011  1.1.1.7  christos      Also compute minimum size of this note.  */
   10012  1.1.1.6  christos   switch (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS])
   10013  1.1.1.6  christos     {
   10014  1.1.1.7  christos     case ELFCLASS32:
   10015  1.1.1.7  christos       offset = 4 + 4;
   10016  1.1.1.7  christos       min_size = offset + (4 * 2) + 4 + 4 + 4;
   10017  1.1.1.6  christos       break;
   10018  1.1.1.6  christos 
   10019  1.1.1.6  christos     case ELFCLASS64:
   10020  1.1.1.6  christos       offset = 4 + 4 + 8;	/* Includes padding before pr_statussz.  */
   10021  1.1.1.6  christos       min_size = offset + (8 * 2) + 4 + 4 + 4 + 4;
   10022  1.1.1.6  christos       break;
   10023  1.1.1.7  christos 
   10024  1.1.1.7  christos     default:
   10025  1.1.1.7  christos       return FALSE;
   10026  1.1.1.7  christos     }
   10027  1.1.1.7  christos 
   10028  1.1.1.7  christos   if (note->descsz < min_size)
   10029  1.1.1.7  christos     return FALSE;
   10030  1.1.1.6  christos 
   10031  1.1.1.7  christos   /* Check for version 1 in pr_version.  */
   10032  1.1.1.7  christos   if (bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata) != 1)
   10033  1.1.1.7  christos     return FALSE;
   10034  1.1.1.7  christos 
   10035  1.1.1.7  christos   /* Extract size of pr_reg from pr_gregsetsz.  */
   10036  1.1.1.7  christos   /* Skip over pr_gregsetsz and pr_fpregsetsz.  */
   10037  1.1.1.6  christos   if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS] == ELFCLASS32)
   10038  1.1.1.7  christos     {
   10039  1.1.1.7  christos       size = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + offset);
   10040  1.1.1.7  christos       offset += 4 * 2;
   10041  1.1.1.7  christos     }
   10042  1.1.1.6  christos   else
   10043  1.1.1.7  christos     {
   10044  1.1.1.6  christos       size = bfd_h_get_64 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + offset);
   10045  1.1.1.6  christos       offset += 8 * 2;
   10046  1.1.1.7  christos     }
   10047  1.1.1.6  christos 
   10048  1.1.1.6  christos   /* Skip over pr_osreldate.  */
   10049  1.1.1.6  christos   offset += 4;
   10050  1.1.1.6  christos 
   10051  1.1.1.6  christos   /* Read signal from pr_cursig.  */
   10052  1.1.1.7  christos   if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal == 0)
   10053  1.1.1.6  christos     elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal
   10054  1.1.1.6  christos       = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + offset);
   10055  1.1.1.6  christos   offset += 4;
   10056  1.1.1.6  christos 
   10057  1.1.1.7  christos   /* Read TID from pr_pid.  */
   10058  1.1.1.7  christos   elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid
   10059  1.1.1.6  christos       = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + offset);
   10060  1.1.1.6  christos   offset += 4;
   10061  1.1.1.7  christos 
   10062  1.1.1.7  christos   /* Padding before pr_reg.  */
   10063  1.1.1.7  christos   if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS] == ELFCLASS64)
   10064  1.1.1.7  christos     offset += 4;
   10065  1.1.1.6  christos 
   10066  1.1.1.6  christos   /* Make sure that there is enough data remaining in the note.  */
   10067  1.1.1.6  christos   if ((note->descsz - offset) < size)
   10068  1.1.1.6  christos     return FALSE;
   10069  1.1.1.6  christos 
   10070  1.1.1.6  christos   /* Make a ".reg/999" section and a ".reg" section.  */
   10071  1.1.1.6  christos   return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg",
   10072  1.1.1.6  christos 					  size, note->descpos + offset);
   10073  1.1.1.7  christos }
   10074  1.1.1.7  christos 
   10075  1.1.1.6  christos static bfd_boolean
   10076  1.1.1.6  christos elfcore_grok_freebsd_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   10077  1.1.1.6  christos {
   10078  1.1.1.7  christos   const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   10079  1.1.1.7  christos 
   10080  1.1.1.7  christos   switch (note->type)
   10081  1.1.1.6  christos     {
   10082  1.1.1.6  christos     case NT_PRSTATUS:
   10083  1.1.1.6  christos       if (bed->elf_backend_grok_freebsd_prstatus)
   10084  1.1.1.6  christos 	if ((*bed->elf_backend_grok_freebsd_prstatus) (abfd, note))
   10085  1.1.1.6  christos 	  return TRUE;
   10086  1.1.1.6  christos       return elfcore_grok_freebsd_prstatus (abfd, note);
   10087  1.1.1.6  christos 
   10088  1.1.1.6  christos     case NT_FPREGSET:
   10089  1.1.1.6  christos       return elfcore_grok_prfpreg (abfd, note);
   10090  1.1.1.6  christos 
   10091  1.1.1.6  christos     case NT_PRPSINFO:
   10092  1.1.1.6  christos       return elfcore_grok_freebsd_psinfo (abfd, note);
   10093  1.1.1.6  christos 
   10094  1.1.1.6  christos     case NT_FREEBSD_THRMISC:
   10095  1.1.1.7  christos       if (note->namesz == 8)
   10096  1.1.1.7  christos 	return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".thrmisc", note);
   10097  1.1.1.7  christos       else
   10098  1.1.1.7  christos 	return TRUE;
   10099  1.1.1.7  christos 
   10100  1.1.1.7  christos     case NT_FREEBSD_PROCSTAT_PROC:
   10101  1.1.1.7  christos       return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.freebsdcore.proc",
   10102  1.1.1.7  christos 					      note);
   10103  1.1.1.7  christos 
   10104  1.1.1.7  christos     case NT_FREEBSD_PROCSTAT_FILES:
   10105  1.1.1.7  christos       return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.freebsdcore.files",
   10106  1.1.1.7  christos 					      note);
   10107  1.1.1.6  christos 
   10108  1.1.1.6  christos     case NT_FREEBSD_PROCSTAT_VMMAP:
   10109  1.1.1.6  christos       return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.freebsdcore.vmmap",
   10110  1.1.1.6  christos 					      note);
   10111  1.1.1.6  christos 
   10112  1.1.1.6  christos     case NT_FREEBSD_PROCSTAT_AUXV:
   10113  1.1.1.6  christos       {
   10114  1.1.1.6  christos 	asection *sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".auxv",
   10115  1.1.1.6  christos 							     SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
   10116  1.1.1.6  christos 
   10117  1.1.1.6  christos 	if (sect == NULL)
   10118  1.1.1.6  christos 	  return FALSE;
   10119  1.1.1.6  christos 	sect->size = note->descsz - 4;
   10120  1.1.1.6  christos 	sect->filepos = note->descpos + 4;
   10121  1.1.1.6  christos 	sect->alignment_power = 1 + bfd_get_arch_size (abfd) / 32;
   10122  1.1.1.6  christos 
   10123  1.1.1.6  christos 	return TRUE;
   10124  1.1.1.6  christos       }
   10125  1.1.1.6  christos 
   10126  1.1.1.6  christos     case NT_X86_XSTATE:
   10127  1.1.1.7  christos       if (note->namesz == 8)
   10128  1.1.1.7  christos 	return elfcore_grok_xstatereg (abfd, note);
   10129  1.1.1.7  christos       else
   10130  1.1.1.7  christos 	return TRUE;
   10131  1.1.1.7  christos 
   10132  1.1.1.7  christos     case NT_FREEBSD_PTLWPINFO:
   10133  1.1.1.7  christos       return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.freebsdcore.lwpinfo",
   10134  1.1.1.6  christos 					      note);
   10135  1.1.1.6  christos 
   10136  1.1.1.6  christos     case NT_ARM_VFP:
   10137  1.1.1.6  christos       return elfcore_grok_arm_vfp (abfd, note);
   10138  1.1.1.6  christos 
   10139  1.1.1.6  christos     default:
   10140      1.1     skrll       return TRUE;
   10141      1.1     skrll     }
   10142      1.1     skrll }
   10143      1.1     skrll 
   10144      1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   10145      1.1     skrll elfcore_netbsd_get_lwpid (Elf_Internal_Note *note, int *lwpidp)
   10146      1.1     skrll {
   10147      1.1     skrll   char *cp;
   10148      1.1     skrll 
   10149      1.1     skrll   cp = strchr (note->namedata, '@');
   10150      1.1     skrll   if (cp != NULL)
   10151      1.1     skrll     {
   10152      1.1     skrll       *lwpidp = atoi(cp + 1);
   10153      1.1     skrll       return TRUE;
   10154      1.1     skrll     }
   10155      1.1     skrll   return FALSE;
   10156  1.1.1.7  christos }
   10157  1.1.1.7  christos 
   10158  1.1.1.7  christos static bfd_boolean
   10159      1.1     skrll elfcore_grok_netbsd_procinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   10160  1.1.1.5  christos {
   10161      1.1     skrll   if (note->descsz <= 0x7c + 31)
   10162      1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   10163      1.1     skrll 
   10164  1.1.1.5  christos   /* Signal number at offset 0x08. */
   10165      1.1     skrll   elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal
   10166      1.1     skrll     = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + 0x08);
   10167      1.1     skrll 
   10168  1.1.1.5  christos   /* Process ID at offset 0x50. */
   10169      1.1     skrll   elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid
   10170      1.1     skrll     = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + 0x50);
   10171      1.1     skrll 
   10172      1.1     skrll   /* Command name at 0x7c (max 32 bytes, including nul). */
   10173      1.1     skrll   elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
   10174      1.1     skrll     = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 0x7c, 31);
   10175      1.1     skrll 
   10176      1.1     skrll   return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.netbsdcore.procinfo",
   10177      1.1     skrll 					  note);
   10178      1.1     skrll }
   10179      1.1     skrll 
   10180      1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   10181  1.1.1.5  christos elfcore_grok_netbsd_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   10182      1.1     skrll {
   10183      1.1     skrll   int lwp;
   10184      1.1     skrll 
   10185      1.1     skrll   if (elfcore_netbsd_get_lwpid (note, &lwp))
   10186      1.1     skrll     elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = lwp;
   10187      1.1     skrll 
   10188      1.1     skrll   if (note->type == NT_NETBSDCORE_PROCINFO)
   10189      1.1     skrll     {
   10190      1.1     skrll       /* NetBSD-specific core "procinfo".  Note that we expect to
   10191      1.1     skrll 	 find this note before any of the others, which is fine,
   10192      1.1     skrll 	 since the kernel writes this note out first when it
   10193      1.1     skrll 	 creates a core file.  */
   10194      1.1     skrll 
   10195      1.1     skrll       return elfcore_grok_netbsd_procinfo (abfd, note);
   10196      1.1     skrll     }
   10197      1.1     skrll 
   10198      1.1     skrll   /* As of Jan 2002 there are no other machine-independent notes
   10199      1.1     skrll      defined for NetBSD core files.  If the note type is less
   10200      1.1     skrll      than the start of the machine-dependent note types, we don't
   10201      1.1     skrll      understand it.  */
   10202      1.1     skrll 
   10203      1.1     skrll   if (note->type < NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH)
   10204      1.1     skrll     return TRUE;
   10205      1.1     skrll 
   10206      1.1     skrll 
   10207      1.1     skrll   switch (bfd_get_arch (abfd))
   10208      1.1     skrll     {
   10209      1.1     skrll       /* On the Alpha, SPARC (32-bit and 64-bit), PT_GETREGS == mach+0 and
   10210      1.1     skrll 	 PT_GETFPREGS == mach+2.  */
   10211      1.1     skrll 
   10212      1.1     skrll     case bfd_arch_alpha:
   10213      1.1     skrll     case bfd_arch_sparc:
   10214      1.1     skrll       switch (note->type)
   10215      1.1     skrll 	{
   10216      1.1     skrll 	case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+0:
   10217      1.1     skrll 	  return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg", note);
   10218      1.1     skrll 
   10219      1.1     skrll 	case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+2:
   10220      1.1     skrll 	  return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
   10221      1.1     skrll 
   10222      1.1     skrll 	default:
   10223      1.1     skrll 	  return TRUE;
   10224      1.1     skrll 	}
   10225      1.1     skrll 
   10226      1.1     skrll       /* On all other arch's, PT_GETREGS == mach+1 and
   10227      1.1     skrll 	 PT_GETFPREGS == mach+3.  */
   10228      1.1     skrll 
   10229      1.1     skrll     default:
   10230      1.1     skrll       switch (note->type)
   10231      1.1     skrll 	{
   10232      1.1     skrll 	case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+1:
   10233      1.1     skrll 	  return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg", note);
   10234      1.1     skrll 
   10235      1.1     skrll 	case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+3:
   10236      1.1     skrll 	  return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
   10237      1.1     skrll 
   10238      1.1     skrll 	default:
   10239      1.1     skrll 	  return TRUE;
   10240      1.1     skrll 	}
   10241  1.1.1.3  christos     }
   10242  1.1.1.3  christos     /* NOTREACHED */
   10243  1.1.1.7  christos }
   10244  1.1.1.7  christos 
   10245  1.1.1.7  christos static bfd_boolean
   10246  1.1.1.3  christos elfcore_grok_openbsd_procinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   10247  1.1.1.5  christos {
   10248  1.1.1.3  christos   if (note->descsz <= 0x48 + 31)
   10249  1.1.1.3  christos     return FALSE;
   10250  1.1.1.3  christos 
   10251  1.1.1.5  christos   /* Signal number at offset 0x08. */
   10252  1.1.1.3  christos   elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal
   10253  1.1.1.3  christos     = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + 0x08);
   10254  1.1.1.3  christos 
   10255  1.1.1.5  christos   /* Process ID at offset 0x20. */
   10256  1.1.1.3  christos   elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid
   10257  1.1.1.3  christos     = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + 0x20);
   10258  1.1.1.3  christos 
   10259  1.1.1.3  christos   /* Command name at 0x48 (max 32 bytes, including nul). */
   10260  1.1.1.3  christos   elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
   10261  1.1.1.3  christos     = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 0x48, 31);
   10262  1.1.1.3  christos 
   10263  1.1.1.3  christos   return TRUE;
   10264  1.1.1.3  christos }
   10265  1.1.1.3  christos 
   10266  1.1.1.3  christos static bfd_boolean
   10267  1.1.1.3  christos elfcore_grok_openbsd_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   10268  1.1.1.3  christos {
   10269  1.1.1.3  christos   if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_PROCINFO)
   10270  1.1.1.3  christos     return elfcore_grok_openbsd_procinfo (abfd, note);
   10271  1.1.1.3  christos 
   10272  1.1.1.3  christos   if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_REGS)
   10273  1.1.1.3  christos     return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg", note);
   10274  1.1.1.3  christos 
   10275  1.1.1.3  christos   if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_FPREGS)
   10276  1.1.1.3  christos     return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
   10277  1.1.1.3  christos 
   10278  1.1.1.3  christos   if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_XFPREGS)
   10279  1.1.1.3  christos     return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-xfp", note);
   10280  1.1.1.3  christos 
   10281  1.1.1.3  christos   if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_AUXV)
   10282  1.1.1.3  christos     {
   10283  1.1.1.3  christos       asection *sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".auxv",
   10284  1.1.1.3  christos 							   SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
   10285  1.1.1.3  christos 
   10286  1.1.1.3  christos       if (sect == NULL)
   10287  1.1.1.3  christos 	return FALSE;
   10288  1.1.1.3  christos       sect->size = note->descsz;
   10289  1.1.1.3  christos       sect->filepos = note->descpos;
   10290  1.1.1.3  christos       sect->alignment_power = 1 + bfd_get_arch_size (abfd) / 32;
   10291  1.1.1.3  christos 
   10292  1.1.1.3  christos       return TRUE;
   10293  1.1.1.3  christos     }
   10294  1.1.1.3  christos 
   10295  1.1.1.3  christos   if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_WCOOKIE)
   10296  1.1.1.3  christos     {
   10297  1.1.1.3  christos       asection *sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".wcookie",
   10298  1.1.1.3  christos 							   SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
   10299  1.1.1.3  christos 
   10300  1.1.1.3  christos       if (sect == NULL)
   10301  1.1.1.3  christos 	return FALSE;
   10302  1.1.1.3  christos       sect->size = note->descsz;
   10303  1.1.1.3  christos       sect->filepos = note->descpos;
   10304  1.1.1.3  christos       sect->alignment_power = 1 + bfd_get_arch_size (abfd) / 32;
   10305  1.1.1.3  christos 
   10306  1.1.1.3  christos       return TRUE;
   10307  1.1.1.3  christos     }
   10308      1.1     skrll 
   10309      1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   10310      1.1     skrll }
   10311      1.1     skrll 
   10312      1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   10313      1.1     skrll elfcore_grok_nto_status (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note, long *tid)
   10314      1.1     skrll {
   10315      1.1     skrll   void *ddata = note->descdata;
   10316      1.1     skrll   char buf[100];
   10317  1.1.1.7  christos   char *name;
   10318  1.1.1.7  christos   asection *sect;
   10319  1.1.1.7  christos   short sig;
   10320      1.1     skrll   unsigned flags;
   10321  1.1.1.5  christos 
   10322      1.1     skrll   if (note->descsz < 16)
   10323      1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   10324      1.1     skrll 
   10325      1.1     skrll   /* nto_procfs_status 'pid' field is at offset 0.  */
   10326      1.1     skrll   elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) ddata);
   10327      1.1     skrll 
   10328      1.1     skrll   /* nto_procfs_status 'tid' field is at offset 4.  Pass it back.  */
   10329      1.1     skrll   *tid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) ddata + 4);
   10330      1.1     skrll 
   10331      1.1     skrll   /* nto_procfs_status 'flags' field is at offset 8.  */
   10332  1.1.1.5  christos   flags = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) ddata + 8);
   10333  1.1.1.5  christos 
   10334      1.1     skrll   /* nto_procfs_status 'what' field is at offset 14.  */
   10335      1.1     skrll   if ((sig = bfd_get_16 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) ddata + 14)) > 0)
   10336      1.1     skrll     {
   10337      1.1     skrll       elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = sig;
   10338      1.1     skrll       elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = *tid;
   10339      1.1     skrll     }
   10340  1.1.1.5  christos 
   10341      1.1     skrll   /* _DEBUG_FLAG_CURTID (current thread) is 0x80.  Some cores
   10342      1.1     skrll      do not come from signals so we make sure we set the current
   10343      1.1     skrll      thread just in case.  */
   10344      1.1     skrll   if (flags & 0x00000080)
   10345  1.1.1.3  christos     elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = *tid;
   10346      1.1     skrll 
   10347      1.1     skrll   /* Make a ".qnx_core_status/%d" section.  */
   10348      1.1     skrll   sprintf (buf, ".qnx_core_status/%ld", *tid);
   10349      1.1     skrll 
   10350      1.1     skrll   name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, strlen (buf) + 1);
   10351      1.1     skrll   if (name == NULL)
   10352      1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   10353      1.1     skrll   strcpy (name, buf);
   10354  1.1.1.7  christos 
   10355  1.1.1.7  christos   sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
   10356      1.1     skrll   if (sect == NULL)
   10357      1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   10358      1.1     skrll 
   10359      1.1     skrll   sect->size		= note->descsz;
   10360      1.1     skrll   sect->filepos		= note->descpos;
   10361      1.1     skrll   sect->alignment_power = 2;
   10362      1.1     skrll 
   10363      1.1     skrll   return (elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, ".qnx_core_status", sect));
   10364      1.1     skrll }
   10365      1.1     skrll 
   10366      1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   10367      1.1     skrll elfcore_grok_nto_regs (bfd *abfd,
   10368      1.1     skrll 		       Elf_Internal_Note *note,
   10369      1.1     skrll 		       long tid,
   10370      1.1     skrll 		       char *base)
   10371      1.1     skrll {
   10372      1.1     skrll   char buf[100];
   10373      1.1     skrll   char *name;
   10374  1.1.1.3  christos   asection *sect;
   10375      1.1     skrll 
   10376      1.1     skrll   /* Make a "(base)/%d" section.  */
   10377      1.1     skrll   sprintf (buf, "%s/%ld", base, tid);
   10378      1.1     skrll 
   10379      1.1     skrll   name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, strlen (buf) + 1);
   10380      1.1     skrll   if (name == NULL)
   10381      1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   10382      1.1     skrll   strcpy (name, buf);
   10383  1.1.1.7  christos 
   10384  1.1.1.7  christos   sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
   10385      1.1     skrll   if (sect == NULL)
   10386      1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   10387      1.1     skrll 
   10388  1.1.1.5  christos   sect->size		= note->descsz;
   10389      1.1     skrll   sect->filepos		= note->descpos;
   10390      1.1     skrll   sect->alignment_power = 2;
   10391      1.1     skrll 
   10392      1.1     skrll   /* This is the current thread.  */
   10393      1.1     skrll   if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid == tid)
   10394      1.1     skrll     return elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, base, sect);
   10395      1.1     skrll 
   10396      1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   10397      1.1     skrll }
   10398      1.1     skrll 
   10399      1.1     skrll #define BFD_QNT_CORE_INFO	7
   10400      1.1     skrll #define BFD_QNT_CORE_STATUS	8
   10401      1.1     skrll #define BFD_QNT_CORE_GREG	9
   10402      1.1     skrll #define BFD_QNT_CORE_FPREG	10
   10403      1.1     skrll 
   10404      1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   10405      1.1     skrll elfcore_grok_nto_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   10406      1.1     skrll {
   10407      1.1     skrll   /* Every GREG section has a STATUS section before it.  Store the
   10408      1.1     skrll      tid from the previous call to pass down to the next gregs
   10409      1.1     skrll      function.  */
   10410      1.1     skrll   static long tid = 1;
   10411      1.1     skrll 
   10412      1.1     skrll   switch (note->type)
   10413      1.1     skrll     {
   10414      1.1     skrll     case BFD_QNT_CORE_INFO:
   10415      1.1     skrll       return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".qnx_core_info", note);
   10416      1.1     skrll     case BFD_QNT_CORE_STATUS:
   10417      1.1     skrll       return elfcore_grok_nto_status (abfd, note, &tid);
   10418      1.1     skrll     case BFD_QNT_CORE_GREG:
   10419      1.1     skrll       return elfcore_grok_nto_regs (abfd, note, tid, ".reg");
   10420      1.1     skrll     case BFD_QNT_CORE_FPREG:
   10421      1.1     skrll       return elfcore_grok_nto_regs (abfd, note, tid, ".reg2");
   10422      1.1     skrll     default:
   10423      1.1     skrll       return TRUE;
   10424      1.1     skrll     }
   10425      1.1     skrll }
   10426      1.1     skrll 
   10427      1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   10428      1.1     skrll elfcore_grok_spu_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   10429      1.1     skrll {
   10430      1.1     skrll   char *name;
   10431  1.1.1.3  christos   asection *sect;
   10432      1.1     skrll   size_t len;
   10433      1.1     skrll 
   10434      1.1     skrll   /* Use note name as section name.  */
   10435      1.1     skrll   len = note->namesz;
   10436      1.1     skrll   name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
   10437      1.1     skrll   if (name == NULL)
   10438      1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   10439      1.1     skrll   memcpy (name, note->namedata, len);
   10440      1.1     skrll   name[len - 1] = '\0';
   10441  1.1.1.7  christos 
   10442  1.1.1.7  christos   sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
   10443      1.1     skrll   if (sect == NULL)
   10444      1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   10445      1.1     skrll 
   10446      1.1     skrll   sect->size		= note->descsz;
   10447      1.1     skrll   sect->filepos		= note->descpos;
   10448      1.1     skrll   sect->alignment_power = 1;
   10449      1.1     skrll 
   10450      1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   10451      1.1     skrll }
   10452      1.1     skrll 
   10453      1.1     skrll /* Function: elfcore_write_note
   10454      1.1     skrll 
   10455      1.1     skrll    Inputs:
   10456      1.1     skrll      buffer to hold note, and current size of buffer
   10457      1.1     skrll      name of note
   10458      1.1     skrll      type of note
   10459      1.1     skrll      data for note
   10460      1.1     skrll      size of data for note
   10461      1.1     skrll 
   10462      1.1     skrll    Writes note to end of buffer.  ELF64 notes are written exactly as
   10463      1.1     skrll    for ELF32, despite the current (as of 2006) ELF gabi specifying
   10464      1.1     skrll    that they ought to have 8-byte namesz and descsz field, and have
   10465      1.1     skrll    8-byte alignment.  Other writers, eg. Linux kernel, do the same.
   10466      1.1     skrll 
   10467      1.1     skrll    Return:
   10468      1.1     skrll    Pointer to realloc'd buffer, *BUFSIZ updated.  */
   10469      1.1     skrll 
   10470      1.1     skrll char *
   10471      1.1     skrll elfcore_write_note (bfd *abfd,
   10472      1.1     skrll 		    char *buf,
   10473      1.1     skrll 		    int *bufsiz,
   10474      1.1     skrll 		    const char *name,
   10475      1.1     skrll 		    int type,
   10476      1.1     skrll 		    const void *input,
   10477      1.1     skrll 		    int size)
   10478      1.1     skrll {
   10479      1.1     skrll   Elf_External_Note *xnp;
   10480      1.1     skrll   size_t namesz;
   10481      1.1     skrll   size_t newspace;
   10482      1.1     skrll   char *dest;
   10483      1.1     skrll 
   10484      1.1     skrll   namesz = 0;
   10485  1.1.1.3  christos   if (name != NULL)
   10486      1.1     skrll     namesz = strlen (name) + 1;
   10487      1.1     skrll 
   10488      1.1     skrll   newspace = 12 + ((namesz + 3) & -4) + ((size + 3) & -4);
   10489      1.1     skrll 
   10490      1.1     skrll   buf = (char *) realloc (buf, *bufsiz + newspace);
   10491      1.1     skrll   if (buf == NULL)
   10492      1.1     skrll     return buf;
   10493      1.1     skrll   dest = buf + *bufsiz;
   10494      1.1     skrll   *bufsiz += newspace;
   10495      1.1     skrll   xnp = (Elf_External_Note *) dest;
   10496      1.1     skrll   H_PUT_32 (abfd, namesz, xnp->namesz);
   10497      1.1     skrll   H_PUT_32 (abfd, size, xnp->descsz);
   10498      1.1     skrll   H_PUT_32 (abfd, type, xnp->type);
   10499      1.1     skrll   dest = xnp->name;
   10500      1.1     skrll   if (name != NULL)
   10501      1.1     skrll     {
   10502      1.1     skrll       memcpy (dest, name, namesz);
   10503      1.1     skrll       dest += namesz;
   10504      1.1     skrll       while (namesz & 3)
   10505      1.1     skrll 	{
   10506      1.1     skrll 	  *dest++ = '\0';
   10507      1.1     skrll 	  ++namesz;
   10508      1.1     skrll 	}
   10509      1.1     skrll     }
   10510      1.1     skrll   memcpy (dest, input, size);
   10511      1.1     skrll   dest += size;
   10512      1.1     skrll   while (size & 3)
   10513      1.1     skrll     {
   10514      1.1     skrll       *dest++ = '\0';
   10515  1.1.1.8  christos       ++size;
   10516  1.1.1.8  christos     }
   10517  1.1.1.8  christos   return buf;
   10518  1.1.1.8  christos }
   10519  1.1.1.8  christos 
   10520  1.1.1.8  christos /* gcc-8 warns (*) on all the strncpy calls in this function about
   10521  1.1.1.8  christos    possible string truncation.  The "truncation" is not a bug.  We
   10522  1.1.1.8  christos    have an external representation of structs with fields that are not
   10523  1.1.1.8  christos    necessarily NULL terminated and corresponding internal
   10524  1.1.1.8  christos    representation fields that are one larger so that they can always
   10525  1.1.1.8  christos    be NULL terminated.
   10526  1.1.1.8  christos    gcc versions between 4.2 and 4.6 do not allow pragma control of
   10527  1.1.1.8  christos    diagnostics inside functions, giving a hard error if you try to use
   10528  1.1.1.8  christos    the finer control available with later versions.
   10529  1.1.1.8  christos    gcc prior to 4.2 warns about diagnostic push and pop.
   10530  1.1.1.8  christos    gcc-5, gcc-6 and gcc-7 warn that -Wstringop-truncation is unknown,
   10531  1.1.1.8  christos    unless you also add #pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wpragma".
   10532      1.1     skrll    (*) Depending on your system header files!  */
   10533      1.1     skrll #if GCC_VERSION >= 8000
   10534      1.1     skrll # pragma GCC diagnostic push
   10535      1.1     skrll # pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wstringop-truncation"
   10536      1.1     skrll #endif
   10537      1.1     skrll char *
   10538      1.1     skrll elfcore_write_prpsinfo (bfd  *abfd,
   10539      1.1     skrll 			char *buf,
   10540      1.1     skrll 			int  *bufsiz,
   10541      1.1     skrll 			const char *fname,
   10542      1.1     skrll 			const char *psargs)
   10543      1.1     skrll {
   10544      1.1     skrll   const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   10545      1.1     skrll 
   10546      1.1     skrll   if (bed->elf_backend_write_core_note != NULL)
   10547      1.1     skrll     {
   10548      1.1     skrll       char *ret;
   10549      1.1     skrll       ret = (*bed->elf_backend_write_core_note) (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
   10550  1.1.1.4  christos 						 NT_PRPSINFO, fname, psargs);
   10551  1.1.1.8  christos       if (ret != NULL)
   10552      1.1     skrll 	return ret;
   10553      1.1     skrll     }
   10554  1.1.1.8  christos 
   10555      1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
   10556      1.1     skrll # if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T)
   10557  1.1.1.8  christos   if (bed->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS32)
   10558      1.1     skrll     {
   10559      1.1     skrll #  if defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T)
   10560  1.1.1.8  christos       psinfo32_t data;
   10561      1.1     skrll       int note_type = NT_PSINFO;
   10562      1.1     skrll #  else
   10563      1.1     skrll       prpsinfo32_t data;
   10564      1.1     skrll       int note_type = NT_PRPSINFO;
   10565      1.1     skrll #  endif
   10566  1.1.1.4  christos 
   10567      1.1     skrll       memset (&data, 0, sizeof (data));
   10568      1.1     skrll       strncpy (data.pr_fname, fname, sizeof (data.pr_fname));
   10569  1.1.1.8  christos       strncpy (data.pr_psargs, psargs, sizeof (data.pr_psargs));
   10570      1.1     skrll       return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
   10571  1.1.1.8  christos 				 "CORE", note_type, &data, sizeof (data));
   10572      1.1     skrll     }
   10573      1.1     skrll   else
   10574  1.1.1.8  christos # endif
   10575      1.1     skrll     {
   10576      1.1     skrll # if defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
   10577  1.1.1.8  christos       psinfo_t data;
   10578      1.1     skrll       int note_type = NT_PSINFO;
   10579      1.1     skrll # else
   10580      1.1     skrll       prpsinfo_t data;
   10581      1.1     skrll       int note_type = NT_PRPSINFO;
   10582      1.1     skrll # endif
   10583  1.1.1.4  christos 
   10584      1.1     skrll       memset (&data, 0, sizeof (data));
   10585      1.1     skrll       strncpy (data.pr_fname, fname, sizeof (data.pr_fname));
   10586      1.1     skrll       strncpy (data.pr_psargs, psargs, sizeof (data.pr_psargs));
   10587  1.1.1.4  christos       return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
   10588  1.1.1.4  christos 				 "CORE", note_type, &data, sizeof (data));
   10589  1.1.1.4  christos     }
   10590  1.1.1.8  christos #endif	/* PSINFO_T or PRPSINFO_T */
   10591  1.1.1.8  christos 
   10592  1.1.1.8  christos   free (buf);
   10593  1.1.1.4  christos   return NULL;
   10594      1.1     skrll }
   10595  1.1.1.5  christos #if GCC_VERSION >= 8000
   10596  1.1.1.5  christos # pragma GCC diagnostic pop
   10597  1.1.1.5  christos #endif
   10598  1.1.1.5  christos 
   10599  1.1.1.7  christos char *
   10600  1.1.1.7  christos elfcore_write_linux_prpsinfo32
   10601  1.1.1.7  christos   (bfd *abfd, char *buf, int *bufsiz,
   10602  1.1.1.7  christos    const struct elf_internal_linux_prpsinfo *prpsinfo)
   10603  1.1.1.7  christos {
   10604  1.1.1.7  christos   if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->linux_prpsinfo32_ugid16)
   10605  1.1.1.7  christos     {
   10606  1.1.1.7  christos       struct elf_external_linux_prpsinfo32_ugid16 data;
   10607  1.1.1.7  christos 
   10608  1.1.1.7  christos       swap_linux_prpsinfo32_ugid16_out (abfd, prpsinfo, &data);
   10609  1.1.1.7  christos       return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, "CORE", NT_PRPSINFO,
   10610  1.1.1.5  christos 				 &data, sizeof (data));
   10611  1.1.1.7  christos     }
   10612  1.1.1.7  christos   else
   10613  1.1.1.7  christos     {
   10614  1.1.1.7  christos       struct elf_external_linux_prpsinfo32_ugid32 data;
   10615  1.1.1.5  christos 
   10616  1.1.1.5  christos       swap_linux_prpsinfo32_ugid32_out (abfd, prpsinfo, &data);
   10617  1.1.1.5  christos       return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, "CORE", NT_PRPSINFO,
   10618  1.1.1.5  christos 				 &data, sizeof (data));
   10619  1.1.1.5  christos     }
   10620  1.1.1.5  christos }
   10621  1.1.1.5  christos 
   10622  1.1.1.7  christos char *
   10623  1.1.1.7  christos elfcore_write_linux_prpsinfo64
   10624  1.1.1.7  christos   (bfd *abfd, char *buf, int *bufsiz,
   10625  1.1.1.5  christos    const struct elf_internal_linux_prpsinfo *prpsinfo)
   10626  1.1.1.7  christos {
   10627  1.1.1.7  christos   if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->linux_prpsinfo64_ugid16)
   10628  1.1.1.7  christos     {
   10629  1.1.1.7  christos       struct elf_external_linux_prpsinfo64_ugid16 data;
   10630  1.1.1.7  christos 
   10631  1.1.1.7  christos       swap_linux_prpsinfo64_ugid16_out (abfd, prpsinfo, &data);
   10632  1.1.1.7  christos       return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
   10633  1.1.1.7  christos 				 "CORE", NT_PRPSINFO, &data, sizeof (data));
   10634  1.1.1.7  christos     }
   10635  1.1.1.7  christos   else
   10636  1.1.1.7  christos     {
   10637  1.1.1.7  christos       struct elf_external_linux_prpsinfo64_ugid32 data;
   10638  1.1.1.5  christos 
   10639  1.1.1.5  christos       swap_linux_prpsinfo64_ugid32_out (abfd, prpsinfo, &data);
   10640  1.1.1.5  christos       return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
   10641      1.1     skrll 				 "CORE", NT_PRPSINFO, &data, sizeof (data));
   10642      1.1     skrll     }
   10643      1.1     skrll }
   10644      1.1     skrll 
   10645      1.1     skrll char *
   10646      1.1     skrll elfcore_write_prstatus (bfd *abfd,
   10647      1.1     skrll 			char *buf,
   10648      1.1     skrll 			int *bufsiz,
   10649      1.1     skrll 			long pid,
   10650      1.1     skrll 			int cursig,
   10651      1.1     skrll 			const void *gregs)
   10652      1.1     skrll {
   10653      1.1     skrll   const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   10654      1.1     skrll 
   10655      1.1     skrll   if (bed->elf_backend_write_core_note != NULL)
   10656      1.1     skrll     {
   10657      1.1     skrll       char *ret;
   10658      1.1     skrll       ret = (*bed->elf_backend_write_core_note) (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
   10659      1.1     skrll 						 NT_PRSTATUS,
   10660  1.1.1.4  christos 						 pid, cursig, gregs);
   10661      1.1     skrll       if (ret != NULL)
   10662      1.1     skrll 	return ret;
   10663      1.1     skrll     }
   10664      1.1     skrll 
   10665      1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T)
   10666      1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T)
   10667      1.1     skrll   if (bed->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS32)
   10668      1.1     skrll     {
   10669      1.1     skrll       prstatus32_t prstat;
   10670  1.1.1.4  christos 
   10671      1.1     skrll       memset (&prstat, 0, sizeof (prstat));
   10672      1.1     skrll       prstat.pr_pid = pid;
   10673      1.1     skrll       prstat.pr_cursig = cursig;
   10674      1.1     skrll       memcpy (&prstat.pr_reg, gregs, sizeof (prstat.pr_reg));
   10675      1.1     skrll       return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, "CORE",
   10676      1.1     skrll 				 NT_PRSTATUS, &prstat, sizeof (prstat));
   10677      1.1     skrll     }
   10678      1.1     skrll   else
   10679      1.1     skrll #endif
   10680      1.1     skrll     {
   10681      1.1     skrll       prstatus_t prstat;
   10682  1.1.1.4  christos 
   10683      1.1     skrll       memset (&prstat, 0, sizeof (prstat));
   10684      1.1     skrll       prstat.pr_pid = pid;
   10685      1.1     skrll       prstat.pr_cursig = cursig;
   10686      1.1     skrll       memcpy (&prstat.pr_reg, gregs, sizeof (prstat.pr_reg));
   10687  1.1.1.4  christos       return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, "CORE",
   10688  1.1.1.4  christos 				 NT_PRSTATUS, &prstat, sizeof (prstat));
   10689  1.1.1.4  christos     }
   10690  1.1.1.4  christos #endif /* HAVE_PRSTATUS_T */
   10691      1.1     skrll 
   10692      1.1     skrll   free (buf);
   10693      1.1     skrll   return NULL;
   10694      1.1     skrll }
   10695      1.1     skrll 
   10696      1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T)
   10697      1.1     skrll char *
   10698      1.1     skrll elfcore_write_lwpstatus (bfd *abfd,
   10699      1.1     skrll 			 char *buf,
   10700      1.1     skrll 			 int *bufsiz,
   10701      1.1     skrll 			 long pid,
   10702      1.1     skrll 			 int cursig,
   10703      1.1     skrll 			 const void *gregs)
   10704      1.1     skrll {
   10705      1.1     skrll   lwpstatus_t lwpstat;
   10706      1.1     skrll   const char *note_name = "CORE";
   10707  1.1.1.5  christos 
   10708      1.1     skrll   memset (&lwpstat, 0, sizeof (lwpstat));
   10709      1.1     skrll   lwpstat.pr_lwpid  = pid >> 16;
   10710      1.1     skrll   lwpstat.pr_cursig = cursig;
   10711      1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_REG)
   10712      1.1     skrll   memcpy (&lwpstat.pr_reg, gregs, sizeof (lwpstat.pr_reg));
   10713      1.1     skrll #elif defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_CONTEXT)
   10714      1.1     skrll #if !defined(gregs)
   10715      1.1     skrll   memcpy (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.gregs,
   10716      1.1     skrll 	  gregs, sizeof (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.gregs));
   10717      1.1     skrll #else
   10718      1.1     skrll   memcpy (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.__gregs,
   10719      1.1     skrll 	  gregs, sizeof (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.__gregs));
   10720      1.1     skrll #endif
   10721      1.1     skrll #endif
   10722      1.1     skrll   return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, note_name,
   10723      1.1     skrll 			     NT_LWPSTATUS, &lwpstat, sizeof (lwpstat));
   10724      1.1     skrll }
   10725      1.1     skrll #endif /* HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T */
   10726      1.1     skrll 
   10727      1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T)
   10728      1.1     skrll char *
   10729      1.1     skrll elfcore_write_pstatus (bfd *abfd,
   10730      1.1     skrll 		       char *buf,
   10731      1.1     skrll 		       int *bufsiz,
   10732      1.1     skrll 		       long pid,
   10733      1.1     skrll 		       int cursig ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
   10734      1.1     skrll 		       const void *gregs ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
   10735      1.1     skrll {
   10736      1.1     skrll   const char *note_name = "CORE";
   10737      1.1     skrll #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS32_T)
   10738      1.1     skrll   const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   10739      1.1     skrll 
   10740      1.1     skrll   if (bed->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS32)
   10741      1.1     skrll     {
   10742      1.1     skrll       pstatus32_t pstat;
   10743      1.1     skrll 
   10744      1.1     skrll       memset (&pstat, 0, sizeof (pstat));
   10745      1.1     skrll       pstat.pr_pid = pid & 0xffff;
   10746      1.1     skrll       buf = elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, note_name,
   10747      1.1     skrll 				NT_PSTATUS, &pstat, sizeof (pstat));
   10748      1.1     skrll       return buf;
   10749      1.1     skrll     }
   10750      1.1     skrll   else
   10751      1.1     skrll #endif
   10752      1.1     skrll     {
   10753      1.1     skrll       pstatus_t pstat;
   10754      1.1     skrll 
   10755      1.1     skrll       memset (&pstat, 0, sizeof (pstat));
   10756      1.1     skrll       pstat.pr_pid = pid & 0xffff;
   10757      1.1     skrll       buf = elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, note_name,
   10758      1.1     skrll 				NT_PSTATUS, &pstat, sizeof (pstat));
   10759      1.1     skrll       return buf;
   10760      1.1     skrll     }
   10761      1.1     skrll }
   10762      1.1     skrll #endif /* HAVE_PSTATUS_T */
   10763      1.1     skrll 
   10764      1.1     skrll char *
   10765      1.1     skrll elfcore_write_prfpreg (bfd *abfd,
   10766      1.1     skrll 		       char *buf,
   10767      1.1     skrll 		       int *bufsiz,
   10768      1.1     skrll 		       const void *fpregs,
   10769      1.1     skrll 		       int size)
   10770      1.1     skrll {
   10771      1.1     skrll   const char *note_name = "CORE";
   10772      1.1     skrll   return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
   10773      1.1     skrll 			     note_name, NT_FPREGSET, fpregs, size);
   10774      1.1     skrll }
   10775      1.1     skrll 
   10776      1.1     skrll char *
   10777      1.1     skrll elfcore_write_prxfpreg (bfd *abfd,
   10778      1.1     skrll 			char *buf,
   10779      1.1     skrll 			int *bufsiz,
   10780      1.1     skrll 			const void *xfpregs,
   10781      1.1     skrll 			int size)
   10782      1.1     skrll {
   10783      1.1     skrll   char *note_name = "LINUX";
   10784  1.1.1.3  christos   return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
   10785  1.1.1.3  christos 			     note_name, NT_PRXFPREG, xfpregs, size);
   10786  1.1.1.3  christos }
   10787  1.1.1.5  christos 
   10788  1.1.1.5  christos char *
   10789  1.1.1.5  christos elfcore_write_xstatereg (bfd *abfd, char *buf, int *bufsiz,
   10790  1.1.1.5  christos 			 const void *xfpregs, int size)
   10791  1.1.1.5  christos {
   10792  1.1.1.3  christos   char *note_name;
   10793  1.1.1.3  christos   if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_osabi == ELFOSABI_FREEBSD)
   10794  1.1.1.3  christos     note_name = "FreeBSD";
   10795  1.1.1.3  christos   else
   10796  1.1.1.3  christos     note_name = "LINUX";
   10797      1.1     skrll   return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
   10798      1.1     skrll 			     note_name, NT_X86_XSTATE, xfpregs, size);
   10799      1.1     skrll }
   10800      1.1     skrll 
   10801      1.1     skrll char *
   10802      1.1     skrll elfcore_write_ppc_vmx (bfd *abfd,
   10803      1.1     skrll 		       char *buf,
   10804      1.1     skrll 		       int *bufsiz,
   10805      1.1     skrll 		       const void *ppc_vmx,
   10806      1.1     skrll 		       int size)
   10807      1.1     skrll {
   10808      1.1     skrll   char *note_name = "LINUX";
   10809      1.1     skrll   return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
   10810  1.1.1.7  christos 			     note_name, NT_PPC_VMX, ppc_vmx, size);
   10811  1.1.1.7  christos }
   10812  1.1.1.7  christos 
   10813  1.1.1.7  christos char *
   10814      1.1     skrll elfcore_write_ppc_vsx (bfd *abfd,
   10815      1.1     skrll 		       char *buf,
   10816      1.1     skrll 		       int *bufsiz,
   10817  1.1.1.7  christos 		       const void *ppc_vsx,
   10818      1.1     skrll 		       int size)
   10819      1.1     skrll {
   10820  1.1.1.3  christos   char *note_name = "LINUX";
   10821  1.1.1.3  christos   return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
   10822  1.1.1.3  christos 			     note_name, NT_PPC_VSX, ppc_vsx, size);
   10823  1.1.1.3  christos }
   10824  1.1.1.3  christos 
   10825  1.1.1.3  christos static char *
   10826  1.1.1.3  christos elfcore_write_s390_high_gprs (bfd *abfd,
   10827  1.1.1.3  christos 			      char *buf,
   10828  1.1.1.3  christos 			      int *bufsiz,
   10829  1.1.1.7  christos 			      const void *s390_high_gprs,
   10830  1.1.1.3  christos 			      int size)
   10831  1.1.1.3  christos {
   10832  1.1.1.3  christos   char *note_name = "LINUX";
   10833  1.1.1.3  christos   return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
   10834  1.1.1.3  christos 			     note_name, NT_S390_HIGH_GPRS,
   10835  1.1.1.7  christos 			     s390_high_gprs, size);
   10836  1.1.1.7  christos }
   10837  1.1.1.7  christos 
   10838  1.1.1.7  christos char *
   10839  1.1.1.3  christos elfcore_write_s390_timer (bfd *abfd,
   10840  1.1.1.3  christos 			  char *buf,
   10841  1.1.1.3  christos 			  int *bufsiz,
   10842  1.1.1.7  christos 			  const void *s390_timer,
   10843  1.1.1.3  christos 			  int size)
   10844  1.1.1.3  christos {
   10845  1.1.1.3  christos   char *note_name = "LINUX";
   10846  1.1.1.3  christos   return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
   10847  1.1.1.7  christos 			     note_name, NT_S390_TIMER, s390_timer, size);
   10848  1.1.1.7  christos }
   10849  1.1.1.7  christos 
   10850  1.1.1.7  christos char *
   10851  1.1.1.3  christos elfcore_write_s390_todcmp (bfd *abfd,
   10852  1.1.1.3  christos 			   char *buf,
   10853  1.1.1.3  christos 			   int *bufsiz,
   10854  1.1.1.7  christos 			   const void *s390_todcmp,
   10855  1.1.1.3  christos 			   int size)
   10856  1.1.1.3  christos {
   10857  1.1.1.3  christos   char *note_name = "LINUX";
   10858  1.1.1.3  christos   return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
   10859  1.1.1.7  christos 			     note_name, NT_S390_TODCMP, s390_todcmp, size);
   10860  1.1.1.7  christos }
   10861  1.1.1.7  christos 
   10862  1.1.1.7  christos char *
   10863  1.1.1.3  christos elfcore_write_s390_todpreg (bfd *abfd,
   10864  1.1.1.3  christos 			    char *buf,
   10865  1.1.1.3  christos 			    int *bufsiz,
   10866  1.1.1.7  christos 			    const void *s390_todpreg,
   10867  1.1.1.3  christos 			    int size)
   10868  1.1.1.3  christos {
   10869  1.1.1.3  christos   char *note_name = "LINUX";
   10870  1.1.1.3  christos   return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
   10871  1.1.1.7  christos 			     note_name, NT_S390_TODPREG, s390_todpreg, size);
   10872  1.1.1.7  christos }
   10873  1.1.1.7  christos 
   10874  1.1.1.7  christos char *
   10875  1.1.1.3  christos elfcore_write_s390_ctrs (bfd *abfd,
   10876  1.1.1.3  christos 			 char *buf,
   10877  1.1.1.3  christos 			 int *bufsiz,
   10878  1.1.1.7  christos 			 const void *s390_ctrs,
   10879  1.1.1.3  christos 			 int size)
   10880  1.1.1.3  christos {
   10881  1.1.1.3  christos   char *note_name = "LINUX";
   10882  1.1.1.3  christos   return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
   10883  1.1.1.7  christos 			     note_name, NT_S390_CTRS, s390_ctrs, size);
   10884  1.1.1.7  christos }
   10885  1.1.1.7  christos 
   10886  1.1.1.7  christos char *
   10887  1.1.1.3  christos elfcore_write_s390_prefix (bfd *abfd,
   10888  1.1.1.3  christos 			   char *buf,
   10889  1.1.1.3  christos 			   int *bufsiz,
   10890  1.1.1.7  christos 			   const void *s390_prefix,
   10891  1.1.1.3  christos 			   int size)
   10892  1.1.1.3  christos {
   10893      1.1     skrll   char *note_name = "LINUX";
   10894  1.1.1.4  christos   return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
   10895  1.1.1.4  christos 			     note_name, NT_S390_PREFIX, s390_prefix, size);
   10896  1.1.1.4  christos }
   10897  1.1.1.4  christos 
   10898  1.1.1.4  christos char *
   10899  1.1.1.4  christos elfcore_write_s390_last_break (bfd *abfd,
   10900  1.1.1.4  christos 			       char *buf,
   10901  1.1.1.4  christos 			       int *bufsiz,
   10902  1.1.1.7  christos 			       const void *s390_last_break,
   10903  1.1.1.4  christos 			       int size)
   10904  1.1.1.4  christos {
   10905  1.1.1.4  christos   char *note_name = "LINUX";
   10906  1.1.1.4  christos   return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
   10907  1.1.1.4  christos 			     note_name, NT_S390_LAST_BREAK,
   10908  1.1.1.4  christos 			     s390_last_break, size);
   10909  1.1.1.4  christos }
   10910  1.1.1.4  christos 
   10911  1.1.1.4  christos char *
   10912  1.1.1.4  christos elfcore_write_s390_system_call (bfd *abfd,
   10913  1.1.1.4  christos 				char *buf,
   10914  1.1.1.4  christos 				int *bufsiz,
   10915  1.1.1.7  christos 				const void *s390_system_call,
   10916  1.1.1.4  christos 				int size)
   10917  1.1.1.4  christos {
   10918  1.1.1.4  christos   char *note_name = "LINUX";
   10919  1.1.1.4  christos   return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
   10920  1.1.1.5  christos 			     note_name, NT_S390_SYSTEM_CALL,
   10921  1.1.1.5  christos 			     s390_system_call, size);
   10922  1.1.1.5  christos }
   10923  1.1.1.5  christos 
   10924  1.1.1.5  christos char *
   10925  1.1.1.5  christos elfcore_write_s390_tdb (bfd *abfd,
   10926  1.1.1.5  christos 			char *buf,
   10927  1.1.1.5  christos 			int *bufsiz,
   10928  1.1.1.7  christos 			const void *s390_tdb,
   10929  1.1.1.5  christos 			int size)
   10930  1.1.1.5  christos {
   10931  1.1.1.5  christos   char *note_name = "LINUX";
   10932  1.1.1.5  christos   return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
   10933  1.1.1.5  christos 			     note_name, NT_S390_TDB, s390_tdb, size);
   10934  1.1.1.5  christos }
   10935  1.1.1.5  christos 
   10936  1.1.1.5  christos char *
   10937  1.1.1.5  christos elfcore_write_s390_vxrs_low (bfd *abfd,
   10938  1.1.1.5  christos 			     char *buf,
   10939  1.1.1.5  christos 			     int *bufsiz,
   10940  1.1.1.5  christos 			     const void *s390_vxrs_low,
   10941  1.1.1.5  christos 			     int size)
   10942  1.1.1.5  christos {
   10943  1.1.1.5  christos   char *note_name = "LINUX";
   10944  1.1.1.5  christos   return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
   10945  1.1.1.5  christos 			     note_name, NT_S390_VXRS_LOW, s390_vxrs_low, size);
   10946  1.1.1.5  christos }
   10947  1.1.1.5  christos 
   10948  1.1.1.5  christos char *
   10949  1.1.1.5  christos elfcore_write_s390_vxrs_high (bfd *abfd,
   10950  1.1.1.5  christos 			     char *buf,
   10951  1.1.1.5  christos 			     int *bufsiz,
   10952  1.1.1.5  christos 			     const void *s390_vxrs_high,
   10953  1.1.1.5  christos 			     int size)
   10954  1.1.1.5  christos {
   10955  1.1.1.5  christos   char *note_name = "LINUX";
   10956  1.1.1.5  christos   return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
   10957  1.1.1.7  christos 			     note_name, NT_S390_VXRS_HIGH,
   10958  1.1.1.7  christos 			     s390_vxrs_high, size);
   10959  1.1.1.7  christos }
   10960  1.1.1.7  christos 
   10961  1.1.1.7  christos char *
   10962  1.1.1.7  christos elfcore_write_s390_gs_cb (bfd *abfd,
   10963  1.1.1.7  christos 			  char *buf,
   10964  1.1.1.7  christos 			  int *bufsiz,
   10965  1.1.1.7  christos 			  const void *s390_gs_cb,
   10966  1.1.1.7  christos 			  int size)
   10967  1.1.1.7  christos {
   10968  1.1.1.7  christos   char *note_name = "LINUX";
   10969  1.1.1.7  christos   return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
   10970  1.1.1.7  christos 			     note_name, NT_S390_GS_CB,
   10971  1.1.1.7  christos 			     s390_gs_cb, size);
   10972  1.1.1.7  christos }
   10973  1.1.1.7  christos 
   10974  1.1.1.7  christos char *
   10975  1.1.1.7  christos elfcore_write_s390_gs_bc (bfd *abfd,
   10976  1.1.1.7  christos 			  char *buf,
   10977  1.1.1.7  christos 			  int *bufsiz,
   10978  1.1.1.7  christos 			  const void *s390_gs_bc,
   10979  1.1.1.7  christos 			  int size)
   10980  1.1.1.7  christos {
   10981  1.1.1.7  christos   char *note_name = "LINUX";
   10982  1.1.1.7  christos   return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
   10983  1.1.1.4  christos 			     note_name, NT_S390_GS_BC,
   10984  1.1.1.4  christos 			     s390_gs_bc, size);
   10985  1.1.1.4  christos }
   10986  1.1.1.4  christos 
   10987  1.1.1.4  christos char *
   10988  1.1.1.4  christos elfcore_write_arm_vfp (bfd *abfd,
   10989  1.1.1.4  christos 		       char *buf,
   10990  1.1.1.4  christos 		       int *bufsiz,
   10991  1.1.1.4  christos 		       const void *arm_vfp,
   10992  1.1.1.4  christos 		       int size)
   10993  1.1.1.4  christos {
   10994  1.1.1.4  christos   char *note_name = "LINUX";
   10995  1.1.1.5  christos   return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
   10996  1.1.1.5  christos 			     note_name, NT_ARM_VFP, arm_vfp, size);
   10997  1.1.1.5  christos }
   10998  1.1.1.5  christos 
   10999  1.1.1.5  christos char *
   11000  1.1.1.5  christos elfcore_write_aarch_tls (bfd *abfd,
   11001  1.1.1.5  christos 		       char *buf,
   11002  1.1.1.5  christos 		       int *bufsiz,
   11003  1.1.1.5  christos 		       const void *aarch_tls,
   11004  1.1.1.5  christos 		       int size)
   11005  1.1.1.5  christos {
   11006  1.1.1.5  christos   char *note_name = "LINUX";
   11007  1.1.1.5  christos   return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
   11008  1.1.1.5  christos 			     note_name, NT_ARM_TLS, aarch_tls, size);
   11009  1.1.1.5  christos }
   11010  1.1.1.5  christos 
   11011  1.1.1.5  christos char *
   11012  1.1.1.5  christos elfcore_write_aarch_hw_break (bfd *abfd,
   11013  1.1.1.5  christos 			    char *buf,
   11014  1.1.1.5  christos 			    int *bufsiz,
   11015  1.1.1.5  christos 			    const void *aarch_hw_break,
   11016  1.1.1.5  christos 			    int size)
   11017  1.1.1.5  christos {
   11018  1.1.1.5  christos   char *note_name = "LINUX";
   11019  1.1.1.5  christos   return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
   11020  1.1.1.5  christos 			     note_name, NT_ARM_HW_BREAK, aarch_hw_break, size);
   11021  1.1.1.5  christos }
   11022  1.1.1.5  christos 
   11023  1.1.1.5  christos char *
   11024  1.1.1.5  christos elfcore_write_aarch_hw_watch (bfd *abfd,
   11025  1.1.1.5  christos 			    char *buf,
   11026  1.1.1.5  christos 			    int *bufsiz,
   11027  1.1.1.5  christos 			    const void *aarch_hw_watch,
   11028  1.1.1.5  christos 			    int size)
   11029  1.1.1.5  christos {
   11030  1.1.1.5  christos   char *note_name = "LINUX";
   11031      1.1     skrll   return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
   11032      1.1     skrll 			     note_name, NT_ARM_HW_WATCH, aarch_hw_watch, size);
   11033      1.1     skrll }
   11034      1.1     skrll 
   11035      1.1     skrll char *
   11036      1.1     skrll elfcore_write_register_note (bfd *abfd,
   11037      1.1     skrll 			     char *buf,
   11038      1.1     skrll 			     int *bufsiz,
   11039      1.1     skrll 			     const char *section,
   11040      1.1     skrll 			     const void *data,
   11041      1.1     skrll 			     int size)
   11042  1.1.1.3  christos {
   11043  1.1.1.3  christos   if (strcmp (section, ".reg2") == 0)
   11044      1.1     skrll     return elfcore_write_prfpreg (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
   11045      1.1     skrll   if (strcmp (section, ".reg-xfp") == 0)
   11046      1.1     skrll     return elfcore_write_prxfpreg (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
   11047      1.1     skrll   if (strcmp (section, ".reg-xstate") == 0)
   11048  1.1.1.3  christos     return elfcore_write_xstatereg (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
   11049  1.1.1.3  christos   if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-vmx") == 0)
   11050  1.1.1.3  christos     return elfcore_write_ppc_vmx (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
   11051  1.1.1.3  christos   if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-vsx") == 0)
   11052  1.1.1.3  christos     return elfcore_write_ppc_vsx (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
   11053  1.1.1.3  christos   if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-high-gprs") == 0)
   11054  1.1.1.3  christos     return elfcore_write_s390_high_gprs (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
   11055  1.1.1.3  christos   if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-timer") == 0)
   11056  1.1.1.3  christos     return elfcore_write_s390_timer (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
   11057  1.1.1.3  christos   if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-todcmp") == 0)
   11058  1.1.1.3  christos     return elfcore_write_s390_todcmp (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
   11059  1.1.1.3  christos   if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-todpreg") == 0)
   11060  1.1.1.4  christos     return elfcore_write_s390_todpreg (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
   11061  1.1.1.4  christos   if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-ctrs") == 0)
   11062  1.1.1.4  christos     return elfcore_write_s390_ctrs (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
   11063  1.1.1.4  christos   if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-prefix") == 0)
   11064  1.1.1.5  christos     return elfcore_write_s390_prefix (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
   11065  1.1.1.5  christos   if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-last-break") == 0)
   11066  1.1.1.5  christos     return elfcore_write_s390_last_break (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
   11067  1.1.1.5  christos   if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-system-call") == 0)
   11068  1.1.1.5  christos     return elfcore_write_s390_system_call (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
   11069  1.1.1.5  christos   if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-tdb") == 0)
   11070  1.1.1.7  christos     return elfcore_write_s390_tdb (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
   11071  1.1.1.7  christos   if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-vxrs-low") == 0)
   11072  1.1.1.7  christos     return elfcore_write_s390_vxrs_low (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
   11073  1.1.1.7  christos   if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-vxrs-high") == 0)
   11074  1.1.1.4  christos     return elfcore_write_s390_vxrs_high (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
   11075  1.1.1.4  christos   if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-gs-cb") == 0)
   11076  1.1.1.5  christos     return elfcore_write_s390_gs_cb (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
   11077  1.1.1.5  christos   if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-gs-bc") == 0)
   11078  1.1.1.5  christos     return elfcore_write_s390_gs_bc (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
   11079  1.1.1.5  christos   if (strcmp (section, ".reg-arm-vfp") == 0)
   11080  1.1.1.5  christos     return elfcore_write_arm_vfp (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
   11081  1.1.1.5  christos   if (strcmp (section, ".reg-aarch-tls") == 0)
   11082      1.1     skrll     return elfcore_write_aarch_tls (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
   11083      1.1     skrll   if (strcmp (section, ".reg-aarch-hw-break") == 0)
   11084      1.1     skrll     return elfcore_write_aarch_hw_break (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
   11085      1.1     skrll   if (strcmp (section, ".reg-aarch-hw-watch") == 0)
   11086  1.1.1.7  christos     return elfcore_write_aarch_hw_watch (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
   11087  1.1.1.7  christos   return NULL;
   11088      1.1     skrll }
   11089      1.1     skrll 
   11090      1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   11091  1.1.1.7  christos elf_parse_notes (bfd *abfd, char *buf, size_t size, file_ptr offset,
   11092  1.1.1.7  christos 		 size_t align)
   11093  1.1.1.7  christos {
   11094  1.1.1.7  christos   char *p;
   11095  1.1.1.7  christos 
   11096  1.1.1.7  christos   /* NB: CORE PT_NOTE segments may have p_align values of 0 or 1.
   11097  1.1.1.8  christos      gABI specifies that PT_NOTE alignment should be aligned to 4
   11098  1.1.1.8  christos      bytes for 32-bit objects and to 8 bytes for 64-bit objects.  If
   11099  1.1.1.7  christos      align is less than 4, we use 4 byte alignment.   */
   11100      1.1     skrll   if (align < 4)
   11101      1.1     skrll     align = 4;
   11102      1.1     skrll   if (align != 4 && align != 8)
   11103      1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   11104      1.1     skrll 
   11105      1.1     skrll   p = buf;
   11106      1.1     skrll   while (p < buf + size)
   11107      1.1     skrll     {
   11108      1.1     skrll       Elf_External_Note *xnp = (Elf_External_Note *) p;
   11109      1.1     skrll       Elf_Internal_Note in;
   11110      1.1     skrll 
   11111      1.1     skrll       if (offsetof (Elf_External_Note, name) > buf - p + size)
   11112      1.1     skrll 	return FALSE;
   11113      1.1     skrll 
   11114      1.1     skrll       in.type = H_GET_32 (abfd, xnp->type);
   11115      1.1     skrll 
   11116      1.1     skrll       in.namesz = H_GET_32 (abfd, xnp->namesz);
   11117  1.1.1.7  christos       in.namedata = xnp->name;
   11118      1.1     skrll       if (in.namesz > buf - in.namedata + size)
   11119      1.1     skrll 	return FALSE;
   11120      1.1     skrll 
   11121      1.1     skrll       in.descsz = H_GET_32 (abfd, xnp->descsz);
   11122      1.1     skrll       in.descdata = p + ELF_NOTE_DESC_OFFSET (in.namesz, align);
   11123      1.1     skrll       in.descpos = offset + (in.descdata - buf);
   11124      1.1     skrll       if (in.descsz != 0
   11125  1.1.1.7  christos 	  && (in.descdata >= buf + size
   11126      1.1     skrll 	      || in.descsz > buf - in.descdata + size))
   11127      1.1     skrll 	return FALSE;
   11128      1.1     skrll 
   11129      1.1     skrll       switch (bfd_get_format (abfd))
   11130  1.1.1.5  christos 	{
   11131  1.1.1.5  christos 	default:
   11132  1.1.1.5  christos 	  return TRUE;
   11133      1.1     skrll 
   11134  1.1.1.5  christos 	case bfd_core:
   11135  1.1.1.5  christos 	  {
   11136  1.1.1.5  christos #define GROKER_ELEMENT(S,F) {S, sizeof (S) - 1, F}
   11137      1.1     skrll 	    struct
   11138  1.1.1.5  christos 	    {
   11139      1.1     skrll 	      const char * string;
   11140  1.1.1.5  christos 	      size_t len;
   11141  1.1.1.6  christos 	      bfd_boolean (* func)(bfd *, Elf_Internal_Note *);
   11142  1.1.1.5  christos 	    }
   11143  1.1.1.5  christos 	    grokers[] =
   11144  1.1.1.5  christos 	    {
   11145  1.1.1.5  christos 	      GROKER_ELEMENT ("", elfcore_grok_note),
   11146  1.1.1.5  christos 	      GROKER_ELEMENT ("FreeBSD", elfcore_grok_freebsd_note),
   11147  1.1.1.5  christos 	      GROKER_ELEMENT ("NetBSD-CORE", elfcore_grok_netbsd_note),
   11148  1.1.1.5  christos 	      GROKER_ELEMENT ( "OpenBSD", elfcore_grok_openbsd_note),
   11149  1.1.1.5  christos 	      GROKER_ELEMENT ("QNX", elfcore_grok_nto_note),
   11150  1.1.1.5  christos 	      GROKER_ELEMENT ("SPU/", elfcore_grok_spu_note)
   11151  1.1.1.5  christos 	    };
   11152  1.1.1.5  christos #undef GROKER_ELEMENT
   11153  1.1.1.5  christos 	    int i;
   11154  1.1.1.5  christos 
   11155  1.1.1.5  christos 	    for (i = ARRAY_SIZE (grokers); i--;)
   11156  1.1.1.5  christos 	      {
   11157  1.1.1.5  christos 		if (in.namesz >= grokers[i].len
   11158  1.1.1.5  christos 		    && strncmp (in.namedata, grokers[i].string,
   11159  1.1.1.5  christos 				grokers[i].len) == 0)
   11160  1.1.1.5  christos 		  {
   11161  1.1.1.5  christos 		    if (! grokers[i].func (abfd, & in))
   11162  1.1.1.5  christos 		      return FALSE;
   11163      1.1     skrll 		    break;
   11164      1.1     skrll 		  }
   11165      1.1     skrll 	      }
   11166      1.1     skrll 	    break;
   11167      1.1     skrll 	  }
   11168      1.1     skrll 
   11169      1.1     skrll 	case bfd_object:
   11170  1.1.1.4  christos 	  if (in.namesz == sizeof "GNU" && strcmp (in.namedata, "GNU") == 0)
   11171  1.1.1.4  christos 	    {
   11172  1.1.1.4  christos 	      if (! elfobj_grok_gnu_note (abfd, &in))
   11173  1.1.1.4  christos 		return FALSE;
   11174  1.1.1.4  christos 	    }
   11175  1.1.1.4  christos 	  else if (in.namesz == sizeof "stapsdt"
   11176      1.1     skrll 		   && strcmp (in.namedata, "stapsdt") == 0)
   11177      1.1     skrll 	    {
   11178      1.1     skrll 	      if (! elfobj_grok_stapsdt_note (abfd, &in))
   11179  1.1.1.7  christos 		return FALSE;
   11180      1.1     skrll 	    }
   11181      1.1     skrll 	  break;
   11182      1.1     skrll 	}
   11183      1.1     skrll 
   11184      1.1     skrll       p += ELF_NOTE_NEXT_OFFSET (in.namesz, in.descsz, align);
   11185      1.1     skrll     }
   11186  1.1.1.7  christos 
   11187  1.1.1.7  christos   return TRUE;
   11188      1.1     skrll }
   11189      1.1     skrll 
   11190      1.1     skrll static bfd_boolean
   11191  1.1.1.7  christos elf_read_notes (bfd *abfd, file_ptr offset, bfd_size_type size,
   11192      1.1     skrll 		size_t align)
   11193      1.1     skrll {
   11194      1.1     skrll   char *buf;
   11195      1.1     skrll 
   11196      1.1     skrll   if (size == 0 || (size + 1) == 0)
   11197  1.1.1.5  christos     return TRUE;
   11198      1.1     skrll 
   11199      1.1     skrll   if (bfd_seek (abfd, offset, SEEK_SET) != 0)
   11200      1.1     skrll     return FALSE;
   11201  1.1.1.5  christos 
   11202  1.1.1.5  christos   buf = (char *) bfd_malloc (size + 1);
   11203  1.1.1.5  christos   if (buf == NULL)
   11204  1.1.1.5  christos     return FALSE;
   11205      1.1     skrll 
   11206  1.1.1.7  christos   /* PR 17512: file: ec08f814
   11207      1.1     skrll      0-termintate the buffer so that string searches will not overflow.  */
   11208      1.1     skrll   buf[size] = 0;
   11209      1.1     skrll 
   11210      1.1     skrll   if (bfd_bread (buf, size, abfd) != size
   11211      1.1     skrll       || !elf_parse_notes (abfd, buf, size, offset, align))
   11212      1.1     skrll     {
   11213      1.1     skrll       free (buf);
   11214      1.1     skrll       return FALSE;
   11215      1.1     skrll     }
   11216      1.1     skrll 
   11217      1.1     skrll   free (buf);
   11218      1.1     skrll   return TRUE;
   11219      1.1     skrll }
   11220      1.1     skrll 
   11221      1.1     skrll /* Providing external access to the ELF program header table.  */
   11223      1.1     skrll 
   11224      1.1     skrll /* Return an upper bound on the number of bytes required to store a
   11225      1.1     skrll    copy of ABFD's program header table entries.  Return -1 if an error
   11226      1.1     skrll    occurs; bfd_get_error will return an appropriate code.  */
   11227      1.1     skrll 
   11228      1.1     skrll long
   11229      1.1     skrll bfd_get_elf_phdr_upper_bound (bfd *abfd)
   11230      1.1     skrll {
   11231      1.1     skrll   if (abfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
   11232      1.1     skrll     {
   11233      1.1     skrll       bfd_set_error (bfd_error_wrong_format);
   11234      1.1     skrll       return -1;
   11235      1.1     skrll     }
   11236      1.1     skrll 
   11237      1.1     skrll   return elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum * sizeof (Elf_Internal_Phdr);
   11238      1.1     skrll }
   11239      1.1     skrll 
   11240      1.1     skrll /* Copy ABFD's program header table entries to *PHDRS.  The entries
   11241      1.1     skrll    will be stored as an array of Elf_Internal_Phdr structures, as
   11242      1.1     skrll    defined in include/elf/internal.h.  To find out how large the
   11243      1.1     skrll    buffer needs to be, call bfd_get_elf_phdr_upper_bound.
   11244      1.1     skrll 
   11245      1.1     skrll    Return the number of program header table entries read, or -1 if an
   11246      1.1     skrll    error occurs; bfd_get_error will return an appropriate code.  */
   11247      1.1     skrll 
   11248      1.1     skrll int
   11249      1.1     skrll bfd_get_elf_phdrs (bfd *abfd, void *phdrs)
   11250      1.1     skrll {
   11251      1.1     skrll   int num_phdrs;
   11252      1.1     skrll 
   11253      1.1     skrll   if (abfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
   11254      1.1     skrll     {
   11255      1.1     skrll       bfd_set_error (bfd_error_wrong_format);
   11256      1.1     skrll       return -1;
   11257      1.1     skrll     }
   11258      1.1     skrll 
   11259      1.1     skrll   num_phdrs = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum;
   11260      1.1     skrll   memcpy (phdrs, elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr,
   11261  1.1.1.5  christos 	  num_phdrs * sizeof (Elf_Internal_Phdr));
   11262  1.1.1.5  christos 
   11263  1.1.1.5  christos   return num_phdrs;
   11264      1.1     skrll }
   11265      1.1     skrll 
   11266      1.1     skrll enum elf_reloc_type_class
   11267      1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_reloc_type_class (const struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
   11268      1.1     skrll 			   const asection *rel_sec ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
   11269      1.1     skrll 			   const Elf_Internal_Rela *rela ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
   11270      1.1     skrll {
   11271      1.1     skrll   return reloc_class_normal;
   11272      1.1     skrll }
   11273      1.1     skrll 
   11274      1.1     skrll /* For RELA architectures, return the relocation value for a
   11275      1.1     skrll    relocation against a local symbol.  */
   11276      1.1     skrll 
   11277      1.1     skrll bfd_vma
   11278      1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_rela_local_sym (bfd *abfd,
   11279      1.1     skrll 			 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
   11280      1.1     skrll 			 asection **psec,
   11281      1.1     skrll 			 Elf_Internal_Rela *rel)
   11282      1.1     skrll {
   11283      1.1     skrll   asection *sec = *psec;
   11284      1.1     skrll   bfd_vma relocation;
   11285  1.1.1.4  christos 
   11286      1.1     skrll   relocation = (sec->output_section->vma
   11287      1.1     skrll 		+ sec->output_offset
   11288      1.1     skrll 		+ sym->st_value);
   11289      1.1     skrll   if ((sec->flags & SEC_MERGE)
   11290      1.1     skrll       && ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_SECTION
   11291      1.1     skrll       && sec->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_MERGE)
   11292      1.1     skrll     {
   11293      1.1     skrll       rel->r_addend =
   11294      1.1     skrll 	_bfd_merged_section_offset (abfd, psec,
   11295      1.1     skrll 				    elf_section_data (sec)->sec_info,
   11296      1.1     skrll 				    sym->st_value + rel->r_addend);
   11297      1.1     skrll       if (sec != *psec)
   11298      1.1     skrll 	{
   11299      1.1     skrll 	  /* If we have changed the section, and our original section is
   11300      1.1     skrll 	     marked with SEC_EXCLUDE, it means that the original
   11301      1.1     skrll 	     SEC_MERGE section has been completely subsumed in some
   11302      1.1     skrll 	     other SEC_MERGE section.  In this case, we need to leave
   11303      1.1     skrll 	     some info around for --emit-relocs.  */
   11304      1.1     skrll 	  if ((sec->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) != 0)
   11305      1.1     skrll 	    sec->kept_section = *psec;
   11306      1.1     skrll 	  sec = *psec;
   11307      1.1     skrll 	}
   11308      1.1     skrll       rel->r_addend -= relocation;
   11309      1.1     skrll       rel->r_addend += sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
   11310      1.1     skrll     }
   11311      1.1     skrll   return relocation;
   11312      1.1     skrll }
   11313      1.1     skrll 
   11314      1.1     skrll bfd_vma
   11315      1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_rel_local_sym (bfd *abfd,
   11316  1.1.1.4  christos 			Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
   11317      1.1     skrll 			asection **psec,
   11318      1.1     skrll 			bfd_vma addend)
   11319      1.1     skrll {
   11320      1.1     skrll   asection *sec = *psec;
   11321      1.1     skrll 
   11322      1.1     skrll   if (sec->sec_info_type != SEC_INFO_TYPE_MERGE)
   11323      1.1     skrll     return sym->st_value + addend;
   11324  1.1.1.6  christos 
   11325  1.1.1.6  christos   return _bfd_merged_section_offset (abfd, psec,
   11326  1.1.1.6  christos 				     elf_section_data (sec)->sec_info,
   11327  1.1.1.6  christos 				     sym->st_value + addend);
   11328  1.1.1.6  christos }
   11329  1.1.1.6  christos 
   11330      1.1     skrll /* Adjust an address within a section.  Given OFFSET within SEC, return
   11331      1.1     skrll    the new offset within the section, based upon changes made to the
   11332      1.1     skrll    section.  Returns -1 if the offset is now invalid.
   11333      1.1     skrll    The offset (in abnd out) is in target sized bytes, however big a
   11334      1.1     skrll    byte may be.  */
   11335      1.1     skrll 
   11336      1.1     skrll bfd_vma
   11337      1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_section_offset (bfd *abfd,
   11338  1.1.1.4  christos 			 struct bfd_link_info *info,
   11339      1.1     skrll 			 asection *sec,
   11340      1.1     skrll 			 bfd_vma offset)
   11341  1.1.1.4  christos {
   11342      1.1     skrll   switch (sec->sec_info_type)
   11343  1.1.1.6  christos     {
   11344      1.1     skrll     case SEC_INFO_TYPE_STABS:
   11345  1.1.1.4  christos       return _bfd_stab_section_offset (sec, elf_section_data (sec)->sec_info,
   11346  1.1.1.4  christos 				       offset);
   11347  1.1.1.6  christos     case SEC_INFO_TYPE_EH_FRAME:
   11348  1.1.1.4  christos       return _bfd_elf_eh_frame_section_offset (abfd, info, sec, offset);
   11349  1.1.1.4  christos 
   11350  1.1.1.6  christos     default:
   11351  1.1.1.6  christos       if ((sec->flags & SEC_ELF_REVERSE_COPY) != 0)
   11352  1.1.1.6  christos 	{
   11353  1.1.1.6  christos 	  /* Reverse the offset.  */
   11354  1.1.1.4  christos 	  const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   11355      1.1     skrll 	  bfd_size_type address_size = bed->s->arch_size / 8;
   11356      1.1     skrll 
   11357      1.1     skrll 	  /* address_size and sec->size are in octets.  Convert
   11358      1.1     skrll 	     to bytes before subtracting the original offset.  */
   11359      1.1     skrll 	  offset = (sec->size - address_size) / bfd_octets_per_byte (abfd) - offset;
   11360      1.1     skrll 	}
   11361      1.1     skrll       return offset;
   11362      1.1     skrll     }
   11363      1.1     skrll }
   11364      1.1     skrll 
   11365      1.1     skrll /* Create a new BFD as if by bfd_openr.  Rather than opening a file,
   11367      1.1     skrll    reconstruct an ELF file by reading the segments out of remote memory
   11368      1.1     skrll    based on the ELF file header at EHDR_VMA and the ELF program headers it
   11369      1.1     skrll    points to.  If not null, *LOADBASEP is filled in with the difference
   11370      1.1     skrll    between the VMAs from which the segments were read, and the VMAs the
   11371      1.1     skrll    file headers (and hence BFD's idea of each section's VMA) put them at.
   11372      1.1     skrll 
   11373      1.1     skrll    The function TARGET_READ_MEMORY is called to copy LEN bytes from the
   11374      1.1     skrll    remote memory at target address VMA into the local buffer at MYADDR; it
   11375      1.1     skrll    should return zero on success or an `errno' code on failure.  TEMPL must
   11376  1.1.1.5  christos    be a BFD for an ELF target with the word size and byte order found in
   11377      1.1     skrll    the remote memory.  */
   11378  1.1.1.4  christos 
   11379      1.1     skrll bfd *
   11380      1.1     skrll bfd_elf_bfd_from_remote_memory
   11381  1.1.1.5  christos   (bfd *templ,
   11382      1.1     skrll    bfd_vma ehdr_vma,
   11383      1.1     skrll    bfd_size_type size,
   11384      1.1     skrll    bfd_vma *loadbasep,
   11385      1.1     skrll    int (*target_read_memory) (bfd_vma, bfd_byte *, bfd_size_type))
   11386      1.1     skrll {
   11387      1.1     skrll   return (*get_elf_backend_data (templ)->elf_backend_bfd_from_remote_memory)
   11388      1.1     skrll     (templ, ehdr_vma, size, loadbasep, target_read_memory);
   11389      1.1     skrll }
   11390      1.1     skrll 
   11391      1.1     skrll long
   11393      1.1     skrll _bfd_elf_get_synthetic_symtab (bfd *abfd,
   11394      1.1     skrll 			       long symcount ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
   11395      1.1     skrll 			       asymbol **syms ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
   11396      1.1     skrll 			       long dynsymcount,
   11397      1.1     skrll 			       asymbol **dynsyms,
   11398      1.1     skrll 			       asymbol **ret)
   11399      1.1     skrll {
   11400      1.1     skrll   const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
   11401      1.1     skrll   asection *relplt;
   11402      1.1     skrll   asymbol *s;
   11403      1.1     skrll   const char *relplt_name;
   11404      1.1     skrll   bfd_boolean (*slurp_relocs) (bfd *, asection *, asymbol **, bfd_boolean);
   11405      1.1     skrll   arelent *p;
   11406      1.1     skrll   long count, i, n;
   11407      1.1     skrll   size_t size;
   11408      1.1     skrll   Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
   11409      1.1     skrll   char *names;
   11410      1.1     skrll   asection *plt;
   11411      1.1     skrll 
   11412      1.1     skrll   *ret = NULL;
   11413      1.1     skrll 
   11414      1.1     skrll   if ((abfd->flags & (DYNAMIC | EXEC_P)) == 0)
   11415      1.1     skrll     return 0;
   11416      1.1     skrll 
   11417      1.1     skrll   if (dynsymcount <= 0)
   11418      1.1     skrll     return 0;
   11419      1.1     skrll 
   11420      1.1     skrll   if (!bed->plt_sym_val)
   11421      1.1     skrll     return 0;
   11422      1.1     skrll 
   11423      1.1     skrll   relplt_name = bed->relplt_name;
   11424      1.1     skrll   if (relplt_name == NULL)
   11425      1.1     skrll     relplt_name = bed->rela_plts_and_copies_p ? ".rela.plt" : ".rel.plt";
   11426      1.1     skrll   relplt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, relplt_name);
   11427      1.1     skrll   if (relplt == NULL)
   11428      1.1     skrll     return 0;
   11429      1.1     skrll 
   11430      1.1     skrll   hdr = &elf_section_data (relplt)->this_hdr;
   11431      1.1     skrll   if (hdr->sh_link != elf_dynsymtab (abfd)
   11432      1.1     skrll       || (hdr->sh_type != SHT_REL && hdr->sh_type != SHT_RELA))
   11433      1.1     skrll     return 0;
   11434      1.1     skrll 
   11435      1.1     skrll   plt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".plt");
   11436      1.1     skrll   if (plt == NULL)
   11437      1.1     skrll     return 0;
   11438      1.1     skrll 
   11439  1.1.1.3  christos   slurp_relocs = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->slurp_reloc_table;
   11440  1.1.1.3  christos   if (! (*slurp_relocs) (abfd, relplt, dynsyms, TRUE))
   11441  1.1.1.3  christos     return -1;
   11442  1.1.1.3  christos 
   11443  1.1.1.3  christos   count = relplt->size / hdr->sh_entsize;
   11444  1.1.1.3  christos   size = count * sizeof (asymbol);
   11445  1.1.1.3  christos   p = relplt->relocation;
   11446  1.1.1.3  christos   for (i = 0; i < count; i++, p += bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel)
   11447  1.1.1.3  christos     {
   11448  1.1.1.3  christos       size += strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name) + sizeof ("@plt");
   11449  1.1.1.3  christos       if (p->addend != 0)
   11450      1.1     skrll 	{
   11451  1.1.1.3  christos #ifdef BFD64
   11452      1.1     skrll 	  size += sizeof ("+0x") - 1 + 8 + 8 * (bed->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS64);
   11453      1.1     skrll #else
   11454      1.1     skrll 	  size += sizeof ("+0x") - 1 + 8;
   11455      1.1     skrll #endif
   11456      1.1     skrll 	}
   11457      1.1     skrll     }
   11458      1.1     skrll 
   11459      1.1     skrll   s = *ret = (asymbol *) bfd_malloc (size);
   11460      1.1     skrll   if (s == NULL)
   11461      1.1     skrll     return -1;
   11462      1.1     skrll 
   11463      1.1     skrll   names = (char *) (s + count);
   11464      1.1     skrll   p = relplt->relocation;
   11465      1.1     skrll   n = 0;
   11466      1.1     skrll   for (i = 0; i < count; i++, p += bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel)
   11467      1.1     skrll     {
   11468      1.1     skrll       size_t len;
   11469      1.1     skrll       bfd_vma addr;
   11470      1.1     skrll 
   11471      1.1     skrll       addr = bed->plt_sym_val (i, plt, p);
   11472      1.1     skrll       if (addr == (bfd_vma) -1)
   11473      1.1     skrll 	continue;
   11474      1.1     skrll 
   11475      1.1     skrll       *s = **p->sym_ptr_ptr;
   11476      1.1     skrll       /* Undefined syms won't have BSF_LOCAL or BSF_GLOBAL set.  Since
   11477      1.1     skrll 	 we are defining a symbol, ensure one of them is set.  */
   11478      1.1     skrll       if ((s->flags & BSF_LOCAL) == 0)
   11479      1.1     skrll 	s->flags |= BSF_GLOBAL;
   11480  1.1.1.3  christos       s->flags |= BSF_SYNTHETIC;
   11481  1.1.1.3  christos       s->section = plt;
   11482  1.1.1.3  christos       s->value = addr - plt->vma;
   11483  1.1.1.4  christos       s->name = names;
   11484  1.1.1.3  christos       s->udata.p = NULL;
   11485  1.1.1.3  christos       len = strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name);
   11486  1.1.1.3  christos       memcpy (names, (*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name, len);
   11487  1.1.1.3  christos       names += len;
   11488  1.1.1.3  christos       if (p->addend != 0)
   11489  1.1.1.3  christos 	{
   11490  1.1.1.3  christos 	  char buf[30], *a;
   11491  1.1.1.3  christos 
   11492  1.1.1.3  christos 	  memcpy (names, "+0x", sizeof ("+0x") - 1);
   11493      1.1     skrll 	  names += sizeof ("+0x") - 1;
   11494      1.1     skrll 	  bfd_sprintf_vma (abfd, buf, p->addend);
   11495      1.1     skrll 	  for (a = buf; *a == '0'; ++a)
   11496      1.1     skrll 	    ;
   11497      1.1     skrll 	  len = strlen (a);
   11498      1.1     skrll 	  memcpy (names, a, len);
   11499      1.1     skrll 	  names += len;
   11500      1.1     skrll 	}
   11501  1.1.1.7  christos       memcpy (names, "@plt", sizeof ("@plt"));
   11502  1.1.1.7  christos       names += sizeof ("@plt");
   11503  1.1.1.7  christos       ++s, ++n;
   11504  1.1.1.7  christos     }
   11505  1.1.1.7  christos 
   11506      1.1     skrll   return n;
   11507  1.1.1.7  christos }
   11508  1.1.1.7  christos 
   11509      1.1     skrll /* It is only used by x86-64 so far.
   11510      1.1     skrll    ??? This repeats *COM* id of zero.  sec->id is supposed to be unique,
   11511  1.1.1.5  christos    but current usage would allow all of _bfd_std_section to be zero.  */
   11512  1.1.1.5  christos static const asymbol lcomm_sym
   11513      1.1     skrll   = GLOBAL_SYM_INIT ("LARGE_COMMON", &_bfd_elf_large_com_section);
   11514      1.1     skrll asection _bfd_elf_large_com_section
   11515      1.1     skrll   = BFD_FAKE_SECTION (_bfd_elf_large_com_section, &lcomm_sym,
   11516      1.1     skrll 		      "LARGE_COMMON", 0, SEC_IS_COMMON);
   11517      1.1     skrll 
   11518      1.1     skrll void
   11519  1.1.1.3  christos _bfd_elf_post_process_headers (bfd * abfd,
   11520  1.1.1.3  christos 			       struct bfd_link_info * link_info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
   11521  1.1.1.4  christos {
   11522  1.1.1.3  christos   Elf_Internal_Ehdr * i_ehdrp;	/* ELF file header, internal form.  */
   11523  1.1.1.3  christos 
   11524  1.1.1.3  christos   i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (abfd);
   11525  1.1.1.4  christos 
   11526      1.1     skrll   i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_OSABI] = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_osabi;
   11527      1.1     skrll 
   11528      1.1     skrll   /* To make things simpler for the loader on Linux systems we set the
   11529      1.1     skrll      osabi field to ELFOSABI_GNU if the binary contains symbols of
   11530      1.1     skrll      the STT_GNU_IFUNC type or STB_GNU_UNIQUE binding.  */
   11531  1.1.1.3  christos   if (i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_OSABI] == ELFOSABI_NONE
   11532      1.1     skrll       && elf_tdata (abfd)->has_gnu_symbols)
   11533      1.1     skrll     i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_OSABI] = ELFOSABI_GNU;
   11534      1.1     skrll }
   11535      1.1     skrll 
   11536  1.1.1.3  christos 
   11537  1.1.1.3  christos /* Return TRUE for ELF symbol types that represent functions.
   11538      1.1     skrll    This is the default version of this function, which is sufficient for
   11539  1.1.1.4  christos    most targets.  It returns true if TYPE is STT_FUNC or STT_GNU_IFUNC.  */
   11540  1.1.1.4  christos 
   11541  1.1.1.4  christos bfd_boolean
   11542  1.1.1.4  christos _bfd_elf_is_function_type (unsigned int type)
   11543  1.1.1.4  christos {
   11544  1.1.1.4  christos   return (type == STT_FUNC
   11545  1.1.1.4  christos 	  || type == STT_GNU_IFUNC);
   11546  1.1.1.4  christos }
   11547  1.1.1.4  christos 
   11548  1.1.1.4  christos /* If the ELF symbol SYM might be a function in SEC, return the
   11549  1.1.1.4  christos    function size and set *CODE_OFF to the function's entry point,
   11550  1.1.1.4  christos    otherwise return zero.  */
   11551  1.1.1.4  christos 
   11552  1.1.1.4  christos bfd_size_type
   11553  1.1.1.4  christos _bfd_elf_maybe_function_sym (const asymbol *sym, asection *sec,
   11554  1.1.1.4  christos 			     bfd_vma *code_off)
   11555  1.1.1.4  christos {
   11556  1.1.1.4  christos   bfd_size_type size;
   11557  1.1.1.4  christos 
   11558  1.1.1.4  christos   if ((sym->flags & (BSF_SECTION_SYM | BSF_FILE | BSF_OBJECT
   11559  1.1.1.4  christos 		     | BSF_THREAD_LOCAL | BSF_RELC | BSF_SRELC)) != 0
   11560  1.1.1.4  christos       || sym->section != sec)
   11561  1.1.1.4  christos     return 0;
   11562  1.1.1.4  christos 
   11563                      *code_off = sym->value;
   11564                      size = 0;
   11565                      if (!(sym->flags & BSF_SYNTHETIC))
   11566                        size = ((elf_symbol_type *) sym)->internal_elf_sym.st_size;
   11567                      if (size == 0)
   11568                        size = 1;
   11569                      return size;
   11570                    }
   11571